Add desktop support for restoring vc-dir buffers (bug#10606)
[emacs.git] / src / xdisp.c
blob3b19d5d14d419b7479d8a1bcf0d7352b339ce141
1 /* Display generation from window structure and buffer text.
3 Copyright (C) 1985-1988, 1993-1995, 1997-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New redisplay written by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>.
22 Redisplay.
24 Emacs separates the task of updating the display from code
25 modifying global state, e.g. buffer text. This way functions
26 operating on buffers don't also have to be concerned with updating
27 the display.
29 Updating the display is triggered by the Lisp interpreter when it
30 decides it's time to do it. This is done either automatically for
31 you as part of the interpreter's command loop or as the result of
32 calling Lisp functions like `sit-for'. The C function `redisplay'
33 in xdisp.c is the only entry into the inner redisplay code.
35 The following diagram shows how redisplay code is invoked. As you
36 can see, Lisp calls redisplay and vice versa. Under window systems
37 like X, some portions of the redisplay code are also called
38 asynchronously during mouse movement or expose events. It is very
39 important that these code parts do NOT use the C library (malloc,
40 free) because many C libraries under Unix are not reentrant. They
41 may also NOT call functions of the Lisp interpreter which could
42 change the interpreter's state. If you don't follow these rules,
43 you will encounter bugs which are very hard to explain.
45 +--------------+ redisplay +----------------+
46 | Lisp machine |---------------->| Redisplay code |<--+
47 +--------------+ (xdisp.c) +----------------+ |
48 ^ | |
49 +----------------------------------+ |
50 Don't use this path when called |
51 asynchronously! |
53 expose_window (asynchronous) |
55 X expose events -----+
57 What does redisplay do? Obviously, it has to figure out somehow what
58 has been changed since the last time the display has been updated,
59 and to make these changes visible. Preferably it would do that in
60 a moderately intelligent way, i.e. fast.
62 Changes in buffer text can be deduced from window and buffer
63 structures, and from some global variables like `beg_unchanged' and
64 `end_unchanged'. The contents of the display are additionally
65 recorded in a `glyph matrix', a two-dimensional matrix of glyph
66 structures. Each row in such a matrix corresponds to a line on the
67 display, and each glyph in a row corresponds to a column displaying
68 a character, an image, or what else. This matrix is called the
69 `current glyph matrix' or `current matrix' in redisplay
70 terminology.
72 For buffer parts that have been changed since the last update, a
73 second glyph matrix is constructed, the so called `desired glyph
74 matrix' or short `desired matrix'. Current and desired matrix are
75 then compared to find a cheap way to update the display, e.g. by
76 reusing part of the display by scrolling lines.
78 You will find a lot of redisplay optimizations when you start
79 looking at the innards of redisplay. The overall goal of all these
80 optimizations is to make redisplay fast because it is done
81 frequently. Some of these optimizations are implemented by the
82 following functions:
84 . try_cursor_movement
86 This function tries to update the display if the text in the
87 window did not change and did not scroll, only point moved, and
88 it did not move off the displayed portion of the text.
90 . try_window_reusing_current_matrix
92 This function reuses the current matrix of a window when text
93 has not changed, but the window start changed (e.g., due to
94 scrolling).
96 . try_window_id
98 This function attempts to redisplay a window by reusing parts of
99 its existing display. It finds and reuses the part that was not
100 changed, and redraws the rest.
102 . try_window
104 This function performs the full redisplay of a single window
105 assuming that its fonts were not changed and that the cursor
106 will not end up in the scroll margins. (Loading fonts requires
107 re-adjustment of dimensions of glyph matrices, which makes this
108 method impossible to use.)
110 These optimizations are tried in sequence (some can be skipped if
111 it is known that they are not applicable). If none of the
112 optimizations were successful, redisplay calls redisplay_windows,
113 which performs a full redisplay of all windows.
115 Desired matrices.
117 Desired matrices are always built per Emacs window. The function
118 `display_line' is the central function to look at if you are
119 interested. It constructs one row in a desired matrix given an
120 iterator structure containing both a buffer position and a
121 description of the environment in which the text is to be
122 displayed. But this is too early, read on.
124 Characters and pixmaps displayed for a range of buffer text depend
125 on various settings of buffers and windows, on overlays and text
126 properties, on display tables, on selective display. The good news
127 is that all this hairy stuff is hidden behind a small set of
128 interface functions taking an iterator structure (struct it)
129 argument.
131 Iteration over things to be displayed is then simple. It is
132 started by initializing an iterator with a call to init_iterator,
133 passing it the buffer position where to start iteration. For
134 iteration over strings, pass -1 as the position to init_iterator,
135 and call reseat_to_string when the string is ready, to initialize
136 the iterator for that string. Thereafter, calls to
137 get_next_display_element fill the iterator structure with relevant
138 information about the next thing to display. Calls to
139 set_iterator_to_next move the iterator to the next thing.
141 Besides this, an iterator also contains information about the
142 display environment in which glyphs for display elements are to be
143 produced. It has fields for the width and height of the display,
144 the information whether long lines are truncated or continued, a
145 current X and Y position, and lots of other stuff you can better
146 see in dispextern.h.
148 Glyphs in a desired matrix are normally constructed in a loop
149 calling get_next_display_element and then PRODUCE_GLYPHS. The call
150 to PRODUCE_GLYPHS will fill the iterator structure with pixel
151 information about the element being displayed and at the same time
152 produce glyphs for it. If the display element fits on the line
153 being displayed, set_iterator_to_next is called next, otherwise the
154 glyphs produced are discarded. The function display_line is the
155 workhorse of filling glyph rows in the desired matrix with glyphs.
156 In addition to producing glyphs, it also handles line truncation
157 and continuation, word wrap, and cursor positioning (for the
158 latter, see also set_cursor_from_row).
160 Frame matrices.
162 That just couldn't be all, could it? What about terminal types not
163 supporting operations on sub-windows of the screen? To update the
164 display on such a terminal, window-based glyph matrices are not
165 well suited. To be able to reuse part of the display (scrolling
166 lines up and down), we must instead have a view of the whole
167 screen. This is what `frame matrices' are for. They are a trick.
169 Frames on terminals like above have a glyph pool. Windows on such
170 a frame sub-allocate their glyph memory from their frame's glyph
171 pool. The frame itself is given its own glyph matrices. By
172 coincidence---or maybe something else---rows in window glyph
173 matrices are slices of corresponding rows in frame matrices. Thus
174 writing to window matrices implicitly updates a frame matrix which
175 provides us with the view of the whole screen that we originally
176 wanted to have without having to move many bytes around. To be
177 honest, there is a little bit more done, but not much more. If you
178 plan to extend that code, take a look at dispnew.c. The function
179 build_frame_matrix is a good starting point.
181 Bidirectional display.
183 Bidirectional display adds quite some hair to this already complex
184 design. The good news are that a large portion of that hairy stuff
185 is hidden in bidi.c behind only 3 interfaces. bidi.c implements a
186 reordering engine which is called by set_iterator_to_next and
187 returns the next character to display in the visual order. See
188 commentary on bidi.c for more details. As far as redisplay is
189 concerned, the effect of calling bidi_move_to_visually_next, the
190 main interface of the reordering engine, is that the iterator gets
191 magically placed on the buffer or string position that is to be
192 displayed next. In other words, a linear iteration through the
193 buffer/string is replaced with a non-linear one. All the rest of
194 the redisplay is oblivious to the bidi reordering.
196 Well, almost oblivious---there are still complications, most of
197 them due to the fact that buffer and string positions no longer
198 change monotonously with glyph indices in a glyph row. Moreover,
199 for continued lines, the buffer positions may not even be
200 monotonously changing with vertical positions. Also, accounting
201 for face changes, overlays, etc. becomes more complex because
202 non-linear iteration could potentially skip many positions with
203 changes, and then cross them again on the way back...
205 One other prominent effect of bidirectional display is that some
206 paragraphs of text need to be displayed starting at the right
207 margin of the window---the so-called right-to-left, or R2L
208 paragraphs. R2L paragraphs are displayed with R2L glyph rows,
209 which have their reversed_p flag set. The bidi reordering engine
210 produces characters in such rows starting from the character which
211 should be the rightmost on display. PRODUCE_GLYPHS then reverses
212 the order, when it fills up the glyph row whose reversed_p flag is
213 set, by prepending each new glyph to what is already there, instead
214 of appending it. When the glyph row is complete, the function
215 extend_face_to_end_of_line fills the empty space to the left of the
216 leftmost character with special glyphs, which will display as,
217 well, empty. On text terminals, these special glyphs are simply
218 blank characters. On graphics terminals, there's a single stretch
219 glyph of a suitably computed width. Both the blanks and the
220 stretch glyph are given the face of the background of the line.
221 This way, the terminal-specific back-end can still draw the glyphs
222 left to right, even for R2L lines.
224 Bidirectional display and character compositions
226 Some scripts cannot be displayed by drawing each character
227 individually, because adjacent characters change each other's shape
228 on display. For example, Arabic and Indic scripts belong to this
229 category.
231 Emacs display supports this by providing "character compositions",
232 most of which is implemented in composite.c. During the buffer
233 scan that delivers characters to PRODUCE_GLYPHS, if the next
234 character to be delivered is a composed character, the iteration
235 calls composition_reseat_it and next_element_from_composition. If
236 they succeed to compose the character with one or more of the
237 following characters, the whole sequence of characters that where
238 composed is recorded in the `struct composition_it' object that is
239 part of the buffer iterator. The composed sequence could produce
240 one or more font glyphs (called "grapheme clusters") on the screen.
241 Each of these grapheme clusters is then delivered to PRODUCE_GLYPHS
242 in the direction corresponding to the current bidi scan direction
243 (recorded in the scan_dir member of the `struct bidi_it' object
244 that is part of the buffer iterator). In particular, if the bidi
245 iterator currently scans the buffer backwards, the grapheme
246 clusters are delivered back to front. This reorders the grapheme
247 clusters as appropriate for the current bidi context. Note that
248 this means that the grapheme clusters are always stored in the
249 LGSTRING object (see composite.c) in the logical order.
251 Moving an iterator in bidirectional text
252 without producing glyphs
254 Note one important detail mentioned above: that the bidi reordering
255 engine, driven by the iterator, produces characters in R2L rows
256 starting at the character that will be the rightmost on display.
257 As far as the iterator is concerned, the geometry of such rows is
258 still left to right, i.e. the iterator "thinks" the first character
259 is at the leftmost pixel position. The iterator does not know that
260 PRODUCE_GLYPHS reverses the order of the glyphs that the iterator
261 delivers. This is important when functions from the move_it_*
262 family are used to get to certain screen position or to match
263 screen coordinates with buffer coordinates: these functions use the
264 iterator geometry, which is left to right even in R2L paragraphs.
265 This works well with most callers of move_it_*, because they need
266 to get to a specific column, and columns are still numbered in the
267 reading order, i.e. the rightmost character in a R2L paragraph is
268 still column zero. But some callers do not get well with this; a
269 notable example is mouse clicks that need to find the character
270 that corresponds to certain pixel coordinates. See
271 buffer_posn_from_coords in dispnew.c for how this is handled. */
273 #include <config.h>
274 #include <stdio.h>
275 #include <limits.h>
277 #include "lisp.h"
278 #include "atimer.h"
279 #include "keyboard.h"
280 #include "frame.h"
281 #include "window.h"
282 #include "termchar.h"
283 #include "dispextern.h"
284 #include "character.h"
285 #include "buffer.h"
286 #include "charset.h"
287 #include "indent.h"
288 #include "commands.h"
289 #include "keymap.h"
290 #include "macros.h"
291 #include "disptab.h"
292 #include "termhooks.h"
293 #include "termopts.h"
294 #include "intervals.h"
295 #include "coding.h"
296 #include "process.h"
297 #include "region-cache.h"
298 #include "font.h"
299 #include "fontset.h"
300 #include "blockinput.h"
302 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
303 #include "xterm.h"
304 #endif
305 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
306 #include "w32term.h"
307 #endif
308 #ifdef HAVE_NS
309 #include "nsterm.h"
310 #endif
311 #ifdef USE_GTK
312 #include "gtkutil.h"
313 #endif
315 #include "font.h"
317 #ifndef FRAME_X_OUTPUT
318 #define FRAME_X_OUTPUT(f) ((f)->output_data.x)
319 #endif
321 #define INFINITY 10000000
323 Lisp_Object Qoverriding_local_map, Qoverriding_terminal_local_map;
324 Lisp_Object Qwindow_scroll_functions;
325 static Lisp_Object Qwindow_text_change_functions;
326 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
327 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks;
328 static Lisp_Object QCeval, QCpropertize;
329 Lisp_Object QCfile, QCdata;
330 static Lisp_Object Qfontified;
331 static Lisp_Object Qgrow_only;
332 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay;
333 static Lisp_Object Qbuffer_position, Qposition, Qobject;
334 static Lisp_Object Qright_to_left, Qleft_to_right;
336 /* Cursor shapes. */
337 Lisp_Object Qbar, Qhbar, Qbox, Qhollow;
339 /* Pointer shapes. */
340 static Lisp_Object Qarrow, Qhand;
341 Lisp_Object Qtext;
343 /* Holds the list (error). */
344 static Lisp_Object list_of_error;
346 static Lisp_Object Qfontification_functions;
348 static Lisp_Object Qwrap_prefix;
349 static Lisp_Object Qline_prefix;
350 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_internal;
352 /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay. */
354 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_redisplay;
356 /* Names of text properties relevant for redisplay. */
358 Lisp_Object Qdisplay;
360 Lisp_Object Qspace, QCalign_to;
361 static Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
362 Lisp_Object Qleft_margin, Qright_margin;
363 static Lisp_Object Qspace_width, Qraise;
364 static Lisp_Object Qslice;
365 Lisp_Object Qcenter;
366 static Lisp_Object Qmargin, Qpointer;
367 static Lisp_Object Qline_height;
369 /* These setters are used only in this file, so they can be private. */
370 static void
371 wset_base_line_number (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
373 w->base_line_number = val;
375 static void
376 wset_base_line_pos (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
378 w->base_line_pos = val;
380 static void
381 wset_column_number_displayed (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
383 w->column_number_displayed = val;
385 static void
386 wset_region_showing (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
388 w->region_showing = val;
391 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
393 /* Test if overflow newline into fringe. Called with iterator IT
394 at or past right window margin, and with IT->current_x set. */
396 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(IT) \
397 (!NILP (Voverflow_newline_into_fringe) \
398 && FRAME_WINDOW_P ((IT)->f) \
399 && ((IT)->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L \
400 ? (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0) \
401 : (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0)) \
402 && (IT)->current_x == (IT)->last_visible_x \
403 && (IT)->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP)
405 #else /* !HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
406 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(it) 0
407 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
409 /* Test if the display element loaded in IT, or the underlying buffer
410 or string character, is a space or a TAB character. This is used
411 to determine where word wrapping can occur. */
413 #define IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE(it) \
414 ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER && (it->c == ' ' || it->c == '\t')) \
415 || ((STRINGP (it->string) \
416 && (SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
417 || SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')) \
418 || (it->s \
419 && (it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == ' ' \
420 || it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == '\t')) \
421 || (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) < ZV_BYTE \
422 && (*BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
423 || *BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')))) \
425 /* Name of the face used to highlight trailing whitespace. */
427 static Lisp_Object Qtrailing_whitespace;
429 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight escape glyphs. */
431 static Lisp_Object Qescape_glyph;
433 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight non-breaking spaces. */
435 static Lisp_Object Qnobreak_space;
437 /* The symbol `image' which is the car of the lists used to represent
438 images in Lisp. Also a tool bar style. */
440 Lisp_Object Qimage;
442 /* The image map types. */
443 Lisp_Object QCmap;
444 static Lisp_Object QCpointer;
445 static Lisp_Object Qrect, Qcircle, Qpoly;
447 /* Tool bar styles */
448 Lisp_Object Qboth, Qboth_horiz, Qtext_image_horiz;
450 /* Non-zero means print newline to stdout before next mini-buffer
451 message. */
453 int noninteractive_need_newline;
455 /* Non-zero means print newline to message log before next message. */
457 static int message_log_need_newline;
459 /* Three markers that message_dolog uses.
460 It could allocate them itself, but that causes trouble
461 in handling memory-full errors. */
462 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker1;
463 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker2;
464 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker3;
466 /* The buffer position of the first character appearing entirely or
467 partially on the line of the selected window which contains the
468 cursor; <= 0 if not known. Set by set_cursor_from_row, used for
469 redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal. */
471 static struct text_pos this_line_start_pos;
473 /* Number of characters past the end of the line above, including the
474 terminating newline. */
476 static struct text_pos this_line_end_pos;
478 /* The vertical positions and the height of this line. */
480 static int this_line_vpos;
481 static int this_line_y;
482 static int this_line_pixel_height;
484 /* X position at which this display line starts. Usually zero;
485 negative if first character is partially visible. */
487 static int this_line_start_x;
489 /* The smallest character position seen by move_it_* functions as they
490 move across display lines. Used to set MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS of
491 hscrolled lines, see display_line. */
493 static struct text_pos this_line_min_pos;
495 /* Buffer that this_line_.* variables are referring to. */
497 static struct buffer *this_line_buffer;
500 /* Values of those variables at last redisplay are stored as
501 properties on `overlay-arrow-position' symbol. However, if
502 Voverlay_arrow_position is a marker, last-arrow-position is its
503 numerical position. */
505 static Lisp_Object Qlast_arrow_position, Qlast_arrow_string;
507 /* Alternative overlay-arrow-string and overlay-arrow-bitmap
508 properties on a symbol in overlay-arrow-variable-list. */
510 static Lisp_Object Qoverlay_arrow_string, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap;
512 Lisp_Object Qmenu_bar_update_hook;
514 /* Nonzero if an overlay arrow has been displayed in this window. */
516 static int overlay_arrow_seen;
518 /* Number of windows showing the buffer of the selected
519 window (or another buffer with the same base buffer). */
521 int buffer_shared;
523 /* Vector containing glyphs for an ellipsis `...'. */
525 static Lisp_Object default_invis_vector[3];
527 /* This is the window where the echo area message was displayed. It
528 is always a mini-buffer window, but it may not be the same window
529 currently active as a mini-buffer. */
531 Lisp_Object echo_area_window;
533 /* List of pairs (MESSAGE . MULTIBYTE). The function save_message
534 pushes the current message and the value of
535 message_enable_multibyte on the stack, the function restore_message
536 pops the stack and displays MESSAGE again. */
538 static Lisp_Object Vmessage_stack;
540 /* Nonzero means multibyte characters were enabled when the echo area
541 message was specified. */
543 static int message_enable_multibyte;
545 /* Nonzero if we should redraw the mode lines on the next redisplay. */
547 int update_mode_lines;
549 /* Nonzero if window sizes or contents have changed since last
550 redisplay that finished. */
552 int windows_or_buffers_changed;
554 /* Nonzero means a frame's cursor type has been changed. */
556 int cursor_type_changed;
558 /* Nonzero after display_mode_line if %l was used and it displayed a
559 line number. */
561 static int line_number_displayed;
563 /* The name of the *Messages* buffer, a string. */
565 static Lisp_Object Vmessages_buffer_name;
567 /* Current, index 0, and last displayed echo area message. Either
568 buffers from echo_buffers, or nil to indicate no message. */
570 Lisp_Object echo_area_buffer[2];
572 /* The buffers referenced from echo_area_buffer. */
574 static Lisp_Object echo_buffer[2];
576 /* A vector saved used in with_area_buffer to reduce consing. */
578 static Lisp_Object Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
580 /* Non-zero means display_echo_area should display the last echo area
581 message again. Set by redisplay_preserve_echo_area. */
583 static int display_last_displayed_message_p;
585 /* Nonzero if echo area is being used by print; zero if being used by
586 message. */
588 static int message_buf_print;
590 /* The symbol `inhibit-menubar-update' and its DEFVAR_BOOL variable. */
592 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_menubar_update;
593 static Lisp_Object Qmessage_truncate_lines;
595 /* Set to 1 in clear_message to make redisplay_internal aware
596 of an emptied echo area. */
598 static int message_cleared_p;
600 /* A scratch glyph row with contents used for generating truncation
601 glyphs. Also used in direct_output_for_insert. */
603 #define MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS 100
604 static struct glyph_row scratch_glyph_row;
605 static struct glyph scratch_glyphs[MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS];
607 /* Ascent and height of the last line processed by move_it_to. */
609 static int last_max_ascent, last_height;
611 /* Non-zero if there's a help-echo in the echo area. */
613 int help_echo_showing_p;
615 /* If >= 0, computed, exact values of mode-line and header-line height
616 to use in the macros CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT and
617 CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT. */
619 int current_mode_line_height, current_header_line_height;
621 /* The maximum distance to look ahead for text properties. Values
622 that are too small let us call compute_char_face and similar
623 functions too often which is expensive. Values that are too large
624 let us call compute_char_face and alike too often because we
625 might not be interested in text properties that far away. */
627 #define TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT 100
629 /* SAVE_IT and RESTORE_IT are called when we save a snapshot of the
630 iterator state and later restore it. This is needed because the
631 bidi iterator on bidi.c keeps a stacked cache of its states, which
632 is really a singleton. When we use scratch iterator objects to
633 move around the buffer, we can cause the bidi cache to be pushed or
634 popped, and therefore we need to restore the cache state when we
635 return to the original iterator. */
636 #define SAVE_IT(ITCOPY,ITORIG,CACHE) \
637 do { \
638 if (CACHE) \
639 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 1); \
640 ITCOPY = ITORIG; \
641 CACHE = bidi_shelve_cache (); \
642 } while (0)
644 #define RESTORE_IT(pITORIG,pITCOPY,CACHE) \
645 do { \
646 if (pITORIG != pITCOPY) \
647 *(pITORIG) = *(pITCOPY); \
648 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 0); \
649 CACHE = NULL; \
650 } while (0)
652 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
654 /* Non-zero means print traces of redisplay if compiled with
655 GLYPH_DEBUG defined. */
657 int trace_redisplay_p;
659 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
661 #ifdef DEBUG_TRACE_MOVE
662 /* Non-zero means trace with TRACE_MOVE to stderr. */
663 int trace_move;
665 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) if (trace_move) fprintf x; else (void) 0
666 #else
667 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) (void) 0
668 #endif
670 static Lisp_Object Qauto_hscroll_mode;
672 /* Buffer being redisplayed -- for redisplay_window_error. */
674 static struct buffer *displayed_buffer;
676 /* Value returned from text property handlers (see below). */
678 enum prop_handled
680 HANDLED_NORMALLY,
681 HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS,
682 HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED,
683 HANDLED_RETURN
686 /* A description of text properties that redisplay is interested
687 in. */
689 struct props
691 /* The name of the property. */
692 Lisp_Object *name;
694 /* A unique index for the property. */
695 enum prop_idx idx;
697 /* A handler function called to set up iterator IT from the property
698 at IT's current position. Value is used to steer handle_stop. */
699 enum prop_handled (*handler) (struct it *it);
702 static enum prop_handled handle_face_prop (struct it *);
703 static enum prop_handled handle_invisible_prop (struct it *);
704 static enum prop_handled handle_display_prop (struct it *);
705 static enum prop_handled handle_composition_prop (struct it *);
706 static enum prop_handled handle_overlay_change (struct it *);
707 static enum prop_handled handle_fontified_prop (struct it *);
709 /* Properties handled by iterators. */
711 static struct props it_props[] =
713 {&Qfontified, FONTIFIED_PROP_IDX, handle_fontified_prop},
714 /* Handle `face' before `display' because some sub-properties of
715 `display' need to know the face. */
716 {&Qface, FACE_PROP_IDX, handle_face_prop},
717 {&Qdisplay, DISPLAY_PROP_IDX, handle_display_prop},
718 {&Qinvisible, INVISIBLE_PROP_IDX, handle_invisible_prop},
719 {&Qcomposition, COMPOSITION_PROP_IDX, handle_composition_prop},
720 {NULL, 0, NULL}
723 /* Value is the position described by X. If X is a marker, value is
724 the marker_position of X. Otherwise, value is X. */
726 #define COERCE_MARKER(X) (MARKERP ((X)) ? Fmarker_position (X) : (X))
728 /* Enumeration returned by some move_it_.* functions internally. */
730 enum move_it_result
732 /* Not used. Undefined value. */
733 MOVE_UNDEFINED,
735 /* Move ended at the requested buffer position or ZV. */
736 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV,
738 /* Move ended at the requested X pixel position. */
739 MOVE_X_REACHED,
741 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that must be
742 continued. */
743 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED,
745 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that would
746 be displayed truncated. */
747 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED,
749 /* Move within a line ended at a line end. */
750 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
753 /* This counter is used to clear the face cache every once in a while
754 in redisplay_internal. It is incremented for each redisplay.
755 Every CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT full redisplays, the face cache is
756 cleared. */
758 #define CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT 500
759 static int clear_face_cache_count;
761 /* Similarly for the image cache. */
763 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
764 #define CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT 101
765 static int clear_image_cache_count;
767 /* Null glyph slice */
768 static struct glyph_slice null_glyph_slice = { 0, 0, 0, 0 };
769 #endif
771 /* True while redisplay_internal is in progress. */
773 bool redisplaying_p;
775 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_free_realized_faces;
776 static Lisp_Object Qmode_line_default_help_echo;
778 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
779 (The display is done in read_char.) */
781 Lisp_Object help_echo_string;
782 Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
783 Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
784 ptrdiff_t help_echo_pos;
786 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
788 Lisp_Object previous_help_echo_string;
790 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
792 /* Non-zero means an hourglass cursor is currently shown. */
793 int hourglass_shown_p;
795 /* If non-null, an asynchronous timer that, when it expires, displays
796 an hourglass cursor on all frames. */
797 struct atimer *hourglass_atimer;
799 /* Name of the face used to display glyphless characters. */
800 Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char;
802 /* Symbol for the purpose of Vglyphless_char_display. */
803 static Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char_display;
805 /* Method symbols for Vglyphless_char_display. */
806 static Lisp_Object Qhex_code, Qempty_box, Qthin_space, Qzero_width;
808 /* Default pixel width of `thin-space' display method. */
809 #define THIN_SPACE_WIDTH 1
811 /* Default number of seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass
812 cursor. */
813 #define DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY 1
816 /* Function prototypes. */
818 static void setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *, int);
819 static void set_iterator_to_next (struct it *, int);
820 static void mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *, int);
821 static int single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
822 static int display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
823 static int cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *);
824 static int redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object, int);
825 static char *decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object, char *, int);
827 static Lisp_Object get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop);
829 static void handle_line_prefix (struct it *);
831 static void pint2str (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
832 static void pint2hrstr (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
833 static struct text_pos run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object,
834 struct text_pos);
835 static void reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *, struct buffer *);
836 static int text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *,
837 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
838 static void store_mode_line_noprop_char (char);
839 static int store_mode_line_noprop (const char *, int, int);
840 static void handle_stop (struct it *);
841 static void handle_stop_backwards (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
842 static void vmessage (const char *, va_list) ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (1, 0);
843 static void ensure_echo_area_buffers (void);
844 static Lisp_Object unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object);
845 static Lisp_Object with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *);
846 static int with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *, int,
847 int (*) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t),
848 ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
849 static void clear_garbaged_frames (void);
850 static int current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
851 static void pop_message (void);
852 static int truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
853 static void set_message (const char *, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, int);
854 static int set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
855 static int display_echo_area (struct window *);
856 static int display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
857 static int resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
858 static Lisp_Object unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
859 static int string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *, int *);
860 static struct text_pos display_prop_end (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
861 struct text_pos);
862 static int compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *);
863 static void insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *);
864 static struct glyph_row *get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *,
865 Lisp_Object);
866 static void extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *);
867 static int append_space_for_newline (struct it *, int);
868 static int cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *, int, int);
869 static int try_scrolling (Lisp_Object, int, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
870 static int try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object, struct text_pos, int *);
871 static int trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t);
872 static intmax_t message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
873 static void push_it (struct it *, struct text_pos *);
874 static void iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *);
875 static void pop_it (struct it *);
876 static void sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *);
877 static void select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
878 static void redisplay_internal (void);
879 static int echo_area_display (int);
880 static void redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object);
881 static void redisplay_window (Lisp_Object, int);
882 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object);
883 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object);
884 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object);
885 static int set_cursor_from_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
886 struct glyph_matrix *, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
887 int, int);
888 static int update_menu_bar (struct frame *, int, int);
889 static int try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *);
890 static int try_window_id (struct window *);
891 static int display_line (struct it *);
892 static int display_mode_lines (struct window *);
893 static int display_mode_line (struct window *, enum face_id, Lisp_Object);
894 static int display_mode_element (struct it *, int, int, int, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object, int);
895 static int store_mode_line_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, int, int, int, Lisp_Object);
896 static const char *decode_mode_spec (struct window *, int, int, Lisp_Object *);
897 static void display_menu_bar (struct window *);
898 static ptrdiff_t display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
899 ptrdiff_t *);
900 static int display_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
901 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, struct it *, int, int, int, int);
902 static void compute_line_metrics (struct it *);
903 static void run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *);
904 static int get_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
905 static int get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int);
906 static void next_overlay_string (struct it *);
907 static void reseat (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
908 static void reseat_1 (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
909 static void back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
910 void reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
911 static void reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *, int);
912 static int next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *);
913 static int next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *);
914 static int next_element_from_string (struct it *);
915 static int next_element_from_c_string (struct it *);
916 static int next_element_from_buffer (struct it *);
917 static int next_element_from_composition (struct it *);
918 static int next_element_from_image (struct it *);
919 static int next_element_from_stretch (struct it *);
920 static void load_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
921 static int init_from_display_pos (struct it *, struct window *,
922 struct display_pos *);
923 static void reseat_to_string (struct it *, const char *,
924 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
925 static int get_next_display_element (struct it *);
926 static enum move_it_result
927 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int,
928 enum move_operation_enum);
929 void move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *, int);
930 static void get_visually_first_element (struct it *);
931 static void init_to_row_start (struct it *, struct window *,
932 struct glyph_row *);
933 static int init_to_row_end (struct it *, struct window *,
934 struct glyph_row *);
935 static void back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *);
936 static int forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *, int *, struct bidi_it *);
937 static struct text_pos string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos,
938 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t);
939 static struct text_pos string_pos (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
940 static struct text_pos c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t, const char *, int);
941 static ptrdiff_t number_of_chars (const char *, int);
942 static void compute_stop_pos (struct it *);
943 static void compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *, struct text_pos,
944 Lisp_Object);
945 static int face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *, int);
946 static ptrdiff_t next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t);
947 static int handle_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
948 Lisp_Object, struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int);
949 static int handle_single_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
950 Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
951 struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
952 static int underlying_face_id (struct it *);
953 static int in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *,
954 struct window *);
956 #define face_before_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 1)
957 #define face_after_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 0)
959 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
961 static void x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object);
962 static int tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *, int *);
963 static void update_tool_bar (struct frame *, int);
964 static void build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f);
965 static int redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *);
966 static void display_tool_bar_line (struct it *, int);
967 static void notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *,
968 enum glyph_row_area,
969 int, int, int, int);
970 static void append_stretch_glyph (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
971 int, int, int);
974 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
976 static void produce_special_glyphs (struct it *, enum display_element_type);
977 static void show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *, enum draw_glyphs_face);
978 static int coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *, int, int);
982 /***********************************************************************
983 Window display dimensions
984 ***********************************************************************/
986 /* Return the bottom boundary y-position for text lines in window W.
987 This is the first y position at which a line cannot start.
988 It is relative to the top of the window.
990 This is the height of W minus the height of a mode line, if any. */
993 window_text_bottom_y (struct window *w)
995 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
997 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
998 height -= CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
999 return height;
1002 /* Return the pixel width of display area AREA of window W. AREA < 0
1003 means return the total width of W, not including fringes to
1004 the left and right of the window. */
1007 window_box_width (struct window *w, int area)
1009 int cols = XFASTINT (w->total_cols);
1010 int pixels = 0;
1012 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
1014 cols -= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w);
1016 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1018 if (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols))
1019 cols -= XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols);
1020 if (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols))
1021 cols -= XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols);
1022 pixels = -WINDOW_TOTAL_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1024 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1026 cols = (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols)
1027 ? XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols) : 0);
1028 pixels = 0;
1030 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1032 cols = (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols)
1033 ? XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols) : 0);
1034 pixels = 0;
1038 return cols * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w) + pixels;
1042 /* Return the pixel height of the display area of window W, not
1043 including mode lines of W, if any. */
1046 window_box_height (struct window *w)
1048 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1049 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
1051 eassert (height >= 0);
1053 /* Note: the code below that determines the mode-line/header-line
1054 height is essentially the same as that contained in the macro
1055 CURRENT_{MODE,HEADER}_LINE_HEIGHT, except that it checks whether
1056 the appropriate glyph row has its `mode_line_p' flag set,
1057 and if it doesn't, uses estimate_mode_line_height instead. */
1059 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1061 struct glyph_row *ml_row
1062 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1063 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1064 : 0);
1065 if (ml_row && ml_row->mode_line_p)
1066 height -= ml_row->height;
1067 else
1068 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w));
1071 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1073 struct glyph_row *hl_row
1074 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1075 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1076 : 0);
1077 if (hl_row && hl_row->mode_line_p)
1078 height -= hl_row->height;
1079 else
1080 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID);
1083 /* With a very small font and a mode-line that's taller than
1084 default, we might end up with a negative height. */
1085 return max (0, height);
1088 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1089 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1090 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1093 window_box_left_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1095 int x;
1097 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1098 return 0;
1100 x = WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
1102 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1103 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1104 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
1105 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1106 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1107 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1108 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA)
1109 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
1111 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)));
1112 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA
1113 && WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w))
1114 x += WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1116 return x;
1120 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1121 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1122 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1125 window_box_right_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1127 return window_box_left_offset (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1130 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1131 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1132 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1135 window_box_left (struct window *w, int area)
1137 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1138 int x;
1140 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1141 return FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1143 x = (WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w)
1144 + window_box_left_offset (w, area));
1146 return x;
1150 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1151 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1152 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1155 window_box_right (struct window *w, int area)
1157 return window_box_left (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1160 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1161 mode lines, in frame-relative coordinates. AREA < 0 means the
1162 whole window, not including the left and right fringes of
1163 the window. Return in *BOX_X and *BOX_Y the frame-relative pixel
1164 coordinates of the upper-left corner of the box. Return in
1165 *BOX_WIDTH, and *BOX_HEIGHT the pixel width and height of the box. */
1167 void
1168 window_box (struct window *w, int area, int *box_x, int *box_y,
1169 int *box_width, int *box_height)
1171 if (box_width)
1172 *box_width = window_box_width (w, area);
1173 if (box_height)
1174 *box_height = window_box_height (w);
1175 if (box_x)
1176 *box_x = window_box_left (w, area);
1177 if (box_y)
1179 *box_y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
1180 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1181 *box_y += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1186 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1187 mode lines. AREA < 0 means the whole window, not including the
1188 left and right fringe of the window. Return in *TOP_LEFT_X
1189 and TOP_LEFT_Y the frame-relative pixel coordinates of the
1190 upper-left corner of the box. Return in *BOTTOM_RIGHT_X, and
1191 *BOTTOM_RIGHT_Y the coordinates of the bottom-right corner of the
1192 box. */
1194 static void
1195 window_box_edges (struct window *w, int area, int *top_left_x, int *top_left_y,
1196 int *bottom_right_x, int *bottom_right_y)
1198 window_box (w, area, top_left_x, top_left_y, bottom_right_x,
1199 bottom_right_y);
1200 *bottom_right_x += *top_left_x;
1201 *bottom_right_y += *top_left_y;
1206 /***********************************************************************
1207 Utilities
1208 ***********************************************************************/
1210 /* Return the bottom y-position of the line the iterator IT is in.
1211 This can modify IT's settings. */
1214 line_bottom_y (struct it *it)
1216 int line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
1217 int line_top_y = it->current_y;
1219 if (line_height == 0)
1221 if (last_height)
1222 line_height = last_height;
1223 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
1225 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
1226 line_height = (it->max_ascent || it->max_descent
1227 ? it->max_ascent + it->max_descent
1228 : last_height);
1230 else
1232 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
1234 /* Use the default character height. */
1235 it->glyph_row = NULL;
1236 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
1237 it->c = ' ';
1238 it->len = 1;
1239 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
1240 line_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
1241 it->glyph_row = row;
1245 return line_top_y + line_height;
1248 /* Subroutine of pos_visible_p below. Extracts a display string, if
1249 any, from the display spec given as its argument. */
1250 static Lisp_Object
1251 string_from_display_spec (Lisp_Object spec)
1253 if (CONSP (spec))
1255 while (CONSP (spec))
1257 if (STRINGP (XCAR (spec)))
1258 return XCAR (spec);
1259 spec = XCDR (spec);
1262 else if (VECTORP (spec))
1264 ptrdiff_t i;
1266 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); i++)
1268 if (STRINGP (AREF (spec, i)))
1269 return AREF (spec, i);
1271 return Qnil;
1274 return spec;
1278 /* Limit insanely large values of W->hscroll on frame F to the largest
1279 value that will still prevent first_visible_x and last_visible_x of
1280 'struct it' from overflowing an int. */
1281 static int
1282 window_hscroll_limited (struct window *w, struct frame *f)
1284 ptrdiff_t window_hscroll = w->hscroll;
1285 int window_text_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
1286 int colwidth = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
1288 if (window_hscroll > (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1)
1289 window_hscroll = (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1;
1291 return window_hscroll;
1294 /* Return 1 if position CHARPOS is visible in window W.
1295 CHARPOS < 0 means return info about WINDOW_END position.
1296 If visible, set *X and *Y to pixel coordinates of top left corner.
1297 Set *RTOP and *RBOT to pixel height of an invisible area of glyph at POS.
1298 Set *ROWH and *VPOS to row's visible height and VPOS (row number). */
1301 pos_visible_p (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos, int *x, int *y,
1302 int *rtop, int *rbot, int *rowh, int *vpos)
1304 struct it it;
1305 void *itdata = bidi_shelve_cache ();
1306 struct text_pos top;
1307 int visible_p = 0;
1308 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
1310 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))))
1311 return visible_p;
1313 if (XBUFFER (w->buffer) != current_buffer)
1315 old_buffer = current_buffer;
1316 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
1319 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (top, w->start);
1320 /* Scrolling a minibuffer window via scroll bar when the echo area
1321 shows long text sometimes resets the minibuffer contents behind
1322 our backs. */
1323 if (CHARPOS (top) > ZV)
1324 SET_TEXT_POS (top, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
1326 /* Compute exact mode line heights. */
1327 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1328 current_mode_line_height
1329 = display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w),
1330 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
1332 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1333 current_header_line_height
1334 = display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
1335 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
1337 start_display (&it, w, top);
1338 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, it.last_visible_y-1, -1,
1339 (charpos >= 0 ? MOVE_TO_POS : 0) | MOVE_TO_Y);
1341 if (charpos >= 0
1342 && (((!it.bidi_p || it.bidi_it.scan_dir == 1)
1343 && IT_CHARPOS (it) >= charpos)
1344 /* When scanning backwards under bidi iteration, move_it_to
1345 stops at or _before_ CHARPOS, because it stops at or to
1346 the _right_ of the character at CHARPOS. */
1347 || (it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1348 && IT_CHARPOS (it) <= charpos)))
1350 /* We have reached CHARPOS, or passed it. How the call to
1351 move_it_to can overshoot: (i) If CHARPOS is on invisible text
1352 or covered by a display property, move_it_to stops at the end
1353 of the invisible text, to the right of CHARPOS. (ii) If
1354 CHARPOS is in a display vector, move_it_to stops on its last
1355 glyph. */
1356 int top_x = it.current_x;
1357 int top_y = it.current_y;
1358 /* Calling line_bottom_y may change it.method, it.position, etc. */
1359 enum it_method it_method = it.method;
1360 int bottom_y = (last_height = 0, line_bottom_y (&it));
1361 int window_top_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1363 if (top_y < window_top_y)
1364 visible_p = bottom_y > window_top_y;
1365 else if (top_y < it.last_visible_y)
1366 visible_p = 1;
1367 if (bottom_y >= it.last_visible_y
1368 && it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1369 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < charpos)
1371 /* When the last line of the window is scanned backwards
1372 under bidi iteration, we could be duped into thinking
1373 that we have passed CHARPOS, when in fact move_it_to
1374 simply stopped short of CHARPOS because it reached
1375 last_visible_y. To see if that's what happened, we call
1376 move_it_to again with a slightly larger vertical limit,
1377 and see if it actually moved vertically; if it did, we
1378 didn't really reach CHARPOS, which is beyond window end. */
1379 struct it save_it = it;
1380 /* Why 10? because we don't know how many canonical lines
1381 will the height of the next line(s) be. So we guess. */
1382 int ten_more_lines =
1383 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)));
1385 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, bottom_y + ten_more_lines, -1,
1386 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
1387 if (it.current_y > top_y)
1388 visible_p = 0;
1390 it = save_it;
1392 if (visible_p)
1394 if (it_method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
1396 /* We stopped on the last glyph of a display vector.
1397 Try and recompute. Hack alert! */
1398 if (charpos < 2 || top.charpos >= charpos)
1399 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1400 else
1402 struct it it2;
1403 start_display (&it2, w, top);
1404 move_it_to (&it2, charpos - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1405 get_next_display_element (&it2);
1406 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it2);
1407 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it2)
1408 || it2.current_x > it2.last_visible_x)
1409 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1410 else
1412 top_x = it2.current_x;
1413 top_y = it2.current_y;
1417 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) != charpos)
1419 Lisp_Object cpos = make_number (charpos);
1420 Lisp_Object spec = Fget_char_property (cpos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
1421 Lisp_Object string = string_from_display_spec (spec);
1422 int newline_in_string = 0;
1424 if (STRINGP (string))
1426 const char *s = SSDATA (string);
1427 const char *e = s + SBYTES (string);
1428 while (s < e)
1430 if (*s++ == '\n')
1432 newline_in_string = 1;
1433 break;
1437 /* The tricky code below is needed because there's a
1438 discrepancy between move_it_to and how we set cursor
1439 when the display line ends in a newline from a
1440 display string. move_it_to will stop _after_ such
1441 display strings, whereas set_cursor_from_row
1442 conspires with cursor_row_p to place the cursor on
1443 the first glyph produced from the display string. */
1445 /* We have overshoot PT because it is covered by a
1446 display property whose value is a string. If the
1447 string includes embedded newlines, we are also in the
1448 wrong display line. Backtrack to the correct line,
1449 where the display string begins. */
1450 if (newline_in_string)
1452 Lisp_Object startpos, endpos;
1453 EMACS_INT start, end;
1454 struct it it3;
1455 int it3_moved;
1457 /* Find the first and the last buffer positions
1458 covered by the display string. */
1459 endpos =
1460 Fnext_single_char_property_change (cpos, Qdisplay,
1461 Qnil, Qnil);
1462 startpos =
1463 Fprevious_single_char_property_change (endpos, Qdisplay,
1464 Qnil, Qnil);
1465 start = XFASTINT (startpos);
1466 end = XFASTINT (endpos);
1467 /* Move to the last buffer position before the
1468 display property. */
1469 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1470 move_it_to (&it3, start - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1471 /* Move forward one more line if the position before
1472 the display string is a newline or if it is the
1473 rightmost character on a line that is
1474 continued or word-wrapped. */
1475 if (it3.method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
1476 && it3.c == '\n')
1477 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1478 else if (move_it_in_display_line_to (&it3, -1,
1479 it3.current_x
1480 + it3.pixel_width,
1481 MOVE_TO_X)
1482 == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
1484 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1485 /* When we are under word-wrap, the #$@%!
1486 move_it_by_lines moves 2 lines, so we need to
1487 fix that up. */
1488 if (it3.line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
1489 move_it_by_lines (&it3, -1);
1492 /* Record the vertical coordinate of the display
1493 line where we wound up. */
1494 top_y = it3.current_y;
1495 if (it3.bidi_p)
1497 /* When characters are reordered for display,
1498 the character displayed to the left of the
1499 display string could be _after_ the display
1500 property in the logical order. Use the
1501 smallest vertical position of these two. */
1502 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1503 move_it_to (&it3, end + 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1504 if (it3.current_y < top_y)
1505 top_y = it3.current_y;
1507 /* Move from the top of the window to the beginning
1508 of the display line where the display string
1509 begins. */
1510 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1511 move_it_to (&it3, -1, 0, top_y, -1, MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
1512 /* If it3_moved stays zero after the 'while' loop
1513 below, that means we already were at a newline
1514 before the loop (e.g., the display string begins
1515 with a newline), so we don't need to (and cannot)
1516 inspect the glyphs of it3.glyph_row, because
1517 PRODUCE_GLYPHS will not produce anything for a
1518 newline, and thus it3.glyph_row stays at its
1519 stale content it got at top of the window. */
1520 it3_moved = 0;
1521 /* Finally, advance the iterator until we hit the
1522 first display element whose character position is
1523 CHARPOS, or until the first newline from the
1524 display string, which signals the end of the
1525 display line. */
1526 while (get_next_display_element (&it3))
1528 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it3);
1529 if (IT_CHARPOS (it3) == charpos
1530 || ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it3))
1531 break;
1532 it3_moved = 1;
1533 set_iterator_to_next (&it3, 0);
1535 top_x = it3.current_x - it3.pixel_width;
1536 /* Normally, we would exit the above loop because we
1537 found the display element whose character
1538 position is CHARPOS. For the contingency that we
1539 didn't, and stopped at the first newline from the
1540 display string, move back over the glyphs
1541 produced from the string, until we find the
1542 rightmost glyph not from the string. */
1543 if (it3_moved
1544 && IT_CHARPOS (it3) != charpos && EQ (it3.object, string))
1546 struct glyph *g = it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1547 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
1549 while (EQ ((g - 1)->object, string))
1551 --g;
1552 top_x -= g->pixel_width;
1554 eassert (g < it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1555 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
1560 *x = top_x;
1561 *y = max (top_y + max (0, it.max_ascent - it.ascent), window_top_y);
1562 *rtop = max (0, window_top_y - top_y);
1563 *rbot = max (0, bottom_y - it.last_visible_y);
1564 *rowh = max (0, (min (bottom_y, it.last_visible_y)
1565 - max (top_y, window_top_y)));
1566 *vpos = it.vpos;
1569 else
1571 /* We were asked to provide info about WINDOW_END. */
1572 struct it it2;
1573 void *it2data = NULL;
1575 SAVE_IT (it2, it, it2data);
1576 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (it)) != '\n')
1577 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
1578 if (charpos < IT_CHARPOS (it)
1579 || (it.what == IT_EOB && charpos == IT_CHARPOS (it)))
1581 visible_p = 1;
1582 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
1583 move_it_to (&it2, charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1584 *x = it2.current_x;
1585 *y = it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent - it2.ascent;
1586 *rtop = max (0, -it2.current_y);
1587 *rbot = max (0, ((it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent)
1588 - it.last_visible_y));
1589 *rowh = max (0, (min (it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent,
1590 it.last_visible_y)
1591 - max (it2.current_y,
1592 WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))));
1593 *vpos = it2.vpos;
1595 else
1596 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
1598 bidi_unshelve_cache (itdata, 0);
1600 if (old_buffer)
1601 set_buffer_internal_1 (old_buffer);
1603 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
1605 if (visible_p && w->hscroll > 0)
1606 *x -=
1607 window_hscroll_limited (w, WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
1608 * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
1610 #if 0
1611 /* Debugging code. */
1612 if (visible_p)
1613 fprintf (stderr, "+pv pt=%d vs=%d --> x=%d y=%d rt=%d rb=%d rh=%d vp=%d\n",
1614 charpos, w->vscroll, *x, *y, *rtop, *rbot, *rowh, *vpos);
1615 else
1616 fprintf (stderr, "-pv pt=%d vs=%d\n", charpos, w->vscroll);
1617 #endif
1619 return visible_p;
1623 /* Return the next character from STR. Return in *LEN the length of
1624 the character. This is like STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH but never
1625 returns an invalid character. If we find one, we return a `?', but
1626 with the length of the invalid character. */
1628 static int
1629 string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *str, int *len)
1631 int c;
1633 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (str, *len);
1634 if (!CHAR_VALID_P (c))
1635 /* We may not change the length here because other places in Emacs
1636 don't use this function, i.e. they silently accept invalid
1637 characters. */
1638 c = '?';
1640 return c;
1645 /* Given a position POS containing a valid character and byte position
1646 in STRING, return the position NCHARS ahead (NCHARS >= 0). */
1648 static struct text_pos
1649 string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t nchars)
1651 eassert (STRINGP (string) && nchars >= 0);
1653 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1655 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (string) + BYTEPOS (pos);
1656 int len;
1658 while (nchars--)
1660 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1661 p += len;
1662 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1663 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1666 else
1667 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, CHARPOS (pos) + nchars, BYTEPOS (pos) + nchars);
1669 return pos;
1673 /* Value is the text position, i.e. character and byte position,
1674 for character position CHARPOS in STRING. */
1676 static struct text_pos
1677 string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, Lisp_Object string)
1679 struct text_pos pos;
1680 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1681 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1682 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, string_char_to_byte (string, charpos));
1683 return pos;
1687 /* Value is a text position, i.e. character and byte position, for
1688 character position CHARPOS in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1689 means recognize multibyte characters. */
1691 static struct text_pos
1692 c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1694 struct text_pos pos;
1696 eassert (s != NULL);
1697 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1699 if (multibyte_p)
1701 int len;
1703 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, 0, 0);
1704 while (charpos--)
1706 string_char_and_length ((const unsigned char *) s, &len);
1707 s += len;
1708 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1709 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1712 else
1713 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, charpos);
1715 return pos;
1719 /* Value is the number of characters in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P
1720 non-zero means recognize multibyte characters. */
1722 static ptrdiff_t
1723 number_of_chars (const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1725 ptrdiff_t nchars;
1727 if (multibyte_p)
1729 ptrdiff_t rest = strlen (s);
1730 int len;
1731 const unsigned char *p = (const unsigned char *) s;
1733 for (nchars = 0; rest > 0; ++nchars)
1735 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1736 rest -= len, p += len;
1739 else
1740 nchars = strlen (s);
1742 return nchars;
1746 /* Compute byte position NEWPOS->bytepos corresponding to
1747 NEWPOS->charpos. POS is a known position in string STRING.
1748 NEWPOS->charpos must be >= POS.charpos. */
1750 static void
1751 compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *newpos, struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string)
1753 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1754 eassert (CHARPOS (*newpos) >= CHARPOS (pos));
1756 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1757 *newpos = string_pos_nchars_ahead (pos, string,
1758 CHARPOS (*newpos) - CHARPOS (pos));
1759 else
1760 BYTEPOS (*newpos) = CHARPOS (*newpos);
1763 /* EXPORT:
1764 Return an estimation of the pixel height of mode or header lines on
1765 frame F. FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
1768 estimate_mode_line_height (struct frame *f, enum face_id face_id)
1770 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1771 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1773 int height = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
1775 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
1776 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
1777 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
1779 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1780 if (face)
1782 if (face->font)
1783 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font);
1784 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1785 height += 2 * face->box_line_width;
1789 return height;
1791 #endif
1793 return 1;
1796 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
1797 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
1798 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
1799 not force the value into range. */
1801 void
1802 pixel_to_glyph_coords (FRAME_PTR f, register int pix_x, register int pix_y,
1803 int *x, int *y, NativeRectangle *bounds, int noclip)
1806 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1807 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1809 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to round down
1810 even for negative values. */
1811 if (pix_x < 0)
1812 pix_x -= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1;
1813 if (pix_y < 0)
1814 pix_y -= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1;
1816 pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL (f, pix_x);
1817 pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_Y_TO_LINE (f, pix_y);
1819 if (bounds)
1820 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*bounds,
1821 FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, pix_x),
1822 FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, pix_y),
1823 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1,
1824 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1);
1826 if (!noclip)
1828 if (pix_x < 0)
1829 pix_x = 0;
1830 else if (pix_x > FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f))
1831 pix_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f);
1833 if (pix_y < 0)
1834 pix_y = 0;
1835 else if (pix_y > FRAME_LINES (f))
1836 pix_y = FRAME_LINES (f);
1839 #endif
1841 *x = pix_x;
1842 *y = pix_y;
1846 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
1847 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
1848 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
1849 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
1850 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
1851 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
1852 date. */
1854 static
1855 struct glyph *
1856 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (struct window *w, int x, int y, int *hpos, int *vpos,
1857 int *dx, int *dy, int *area)
1859 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
1860 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
1861 int x0, i;
1863 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
1864 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
1866 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
1867 if (!row->enabled_p)
1868 return NULL;
1869 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
1870 break;
1873 *vpos = i;
1874 *hpos = 0;
1876 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
1877 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
1878 return NULL;
1880 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
1881 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1883 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1884 x0 = 0;
1886 else
1888 if (x < window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1890 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
1891 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
1893 else if (x < window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1895 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1896 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + min (row->x, 0);
1898 else
1900 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
1901 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
1905 /* Find glyph containing X. */
1906 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
1907 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
1908 x -= x0;
1909 while (glyph < end && x >= glyph->pixel_width)
1911 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
1912 ++glyph;
1915 if (glyph == end)
1916 return NULL;
1918 if (dx)
1920 *dx = x;
1921 *dy = y - (row->y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent);
1924 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
1925 return glyph;
1928 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
1929 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
1931 static void
1932 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (struct window *w, int *x, int *y)
1934 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1936 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
1937 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
1938 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1939 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1940 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1942 else
1944 *x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
1945 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1949 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1951 /* EXPORT:
1952 Return in RECTS[] at most N clipping rectangles for glyph string S.
1953 Return the number of stored rectangles. */
1956 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *rects, int n)
1958 XRectangle r;
1960 if (n <= 0)
1961 return 0;
1963 if (s->row->full_width_p)
1965 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left_col. */
1966 r.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (s->w);
1967 r.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (s->w);
1969 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
1970 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
1971 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
1972 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1973 else
1974 r.height = s->height;
1976 else
1978 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
1979 r.x = window_box_left (s->w, s->area);
1980 r.width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
1981 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1984 if (s->clip_head)
1985 if (r.x < s->clip_head->x)
1987 if (r.width >= s->clip_head->x - r.x)
1988 r.width -= s->clip_head->x - r.x;
1989 else
1990 r.width = 0;
1991 r.x = s->clip_head->x;
1993 if (s->clip_tail)
1994 if (r.x + r.width > s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width)
1996 if (s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width >= r.x)
1997 r.width = s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width - r.x;
1998 else
1999 r.width = 0;
2002 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
2003 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
2004 intentionally draws over other lines. */
2005 if (s->for_overlaps)
2007 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2008 r.height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r.y;
2010 /* Alas, the above simple strategy does not work for the
2011 environments with anti-aliased text: if the same text is
2012 drawn onto the same place multiple times, it gets thicker.
2013 If the overlap we are processing is for the erased cursor, we
2014 take the intersection with the rectangle of the cursor. */
2015 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR)
2017 XRectangle rc, r_save = r;
2019 rc.x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->w->phys_cursor.x);
2020 rc.y = s->w->phys_cursor.y;
2021 rc.width = s->w->phys_cursor_width;
2022 rc.height = s->w->phys_cursor_height;
2024 x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, &rc, &r);
2027 else
2029 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
2030 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
2031 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
2032 if (!s->row->full_width_p
2033 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
2034 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2035 else
2036 r.y = max (0, s->row->y);
2039 r.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r.y);
2041 /* If drawing the cursor, don't let glyph draw outside its
2042 advertised boundaries. Cleartype does this under some circumstances. */
2043 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2045 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
2046 int height, max_y;
2048 if (s->x > r.x)
2050 r.width -= s->x - r.x;
2051 r.x = s->x;
2053 r.width = min (r.width, glyph->pixel_width);
2055 /* If r.y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2056 height = min (glyph->ascent + glyph->descent,
2057 min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), s->row->visible_height));
2058 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - height;
2059 max_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, max_y);
2060 if (s->ybase - glyph->ascent > max_y)
2062 r.y = max_y;
2063 r.height = height;
2065 else
2067 /* Don't draw cursor glyph taller than our actual glyph. */
2068 height = max (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2069 if (height < r.height)
2071 max_y = r.y + r.height;
2072 r.y = min (max_y, max (r.y, s->ybase + glyph->descent - height));
2073 r.height = min (max_y - r.y, height);
2078 if (s->row->clip)
2080 XRectangle r_save = r;
2082 if (! x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, s->row->clip, &r))
2083 r.width = 0;
2086 if ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == 0
2087 || ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == OVERLAPS_BOTH && n == 1))
2089 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2090 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (r, *rects);
2091 #else
2092 *rects = r;
2093 #endif
2094 return 1;
2096 else
2098 /* If we are processing overlapping and allowed to return
2099 multiple clipping rectangles, we exclude the row of the glyph
2100 string from the clipping rectangle. This is to avoid drawing
2101 the same text on the environment with anti-aliasing. */
2102 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2103 XRectangle rs[2];
2104 #else
2105 XRectangle *rs = rects;
2106 #endif
2107 int i = 0, row_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, s->row->y);
2109 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_PRED)
2111 rs[i] = r;
2112 if (r.y + r.height > row_y)
2114 if (r.y < row_y)
2115 rs[i].height = row_y - r.y;
2116 else
2117 rs[i].height = 0;
2119 i++;
2121 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_SUCC)
2123 rs[i] = r;
2124 if (r.y < row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2126 if (r.y + r.height > row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2128 rs[i].y = row_y + s->row->visible_height;
2129 rs[i].height = r.y + r.height - rs[i].y;
2131 else
2132 rs[i].height = 0;
2134 i++;
2137 n = i;
2138 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2139 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
2140 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (rs[i], rects[i]);
2141 #endif
2142 return n;
2146 /* EXPORT:
2147 Return in *NR the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2149 void
2150 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *nr)
2152 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, nr, 1);
2156 /* EXPORT:
2157 Return the position and height of the phys cursor in window W.
2158 Set w->phys_cursor_width to width of phys cursor.
2161 void
2162 get_phys_cursor_geometry (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
2163 struct glyph *glyph, int *xp, int *yp, int *heightp)
2165 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
2166 int x, y, wd, h, h0, y0;
2168 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
2169 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
2170 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
2171 width instead. */
2172 wd = glyph->pixel_width - 1;
2173 #if defined (HAVE_NTGUI) || defined (HAVE_NS)
2174 wd++; /* Why? */
2175 #endif
2177 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
2178 if (x < 0)
2180 wd += x;
2181 x = 0;
2184 if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
2185 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2186 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
2187 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
2189 y = w->phys_cursor.y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent;
2191 /* If y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2192 h0 = min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->visible_height);
2194 h = max (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2195 h0 = min (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2197 y0 = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2198 if (y < y0)
2200 h = max (h - (y0 - y) + 1, h0);
2201 y = y0 - 1;
2203 else
2205 y0 = window_text_bottom_y (w) - h0;
2206 if (y > y0)
2208 h += y - y0;
2209 y = y0;
2213 *xp = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, x);
2214 *yp = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, y);
2215 *heightp = h;
2219 * Remember which glyph the mouse is over.
2222 void
2223 remember_mouse_glyph (struct frame *f, int gx, int gy, NativeRectangle *rect)
2225 Lisp_Object window;
2226 struct window *w;
2227 struct glyph_row *r, *gr, *end_row;
2228 enum window_part part;
2229 enum glyph_row_area area;
2230 int x, y, width, height;
2232 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
2233 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F. */
2235 if (!f->glyphs_initialized_p
2236 || (window = window_from_coordinates (f, gx, gy, &part, 0),
2237 NILP (window)))
2239 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f);
2240 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f);
2241 goto virtual_glyph;
2244 w = XWINDOW (window);
2245 width = WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
2246 height = WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2248 x = window_relative_x_coord (w, part, gx);
2249 y = gy - WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2251 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
2252 end_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
2254 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
2256 area = TEXT_AREA;
2257 part = ON_MODE_LINE; /* Don't adjust margin. */
2258 goto text_glyph;
2261 switch (part)
2263 case ON_LEFT_MARGIN:
2264 area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
2265 goto text_glyph;
2267 case ON_RIGHT_MARGIN:
2268 area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
2269 goto text_glyph;
2271 case ON_HEADER_LINE:
2272 case ON_MODE_LINE:
2273 gr = (part == ON_HEADER_LINE
2274 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
2275 : MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
2276 gy = gr->y;
2277 area = TEXT_AREA;
2278 goto text_glyph_row_found;
2280 case ON_TEXT:
2281 area = TEXT_AREA;
2283 text_glyph:
2284 gr = 0; gy = 0;
2285 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2286 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2288 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2289 break;
2292 text_glyph_row_found:
2293 if (gr && gy <= y)
2295 struct glyph *g = gr->glyphs[area];
2296 struct glyph *end = g + gr->used[area];
2298 height = gr->height;
2299 for (gx = gr->x; g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
2300 if (gx + g->pixel_width > x)
2301 break;
2303 if (g < end)
2305 if (g->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
2307 /* Don't remember when mouse is over image, as
2308 image may have hot-spots. */
2309 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, 0, 0, 0, 0);
2310 return;
2312 width = g->pixel_width;
2314 else
2316 /* Use nominal char spacing at end of line. */
2317 x -= gx;
2318 gx += (x / width) * width;
2321 if (part != ON_MODE_LINE && part != ON_HEADER_LINE)
2322 gx += window_box_left_offset (w, area);
2324 else
2326 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2327 gx = (x / width) * width;
2328 y -= gy;
2329 gy += (y / height) * height;
2331 break;
2333 case ON_LEFT_FRINGE:
2334 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2335 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w)
2336 : window_box_right_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
2337 width = WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2338 goto row_glyph;
2340 case ON_RIGHT_FRINGE:
2341 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2342 ? window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2343 : window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA));
2344 width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2345 goto row_glyph;
2347 case ON_SCROLL_BAR:
2348 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w)
2350 : (window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2351 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2352 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
2353 : 0)));
2354 width = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
2356 row_glyph:
2357 gr = 0, gy = 0;
2358 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2359 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2361 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2362 break;
2365 if (gr && gy <= y)
2366 height = gr->height;
2367 else
2369 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2370 y -= gy;
2371 gy += (y / height) * height;
2373 break;
2375 default:
2377 virtual_glyph:
2378 /* If there is no glyph under the mouse, then we divide the screen
2379 into a grid of the smallest glyph in the frame, and use that
2380 as our "glyph". */
2382 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
2383 round down even for negative values. */
2384 if (gx < 0)
2385 gx -= width - 1;
2386 if (gy < 0)
2387 gy -= height - 1;
2389 gx = (gx / width) * width;
2390 gy = (gy / height) * height;
2392 goto store_rect;
2395 gx += WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
2396 gy += WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2398 store_rect:
2399 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, gx, gy, width, height);
2401 /* Visible feedback for debugging. */
2402 #if 0
2403 #if HAVE_X_WINDOWS
2404 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2405 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2406 gx, gy, width, height);
2407 #endif
2408 #endif
2412 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
2415 /***********************************************************************
2416 Lisp form evaluation
2417 ***********************************************************************/
2419 /* Error handler for safe_eval and safe_call. */
2421 static Lisp_Object
2422 safe_eval_handler (Lisp_Object arg, ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
2424 add_to_log ("Error during redisplay: %S signaled %S",
2425 Flist (nargs, args), arg);
2426 return Qnil;
2429 /* Call function FUNC with the rest of NARGS - 1 arguments
2430 following. Return the result, or nil if something went
2431 wrong. Prevent redisplay during the evaluation. */
2433 Lisp_Object
2434 safe_call (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object func, ...)
2436 Lisp_Object val;
2438 if (inhibit_eval_during_redisplay)
2439 val = Qnil;
2440 else
2442 va_list ap;
2443 ptrdiff_t i;
2444 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
2445 struct gcpro gcpro1;
2446 Lisp_Object *args = alloca (nargs * word_size);
2448 args[0] = func;
2449 va_start (ap, func);
2450 for (i = 1; i < nargs; i++)
2451 args[i] = va_arg (ap, Lisp_Object);
2452 va_end (ap);
2454 GCPRO1 (args[0]);
2455 gcpro1.nvars = nargs;
2456 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
2457 /* Use Qt to ensure debugger does not run,
2458 so there is no possibility of wanting to redisplay. */
2459 val = internal_condition_case_n (Ffuncall, nargs, args, Qt,
2460 safe_eval_handler);
2461 UNGCPRO;
2462 val = unbind_to (count, val);
2465 return val;
2469 /* Call function FN with one argument ARG.
2470 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2472 Lisp_Object
2473 safe_call1 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg)
2475 return safe_call (2, fn, arg);
2478 static Lisp_Object Qeval;
2480 Lisp_Object
2481 safe_eval (Lisp_Object sexpr)
2483 return safe_call1 (Qeval, sexpr);
2486 /* Call function FN with two arguments ARG1 and ARG2.
2487 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2489 Lisp_Object
2490 safe_call2 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
2492 return safe_call (3, fn, arg1, arg2);
2497 /***********************************************************************
2498 Debugging
2499 ***********************************************************************/
2501 #if 0
2503 /* Define CHECK_IT to perform sanity checks on iterators.
2504 This is for debugging. It is too slow to do unconditionally. */
2506 static void
2507 check_it (struct it *it)
2509 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
2511 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
2512 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
2514 else
2516 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < 0);
2517 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
2519 /* Check that character and byte positions agree. */
2520 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BYTE_TO_CHAR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)));
2524 if (it->dpvec)
2525 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
2526 else
2527 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index < 0);
2530 #define CHECK_IT(IT) check_it ((IT))
2532 #else /* not 0 */
2534 #define CHECK_IT(IT) (void) 0
2536 #endif /* not 0 */
2539 #if defined GLYPH_DEBUG && defined ENABLE_CHECKING
2541 /* Check that the window end of window W is what we expect it
2542 to be---the last row in the current matrix displaying text. */
2544 static void
2545 check_window_end (struct window *w)
2547 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
2548 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
2550 struct glyph_row *row;
2551 eassert ((row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix,
2552 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos)),
2553 !row->enabled_p
2554 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
2555 || MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix) == 0));
2559 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) check_window_end ((W))
2561 #else
2563 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) (void) 0
2565 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG and ENABLE_CHECKING */
2569 /***********************************************************************
2570 Iterator initialization
2571 ***********************************************************************/
2573 /* Initialize IT for displaying current_buffer in window W, starting
2574 at character position CHARPOS. CHARPOS < 0 means that no buffer
2575 position is specified which is useful when the iterator is assigned
2576 a position later. BYTEPOS is the byte position corresponding to
2577 CHARPOS. BYTEPOS < 0 means compute it from CHARPOS.
2579 If ROW is not null, calls to produce_glyphs with IT as parameter
2580 will produce glyphs in that row.
2582 BASE_FACE_ID is the id of a base face to use. It must be one of
2583 DEFAULT_FACE_ID for normal text, MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2584 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID for displaying
2585 mode lines, or TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID for displaying the tool-bar.
2587 If ROW is null and BASE_FACE_ID is equal to MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2588 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID, the iterator
2589 will be initialized to use the corresponding mode line glyph row of
2590 the desired matrix of W. */
2592 void
2593 init_iterator (struct it *it, struct window *w,
2594 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos,
2595 struct glyph_row *row, enum face_id base_face_id)
2597 int highlight_region_p;
2598 enum face_id remapped_base_face_id = base_face_id;
2600 /* Some precondition checks. */
2601 eassert (w != NULL && it != NULL);
2602 eassert (charpos < 0 || (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer)
2603 && charpos <= ZV));
2605 /* If face attributes have been changed since the last redisplay,
2606 free realized faces now because they depend on face definitions
2607 that might have changed. Don't free faces while there might be
2608 desired matrices pending which reference these faces. */
2609 if (face_change_count && !inhibit_free_realized_faces)
2611 face_change_count = 0;
2612 free_all_realized_faces (Qnil);
2615 /* Perhaps remap BASE_FACE_ID to a user-specified alternative. */
2616 if (! NILP (Vface_remapping_alist))
2617 remapped_base_face_id
2618 = lookup_basic_face (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face_id);
2620 /* Use one of the mode line rows of W's desired matrix if
2621 appropriate. */
2622 if (row == NULL)
2624 if (base_face_id == MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
2625 || base_face_id == MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
2626 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2627 else if (base_face_id == HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID)
2628 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2631 /* Clear IT. */
2632 memset (it, 0, sizeof *it);
2633 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
2634 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
2635 it->base_face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2636 it->string = Qnil;
2637 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
2638 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2639 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
2640 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
2641 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
2643 /* The window in which we iterate over current_buffer: */
2644 XSETWINDOW (it->window, w);
2645 it->w = w;
2646 it->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
2648 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
2650 /* Extra space between lines (on window systems only). */
2651 if (base_face_id == DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2652 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
2654 if (NATNUMP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2655 it->extra_line_spacing = XFASTINT (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing));
2656 else if (FLOATP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2657 it->extra_line_spacing = (XFLOAT_DATA (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing))
2658 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
2659 else if (it->f->extra_line_spacing > 0)
2660 it->extra_line_spacing = it->f->extra_line_spacing;
2661 it->max_extra_line_spacing = 0;
2664 /* If realized faces have been removed, e.g. because of face
2665 attribute changes of named faces, recompute them. When running
2666 in batch mode, the face cache of the initial frame is null. If
2667 we happen to get called, make a dummy face cache. */
2668 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f) == NULL)
2669 init_frame_faces (it->f);
2670 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f)->used == 0)
2671 recompute_basic_faces (it->f);
2673 /* Current value of the `slice', `space-width', and 'height' properties. */
2674 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
2675 it->space_width = Qnil;
2676 it->font_height = Qnil;
2677 it->override_ascent = -1;
2679 /* Are control characters displayed as `^C'? */
2680 it->ctl_arrow_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, ctl_arrow));
2682 /* -1 means everything between a CR and the following line end
2683 is invisible. >0 means lines indented more than this value are
2684 invisible. */
2685 it->selective = (INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2686 ? (clip_to_bounds
2687 (-1, XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)),
2688 PTRDIFF_MAX))
2689 : (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2690 ? -1 : 0));
2691 it->selective_display_ellipsis_p
2692 = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display_ellipses));
2694 /* Display table to use. */
2695 it->dp = window_display_table (w);
2697 /* Are multibyte characters enabled in current_buffer? */
2698 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
2700 /* Non-zero if we should highlight the region. */
2701 highlight_region_p
2702 = (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
2703 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active))
2704 && XMARKER (BVAR (current_buffer, mark))->buffer != 0);
2706 /* Set IT->region_beg_charpos and IT->region_end_charpos to the
2707 start and end of a visible region in window IT->w. Set both to
2708 -1 to indicate no region. */
2709 if (highlight_region_p
2710 /* Maybe highlight only in selected window. */
2711 && (/* Either show region everywhere. */
2712 highlight_nonselected_windows
2713 /* Or show region in the selected window. */
2714 || w == XWINDOW (selected_window)
2715 /* Or show the region if we are in the mini-buffer and W is
2716 the window the mini-buffer refers to. */
2717 || (MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))
2718 && WINDOWP (minibuf_selected_window)
2719 && w == XWINDOW (minibuf_selected_window))))
2721 ptrdiff_t markpos = marker_position (BVAR (current_buffer, mark));
2722 it->region_beg_charpos = min (PT, markpos);
2723 it->region_end_charpos = max (PT, markpos);
2725 else
2726 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
2728 /* Get the position at which the redisplay_end_trigger hook should
2729 be run, if it is to be run at all. */
2730 if (MARKERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger)
2731 && XMARKER (w->redisplay_end_trigger)->buffer != 0)
2732 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
2733 = marker_position (w->redisplay_end_trigger);
2734 else if (INTEGERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger))
2735 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos =
2736 clip_to_bounds (PTRDIFF_MIN, XINT (w->redisplay_end_trigger), PTRDIFF_MAX);
2738 it->tab_width = SANE_TAB_WIDTH (current_buffer);
2740 /* Are lines in the display truncated? */
2741 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2742 || it->w->hscroll
2743 || (! WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (it->w)
2744 && ((!NILP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2745 && !INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))
2746 || (INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2747 && (WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (it->w)
2748 < XINT (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))))))
2749 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2750 else if (NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, truncate_lines)))
2751 it->line_wrap = NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, word_wrap))
2752 ? WINDOW_WRAP : WORD_WRAP;
2753 else
2754 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2756 /* Get dimensions of truncation and continuation glyphs. These are
2757 displayed as fringe bitmaps under X, but we need them for such
2758 frames when the fringes are turned off. But leave the dimensions
2759 zero for tooltip frames, as these glyphs look ugly there and also
2760 sabotage calculations of tooltip dimensions in x-show-tip. */
2761 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
2762 if (!(FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2763 && FRAMEP (tip_frame)
2764 && it->f == XFRAME (tip_frame)))
2765 #endif
2767 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2769 /* We will need the truncation glyph. */
2770 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2771 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
2772 it->truncation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2774 else
2776 /* We will need the continuation glyph. */
2777 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2778 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
2779 it->continuation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2783 /* Reset these values to zero because the produce_special_glyphs
2784 above has changed them. */
2785 it->pixel_width = it->ascent = it->descent = 0;
2786 it->phys_ascent = it->phys_descent = 0;
2788 /* Set this after getting the dimensions of truncation and
2789 continuation glyphs, so that we don't produce glyphs when calling
2790 produce_special_glyphs, above. */
2791 it->glyph_row = row;
2792 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
2794 /* Forget any previous info about this row being reversed. */
2795 if (it->glyph_row)
2796 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = 0;
2798 /* Get the dimensions of the display area. The display area
2799 consists of the visible window area plus a horizontally scrolled
2800 part to the left of the window. All x-values are relative to the
2801 start of this total display area. */
2802 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2804 /* Mode lines, menu bar in terminal frames. */
2805 it->first_visible_x = 0;
2806 it->last_visible_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
2808 else
2810 it->first_visible_x =
2811 window_hscroll_limited (it->w, it->f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
2812 it->last_visible_x = (it->first_visible_x
2813 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
2815 /* If we truncate lines, leave room for the truncation glyph(s) at
2816 the right margin. Otherwise, leave room for the continuation
2817 glyph(s). Done only if the window has no fringes. Since we
2818 don't know at this point whether there will be any R2L lines in
2819 the window, we reserve space for truncation/continuation glyphs
2820 even if only one of the fringes is absent. */
2821 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
2822 || (it->bidi_p && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0))
2824 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2825 it->last_visible_x -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
2826 else
2827 it->last_visible_x -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
2830 it->header_line_p = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w);
2831 it->current_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) + w->vscroll;
2834 /* Leave room for a border glyph. */
2835 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2836 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (it->w))
2837 it->last_visible_x -= 1;
2839 it->last_visible_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
2841 /* For mode lines and alike, arrange for the first glyph having a
2842 left box line if the face specifies a box. */
2843 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2845 struct face *face;
2847 it->face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2849 /* If we have a boxed mode line, make the first character appear
2850 with a left box line. */
2851 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, remapped_base_face_id);
2852 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2853 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
2856 /* If a buffer position was specified, set the iterator there,
2857 getting overlays and face properties from that position. */
2858 if (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer))
2860 it->end_charpos = ZV;
2861 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = charpos;
2863 /* We will rely on `reseat' to set this up properly, via
2864 handle_face_prop. */
2865 it->face_id = it->base_face_id;
2867 /* Compute byte position if not specified. */
2868 if (bytepos < charpos)
2869 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
2870 else
2871 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = bytepos;
2873 it->start = it->current;
2874 /* Do we need to reorder bidirectional text? Not if this is a
2875 unibyte buffer: by definition, none of the single-byte
2876 characters are strong R2L, so no reordering is needed. And
2877 bidi.c doesn't support unibyte buffers anyway. Also, don't
2878 reorder while we are loading loadup.el, since the tables of
2879 character properties needed for reordering are not yet
2880 available. */
2881 it->bidi_p =
2882 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
2883 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering))
2884 && it->multibyte_p;
2886 /* If we are to reorder bidirectional text, init the bidi
2887 iterator. */
2888 if (it->bidi_p)
2890 /* Note the paragraph direction that this buffer wants to
2891 use. */
2892 if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2893 Qleft_to_right))
2894 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2895 else if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2896 Qright_to_left))
2897 it->paragraph_embedding = R2L;
2898 else
2899 it->paragraph_embedding = NEUTRAL_DIR;
2900 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
2901 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
2902 &it->bidi_it);
2905 /* Compute faces etc. */
2906 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
2909 CHECK_IT (it);
2913 /* Initialize IT for the display of window W with window start POS. */
2915 void
2916 start_display (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct text_pos pos)
2918 struct glyph_row *row;
2919 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
2921 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + first_vpos;
2922 init_iterator (it, w, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos), row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
2923 it->first_vpos = first_vpos;
2925 /* Don't reseat to previous visible line start if current start
2926 position is in a string or image. */
2927 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
2929 int start_at_line_beg_p;
2930 int first_y = it->current_y;
2932 /* If window start is not at a line start, skip forward to POS to
2933 get the correct continuation lines width. */
2934 start_at_line_beg_p = (CHARPOS (pos) == BEGV
2935 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (pos) - 1) == '\n');
2936 if (!start_at_line_beg_p)
2938 int new_x;
2940 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (it);
2941 move_it_to (it, CHARPOS (pos), -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
2943 new_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width;
2945 /* If lines are continued, this line may end in the middle
2946 of a multi-glyph character (e.g. a control character
2947 displayed as \003, or in the middle of an overlay
2948 string). In this case move_it_to above will not have
2949 taken us to the start of the continuation line but to the
2950 end of the continued line. */
2951 if (it->current_x > 0
2952 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE /* Lines are continued. */
2953 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
2954 new_x > it->last_visible_x
2955 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
2956 system frame. */
2957 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
2958 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2959 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
2960 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
2961 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
2963 if ((it->current.dpvec_index >= 0
2964 || it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
2965 /* If we are on a newline from a display vector or
2966 overlay string, then we are already at the end of
2967 a screen line; no need to go to the next line in
2968 that case, as this line is not really continued.
2969 (If we do go to the next line, C-e will not DTRT.) */
2970 && it->c != '\n')
2972 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
2973 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
2976 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
2978 /* If the character at POS is displayed via a display
2979 vector, move_it_to above stops at the final glyph of
2980 IT->dpvec. To make the caller redisplay that character
2981 again (a.k.a. start at POS), we need to reset the
2982 dpvec_index to the beginning of IT->dpvec. */
2983 else if (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0)
2984 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
2986 /* We're starting a new display line, not affected by the
2987 height of the continued line, so clear the appropriate
2988 fields in the iterator structure. */
2989 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
2990 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
2992 it->current_y = first_y;
2993 it->vpos = 0;
2994 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
3000 /* Return 1 if POS is a position in ellipses displayed for invisible
3001 text. W is the window we display, for text property lookup. */
3003 static int
3004 in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *pos, struct window *w)
3006 Lisp_Object prop, window;
3007 int ellipses_p = 0;
3008 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos);
3010 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3011 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3012 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3013 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3014 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0
3015 && pos->overlay_string_index < 0
3016 && CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) < 0
3017 && charpos > BEGV
3018 && (XSETWINDOW (window, w),
3019 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos),
3020 Qinvisible, window),
3021 !TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop)))
3023 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qinvisible,
3024 window);
3025 ellipses_p = 2 == TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
3028 return ellipses_p;
3032 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W,
3033 starting at position POS that includes overlay string and display
3034 vector/ control character translation position information. Value
3035 is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at POS. */
3037 static int
3038 init_from_display_pos (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct display_pos *pos)
3040 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos), bytepos = BYTEPOS (pos->pos);
3041 int i, overlay_strings_with_newlines = 0;
3043 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3044 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3045 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3046 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3047 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (pos, w))
3049 --charpos;
3050 bytepos = 0;
3053 /* Keep in mind: the call to reseat in init_iterator skips invisible
3054 text, so we might end up at a position different from POS. This
3055 is only a problem when POS is a row start after a newline and an
3056 overlay starts there with an after-string, and the overlay has an
3057 invisible property. Since we don't skip invisible text in
3058 display_line and elsewhere immediately after consuming the
3059 newline before the row start, such a POS will not be in a string,
3060 but the call to init_iterator below will move us to the
3061 after-string. */
3062 init_iterator (it, w, charpos, bytepos, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
3064 /* This only scans the current chunk -- it should scan all chunks.
3065 However, OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE has been increased from 3 in 21.1
3066 to 16 in 22.1 to make this a lesser problem. */
3067 for (i = 0; i < it->n_overlay_strings && i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE; ++i)
3069 const char *s = SSDATA (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3070 const char *e = s + SBYTES (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3072 while (s < e && *s != '\n')
3073 ++s;
3075 if (s < e)
3077 overlay_strings_with_newlines = 1;
3078 break;
3082 /* If position is within an overlay string, set up IT to the right
3083 overlay string. */
3084 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= 0)
3086 int relative_index;
3088 /* If the first overlay string happens to have a `display'
3089 property for an image, the iterator will be set up for that
3090 image, and we have to undo that setup first before we can
3091 correct the overlay string index. */
3092 if (it->method == GET_FROM_IMAGE)
3093 pop_it (it);
3095 /* We already have the first chunk of overlay strings in
3096 IT->overlay_strings. Load more until the one for
3097 pos->overlay_string_index is in IT->overlay_strings. */
3098 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE)
3100 ptrdiff_t n = pos->overlay_string_index / OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3101 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
3102 while (n--)
3104 load_overlay_strings (it, 0);
3105 it->current.overlay_string_index += OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3109 it->current.overlay_string_index = pos->overlay_string_index;
3110 relative_index = (it->current.overlay_string_index
3111 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE);
3112 it->string = it->overlay_strings[relative_index];
3113 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3114 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3115 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
3116 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
3117 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
3118 if (it->bidi_p)
3120 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
3121 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
3122 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
3123 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
3124 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
3125 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
3126 bidi_init_it (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
3127 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
3129 /* Synchronize the state of the bidi iterator with
3130 pos->string_pos. For any string position other than
3131 zero, this will be done automagically when we resume
3132 iteration over the string and get_visually_first_element
3133 is called. But if string_pos is zero, and the string is
3134 to be reordered for display, we need to resync manually,
3135 since it could be that the iteration state recorded in
3136 pos ended at string_pos of 0 moving backwards in string. */
3137 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) == 0)
3139 get_visually_first_element (it);
3140 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) != 0)
3141 do {
3142 /* Paranoia. */
3143 eassert (it->bidi_it.charpos < it->bidi_it.string.schars);
3144 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
3145 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != 0);
3147 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
3148 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos);
3152 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) >= 0)
3154 /* Recorded position is not in an overlay string, but in another
3155 string. This can only be a string from a `display' property.
3156 IT should already be filled with that string. */
3157 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3158 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3159 if (it->bidi_p)
3160 bidi_init_it (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
3161 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
3164 /* Restore position in display vector translations, control
3165 character translations or ellipses. */
3166 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0)
3168 if (it->dpvec == NULL)
3169 get_next_display_element (it);
3170 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index == 0);
3171 it->current.dpvec_index = pos->dpvec_index;
3174 CHECK_IT (it);
3175 return !overlay_strings_with_newlines;
3179 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3180 starting at ROW->start. */
3182 static void
3183 init_to_row_start (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3185 init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->start);
3186 it->start = row->start;
3187 it->continuation_lines_width = row->continuation_lines_width;
3188 CHECK_IT (it);
3192 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3193 starting in the line following ROW, i.e. starting at ROW->end.
3194 Value is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at ROW's
3195 end position. */
3197 static int
3198 init_to_row_end (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3200 int success = 0;
3202 if (init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->end))
3204 if (row->continued_p)
3205 it->continuation_lines_width
3206 = row->continuation_lines_width + row->pixel_width;
3207 CHECK_IT (it);
3208 success = 1;
3211 return success;
3217 /***********************************************************************
3218 Text properties
3219 ***********************************************************************/
3221 /* Called when IT reaches IT->stop_charpos. Handle text property and
3222 overlay changes. Set IT->stop_charpos to the next position where
3223 to stop. */
3225 static void
3226 handle_stop (struct it *it)
3228 enum prop_handled handled;
3229 int handle_overlay_change_p;
3230 struct props *p;
3232 it->dpvec = NULL;
3233 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
3234 handle_overlay_change_p = !it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p;
3235 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
3236 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
3238 /* Use face of preceding text for ellipsis (if invisible) */
3239 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
3240 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
3244 handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3246 /* Call text property handlers. */
3247 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3249 handled = p->handler (it);
3251 if (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3252 break;
3253 else if (handled == HANDLED_RETURN)
3255 /* We still want to show before and after strings from
3256 overlays even if the actual buffer text is replaced. */
3257 if (!handle_overlay_change_p
3258 || it->sp > 1
3259 /* Don't call get_overlay_strings_1 if we already
3260 have overlay strings loaded, because doing so
3261 will load them again and push the iterator state
3262 onto the stack one more time, which is not
3263 expected by the rest of the code that processes
3264 overlay strings. */
3265 || (it->current.overlay_string_index < 0
3266 ? !get_overlay_strings_1 (it, 0, 0)
3267 : 0))
3269 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3270 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3271 /* When handling a display spec, we might load an
3272 empty string. In that case, discard it here. We
3273 used to discard it in handle_single_display_spec,
3274 but that causes get_overlay_strings_1, above, to
3275 ignore overlay strings that we must check. */
3276 if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3277 pop_it (it);
3278 return;
3280 else if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3281 pop_it (it);
3282 else
3284 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
3285 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
3286 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
3287 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3289 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3290 break;
3292 else if (handled == HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED)
3293 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3296 if (handled != HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3298 /* Don't check for overlay strings below when set to deliver
3299 characters from a display vector. */
3300 if (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
3301 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3303 /* Handle overlay changes.
3304 This sets HANDLED to HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS
3305 if it finds overlays. */
3306 if (handle_overlay_change_p)
3307 handled = handle_overlay_change (it);
3310 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3312 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3313 break;
3316 while (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS);
3318 /* Determine where to stop next. */
3319 if (handled == HANDLED_NORMALLY)
3320 compute_stop_pos (it);
3324 /* Compute IT->stop_charpos from text property and overlay change
3325 information for IT's current position. */
3327 static void
3328 compute_stop_pos (struct it *it)
3330 register INTERVAL iv, next_iv;
3331 Lisp_Object object, limit, position;
3332 ptrdiff_t charpos, bytepos;
3334 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3336 /* Strings are usually short, so don't limit the search for
3337 properties. */
3338 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3339 object = it->string;
3340 limit = Qnil;
3341 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
3342 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
3344 else
3346 ptrdiff_t pos;
3348 /* If end_charpos is out of range for some reason, such as a
3349 misbehaving display function, rationalize it (Bug#5984). */
3350 if (it->end_charpos > ZV)
3351 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3352 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3354 /* If next overlay change is in front of the current stop pos
3355 (which is IT->end_charpos), stop there. Note: value of
3356 next_overlay_change is point-max if no overlay change
3357 follows. */
3358 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3359 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
3360 pos = next_overlay_change (charpos);
3361 if (pos < it->stop_charpos)
3362 it->stop_charpos = pos;
3364 /* If showing the region, we have to stop at the region
3365 start or end because the face might change there. */
3366 if (it->region_beg_charpos > 0)
3368 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_beg_charpos)
3369 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_beg_charpos);
3370 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_end_charpos)
3371 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_end_charpos);
3374 /* Set up variables for computing the stop position from text
3375 property changes. */
3376 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
3377 limit = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT);
3380 /* Get the interval containing IT's position. Value is a null
3381 interval if there isn't such an interval. */
3382 position = make_number (charpos);
3383 iv = validate_interval_range (object, &position, &position, 0);
3384 if (iv)
3386 Lisp_Object values_here[LAST_PROP_IDX];
3387 struct props *p;
3389 /* Get properties here. */
3390 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3391 values_here[p->idx] = textget (iv->plist, *p->name);
3393 /* Look for an interval following iv that has different
3394 properties. */
3395 for (next_iv = next_interval (iv);
3396 (next_iv
3397 && (NILP (limit)
3398 || XFASTINT (limit) > next_iv->position));
3399 next_iv = next_interval (next_iv))
3401 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3403 Lisp_Object new_value;
3405 new_value = textget (next_iv->plist, *p->name);
3406 if (!EQ (values_here[p->idx], new_value))
3407 break;
3410 if (p->handler)
3411 break;
3414 if (next_iv)
3416 if (INTEGERP (limit)
3417 && next_iv->position >= XFASTINT (limit))
3418 /* No text property change up to limit. */
3419 it->stop_charpos = min (XFASTINT (limit), it->stop_charpos);
3420 else
3421 /* Text properties change in next_iv. */
3422 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, next_iv->position);
3426 if (it->cmp_it.id < 0)
3428 ptrdiff_t stoppos = it->end_charpos;
3430 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
3431 stoppos = -1;
3432 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos,
3433 stoppos, it->string);
3436 eassert (STRINGP (it->string)
3437 || (it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
3438 && it->stop_charpos >= IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
3442 /* Return the position of the next overlay change after POS in
3443 current_buffer. Value is point-max if no overlay change
3444 follows. This is like `next-overlay-change' but doesn't use
3445 xmalloc. */
3447 static ptrdiff_t
3448 next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t pos)
3450 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
3451 ptrdiff_t endpos;
3452 Lisp_Object *overlays;
3454 /* Get all overlays at the given position. */
3455 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlays, noverlays, &endpos, 1);
3457 /* If any of these overlays ends before endpos,
3458 use its ending point instead. */
3459 for (i = 0; i < noverlays; ++i)
3461 Lisp_Object oend;
3462 ptrdiff_t oendpos;
3464 oend = OVERLAY_END (overlays[i]);
3465 oendpos = OVERLAY_POSITION (oend);
3466 endpos = min (endpos, oendpos);
3469 return endpos;
3472 /* How many characters forward to search for a display property or
3473 display string. Searching too far forward makes the bidi display
3474 sluggish, especially in small windows. */
3475 #define MAX_DISP_SCAN 250
3477 /* Return the character position of a display string at or after
3478 position specified by POSITION. If no display string exists at or
3479 after POSITION, return ZV. A display string is either an overlay
3480 with `display' property whose value is a string, or a `display'
3481 text property whose value is a string. STRING is data about the
3482 string to iterate; if STRING->lstring is nil, we are iterating a
3483 buffer. FRAME_WINDOW_P is non-zero when we are displaying a window
3484 on a GUI frame. DISP_PROP is set to zero if we searched
3485 MAX_DISP_SCAN characters forward without finding any display
3486 strings, non-zero otherwise. It is set to 2 if the display string
3487 uses any kind of `(space ...)' spec that will produce a stretch of
3488 white space in the text area. */
3489 ptrdiff_t
3490 compute_display_string_pos (struct text_pos *position,
3491 struct bidi_string_data *string,
3492 int frame_window_p, int *disp_prop)
3494 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3495 Lisp_Object object =
3496 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3497 Lisp_Object pos, spec, limpos;
3498 int string_p = (string && (STRINGP (string->lstring) || string->s));
3499 ptrdiff_t eob = string_p ? string->schars : ZV;
3500 ptrdiff_t begb = string_p ? 0 : BEGV;
3501 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos = CHARPOS (*position);
3502 ptrdiff_t lim =
3503 (charpos < eob - MAX_DISP_SCAN) ? charpos + MAX_DISP_SCAN : eob;
3504 struct text_pos tpos;
3505 int rv = 0;
3507 *disp_prop = 1;
3509 if (charpos >= eob
3510 /* We don't support display properties whose values are strings
3511 that have display string properties. */
3512 || string->from_disp_str
3513 /* C strings cannot have display properties. */
3514 || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3516 *disp_prop = 0;
3517 return eob;
3520 /* If the character at CHARPOS is where the display string begins,
3521 return CHARPOS. */
3522 pos = make_number (charpos);
3523 if (STRINGP (object))
3524 bufpos = string->bufpos;
3525 else
3526 bufpos = charpos;
3527 tpos = *position;
3528 if (!NILP (spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object))
3529 && (charpos <= begb
3530 || !EQ (Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qdisplay,
3531 object),
3532 spec))
3533 && (rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos, bufpos,
3534 frame_window_p)))
3536 if (rv == 2)
3537 *disp_prop = 2;
3538 return charpos;
3541 /* Look forward for the first character with a `display' property
3542 that will replace the underlying text when displayed. */
3543 limpos = make_number (lim);
3544 do {
3545 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, limpos);
3546 CHARPOS (tpos) = XFASTINT (pos);
3547 if (CHARPOS (tpos) >= lim)
3549 *disp_prop = 0;
3550 break;
3552 if (STRINGP (object))
3553 BYTEPOS (tpos) = string_char_to_byte (object, CHARPOS (tpos));
3554 else
3555 BYTEPOS (tpos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (CHARPOS (tpos));
3556 spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object);
3557 if (!STRINGP (object))
3558 bufpos = CHARPOS (tpos);
3559 } while (NILP (spec)
3560 || !(rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos,
3561 bufpos, frame_window_p)));
3562 if (rv == 2)
3563 *disp_prop = 2;
3565 return CHARPOS (tpos);
3568 /* Return the character position of the end of the display string that
3569 started at CHARPOS. If there's no display string at CHARPOS,
3570 return -1. A display string is either an overlay with `display'
3571 property whose value is a string or a `display' text property whose
3572 value is a string. */
3573 ptrdiff_t
3574 compute_display_string_end (ptrdiff_t charpos, struct bidi_string_data *string)
3576 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3577 Lisp_Object object =
3578 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3579 Lisp_Object pos = make_number (charpos);
3580 ptrdiff_t eob =
3581 (STRINGP (object) || (string && string->s)) ? string->schars : ZV;
3583 if (charpos >= eob || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3584 return eob;
3586 /* It could happen that the display property or overlay was removed
3587 since we found it in compute_display_string_pos above. One way
3588 this can happen is if JIT font-lock was called (through
3589 handle_fontified_prop), and jit-lock-functions remove text
3590 properties or overlays from the portion of buffer that includes
3591 CHARPOS. Muse mode is known to do that, for example. In this
3592 case, we return -1 to the caller, to signal that no display
3593 string is actually present at CHARPOS. See bidi_fetch_char for
3594 how this is handled.
3596 An alternative would be to never look for display properties past
3597 it->stop_charpos. But neither compute_display_string_pos nor
3598 bidi_fetch_char that calls it know or care where the next
3599 stop_charpos is. */
3600 if (NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object)))
3601 return -1;
3603 /* Look forward for the first character where the `display' property
3604 changes. */
3605 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
3607 return XFASTINT (pos);
3612 /***********************************************************************
3613 Fontification
3614 ***********************************************************************/
3616 /* Handle changes in the `fontified' property of the current buffer by
3617 calling hook functions from Qfontification_functions to fontify
3618 regions of text. */
3620 static enum prop_handled
3621 handle_fontified_prop (struct it *it)
3623 Lisp_Object prop, pos;
3624 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3626 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
3627 return handled;
3629 /* Get the value of the `fontified' property at IT's current buffer
3630 position. (The `fontified' property doesn't have a special
3631 meaning in strings.) If the value is nil, call functions from
3632 Qfontification_functions. */
3633 if (!STRINGP (it->string)
3634 && it->s == NULL
3635 && !NILP (Vfontification_functions)
3636 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks)
3637 && (pos = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it)),
3638 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil),
3639 /* Ignore the special cased nil value always present at EOB since
3640 no amount of fontifying will be able to change it. */
3641 NILP (prop) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < Z))
3643 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
3644 Lisp_Object val;
3645 struct buffer *obuf = current_buffer;
3646 int begv = BEGV, zv = ZV;
3647 int old_clip_changed = current_buffer->clip_changed;
3649 val = Vfontification_functions;
3650 specbind (Qfontification_functions, Qnil);
3652 eassert (it->end_charpos == ZV);
3654 if (!CONSP (val) || EQ (XCAR (val), Qlambda))
3655 safe_call1 (val, pos);
3656 else
3658 Lisp_Object fns, fn;
3659 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
3661 fns = Qnil;
3662 GCPRO2 (val, fns);
3664 for (; CONSP (val); val = XCDR (val))
3666 fn = XCAR (val);
3668 if (EQ (fn, Qt))
3670 /* A value of t indicates this hook has a local
3671 binding; it means to run the global binding too.
3672 In a global value, t should not occur. If it
3673 does, we must ignore it to avoid an endless
3674 loop. */
3675 for (fns = Fdefault_value (Qfontification_functions);
3676 CONSP (fns);
3677 fns = XCDR (fns))
3679 fn = XCAR (fns);
3680 if (!EQ (fn, Qt))
3681 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3684 else
3685 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3688 UNGCPRO;
3691 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
3693 /* Fontification functions routinely call `save-restriction'.
3694 Normally, this tags clip_changed, which can confuse redisplay
3695 (see discussion in Bug#6671). Since we don't perform any
3696 special handling of fontification changes in the case where
3697 `save-restriction' isn't called, there's no point doing so in
3698 this case either. So, if the buffer's restrictions are
3699 actually left unchanged, reset clip_changed. */
3700 if (obuf == current_buffer)
3702 if (begv == BEGV && zv == ZV)
3703 current_buffer->clip_changed = old_clip_changed;
3705 /* There isn't much we can reasonably do to protect against
3706 misbehaving fontification, but here's a fig leaf. */
3707 else if (BUFFER_LIVE_P (obuf))
3708 set_buffer_internal_1 (obuf);
3710 /* The fontification code may have added/removed text.
3711 It could do even a lot worse, but let's at least protect against
3712 the most obvious case where only the text past `pos' gets changed',
3713 as is/was done in grep.el where some escapes sequences are turned
3714 into face properties (bug#7876). */
3715 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3717 /* Return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS only if function fontified
3718 something. This avoids an endless loop if they failed to
3719 fontify the text for which reason ever. */
3720 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil)))
3721 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3724 return handled;
3729 /***********************************************************************
3730 Faces
3731 ***********************************************************************/
3733 /* Set up iterator IT from face properties at its current position.
3734 Called from handle_stop. */
3736 static enum prop_handled
3737 handle_face_prop (struct it *it)
3739 int new_face_id;
3740 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
3742 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
3744 new_face_id
3745 = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
3746 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3747 it->region_beg_charpos,
3748 it->region_end_charpos,
3749 &next_stop,
3750 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3751 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3752 0, it->base_face_id);
3754 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box face?
3755 Caveat: this can be called for a freshly initialized
3756 iterator; face_id is -1 in this case. We know that the new
3757 face will not change until limit, i.e. if the new face has a
3758 box, all characters up to limit will have one. But, as
3759 usual, we don't know whether limit is really the end. */
3760 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3762 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3764 /* If new face has a box but old face has not, this is
3765 the start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has
3766 a shadow on the left side. The value of face_id of the
3767 iterator will be -1 if this is the initial call that gets
3768 the face. In this case, we have to look in front of IT's
3769 position and see whether there is a face != new_face_id. */
3770 it->start_of_box_run_p
3771 = (new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3772 && (it->face_id >= 0
3773 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEG
3774 || new_face_id != face_before_it_pos (it)));
3775 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3778 else
3780 int base_face_id;
3781 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
3782 int i;
3783 Lisp_Object from_overlay
3784 = (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
3785 ? it->string_overlays[it->current.overlay_string_index
3786 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE]
3787 : Qnil);
3789 /* See if we got to this string directly or indirectly from
3790 an overlay property. That includes the before-string or
3791 after-string of an overlay, strings in display properties
3792 provided by an overlay, their text properties, etc.
3794 FROM_OVERLAY is the overlay that brought us here, or nil if none. */
3795 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3796 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3798 if (it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3799 from_overlay
3800 = it->string_overlays[it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index
3801 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE];
3802 else if (! NILP (it->stack[i].from_overlay))
3803 from_overlay = it->stack[i].from_overlay;
3805 if (!NILP (from_overlay))
3806 break;
3809 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3811 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3812 /* For a string from an overlay, the base face depends
3813 only on text properties and ignores overlays. */
3814 base_face_id
3815 = face_for_overlay_string (it->w,
3816 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3817 it->region_beg_charpos,
3818 it->region_end_charpos,
3819 &next_stop,
3820 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3821 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3823 from_overlay);
3825 else
3827 bufpos = 0;
3829 /* For strings from a `display' property, use the face at
3830 IT's current buffer position as the base face to merge
3831 with, so that overlay strings appear in the same face as
3832 surrounding text, unless they specify their own
3833 faces. */
3834 base_face_id = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p
3835 ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
3836 : underlying_face_id (it);
3839 new_face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3840 it->string,
3841 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
3842 bufpos,
3843 it->region_beg_charpos,
3844 it->region_end_charpos,
3845 &next_stop,
3846 base_face_id, 0);
3848 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box? Caveat:
3849 this can be called for a freshly allocated iterator; face_id
3850 is -1 is this case. We know that the new face will not
3851 change until the next check pos, i.e. if the new face has a
3852 box, all characters up to that position will have a
3853 box. But, as usual, we don't know whether that position
3854 is really the end. */
3855 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3857 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3858 struct face *old_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
3860 /* If new face has a box but old face hasn't, this is the
3861 start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has a
3862 shadow on the left side. */
3863 it->start_of_box_run_p
3864 = new_face->box && (old_face == NULL || !old_face->box);
3865 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3869 it->face_id = new_face_id;
3870 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3874 /* Return the ID of the face ``underlying'' IT's current position,
3875 which is in a string. If the iterator is associated with a
3876 buffer, return the face at IT's current buffer position.
3877 Otherwise, use the iterator's base_face_id. */
3879 static int
3880 underlying_face_id (struct it *it)
3882 int face_id = it->base_face_id, i;
3884 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3886 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3887 if (NILP (it->stack[i].string))
3888 face_id = it->stack[i].face_id;
3890 return face_id;
3894 /* Compute the face one character before or after the current position
3895 of IT, in the visual order. BEFORE_P non-zero means get the face
3896 in front (to the left in L2R paragraphs, to the right in R2L
3897 paragraphs) of IT's screen position. Value is the ID of the face. */
3899 static int
3900 face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *it, int before_p)
3902 int face_id, limit;
3903 ptrdiff_t next_check_charpos;
3904 struct it it_copy;
3905 void *it_copy_data = NULL;
3907 eassert (it->s == NULL);
3909 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3911 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos;
3912 int base_face_id;
3914 /* No face change past the end of the string (for the case
3915 we are padding with spaces). No face change before the
3916 string start. */
3917 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string)
3918 || (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 && before_p))
3919 return it->face_id;
3921 if (!it->bidi_p)
3923 /* Set charpos to the position before or after IT's current
3924 position, in the logical order, which in the non-bidi
3925 case is the same as the visual order. */
3926 if (before_p)
3927 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) - 1;
3928 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
3929 /* For composition, we must check the character after the
3930 composition. */
3931 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + it->cmp_it.nchars;
3932 else
3933 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + 1;
3935 else
3937 if (before_p)
3939 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
3940 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
3941 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
3942 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
3943 family of functions. */
3944 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
3945 character on this display line. */
3946 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
3947 return it->face_id;
3948 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
3949 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
3950 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
3951 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
3952 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
3953 cases here. */
3954 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, SCHARS (it_copy.string),
3955 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
3956 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it_copy);
3957 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
3959 else
3961 /* Set charpos to the string position of the character
3962 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
3963 order. */
3964 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
3966 it_copy = *it;
3967 while (n--)
3968 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
3970 charpos = it_copy.bidi_it.charpos;
3973 eassert (0 <= charpos && charpos <= SCHARS (it->string));
3975 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3976 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3977 else
3978 bufpos = 0;
3980 base_face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
3982 /* Get the face for ASCII, or unibyte. */
3983 face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3984 it->string,
3985 charpos,
3986 bufpos,
3987 it->region_beg_charpos,
3988 it->region_end_charpos,
3989 &next_check_charpos,
3990 base_face_id, 0);
3992 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
3993 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
3994 suitable for unibyte text if IT->string is unibyte. */
3995 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
3997 struct text_pos pos1 = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
3998 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (it->string) + BYTEPOS (pos1);
3999 int c, len;
4000 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
4002 c = string_char_and_length (p, &len);
4003 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, charpos, it->string);
4006 else
4008 struct text_pos pos;
4010 if ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= ZV && !before_p)
4011 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV && before_p))
4012 return it->face_id;
4014 limit = IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT;
4015 pos = it->current.pos;
4017 if (!it->bidi_p)
4019 if (before_p)
4020 DEC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
4021 else
4023 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
4025 /* For composition, we must check the position after
4026 the composition. */
4027 pos.charpos += it->cmp_it.nchars;
4028 pos.bytepos += it->len;
4030 else
4031 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
4034 else
4036 if (before_p)
4038 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
4039 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
4040 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
4041 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
4042 family of functions. */
4043 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
4044 character on this display line. */
4045 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
4046 return it->face_id;
4047 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
4048 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
4049 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
4050 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
4051 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
4052 cases here. */
4053 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, ZV,
4054 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
4055 pos = it_copy.current.pos;
4056 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
4058 else
4060 /* Set charpos to the buffer position of the character
4061 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
4062 order. */
4063 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
4065 it_copy = *it;
4066 while (n--)
4067 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
4069 SET_TEXT_POS (pos,
4070 it_copy.bidi_it.charpos, it_copy.bidi_it.bytepos);
4073 eassert (BEGV <= CHARPOS (pos) && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
4075 /* Determine face for CHARSET_ASCII, or unibyte. */
4076 face_id = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
4077 CHARPOS (pos),
4078 it->region_beg_charpos,
4079 it->region_end_charpos,
4080 &next_check_charpos,
4081 limit, 0, -1);
4083 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
4084 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
4085 suitable for unibyte text if current_buffer is unibyte. */
4086 if (it->multibyte_p)
4088 int c = FETCH_MULTIBYTE_CHAR (BYTEPOS (pos));
4089 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
4090 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, CHARPOS (pos), Qnil);
4094 return face_id;
4099 /***********************************************************************
4100 Invisible text
4101 ***********************************************************************/
4103 /* Set up iterator IT from invisible properties at its current
4104 position. Called from handle_stop. */
4106 static enum prop_handled
4107 handle_invisible_prop (struct it *it)
4109 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4110 int invis_p;
4111 Lisp_Object prop;
4113 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4115 Lisp_Object end_charpos, limit, charpos;
4117 /* Get the value of the invisible text property at the
4118 current position. Value will be nil if there is no such
4119 property. */
4120 charpos = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
4121 prop = Fget_text_property (charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4122 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4124 if (invis_p && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
4126 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4127 invisible text. */
4128 int display_ellipsis_p = (invis_p == 2);
4129 ptrdiff_t len, endpos;
4131 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4133 /* Get the position at which the next visible text can be
4134 found in IT->string, if any. */
4135 endpos = len = SCHARS (it->string);
4136 XSETINT (limit, len);
4139 end_charpos = Fnext_single_property_change (charpos, Qinvisible,
4140 it->string, limit);
4141 if (INTEGERP (end_charpos))
4143 endpos = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4144 prop = Fget_text_property (end_charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4145 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4146 if (invis_p == 2)
4147 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4150 while (invis_p && endpos < len);
4152 if (display_ellipsis_p)
4153 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4155 if (endpos < len)
4157 /* Text at END_CHARPOS is visible. Move IT there. */
4158 struct text_pos old;
4159 ptrdiff_t oldpos;
4161 old = it->current.string_pos;
4162 oldpos = CHARPOS (old);
4163 if (it->bidi_p)
4165 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt
4166 && it->bidi_it.charpos < SCHARS (it->string))
4167 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4168 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4169 /* Bidi-iterate out of the invisible text. */
4172 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4174 while (oldpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4175 && it->bidi_it.charpos < endpos);
4177 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4178 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4179 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= endpos)
4180 it->prev_stop = endpos;
4182 else
4184 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4185 compute_string_pos (&it->current.string_pos, old, it->string);
4188 else
4190 /* The rest of the string is invisible. If this is an
4191 overlay string, proceed with the next overlay string
4192 or whatever comes and return a character from there. */
4193 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
4194 && !display_ellipsis_p)
4196 next_overlay_string (it);
4197 /* Don't check for overlay strings when we just
4198 finished processing them. */
4199 handled = HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED;
4201 else
4203 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = SCHARS (it->string);
4204 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = SBYTES (it->string);
4209 else
4211 ptrdiff_t newpos, next_stop, start_charpos, tem;
4212 Lisp_Object pos, overlay;
4214 /* First of all, is there invisible text at this position? */
4215 tem = start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
4216 pos = make_number (tem);
4217 prop = get_char_property_and_overlay (pos, Qinvisible, it->window,
4218 &overlay);
4219 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4221 /* If we are on invisible text, skip over it. */
4222 if (invis_p && start_charpos < it->end_charpos)
4224 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4225 invisible text. */
4226 int display_ellipsis_p = invis_p == 2;
4228 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4230 /* Loop skipping over invisible text. The loop is left at
4231 ZV or with IT on the first char being visible again. */
4234 /* Try to skip some invisible text. Return value is the
4235 position reached which can be equal to where we start
4236 if there is nothing invisible there. This skips both
4237 over invisible text properties and overlays with
4238 invisible property. */
4239 newpos = skip_invisible (tem, &next_stop, ZV, it->window);
4241 /* If we skipped nothing at all we weren't at invisible
4242 text in the first place. If everything to the end of
4243 the buffer was skipped, end the loop. */
4244 if (newpos == tem || newpos >= ZV)
4245 invis_p = 0;
4246 else
4248 /* We skipped some characters but not necessarily
4249 all there are. Check if we ended up on visible
4250 text. Fget_char_property returns the property of
4251 the char before the given position, i.e. if we
4252 get invis_p = 0, this means that the char at
4253 newpos is visible. */
4254 pos = make_number (newpos);
4255 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qinvisible, it->window);
4256 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4259 /* If we ended up on invisible text, proceed to
4260 skip starting with next_stop. */
4261 if (invis_p)
4262 tem = next_stop;
4264 /* If there are adjacent invisible texts, don't lose the
4265 second one's ellipsis. */
4266 if (invis_p == 2)
4267 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4269 while (invis_p);
4271 /* The position newpos is now either ZV or on visible text. */
4272 if (it->bidi_p)
4274 ptrdiff_t bpos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4275 int on_newline =
4276 bpos == ZV_BYTE || FETCH_BYTE (bpos) == '\n';
4277 int after_newline =
4278 newpos <= BEGV || FETCH_BYTE (bpos - 1) == '\n';
4280 /* If the invisible text ends on a newline or on a
4281 character after a newline, we can avoid the costly,
4282 character by character, bidi iteration to NEWPOS, and
4283 instead simply reseat the iterator there. That's
4284 because all bidi reordering information is tossed at
4285 the newline. This is a big win for modes that hide
4286 complete lines, like Outline, Org, etc. */
4287 if (on_newline || after_newline)
4289 struct text_pos tpos;
4290 bidi_dir_t pdir = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
4292 SET_TEXT_POS (tpos, newpos, bpos);
4293 reseat_1 (it, tpos, 0);
4294 /* If we reseat on a newline/ZV, we need to prep the
4295 bidi iterator for advancing to the next character
4296 after the newline/EOB, keeping the current paragraph
4297 direction (so that PRODUCE_GLYPHS does TRT wrt
4298 prepending/appending glyphs to a glyph row). */
4299 if (on_newline)
4301 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
4302 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = pdir;
4303 it->bidi_it.ch = (bpos == ZV_BYTE) ? -1 : '\n';
4304 it->bidi_it.nchars = 1;
4305 it->bidi_it.ch_len = 1;
4308 else /* Must use the slow method. */
4310 /* With bidi iteration, the region of invisible text
4311 could start and/or end in the middle of a
4312 non-base embedding level. Therefore, we need to
4313 skip invisible text using the bidi iterator,
4314 starting at IT's current position, until we find
4315 ourselves outside of the invisible text.
4316 Skipping invisible text _after_ bidi iteration
4317 avoids affecting the visual order of the
4318 displayed text when invisible properties are
4319 added or removed. */
4320 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < ZV)
4322 /* If we were `reseat'ed to a new paragraph,
4323 determine the paragraph base direction. We
4324 need to do it now because
4325 next_element_from_buffer may not have a
4326 chance to do it, if we are going to skip any
4327 text at the beginning, which resets the
4328 FIRST_ELT flag. */
4329 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4330 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4334 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4336 while (it->stop_charpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4337 && it->bidi_it.charpos < newpos);
4338 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4339 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4340 /* If we overstepped NEWPOS, record its position in
4341 the iterator, so that we skip invisible text if
4342 later the bidi iteration lands us in the
4343 invisible region again. */
4344 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= newpos)
4345 it->prev_stop = newpos;
4348 else
4350 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = newpos;
4351 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4354 /* If there are before-strings at the start of invisible
4355 text, and the text is invisible because of a text
4356 property, arrange to show before-strings because 20.x did
4357 it that way. (If the text is invisible because of an
4358 overlay property instead of a text property, this is
4359 already handled in the overlay code.) */
4360 if (NILP (overlay)
4361 && get_overlay_strings (it, it->stop_charpos))
4363 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4364 it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p = display_ellipsis_p;
4366 else if (display_ellipsis_p)
4368 /* Make sure that the glyphs of the ellipsis will get
4369 correct `charpos' values. If we would not update
4370 it->position here, the glyphs would belong to the
4371 last visible character _before_ the invisible
4372 text, which confuses `set_cursor_from_row'.
4374 We use the last invisible position instead of the
4375 first because this way the cursor is always drawn on
4376 the first "." of the ellipsis, whenever PT is inside
4377 the invisible text. Otherwise the cursor would be
4378 placed _after_ the ellipsis when the point is after the
4379 first invisible character. */
4380 if (!STRINGP (it->object))
4382 it->position.charpos = newpos - 1;
4383 it->position.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->position.charpos);
4385 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4386 /* Let the ellipsis display before
4387 considering any properties of the following char.
4388 Fixes jasonr@gnu.org 01 Oct 07 bug. */
4389 handled = HANDLED_RETURN;
4394 return handled;
4398 /* Make iterator IT return `...' next.
4399 Replaces LEN characters from buffer. */
4401 static void
4402 setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *it, int len)
4404 /* Use the display table definition for `...'. Invalid glyphs
4405 will be handled by the method returning elements from dpvec. */
4406 if (it->dp && VECTORP (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp)))
4408 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp));
4409 it->dpvec = v->contents;
4410 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
4412 else
4414 /* Default `...'. */
4415 it->dpvec = default_invis_vector;
4416 it->dpend = default_invis_vector + 3;
4419 it->dpvec_char_len = len;
4420 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
4421 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
4423 /* Remember the current face id in case glyphs specify faces.
4424 IT's face is restored in set_iterator_to_next.
4425 saved_face_id was set to preceding char's face in handle_stop. */
4426 if (it->saved_face_id < 0 || it->saved_face_id != it->face_id)
4427 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
4429 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
4430 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4435 /***********************************************************************
4436 'display' property
4437 ***********************************************************************/
4439 /* Set up iterator IT from `display' property at its current position.
4440 Called from handle_stop.
4441 We return HANDLED_RETURN if some part of the display property
4442 overrides the display of the buffer text itself.
4443 Otherwise we return HANDLED_NORMALLY. */
4445 static enum prop_handled
4446 handle_display_prop (struct it *it)
4448 Lisp_Object propval, object, overlay;
4449 struct text_pos *position;
4450 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
4451 /* Nonzero if some property replaces the display of the text itself. */
4452 int display_replaced_p = 0;
4454 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4456 object = it->string;
4457 position = &it->current.string_pos;
4458 bufpos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
4460 else
4462 XSETWINDOW (object, it->w);
4463 position = &it->current.pos;
4464 bufpos = CHARPOS (*position);
4467 /* Reset those iterator values set from display property values. */
4468 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
4469 it->space_width = Qnil;
4470 it->font_height = Qnil;
4471 it->voffset = 0;
4473 /* We don't support recursive `display' properties, i.e. string
4474 values that have a string `display' property, that have a string
4475 `display' property etc. */
4476 if (!it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4477 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4479 propval = get_char_property_and_overlay (make_number (position->charpos),
4480 Qdisplay, object, &overlay);
4481 if (NILP (propval))
4482 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4483 /* Now OVERLAY is the overlay that gave us this property, or nil
4484 if it was a text property. */
4486 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
4487 object = it->w->buffer;
4489 display_replaced_p = handle_display_spec (it, propval, object, overlay,
4490 position, bufpos,
4491 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f));
4493 return display_replaced_p ? HANDLED_RETURN : HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4496 /* Subroutine of handle_display_prop. Returns non-zero if the display
4497 specification in SPEC is a replacing specification, i.e. it would
4498 replace the text covered by `display' property with something else,
4499 such as an image or a display string. If SPEC includes any kind or
4500 `(space ...) specification, the value is 2; this is used by
4501 compute_display_string_pos, which see.
4503 See handle_single_display_spec for documentation of arguments.
4504 frame_window_p is non-zero if the window being redisplayed is on a
4505 GUI frame; this argument is used only if IT is NULL, see below.
4507 IT can be NULL, if this is called by the bidi reordering code
4508 through compute_display_string_pos, which see. In that case, this
4509 function only examines SPEC, but does not otherwise "handle" it, in
4510 the sense that it doesn't set up members of IT from the display
4511 spec. */
4512 static int
4513 handle_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4514 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4515 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int frame_window_p)
4517 int replacing_p = 0;
4518 int rv;
4520 if (CONSP (spec)
4521 /* Simple specifications. */
4522 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qimage)
4523 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace)
4524 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen)
4525 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice)
4526 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4527 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4528 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4529 /* Marginal area specifications. */
4530 && !(CONSP (XCAR (spec)) && EQ (XCAR (XCAR (spec)), Qmargin))
4531 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4532 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe)
4533 && !NILP (XCAR (spec)))
4535 for (; CONSP (spec); spec = XCDR (spec))
4537 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, XCAR (spec), object,
4538 overlay, position, bufpos,
4539 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4541 replacing_p = rv;
4542 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4543 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4544 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4545 break;
4549 else if (VECTORP (spec))
4551 ptrdiff_t i;
4552 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); ++i)
4553 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, AREF (spec, i), object,
4554 overlay, position, bufpos,
4555 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4557 replacing_p = rv;
4558 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4559 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4560 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4561 break;
4564 else
4566 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, spec, object, overlay,
4567 position, bufpos, 0,
4568 frame_window_p)))
4569 replacing_p = rv;
4572 return replacing_p;
4575 /* Value is the position of the end of the `display' property starting
4576 at START_POS in OBJECT. */
4578 static struct text_pos
4579 display_prop_end (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object, struct text_pos start_pos)
4581 Lisp_Object end;
4582 struct text_pos end_pos;
4584 end = Fnext_single_char_property_change (make_number (CHARPOS (start_pos)),
4585 Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
4586 CHARPOS (end_pos) = XFASTINT (end);
4587 if (STRINGP (object))
4588 compute_string_pos (&end_pos, start_pos, it->string);
4589 else
4590 BYTEPOS (end_pos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (XFASTINT (end));
4592 return end_pos;
4596 /* Set up IT from a single `display' property specification SPEC. OBJECT
4597 is the object in which the `display' property was found. *POSITION
4598 is the position in OBJECT at which the `display' property was found.
4599 BUFPOS is the buffer position of OBJECT (different from POSITION if
4600 OBJECT is not a buffer). DISPLAY_REPLACED_P non-zero means that we
4601 previously saw a display specification which already replaced text
4602 display with something else, for example an image; we ignore such
4603 properties after the first one has been processed.
4605 OVERLAY is the overlay this `display' property came from,
4606 or nil if it was a text property.
4608 If SPEC is a `space' or `image' specification, and in some other
4609 cases too, set *POSITION to the position where the `display'
4610 property ends.
4612 If IT is NULL, only examine the property specification in SPEC, but
4613 don't set up IT. In that case, FRAME_WINDOW_P non-zero means SPEC
4614 is intended to be displayed in a window on a GUI frame.
4616 Value is non-zero if something was found which replaces the display
4617 of buffer or string text. */
4619 static int
4620 handle_single_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4621 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4622 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int display_replaced_p,
4623 int frame_window_p)
4625 Lisp_Object form;
4626 Lisp_Object location, value;
4627 struct text_pos start_pos = *position;
4628 int valid_p;
4630 /* If SPEC is a list of the form `(when FORM . VALUE)', evaluate FORM.
4631 If the result is non-nil, use VALUE instead of SPEC. */
4632 form = Qt;
4633 if (CONSP (spec) && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen))
4635 spec = XCDR (spec);
4636 if (!CONSP (spec))
4637 return 0;
4638 form = XCAR (spec);
4639 spec = XCDR (spec);
4642 if (!NILP (form) && !EQ (form, Qt))
4644 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4645 struct gcpro gcpro1;
4647 /* Bind `object' to the object having the `display' property, a
4648 buffer or string. Bind `position' to the position in the
4649 object where the property was found, and `buffer-position'
4650 to the current position in the buffer. */
4652 if (NILP (object))
4653 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
4654 specbind (Qobject, object);
4655 specbind (Qposition, make_number (CHARPOS (*position)));
4656 specbind (Qbuffer_position, make_number (bufpos));
4657 GCPRO1 (form);
4658 form = safe_eval (form);
4659 UNGCPRO;
4660 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4663 if (NILP (form))
4664 return 0;
4666 /* Handle `(height HEIGHT)' specifications. */
4667 if (CONSP (spec)
4668 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4669 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4671 if (it)
4673 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4674 return 0;
4676 it->font_height = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4677 if (!NILP (it->font_height))
4679 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4680 int new_height = -1;
4682 if (CONSP (it->font_height)
4683 && (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus)
4684 || EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qminus))
4685 && CONSP (XCDR (it->font_height))
4686 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)), INT_MAX))
4688 /* `(+ N)' or `(- N)' where N is an integer. */
4689 int steps = XINT (XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)));
4690 if (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus))
4691 steps = - steps;
4692 it->face_id = smaller_face (it->f, it->face_id, steps);
4694 else if (FUNCTIONP (it->font_height))
4696 /* Call function with current height as argument.
4697 Value is the new height. */
4698 Lisp_Object height;
4699 height = safe_call1 (it->font_height,
4700 face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4701 if (NUMBERP (height))
4702 new_height = XFLOATINT (height);
4704 else if (NUMBERP (it->font_height))
4706 /* Value is a multiple of the canonical char height. */
4707 struct face *f;
4709 f = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f,
4710 lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
4711 new_height = (XFLOATINT (it->font_height)
4712 * XINT (f->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]));
4714 else
4716 /* Evaluate IT->font_height with `height' bound to the
4717 current specified height to get the new height. */
4718 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4720 specbind (Qheight, face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4721 value = safe_eval (it->font_height);
4722 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4724 if (NUMBERP (value))
4725 new_height = XFLOATINT (value);
4728 if (new_height > 0)
4729 it->face_id = face_with_height (it->f, it->face_id, new_height);
4733 return 0;
4736 /* Handle `(space-width WIDTH)'. */
4737 if (CONSP (spec)
4738 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4739 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4741 if (it)
4743 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4744 return 0;
4746 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4747 if (NUMBERP (value) && XFLOATINT (value) > 0)
4748 it->space_width = value;
4751 return 0;
4754 /* Handle `(slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT)'. */
4755 if (CONSP (spec)
4756 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice))
4758 Lisp_Object tem;
4760 if (it)
4762 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4763 return 0;
4765 if (tem = XCDR (spec), CONSP (tem))
4767 it->slice.x = XCAR (tem);
4768 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4770 it->slice.y = XCAR (tem);
4771 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4773 it->slice.width = XCAR (tem);
4774 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4775 it->slice.height = XCAR (tem);
4781 return 0;
4784 /* Handle `(raise FACTOR)'. */
4785 if (CONSP (spec)
4786 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4787 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4789 if (it)
4791 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4792 return 0;
4794 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4795 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4796 if (NUMBERP (value))
4798 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4799 it->voffset = - (XFLOATINT (value)
4800 * (FONT_HEIGHT (face->font)));
4802 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4805 return 0;
4808 /* Don't handle the other kinds of display specifications
4809 inside a string that we got from a `display' property. */
4810 if (it && it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4811 return 0;
4813 /* Characters having this form of property are not displayed, so
4814 we have to find the end of the property. */
4815 if (it)
4817 start_pos = *position;
4818 *position = display_prop_end (it, object, start_pos);
4820 value = Qnil;
4822 /* Stop the scan at that end position--we assume that all
4823 text properties change there. */
4824 if (it)
4825 it->stop_charpos = position->charpos;
4827 /* Handle `(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'
4828 and `(right-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'. */
4829 if (CONSP (spec)
4830 && (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4831 || EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe))
4832 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4834 int fringe_bitmap;
4836 if (it)
4838 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4839 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4840 across the text with this property. */
4842 /* Synchronize the bidi iterator with POSITION. This is
4843 needed because we are not going to push the iterator
4844 on behalf of this display property, so there will be
4845 no pop_it call to do this synchronization for us. */
4846 if (it->bidi_p)
4848 it->position = *position;
4849 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4850 *position = it->position;
4852 return 1;
4855 else if (!frame_window_p)
4856 return 1;
4858 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4859 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4860 if (!SYMBOLP (value)
4861 || !(fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (value)))
4862 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4863 across the text with this property. */
4865 if (it && it->bidi_p)
4867 it->position = *position;
4868 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4869 *position = it->position;
4871 return 1;
4874 if (it)
4876 int face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);;
4878 if (CONSP (XCDR (XCDR (spec))))
4880 Lisp_Object face_name = XCAR (XCDR (XCDR (spec)));
4881 int face_id2 = lookup_derived_face (it->f, face_name,
4882 FRINGE_FACE_ID, 0);
4883 if (face_id2 >= 0)
4884 face_id = face_id2;
4887 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4888 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4889 push_it (it, position);
4891 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4892 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
4893 it->image_id = -1; /* no image */
4894 it->position = start_pos;
4895 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
4896 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
4897 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
4898 it->face_id = face_id;
4899 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4901 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4902 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4903 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4904 *position = start_pos;
4906 if (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe))
4908 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4909 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4911 else
4913 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4914 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4917 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4918 return 1;
4921 /* Prepare to handle `((margin left-margin) ...)',
4922 `((margin right-margin) ...)' and `((margin nil) ...)'
4923 prefixes for display specifications. */
4924 location = Qunbound;
4925 if (CONSP (spec) && CONSP (XCAR (spec)))
4927 Lisp_Object tem;
4929 value = XCDR (spec);
4930 if (CONSP (value))
4931 value = XCAR (value);
4933 tem = XCAR (spec);
4934 if (EQ (XCAR (tem), Qmargin)
4935 && (tem = XCDR (tem),
4936 tem = CONSP (tem) ? XCAR (tem) : Qnil,
4937 (NILP (tem)
4938 || EQ (tem, Qleft_margin)
4939 || EQ (tem, Qright_margin))))
4940 location = tem;
4943 if (EQ (location, Qunbound))
4945 location = Qnil;
4946 value = spec;
4949 /* After this point, VALUE is the property after any
4950 margin prefix has been stripped. It must be a string,
4951 an image specification, or `(space ...)'.
4953 LOCATION specifies where to display: `left-margin',
4954 `right-margin' or nil. */
4956 valid_p = (STRINGP (value)
4957 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4958 || ((it ? FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) : frame_window_p)
4959 && valid_image_p (value))
4960 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4961 || (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace)));
4963 if (valid_p && !display_replaced_p)
4965 int retval = 1;
4967 if (!it)
4969 /* Callers need to know whether the display spec is any kind
4970 of `(space ...)' spec that is about to affect text-area
4971 display. */
4972 if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace) && NILP (location))
4973 retval = 2;
4974 return retval;
4977 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4978 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4979 push_it (it, position);
4980 it->from_overlay = overlay;
4981 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4983 if (NILP (location))
4984 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4985 else if (EQ (location, Qleft_margin))
4986 it->area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
4987 else
4988 it->area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
4990 if (STRINGP (value))
4992 it->string = value;
4993 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
4994 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
4995 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
4996 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
4997 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
4998 it->stop_charpos = 0;
4999 it->prev_stop = 0;
5000 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5001 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 1;
5002 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
5003 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
5004 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
5005 if (BUFFERP (object))
5006 *position = start_pos;
5008 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5009 object. If the parent object's paragraph direction is
5010 not yet determined, default to L2R. */
5011 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5012 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5013 else
5014 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5016 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
5017 if (it->bidi_p)
5019 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5020 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5021 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
5022 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = bufpos;
5023 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 1;
5024 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5025 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5028 else if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace))
5030 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
5031 it->object = value;
5032 *position = it->position = start_pos;
5033 retval = 1 + (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
5035 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
5036 else
5038 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
5039 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, value);
5040 it->position = start_pos;
5041 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
5042 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
5044 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
5045 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
5046 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
5047 *position = start_pos;
5049 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
5051 return retval;
5054 /* Invalid property or property not supported. Restore
5055 POSITION to what it was before. */
5056 *position = start_pos;
5057 return 0;
5060 /* Check if PROP is a display property value whose text should be
5061 treated as intangible. OVERLAY is the overlay from which PROP
5062 came, or nil if it came from a text property. CHARPOS and BYTEPOS
5063 specify the buffer position covered by PROP. */
5066 display_prop_intangible_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object overlay,
5067 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos)
5069 int frame_window_p = FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (selected_frame));
5070 struct text_pos position;
5072 SET_TEXT_POS (position, charpos, bytepos);
5073 return handle_display_spec (NULL, prop, Qnil, overlay,
5074 &position, charpos, frame_window_p);
5078 /* Return 1 if PROP is a display sub-property value containing STRING.
5080 Implementation note: this and the following function are really
5081 special cases of handle_display_spec and
5082 handle_single_display_spec, and should ideally use the same code.
5083 Until they do, these two pairs must be consistent and must be
5084 modified in sync. */
5086 static int
5087 single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5089 if (EQ (string, prop))
5090 return 1;
5092 /* Skip over `when FORM'. */
5093 if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen))
5095 prop = XCDR (prop);
5096 if (!CONSP (prop))
5097 return 0;
5098 /* Actually, the condition following `when' should be eval'ed,
5099 like handle_single_display_spec does, and we should return
5100 zero if it evaluates to nil. However, this function is
5101 called only when the buffer was already displayed and some
5102 glyph in the glyph matrix was found to come from a display
5103 string. Therefore, the condition was already evaluated, and
5104 the result was non-nil, otherwise the display string wouldn't
5105 have been displayed and we would have never been called for
5106 this property. Thus, we can skip the evaluation and assume
5107 its result is non-nil. */
5108 prop = XCDR (prop);
5111 if (CONSP (prop))
5112 /* Skip over `margin LOCATION'. */
5113 if (EQ (XCAR (prop), Qmargin))
5115 prop = XCDR (prop);
5116 if (!CONSP (prop))
5117 return 0;
5119 prop = XCDR (prop);
5120 if (!CONSP (prop))
5121 return 0;
5124 return EQ (prop, string) || (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), string));
5128 /* Return 1 if STRING appears in the `display' property PROP. */
5130 static int
5131 display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5133 if (CONSP (prop)
5134 && !EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen)
5135 && !(CONSP (XCAR (prop)) && EQ (Qmargin, XCAR (XCAR (prop)))))
5137 /* A list of sub-properties. */
5138 while (CONSP (prop))
5140 if (single_display_spec_string_p (XCAR (prop), string))
5141 return 1;
5142 prop = XCDR (prop);
5145 else if (VECTORP (prop))
5147 /* A vector of sub-properties. */
5148 ptrdiff_t i;
5149 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (prop); ++i)
5150 if (single_display_spec_string_p (AREF (prop, i), string))
5151 return 1;
5153 else
5154 return single_display_spec_string_p (prop, string);
5156 return 0;
5159 /* Look for STRING in overlays and text properties in the current
5160 buffer, between character positions FROM and TO (excluding TO).
5161 BACK_P non-zero means look back (in this case, TO is supposed to be
5162 less than FROM).
5163 Value is the first character position where STRING was found, or
5164 zero if it wasn't found before hitting TO.
5166 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5167 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5169 static ptrdiff_t
5170 string_buffer_position_lim (Lisp_Object string,
5171 ptrdiff_t from, ptrdiff_t to, int back_p)
5173 Lisp_Object limit, prop, pos;
5174 int found = 0;
5176 pos = make_number (max (from, BEGV));
5178 if (!back_p) /* looking forward */
5180 limit = make_number (min (to, ZV));
5181 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5183 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5184 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5185 found = 1;
5186 else
5187 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5188 limit);
5191 else /* looking back */
5193 limit = make_number (max (to, BEGV));
5194 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5196 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5197 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5198 found = 1;
5199 else
5200 pos = Fprevious_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5201 limit);
5205 return found ? XINT (pos) : 0;
5208 /* Determine which buffer position in current buffer STRING comes from.
5209 AROUND_CHARPOS is an approximate position where it could come from.
5210 Value is the buffer position or 0 if it couldn't be determined.
5212 This function is necessary because we don't record buffer positions
5213 in glyphs generated from strings (to keep struct glyph small).
5214 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5215 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5217 static ptrdiff_t
5218 string_buffer_position (Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t around_charpos)
5220 const int MAX_DISTANCE = 1000;
5221 ptrdiff_t found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5222 around_charpos + MAX_DISTANCE,
5225 if (!found)
5226 found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5227 around_charpos - MAX_DISTANCE, 1);
5228 return found;
5233 /***********************************************************************
5234 `composition' property
5235 ***********************************************************************/
5237 /* Set up iterator IT from `composition' property at its current
5238 position. Called from handle_stop. */
5240 static enum prop_handled
5241 handle_composition_prop (struct it *it)
5243 Lisp_Object prop, string;
5244 ptrdiff_t pos, pos_byte, start, end;
5246 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5248 unsigned char *s;
5250 pos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
5251 pos_byte = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
5252 string = it->string;
5253 s = SDATA (string) + pos_byte;
5254 it->c = STRING_CHAR (s);
5256 else
5258 pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5259 pos_byte = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
5260 string = Qnil;
5261 it->c = FETCH_CHAR (pos_byte);
5264 /* If there's a valid composition and point is not inside of the
5265 composition (in the case that the composition is from the current
5266 buffer), draw a glyph composed from the composition components. */
5267 if (find_composition (pos, -1, &start, &end, &prop, string)
5268 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
5269 && (STRINGP (it->string) || (PT <= start || PT >= end)))
5271 if (start < pos)
5272 /* As we can't handle this situation (perhaps font-lock added
5273 a new composition), we just return here hoping that next
5274 redisplay will detect this composition much earlier. */
5275 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5276 if (start != pos)
5278 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5279 pos_byte = string_char_to_byte (it->string, start);
5280 else
5281 pos_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (start);
5283 it->cmp_it.id = get_composition_id (start, pos_byte, end - start,
5284 prop, string);
5286 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
5288 it->cmp_it.ch = -1;
5289 it->cmp_it.nchars = COMPOSITION_LENGTH (prop);
5290 it->cmp_it.nglyphs = -1;
5294 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5299 /***********************************************************************
5300 Overlay strings
5301 ***********************************************************************/
5303 /* The following structure is used to record overlay strings for
5304 later sorting in load_overlay_strings. */
5306 struct overlay_entry
5308 Lisp_Object overlay;
5309 Lisp_Object string;
5310 EMACS_INT priority;
5311 int after_string_p;
5315 /* Set up iterator IT from overlay strings at its current position.
5316 Called from handle_stop. */
5318 static enum prop_handled
5319 handle_overlay_change (struct it *it)
5321 if (!STRINGP (it->string) && get_overlay_strings (it, 0))
5322 return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
5323 else
5324 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5328 /* Set up the next overlay string for delivery by IT, if there is an
5329 overlay string to deliver. Called by set_iterator_to_next when the
5330 end of the current overlay string is reached. If there are more
5331 overlay strings to display, IT->string and
5332 IT->current.overlay_string_index are set appropriately here.
5333 Otherwise IT->string is set to nil. */
5335 static void
5336 next_overlay_string (struct it *it)
5338 ++it->current.overlay_string_index;
5339 if (it->current.overlay_string_index == it->n_overlay_strings)
5341 /* No more overlay strings. Restore IT's settings to what
5342 they were before overlay strings were processed, and
5343 continue to deliver from current_buffer. */
5345 it->ellipsis_p = (it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p != 0);
5346 pop_it (it);
5347 eassert (it->sp > 0
5348 || (NILP (it->string)
5349 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
5350 && it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
5351 && it->stop_charpos <= it->end_charpos));
5352 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5353 it->n_overlay_strings = 0;
5354 it->overlay_strings_charpos = -1;
5355 /* If there's an empty display string on the stack, pop the
5356 stack, to resync the bidi iterator with IT's position. Such
5357 empty strings are pushed onto the stack in
5358 get_overlay_strings_1. */
5359 if (it->sp > 0 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
5360 pop_it (it);
5362 /* If we're at the end of the buffer, record that we have
5363 processed the overlay strings there already, so that
5364 next_element_from_buffer doesn't try it again. */
5365 if (NILP (it->string) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
5366 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
5368 else
5370 /* There are more overlay strings to process. If
5371 IT->current.overlay_string_index has advanced to a position
5372 where we must load IT->overlay_strings with more strings, do
5373 it. We must load at the IT->overlay_strings_charpos where
5374 IT->n_overlay_strings was originally computed; when invisible
5375 text is present, this might not be IT_CHARPOS (Bug#7016). */
5376 int i = it->current.overlay_string_index % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
5378 if (it->current.overlay_string_index && i == 0)
5379 load_overlay_strings (it, it->overlay_strings_charpos);
5381 /* Initialize IT to deliver display elements from the overlay
5382 string. */
5383 it->string = it->overlay_strings[i];
5384 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5385 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, 0, 0);
5386 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5387 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5388 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5389 if (it->cmp_it.stop_pos >= 0)
5390 it->cmp_it.stop_pos = 0;
5391 it->prev_stop = 0;
5392 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5394 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5395 if (it->bidi_p)
5397 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5398 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5399 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5400 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
5401 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5402 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5403 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5407 CHECK_IT (it);
5411 /* Compare two overlay_entry structures E1 and E2. Used as a
5412 comparison function for qsort in load_overlay_strings. Overlay
5413 strings for the same position are sorted so that
5415 1. All after-strings come in front of before-strings, except
5416 when they come from the same overlay.
5418 2. Within after-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay strings
5419 from overlays with higher priorities come first.
5421 2. Within before-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay
5422 strings from overlays with higher priorities come last.
5424 Value is analogous to strcmp. */
5427 static int
5428 compare_overlay_entries (const void *e1, const void *e2)
5430 struct overlay_entry *entry1 = (struct overlay_entry *) e1;
5431 struct overlay_entry *entry2 = (struct overlay_entry *) e2;
5432 int result;
5434 if (entry1->after_string_p != entry2->after_string_p)
5436 /* Let after-strings appear in front of before-strings if
5437 they come from different overlays. */
5438 if (EQ (entry1->overlay, entry2->overlay))
5439 result = entry1->after_string_p ? 1 : -1;
5440 else
5441 result = entry1->after_string_p ? -1 : 1;
5443 else if (entry1->priority != entry2->priority)
5445 if (entry1->after_string_p)
5446 /* After-strings sorted in order of decreasing priority. */
5447 result = entry2->priority < entry1->priority ? -1 : 1;
5448 else
5449 /* Before-strings sorted in order of increasing priority. */
5450 result = entry1->priority < entry2->priority ? -1 : 1;
5452 else
5453 result = 0;
5455 return result;
5459 /* Load the vector IT->overlay_strings with overlay strings from IT's
5460 current buffer position, or from CHARPOS if that is > 0. Set
5461 IT->n_overlays to the total number of overlay strings found.
5463 Overlay strings are processed OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE strings at
5464 a time. On entry into load_overlay_strings,
5465 IT->current.overlay_string_index gives the number of overlay
5466 strings that have already been loaded by previous calls to this
5467 function.
5469 IT->add_overlay_start contains an additional overlay start
5470 position to consider for taking overlay strings from, if non-zero.
5471 This position comes into play when the overlay has an `invisible'
5472 property, and both before and after-strings. When we've skipped to
5473 the end of the overlay, because of its `invisible' property, we
5474 nevertheless want its before-string to appear.
5475 IT->add_overlay_start will contain the overlay start position
5476 in this case.
5478 Overlay strings are sorted so that after-string strings come in
5479 front of before-string strings. Within before and after-strings,
5480 strings are sorted by overlay priority. See also function
5481 compare_overlay_entries. */
5483 static void
5484 load_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5486 Lisp_Object overlay, window, str, invisible;
5487 struct Lisp_Overlay *ov;
5488 ptrdiff_t start, end;
5489 ptrdiff_t size = 20;
5490 ptrdiff_t n = 0, i, j;
5491 int invis_p;
5492 struct overlay_entry *entries = alloca (size * sizeof *entries);
5493 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5495 if (charpos <= 0)
5496 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5498 /* Append the overlay string STRING of overlay OVERLAY to vector
5499 `entries' which has size `size' and currently contains `n'
5500 elements. AFTER_P non-zero means STRING is an after-string of
5501 OVERLAY. */
5502 #define RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING(OVERLAY, STRING, AFTER_P) \
5503 do \
5505 Lisp_Object priority; \
5507 if (n == size) \
5509 struct overlay_entry *old = entries; \
5510 SAFE_NALLOCA (entries, 2, size); \
5511 memcpy (entries, old, size * sizeof *entries); \
5512 size *= 2; \
5515 entries[n].string = (STRING); \
5516 entries[n].overlay = (OVERLAY); \
5517 priority = Foverlay_get ((OVERLAY), Qpriority); \
5518 entries[n].priority = INTEGERP (priority) ? XINT (priority) : 0; \
5519 entries[n].after_string_p = (AFTER_P); \
5520 ++n; \
5522 while (0)
5524 /* Process overlay before the overlay center. */
5525 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_before; ov; ov = ov->next)
5527 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5528 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5529 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5530 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5532 if (end < charpos)
5533 break;
5535 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5536 position. */
5537 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5538 continue;
5540 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5541 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5542 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5543 continue;
5545 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, both before-
5546 and after-strings from this overlay are visible; start and
5547 end position are indistinguishable. */
5548 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5549 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5551 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5552 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5553 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5554 && SCHARS (str))
5555 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5557 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5558 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5559 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5560 && SCHARS (str))
5561 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5564 /* Process overlays after the overlay center. */
5565 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_after; ov; ov = ov->next)
5567 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5568 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5569 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5570 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5572 if (start > charpos)
5573 break;
5575 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5576 position. */
5577 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5578 continue;
5580 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5581 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5582 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5583 continue;
5585 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, it has a zero
5586 dimension, and both before- and after-strings apply. */
5587 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5588 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5590 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5591 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5592 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5593 && SCHARS (str))
5594 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5596 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5597 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5598 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5599 && SCHARS (str))
5600 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5603 #undef RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING
5605 /* Sort entries. */
5606 if (n > 1)
5607 qsort (entries, n, sizeof *entries, compare_overlay_entries);
5609 /* Record number of overlay strings, and where we computed it. */
5610 it->n_overlay_strings = n;
5611 it->overlay_strings_charpos = charpos;
5613 /* IT->current.overlay_string_index is the number of overlay strings
5614 that have already been consumed by IT. Copy some of the
5615 remaining overlay strings to IT->overlay_strings. */
5616 i = 0;
5617 j = it->current.overlay_string_index;
5618 while (i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE && j < n)
5620 it->overlay_strings[i] = entries[j].string;
5621 it->string_overlays[i++] = entries[j++].overlay;
5624 CHECK_IT (it);
5625 SAFE_FREE ();
5629 /* Get the first chunk of overlay strings at IT's current buffer
5630 position, or at CHARPOS if that is > 0. Value is non-zero if at
5631 least one overlay string was found. */
5633 static int
5634 get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos, int compute_stop_p)
5636 /* Get the first OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE overlay strings to
5637 process. This fills IT->overlay_strings with strings, and sets
5638 IT->n_overlay_strings to the total number of strings to process.
5639 IT->pos.overlay_string_index has to be set temporarily to zero
5640 because load_overlay_strings needs this; it must be set to -1
5641 when no overlay strings are found because a zero value would
5642 indicate a position in the first overlay string. */
5643 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
5644 load_overlay_strings (it, charpos);
5646 /* If we found overlay strings, set up IT to deliver display
5647 elements from the first one. Otherwise set up IT to deliver
5648 from current_buffer. */
5649 if (it->n_overlay_strings)
5651 /* Make sure we know settings in current_buffer, so that we can
5652 restore meaningful values when we're done with the overlay
5653 strings. */
5654 if (compute_stop_p)
5655 compute_stop_pos (it);
5656 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5658 /* Save IT's settings. They are restored after all overlay
5659 strings have been processed. */
5660 eassert (!compute_stop_p || it->sp == 0);
5662 /* When called from handle_stop, there might be an empty display
5663 string loaded. In that case, don't bother saving it. But
5664 don't use this optimization with the bidi iterator, since we
5665 need the corresponding pop_it call to resync the bidi
5666 iterator's position with IT's position, after we are done
5667 with the overlay strings. (The corresponding call to pop_it
5668 in case of an empty display string is in
5669 next_overlay_string.) */
5670 if (!(!it->bidi_p
5671 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string)))
5672 push_it (it, NULL);
5674 /* Set up IT to deliver display elements from the first overlay
5675 string. */
5676 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
5677 it->string = it->overlay_strings[0];
5678 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
5679 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5680 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
5681 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5682 it->prev_stop = 0;
5683 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5684 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5685 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5686 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
5688 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5689 buffer. */
5690 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5691 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5692 else
5693 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5695 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5696 if (it->bidi_p)
5698 ptrdiff_t pos = (charpos > 0 ? charpos : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5700 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5701 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5702 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5703 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = pos;
5704 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5705 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5706 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5708 return 1;
5711 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5712 return 0;
5715 static int
5716 get_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5718 it->string = Qnil;
5719 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5721 (void) get_overlay_strings_1 (it, charpos, 1);
5723 CHECK_IT (it);
5725 /* Value is non-zero if we found at least one overlay string. */
5726 return STRINGP (it->string);
5731 /***********************************************************************
5732 Saving and restoring state
5733 ***********************************************************************/
5735 /* Save current settings of IT on IT->stack. Called, for example,
5736 before setting up IT for an overlay string, to be able to restore
5737 IT's settings to what they were after the overlay string has been
5738 processed. If POSITION is non-NULL, it is the position to save on
5739 the stack instead of IT->position. */
5741 static void
5742 push_it (struct it *it, struct text_pos *position)
5744 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5746 eassert (it->sp < IT_STACK_SIZE);
5747 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5749 p->stop_charpos = it->stop_charpos;
5750 p->prev_stop = it->prev_stop;
5751 p->base_level_stop = it->base_level_stop;
5752 p->cmp_it = it->cmp_it;
5753 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5754 p->face_id = it->face_id;
5755 p->string = it->string;
5756 p->method = it->method;
5757 p->from_overlay = it->from_overlay;
5758 switch (p->method)
5760 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5761 p->u.image.object = it->object;
5762 p->u.image.image_id = it->image_id;
5763 p->u.image.slice = it->slice;
5764 break;
5765 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5766 p->u.stretch.object = it->object;
5767 break;
5769 p->position = position ? *position : it->position;
5770 p->current = it->current;
5771 p->end_charpos = it->end_charpos;
5772 p->string_nchars = it->string_nchars;
5773 p->area = it->area;
5774 p->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
5775 p->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
5776 p->space_width = it->space_width;
5777 p->font_height = it->font_height;
5778 p->voffset = it->voffset;
5779 p->string_from_display_prop_p = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5780 p->string_from_prefix_prop_p = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5781 p->display_ellipsis_p = 0;
5782 p->line_wrap = it->line_wrap;
5783 p->bidi_p = it->bidi_p;
5784 p->paragraph_embedding = it->paragraph_embedding;
5785 p->from_disp_prop_p = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5786 ++it->sp;
5788 /* Save the state of the bidi iterator as well. */
5789 if (it->bidi_p)
5790 bidi_push_it (&it->bidi_it);
5793 static void
5794 iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *it)
5796 int buffer_p = !STRINGP (it->string);
5797 ptrdiff_t eob = (buffer_p ? ZV : it->end_charpos);
5798 ptrdiff_t bob = (buffer_p ? BEGV : 0);
5800 eassert (eob >= CHARPOS (it->position) && CHARPOS (it->position) >= bob);
5802 /* Maybe initialize paragraph direction. If we are at the beginning
5803 of a new paragraph, next_element_from_buffer may not have a
5804 chance to do that. */
5805 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5806 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
5807 /* prev_stop can be zero, so check against BEGV as well. */
5808 while (it->bidi_it.charpos >= bob
5809 && it->prev_stop <= it->bidi_it.charpos
5810 && it->bidi_it.charpos < CHARPOS (it->position)
5811 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5812 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
5813 /* Record the stop_pos we just crossed, for when we cross it
5814 back, maybe. */
5815 if (it->bidi_it.charpos > CHARPOS (it->position))
5816 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (it->position);
5817 /* If we ended up not where pop_it put us, resync IT's
5818 positional members with the bidi iterator. */
5819 if (it->bidi_it.charpos != CHARPOS (it->position))
5820 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, it->bidi_it.charpos, it->bidi_it.bytepos);
5821 if (buffer_p)
5822 it->current.pos = it->position;
5823 else
5824 it->current.string_pos = it->position;
5827 /* Restore IT's settings from IT->stack. Called, for example, when no
5828 more overlay strings must be processed, and we return to delivering
5829 display elements from a buffer, or when the end of a string from a
5830 `display' property is reached and we return to delivering display
5831 elements from an overlay string, or from a buffer. */
5833 static void
5834 pop_it (struct it *it)
5836 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5837 int from_display_prop = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5839 eassert (it->sp > 0);
5840 --it->sp;
5841 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5842 it->stop_charpos = p->stop_charpos;
5843 it->prev_stop = p->prev_stop;
5844 it->base_level_stop = p->base_level_stop;
5845 it->cmp_it = p->cmp_it;
5846 it->face_id = p->face_id;
5847 it->current = p->current;
5848 it->position = p->position;
5849 it->string = p->string;
5850 it->from_overlay = p->from_overlay;
5851 if (NILP (it->string))
5852 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, -1, -1);
5853 it->method = p->method;
5854 switch (it->method)
5856 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5857 it->image_id = p->u.image.image_id;
5858 it->object = p->u.image.object;
5859 it->slice = p->u.image.slice;
5860 break;
5861 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5862 it->object = p->u.stretch.object;
5863 break;
5864 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
5865 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5866 break;
5867 case GET_FROM_STRING:
5868 it->object = it->string;
5869 break;
5870 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
5871 if (it->s)
5872 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
5873 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
5874 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5875 else
5877 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5878 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5881 it->end_charpos = p->end_charpos;
5882 it->string_nchars = p->string_nchars;
5883 it->area = p->area;
5884 it->multibyte_p = p->multibyte_p;
5885 it->avoid_cursor_p = p->avoid_cursor_p;
5886 it->space_width = p->space_width;
5887 it->font_height = p->font_height;
5888 it->voffset = p->voffset;
5889 it->string_from_display_prop_p = p->string_from_display_prop_p;
5890 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = p->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5891 it->line_wrap = p->line_wrap;
5892 it->bidi_p = p->bidi_p;
5893 it->paragraph_embedding = p->paragraph_embedding;
5894 it->from_disp_prop_p = p->from_disp_prop_p;
5895 if (it->bidi_p)
5897 bidi_pop_it (&it->bidi_it);
5898 /* Bidi-iterate until we get out of the portion of text, if any,
5899 covered by a `display' text property or by an overlay with
5900 `display' property. (We cannot just jump there, because the
5901 internal coherency of the bidi iterator state can not be
5902 preserved across such jumps.) We also must determine the
5903 paragraph base direction if the overlay we just processed is
5904 at the beginning of a new paragraph. */
5905 if (from_display_prop
5906 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING))
5907 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
5909 eassert ((BUFFERP (it->object)
5910 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5911 && IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5912 || (STRINGP (it->object)
5913 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5914 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5915 || (CONSP (it->object) && it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH));
5921 /***********************************************************************
5922 Moving over lines
5923 ***********************************************************************/
5925 /* Set IT's current position to the previous line start. */
5927 static void
5928 back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *it)
5930 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
5931 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5935 /* Move IT to the next line start.
5937 Value is non-zero if a newline was found. Set *SKIPPED_P to 1 if
5938 we skipped over part of the text (as opposed to moving the iterator
5939 continuously over the text). Otherwise, don't change the value
5940 of *SKIPPED_P.
5942 If BIDI_IT_PREV is non-NULL, store into it the state of the bidi
5943 iterator on the newline, if it was found.
5945 Newlines may come from buffer text, overlay strings, or strings
5946 displayed via the `display' property. That's the reason we can't
5947 simply use find_next_newline_no_quit.
5949 Note that this function may not skip over invisible text that is so
5950 because of text properties and immediately follows a newline. If
5951 it would, function reseat_at_next_visible_line_start, when called
5952 from set_iterator_to_next, would effectively make invisible
5953 characters following a newline part of the wrong glyph row, which
5954 leads to wrong cursor motion. */
5956 static int
5957 forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *it, int *skipped_p,
5958 struct bidi_it *bidi_it_prev)
5960 ptrdiff_t old_selective;
5961 int newline_found_p, n;
5962 const int MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE = 500;
5964 /* If already on a newline, just consume it to avoid unintended
5965 skipping over invisible text below. */
5966 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER
5967 && it->c == '\n'
5968 && CHARPOS (it->position) == IT_CHARPOS (*it))
5970 if (it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5971 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5972 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5973 it->c = 0;
5974 return 1;
5977 /* Don't handle selective display in the following. It's (a)
5978 unnecessary because it's done by the caller, and (b) leads to an
5979 infinite recursion because next_element_from_ellipsis indirectly
5980 calls this function. */
5981 old_selective = it->selective;
5982 it->selective = 0;
5984 /* Scan for a newline within MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE display elements
5985 from buffer text. */
5986 for (n = newline_found_p = 0;
5987 !newline_found_p && n < MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE;
5988 n += STRINGP (it->string) ? 0 : 1)
5990 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
5991 return 0;
5992 newline_found_p = it->what == IT_CHARACTER && it->c == '\n';
5993 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5994 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5995 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5998 /* If we didn't find a newline near enough, see if we can use a
5999 short-cut. */
6000 if (!newline_found_p)
6002 ptrdiff_t start = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6003 ptrdiff_t limit = find_next_newline_no_quit (start, 1);
6004 Lisp_Object pos;
6006 eassert (!STRINGP (it->string));
6008 /* If there isn't any `display' property in sight, and no
6009 overlays, we can just use the position of the newline in
6010 buffer text. */
6011 if (it->stop_charpos >= limit
6012 || ((pos = Fnext_single_property_change (make_number (start),
6013 Qdisplay, Qnil,
6014 make_number (limit)),
6015 NILP (pos))
6016 && next_overlay_change (start) == ZV))
6018 if (!it->bidi_p)
6020 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
6021 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
6023 else
6025 struct bidi_it bprev;
6027 /* Help bidi.c avoid expensive searches for display
6028 properties and overlays, by telling it that there are
6029 none up to `limit'. */
6030 if (it->bidi_it.disp_pos < limit)
6032 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = limit;
6033 it->bidi_it.disp_prop = 0;
6035 do {
6036 bprev = it->bidi_it;
6037 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
6038 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != limit);
6039 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
6040 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6041 if (bidi_it_prev)
6042 *bidi_it_prev = bprev;
6044 *skipped_p = newline_found_p = 1;
6046 else
6048 while (get_next_display_element (it)
6049 && !newline_found_p)
6051 newline_found_p = ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it);
6052 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
6053 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
6054 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6059 it->selective = old_selective;
6060 return newline_found_p;
6064 /* Set IT's current position to the previous visible line start. Skip
6065 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6066 selective display. Caution: this does not change IT->current_x and
6067 IT->hpos. */
6069 static void
6070 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6072 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6074 back_to_previous_line_start (it);
6076 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6077 break;
6079 /* If selective > 0, then lines indented more than its value are
6080 invisible. */
6081 if (it->selective > 0
6082 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6083 it->selective))
6084 continue;
6086 /* Check the newline before point for invisibility. */
6088 Lisp_Object prop;
6089 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1),
6090 Qinvisible, it->window);
6091 if (TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop))
6092 continue;
6095 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6096 break;
6099 struct it it2;
6100 void *it2data = NULL;
6101 ptrdiff_t pos;
6102 ptrdiff_t beg, end;
6103 Lisp_Object val, overlay;
6105 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
6107 /* If newline is part of a composition, continue from start of composition */
6108 if (find_composition (IT_CHARPOS (*it), -1, &beg, &end, &val, Qnil)
6109 && beg < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
6110 goto replaced;
6112 /* If newline is replaced by a display property, find start of overlay
6113 or interval and continue search from that point. */
6114 pos = --IT_CHARPOS (it2);
6115 --IT_BYTEPOS (it2);
6116 it2.sp = 0;
6117 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6118 it2.string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6119 it2.from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6120 if (handle_display_prop (&it2) == HANDLED_RETURN
6121 && !NILP (val = get_char_property_and_overlay
6122 (make_number (pos), Qdisplay, Qnil, &overlay))
6123 && (OVERLAYP (overlay)
6124 ? (beg = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay)))
6125 : get_property_and_range (pos, Qdisplay, &val, &beg, &end, Qnil)))
6127 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6128 goto replaced;
6131 /* Newline is not replaced by anything -- so we are done. */
6132 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6133 break;
6135 replaced:
6136 if (beg < BEGV)
6137 beg = BEGV;
6138 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = beg;
6139 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (current_buffer, beg);
6143 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
6145 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
6146 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEGV
6147 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6148 CHECK_IT (it);
6152 /* Reseat iterator IT at the previous visible line start. Skip
6153 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6154 selective display. At the end, update IT's overlay information,
6155 face information etc. */
6157 void
6158 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6160 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
6161 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
6162 CHECK_IT (it);
6166 /* Reseat iterator IT on the next visible line start in the current
6167 buffer. ON_NEWLINE_P non-zero means position IT on the newline
6168 preceding the line start. Skip over invisible text that is so
6169 because of selective display. Compute faces, overlays etc at the
6170 new position. Note that this function does not skip over text that
6171 is invisible because of text properties. */
6173 static void
6174 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *it, int on_newline_p)
6176 int newline_found_p, skipped_p = 0;
6177 struct bidi_it bidi_it_prev;
6179 newline_found_p = forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6181 /* Skip over lines that are invisible because they are indented
6182 more than the value of IT->selective. */
6183 if (it->selective > 0)
6184 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV
6185 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6186 it->selective))
6188 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == BEGV
6189 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6190 newline_found_p =
6191 forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6194 /* Position on the newline if that's what's requested. */
6195 if (on_newline_p && newline_found_p)
6197 if (STRINGP (it->string))
6199 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) > 0)
6201 if (!it->bidi_p)
6203 --IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
6204 --IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
6206 else
6208 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state
6209 it had on the newline, and resync the IT's
6210 position with that. */
6211 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6212 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6213 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6217 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6219 if (!it->bidi_p)
6221 --IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6222 --IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
6224 else
6226 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state it
6227 had on the newline and resync IT with that. */
6228 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6229 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6230 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6232 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6235 else if (skipped_p)
6236 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6238 CHECK_IT (it);
6243 /***********************************************************************
6244 Changing an iterator's position
6245 ***********************************************************************/
6247 /* Change IT's current position to POS in current_buffer. If FORCE_P
6248 is non-zero, always check for text properties at the new position.
6249 Otherwise, text properties are only looked up if POS >=
6250 IT->check_charpos of a property. */
6252 static void
6253 reseat (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int force_p)
6255 ptrdiff_t original_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6257 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
6259 /* Determine where to check text properties. Avoid doing it
6260 where possible because text property lookup is very expensive. */
6261 if (force_p
6262 || CHARPOS (pos) > it->stop_charpos
6263 || CHARPOS (pos) < original_pos)
6265 if (it->bidi_p)
6267 /* For bidi iteration, we need to prime prev_stop and
6268 base_level_stop with our best estimations. */
6269 /* Implementation note: Of course, POS is not necessarily a
6270 stop position, so assigning prev_pos to it is a lie; we
6271 should have called compute_stop_backwards. However, if
6272 the current buffer does not include any R2L characters,
6273 that call would be a waste of cycles, because the
6274 iterator will never move back, and thus never cross this
6275 "fake" stop position. So we delay that backward search
6276 until the time we really need it, in next_element_from_buffer. */
6277 if (CHARPOS (pos) != it->prev_stop)
6278 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6279 if (CHARPOS (pos) < it->base_level_stop)
6280 it->base_level_stop = 0; /* meaning it's unknown */
6281 handle_stop (it);
6283 else
6285 handle_stop (it);
6286 it->prev_stop = it->base_level_stop = 0;
6291 CHECK_IT (it);
6295 /* Change IT's buffer position to POS. SET_STOP_P non-zero means set
6296 IT->stop_pos to POS, also. */
6298 static void
6299 reseat_1 (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int set_stop_p)
6301 /* Don't call this function when scanning a C string. */
6302 eassert (it->s == NULL);
6304 /* POS must be a reasonable value. */
6305 eassert (CHARPOS (pos) >= BEGV && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
6307 it->current.pos = it->position = pos;
6308 it->end_charpos = ZV;
6309 it->dpvec = NULL;
6310 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6311 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6312 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = -1;
6313 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6314 it->string = Qnil;
6315 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
6316 it->object = it->w->buffer;
6317 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
6318 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
6319 it->sp = 0;
6320 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6321 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 0;
6323 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6324 it->face_before_selective_p = 0;
6325 if (it->bidi_p)
6327 bidi_init_it (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6328 &it->bidi_it);
6329 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6330 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6331 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6332 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6333 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6334 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = 0;
6337 if (set_stop_p)
6339 it->stop_charpos = CHARPOS (pos);
6340 it->base_level_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6342 /* This make the information stored in it->cmp_it invalidate. */
6343 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
6347 /* Set up IT for displaying a string, starting at CHARPOS in window W.
6348 If S is non-null, it is a C string to iterate over. Otherwise,
6349 STRING gives a Lisp string to iterate over.
6351 If PRECISION > 0, don't return more then PRECISION number of
6352 characters from the string.
6354 If FIELD_WIDTH > 0, return padding spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6355 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means an infinite
6356 field width.
6358 MULTIBYTE = 0 means disable processing of multibyte characters,
6359 MULTIBYTE > 0 means enable it,
6360 MULTIBYTE < 0 means use IT->multibyte_p.
6362 IT must be initialized via a prior call to init_iterator before
6363 calling this function. */
6365 static void
6366 reseat_to_string (struct it *it, const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
6367 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t precision, int field_width,
6368 int multibyte)
6370 /* No region in strings. */
6371 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
6373 /* No text property checks performed by default, but see below. */
6374 it->stop_charpos = -1;
6376 /* Set iterator position and end position. */
6377 memset (&it->current, 0, sizeof it->current);
6378 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6379 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6380 eassert (charpos >= 0);
6382 /* If STRING is specified, use its multibyteness, otherwise use the
6383 setting of MULTIBYTE, if specified. */
6384 if (multibyte >= 0)
6385 it->multibyte_p = multibyte > 0;
6387 /* Bidirectional reordering of strings is controlled by the default
6388 value of bidi-display-reordering. Don't try to reorder while
6389 loading loadup.el, as the necessary character property tables are
6390 not yet available. */
6391 it->bidi_p =
6392 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
6393 && !NILP (BVAR (&buffer_defaults, bidi_display_reordering));
6395 if (s == NULL)
6397 eassert (STRINGP (string));
6398 it->string = string;
6399 it->s = NULL;
6400 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (string);
6401 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
6402 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, string);
6404 if (it->bidi_p)
6406 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = string;
6407 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6408 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6409 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6410 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6411 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6412 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
6413 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
6416 else
6418 it->s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6419 it->string = Qnil;
6421 /* Note that we use IT->current.pos, not it->current.string_pos,
6422 for displaying C strings. */
6423 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6424 if (it->multibyte_p)
6426 it->current.pos = c_string_pos (charpos, s, 1);
6427 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = number_of_chars (s, 1);
6429 else
6431 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = charpos;
6432 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = strlen (s);
6435 if (it->bidi_p)
6437 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6438 it->bidi_it.string.s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6439 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6440 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6441 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6442 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6443 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6444 &it->bidi_it);
6446 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
6449 /* PRECISION > 0 means don't return more than PRECISION characters
6450 from the string. */
6451 if (precision > 0 && it->end_charpos - charpos > precision)
6453 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = charpos + precision;
6454 if (it->bidi_p)
6455 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6458 /* FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6459 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH == 0 means don't pad,
6460 FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means infinite field width. This is useful for
6461 padding with `-' at the end of a mode line. */
6462 if (field_width < 0)
6463 field_width = INFINITY;
6464 /* Implementation note: We deliberately don't enlarge
6465 it->bidi_it.string.schars here to fit it->end_charpos, because
6466 the bidi iterator cannot produce characters out of thin air. */
6467 if (field_width > it->end_charpos - charpos)
6468 it->end_charpos = charpos + field_width;
6470 /* Use the standard display table for displaying strings. */
6471 if (DISP_TABLE_P (Vstandard_display_table))
6472 it->dp = XCHAR_TABLE (Vstandard_display_table);
6474 it->stop_charpos = charpos;
6475 it->prev_stop = charpos;
6476 it->base_level_stop = 0;
6477 if (it->bidi_p)
6479 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 1;
6480 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6481 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = -1;
6483 if (s == NULL && it->multibyte_p)
6485 ptrdiff_t endpos = SCHARS (it->string);
6486 if (endpos > it->end_charpos)
6487 endpos = it->end_charpos;
6488 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, -1, endpos,
6489 it->string);
6491 CHECK_IT (it);
6496 /***********************************************************************
6497 Iteration
6498 ***********************************************************************/
6500 /* Map enum it_method value to corresponding next_element_from_* function. */
6502 static int (* get_next_element[NUM_IT_METHODS]) (struct it *it) =
6504 next_element_from_buffer,
6505 next_element_from_display_vector,
6506 next_element_from_string,
6507 next_element_from_c_string,
6508 next_element_from_image,
6509 next_element_from_stretch
6512 #define GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT(it) (*get_next_element[(it)->method]) (it)
6515 /* Return 1 iff a character at CHARPOS (and BYTEPOS) is composed
6516 (possibly with the following characters). */
6518 #define CHAR_COMPOSED_P(IT,CHARPOS,BYTEPOS,END_CHARPOS) \
6519 ((IT)->cmp_it.id >= 0 \
6520 || ((IT)->cmp_it.stop_pos == (CHARPOS) \
6521 && composition_reseat_it (&(IT)->cmp_it, CHARPOS, BYTEPOS, \
6522 END_CHARPOS, (IT)->w, \
6523 FACE_FROM_ID ((IT)->f, (IT)->face_id), \
6524 (IT)->string)))
6527 /* Lookup the char-table Vglyphless_char_display for character C (-1
6528 if we want information for no-font case), and return the display
6529 method symbol. By side-effect, update it->what and
6530 it->glyphless_method. This function is called from
6531 get_next_display_element for each character element, and from
6532 x_produce_glyphs when no suitable font was found. */
6534 Lisp_Object
6535 lookup_glyphless_char_display (int c, struct it *it)
6537 Lisp_Object glyphless_method = Qnil;
6539 if (CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
6540 && CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)) >= 1)
6542 if (c >= 0)
6544 glyphless_method = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, c);
6545 if (CONSP (glyphless_method))
6546 glyphless_method = FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
6547 ? XCAR (glyphless_method)
6548 : XCDR (glyphless_method);
6550 else
6551 glyphless_method = XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0];
6554 retry:
6555 if (NILP (glyphless_method))
6557 if (c >= 0)
6558 /* The default is to display the character by a proper font. */
6559 return Qnil;
6560 /* The default for the no-font case is to display an empty box. */
6561 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6563 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qzero_width))
6565 if (c >= 0)
6566 return glyphless_method;
6567 /* This method can't be used for the no-font case. */
6568 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6570 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qthin_space))
6571 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE;
6572 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qempty_box))
6573 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX;
6574 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qhex_code))
6575 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE;
6576 else if (STRINGP (glyphless_method))
6577 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM;
6578 else
6580 /* Invalid value. We use the default method. */
6581 glyphless_method = Qnil;
6582 goto retry;
6584 it->what = IT_GLYPHLESS;
6585 return glyphless_method;
6588 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
6589 display element from the current position of IT. Value is zero if
6590 end of buffer (or C string) is reached. */
6592 static struct frame *last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
6593 static int last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6594 static int last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6596 struct frame *last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
6597 int last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6598 int last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6600 static int
6601 get_next_display_element (struct it *it)
6603 /* Non-zero means that we found a display element. Zero means that
6604 we hit the end of what we iterate over. Performance note: the
6605 function pointer `method' used here turns out to be faster than
6606 using a sequence of if-statements. */
6607 int success_p;
6609 get_next:
6610 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
6612 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6614 /* UAX#9, L4: "A character is depicted by a mirrored glyph if
6615 and only if (a) the resolved directionality of that character
6616 is R..." */
6617 /* FIXME: Do we need an exception for characters from display
6618 tables? */
6619 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.type == STRONG_R)
6620 it->c = bidi_mirror_char (it->c);
6621 /* Map via display table or translate control characters.
6622 IT->c, IT->len etc. have been set to the next character by
6623 the function call above. If we have a display table, and it
6624 contains an entry for IT->c, translate it. Don't do this if
6625 IT->c itself comes from a display table, otherwise we could
6626 end up in an infinite recursion. (An alternative could be to
6627 count the recursion depth of this function and signal an
6628 error when a certain maximum depth is reached.) Is it worth
6629 it? */
6630 if (success_p && it->dpvec == NULL)
6632 Lisp_Object dv;
6633 struct charset *unibyte = CHARSET_FROM_ID (charset_unibyte);
6634 int nonascii_space_p = 0;
6635 int nonascii_hyphen_p = 0;
6636 int c = it->c; /* This is the character to display. */
6638 if (! it->multibyte_p && ! ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
6640 eassert (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c));
6641 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment)
6643 c = DECODE_CHAR (unibyte, c);
6644 if (c < 0)
6645 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6647 else
6648 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6651 if (it->dp
6652 && (dv = DISP_CHAR_VECTOR (it->dp, c),
6653 VECTORP (dv)))
6655 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (dv);
6657 /* Return the first character from the display table
6658 entry, if not empty. If empty, don't display the
6659 current character. */
6660 if (v->header.size)
6662 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6663 it->dpvec = v->contents;
6664 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
6665 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6666 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
6667 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6668 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6669 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6671 else
6673 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6675 goto get_next;
6678 if (! NILP (lookup_glyphless_char_display (c, it)))
6680 if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
6681 goto done;
6682 /* Don't display this character. */
6683 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6684 goto get_next;
6687 /* If `nobreak-char-display' is non-nil, we display
6688 non-ASCII spaces and hyphens specially. */
6689 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && ! NILP (Vnobreak_char_display))
6691 if (c == 0xA0)
6692 nonascii_space_p = 1;
6693 else if (c == 0xAD || c == 0x2010 || c == 0x2011)
6694 nonascii_hyphen_p = 1;
6697 /* Translate control characters into `\003' or `^C' form.
6698 Control characters coming from a display table entry are
6699 currently not translated because we use IT->dpvec to hold
6700 the translation. This could easily be changed but I
6701 don't believe that it is worth doing.
6703 The characters handled by `nobreak-char-display' must be
6704 translated too.
6706 Non-printable characters and raw-byte characters are also
6707 translated to octal form. */
6708 if (((c < ' ' || c == 127) /* ASCII control chars */
6709 ? (it->area != TEXT_AREA
6710 /* In mode line, treat \n, \t like other crl chars. */
6711 || (c != '\t'
6712 && it->glyph_row
6713 && (it->glyph_row->mode_line_p || it->avoid_cursor_p))
6714 || (c != '\n' && c != '\t'))
6715 : (nonascii_space_p
6716 || nonascii_hyphen_p
6717 || CHAR_BYTE8_P (c)
6718 || ! CHAR_PRINTABLE_P (c))))
6720 /* C is a control character, non-ASCII space/hyphen,
6721 raw-byte, or a non-printable character which must be
6722 displayed either as '\003' or as `^C' where the '\\'
6723 and '^' can be defined in the display table. Fill
6724 IT->ctl_chars with glyphs for what we have to
6725 display. Then, set IT->dpvec to these glyphs. */
6726 Lisp_Object gc;
6727 int ctl_len;
6728 int face_id;
6729 int lface_id = 0;
6730 int escape_glyph;
6732 /* Handle control characters with ^. */
6734 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && it->ctl_arrow_p)
6736 int g;
6738 g = '^'; /* default glyph for Control */
6739 /* Set IT->ctl_chars[0] to the glyph for `^'. */
6740 if (it->dp
6741 && (gc = DISP_CTRL_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6743 g = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6744 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6746 if (lface_id)
6748 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id, it->face_id);
6750 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6751 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6753 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6755 else
6757 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6758 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6759 it->face_id);
6760 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6761 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6762 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6765 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], g);
6766 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], c ^ 0100);
6767 ctl_len = 2;
6768 goto display_control;
6771 /* Handle non-ascii space in the mode where it only gets
6772 highlighting. */
6774 if (nonascii_space_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6776 /* Merge `nobreak-space' into the current face. */
6777 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qnobreak_space, 0,
6778 it->face_id);
6779 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], ' ');
6780 ctl_len = 1;
6781 goto display_control;
6784 /* Handle sequences that start with the "escape glyph". */
6786 /* the default escape glyph is \. */
6787 escape_glyph = '\\';
6789 if (it->dp
6790 && (gc = DISP_ESCAPE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6792 escape_glyph = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6793 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6795 if (lface_id)
6797 /* The display table specified a face.
6798 Merge it into face_id and also into escape_glyph. */
6799 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
6800 it->face_id);
6802 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6803 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6805 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6807 else
6809 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6810 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6811 it->face_id);
6812 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6813 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6814 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6817 /* Draw non-ASCII hyphen with just highlighting: */
6819 if (nonascii_hyphen_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6821 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], '-');
6822 ctl_len = 1;
6823 goto display_control;
6826 /* Draw non-ASCII space/hyphen with escape glyph: */
6828 if (nonascii_space_p || nonascii_hyphen_p)
6830 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6831 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], nonascii_space_p ? ' ' : '-');
6832 ctl_len = 2;
6833 goto display_control;
6837 char str[10];
6838 int len, i;
6840 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
6841 /* Display \200 instead of \17777600. */
6842 c = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
6843 len = sprintf (str, "%03o", c);
6845 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6846 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
6847 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[i + 1], str[i]);
6848 ctl_len = len + 1;
6851 display_control:
6852 /* Set up IT->dpvec and return first character from it. */
6853 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6854 it->dpvec = it->ctl_chars;
6855 it->dpend = it->dpvec + ctl_len;
6856 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6857 it->dpvec_face_id = face_id;
6858 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6859 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6860 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6861 goto get_next;
6863 it->char_to_display = c;
6865 else if (success_p)
6867 it->char_to_display = it->c;
6871 /* Adjust face id for a multibyte character. There are no multibyte
6872 character in unibyte text. */
6873 if ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER || it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
6874 && it->multibyte_p
6875 && success_p
6876 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
6878 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
6880 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch >= 0)
6882 /* Automatic composition with glyph-string. */
6883 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
6885 it->face_id = face_for_font (it->f, LGSTRING_FONT (gstring), face);
6887 else
6889 ptrdiff_t pos = (it->s ? -1
6890 : STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
6891 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
6892 int c;
6894 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6895 c = it->char_to_display;
6896 else
6898 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
6899 int i;
6901 c = ' ';
6902 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
6903 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with
6904 padding space on the left or right. */
6905 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
6906 break;
6908 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, pos, it->string);
6912 done:
6913 /* Is this character the last one of a run of characters with
6914 box? If yes, set IT->end_of_box_run_p to 1. */
6915 if (it->face_box_p
6916 && it->s == NULL)
6918 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING && it->sp)
6920 int face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
6921 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
6923 if (face)
6925 if (face->box == FACE_NO_BOX)
6927 /* If the box comes from face properties in a
6928 display string, check faces in that string. */
6929 int string_face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6930 it->end_of_box_run_p
6931 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, string_face_id)->box
6932 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6934 /* Otherwise, the box comes from the underlying face.
6935 If this is the last string character displayed, check
6936 the next buffer location. */
6937 else if ((IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string) - 1)
6938 && (it->current.overlay_string_index
6939 == it->n_overlay_strings - 1))
6941 ptrdiff_t ignore;
6942 int next_face_id;
6943 struct text_pos pos = it->current.pos;
6944 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
6946 next_face_id = face_at_buffer_position
6947 (it->w, CHARPOS (pos), it->region_beg_charpos,
6948 it->region_end_charpos, &ignore,
6949 (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT), 0,
6950 -1);
6951 it->end_of_box_run_p
6952 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, next_face_id)->box
6953 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6957 else
6959 int face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6960 it->end_of_box_run_p
6961 = (face_id != it->face_id
6962 && FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id)->box == FACE_NO_BOX);
6965 /* If we reached the end of the object we've been iterating (e.g., a
6966 display string or an overlay string), and there's something on
6967 IT->stack, proceed with what's on the stack. It doesn't make
6968 sense to return zero if there's unprocessed stuff on the stack,
6969 because otherwise that stuff will never be displayed. */
6970 if (!success_p && it->sp > 0)
6972 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6973 success_p = get_next_display_element (it);
6976 /* Value is 0 if end of buffer or string reached. */
6977 return success_p;
6981 /* Move IT to the next display element.
6983 RESEAT_P non-zero means if called on a newline in buffer text,
6984 skip to the next visible line start.
6986 Functions get_next_display_element and set_iterator_to_next are
6987 separate because I find this arrangement easier to handle than a
6988 get_next_display_element function that also increments IT's
6989 position. The way it is we can first look at an iterator's current
6990 display element, decide whether it fits on a line, and if it does,
6991 increment the iterator position. The other way around we probably
6992 would either need a flag indicating whether the iterator has to be
6993 incremented the next time, or we would have to implement a
6994 decrement position function which would not be easy to write. */
6996 void
6997 set_iterator_to_next (struct it *it, int reseat_p)
6999 /* Reset flags indicating start and end of a sequence of characters
7000 with box. Reset them at the start of this function because
7001 moving the iterator to a new position might set them. */
7002 it->start_of_box_run_p = it->end_of_box_run_p = 0;
7004 switch (it->method)
7006 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
7007 /* The current display element of IT is a character from
7008 current_buffer. Advance in the buffer, and maybe skip over
7009 invisible lines that are so because of selective display. */
7010 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it) && reseat_p)
7011 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
7012 else if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
7014 /* We are currently getting glyphs from a composition. */
7015 int i;
7017 if (! it->bidi_p)
7019 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7020 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7021 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7023 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7025 else
7027 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
7028 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7029 IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
7030 it->end_charpos, Qnil);
7033 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
7035 /* Composition created while scanning forward. */
7036 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the first
7037 character of the next grapheme cluster, or to the
7038 character visually after the current composition. */
7039 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7040 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7041 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7042 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7044 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7046 /* Proceed to the next grapheme cluster. */
7047 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7049 else
7051 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7052 Find the next stop position. */
7053 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7054 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7055 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7056 where to stop. */
7057 stop = -1;
7058 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7059 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7062 else
7064 /* Composition created while scanning backward. */
7065 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the last
7066 character of the previous grapheme cluster, or the
7067 character visually after the current composition. */
7068 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7069 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7070 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7071 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7072 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7074 /* Proceed to the previous grapheme cluster. */
7075 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7077 else
7079 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7080 Find the next stop position. */
7081 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7082 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7083 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7084 where to stop. */
7085 stop = -1;
7086 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7087 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7091 else
7093 eassert (it->len != 0);
7095 if (!it->bidi_p)
7097 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7098 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7100 else
7102 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7103 /* If this is a new paragraph, determine its base
7104 direction (a.k.a. its base embedding level). */
7105 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
7106 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
7107 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7108 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7109 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7110 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7112 /* As the scan direction was changed, we must
7113 re-compute the stop position for composition. */
7114 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7115 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7116 stop = -1;
7117 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7118 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7121 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
7123 break;
7125 case GET_FROM_C_STRING:
7126 /* Current display element of IT is from a C string. */
7127 if (!it->bidi_p
7128 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it means
7129 next_element_from_c_string is padding the string with
7130 blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi iterator,
7131 because it cannot deal with such virtual characters. */
7132 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7134 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7135 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7137 else
7139 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7140 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7141 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7143 break;
7145 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
7146 /* Current display element of IT is from a display table entry.
7147 Advance in the display table definition. Reset it to null if
7148 end reached, and continue with characters from buffers/
7149 strings. */
7150 ++it->current.dpvec_index;
7152 /* Restore face of the iterator to what they were before the
7153 display vector entry (these entries may contain faces). */
7154 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7156 if (it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index >= it->dpend)
7158 int recheck_faces = it->ellipsis_p;
7160 if (it->s)
7161 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
7162 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
7163 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
7164 else
7166 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7167 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7170 it->dpvec = NULL;
7171 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
7173 /* Skip over characters which were displayed via IT->dpvec. */
7174 if (it->dpvec_char_len < 0)
7175 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7176 else if (it->dpvec_char_len > 0)
7178 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING
7179 && it->n_overlay_strings > 0)
7180 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
7181 it->len = it->dpvec_char_len;
7182 set_iterator_to_next (it, reseat_p);
7185 /* Maybe recheck faces after display vector */
7186 if (recheck_faces)
7187 it->stop_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7189 break;
7191 case GET_FROM_STRING:
7192 /* Current display element is a character from a Lisp string. */
7193 eassert (it->s == NULL && STRINGP (it->string));
7194 /* Don't advance past string end. These conditions are true
7195 when set_iterator_to_next is called at the end of
7196 get_next_display_element, in which case the Lisp string is
7197 already exhausted, and all we want is pop the iterator
7198 stack. */
7199 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7201 /* This is an overlay string, so there's no padding with
7202 spaces, and the number of characters in the string is
7203 where the string ends. */
7204 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7205 goto consider_string_end;
7207 else
7209 /* Not an overlay string. There could be padding, so test
7210 against it->end_charpos . */
7211 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7212 goto consider_string_end;
7214 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
7216 int i;
7218 if (! it->bidi_p)
7220 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7221 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7222 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7223 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7224 else
7226 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
7227 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7228 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7229 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7230 it->end_charpos, it->string);
7233 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
7235 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7236 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7237 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7238 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7240 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7241 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7242 else
7244 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7245 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7246 stop = -1;
7247 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7248 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7249 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7250 it->string);
7253 else
7255 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7256 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7257 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7258 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7259 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7260 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7261 else
7263 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7264 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7265 stop = -1;
7266 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7267 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7268 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7269 it->string);
7273 else
7275 if (!it->bidi_p
7276 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it
7277 means next_element_from_string is padding the string
7278 with blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi
7279 iterator, because it cannot deal with such virtual
7280 characters. */
7281 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7283 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7284 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7286 else
7288 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7290 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7291 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7292 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7293 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7295 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7297 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7298 stop = -1;
7299 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7300 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7301 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7302 it->string);
7307 consider_string_end:
7309 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7311 /* IT->string is an overlay string. Advance to the
7312 next, if there is one. */
7313 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7315 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
7316 next_overlay_string (it);
7317 if (it->ellipsis_p)
7318 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
7321 else
7323 /* IT->string is not an overlay string. If we reached
7324 its end, and there is something on IT->stack, proceed
7325 with what is on the stack. This can be either another
7326 string, this time an overlay string, or a buffer. */
7327 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == SCHARS (it->string)
7328 && it->sp > 0)
7330 pop_it (it);
7331 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7332 goto consider_string_end;
7335 break;
7337 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
7338 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
7339 /* The position etc with which we have to proceed are on
7340 the stack. The position may be at the end of a string,
7341 if the `display' property takes up the whole string. */
7342 eassert (it->sp > 0);
7343 pop_it (it);
7344 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7345 goto consider_string_end;
7346 break;
7348 default:
7349 /* There are no other methods defined, so this should be a bug. */
7350 emacs_abort ();
7353 eassert (it->method != GET_FROM_STRING
7354 || (STRINGP (it->string)
7355 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0));
7358 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
7359 display element which comes from a display table entry or from the
7360 result of translating a control character to one of the forms `^C'
7361 or `\003'.
7363 IT->dpvec holds the glyphs to return as characters.
7364 IT->saved_face_id holds the face id before the display vector--it
7365 is restored into IT->face_id in set_iterator_to_next. */
7367 static int
7368 next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *it)
7370 Lisp_Object gc;
7372 /* Precondition. */
7373 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
7375 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7377 /* KFS: This code used to check ip->dpvec[0] instead of the current element.
7378 That seemed totally bogus - so I changed it... */
7379 gc = it->dpvec[it->current.dpvec_index];
7381 if (GLYPH_CODE_P (gc))
7383 it->c = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
7384 it->len = CHAR_BYTES (it->c);
7386 /* The entry may contain a face id to use. Such a face id is
7387 the id of a Lisp face, not a realized face. A face id of
7388 zero means no face is specified. */
7389 if (it->dpvec_face_id >= 0)
7390 it->face_id = it->dpvec_face_id;
7391 else
7393 int lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
7394 if (lface_id > 0)
7395 it->face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
7396 it->saved_face_id);
7399 else
7400 /* Display table entry is invalid. Return a space. */
7401 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7403 /* Don't change position and object of the iterator here. They are
7404 still the values of the character that had this display table
7405 entry or was translated, and that's what we want. */
7406 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7407 return 1;
7410 /* Get the first element of string/buffer in the visual order, after
7411 being reseated to a new position in a string or a buffer. */
7412 static void
7413 get_visually_first_element (struct it *it)
7415 int string_p = STRINGP (it->string) || it->s;
7416 ptrdiff_t eob = (string_p ? it->bidi_it.string.schars : ZV);
7417 ptrdiff_t bob = (string_p ? 0 : BEGV);
7419 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7421 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7422 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7424 else
7426 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7427 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7430 if (it->bidi_it.charpos == eob)
7432 /* Nothing to do, but reset the FIRST_ELT flag, like
7433 bidi_paragraph_init does, because we are not going to
7434 call it. */
7435 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
7437 else if (it->bidi_it.charpos == bob
7438 || (!string_p
7439 && (FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos - 1) == '\n'
7440 || FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos) == '\n')))
7442 /* If we are at the beginning of a line/string, we can produce
7443 the next element right away. */
7444 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7445 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7447 else
7449 ptrdiff_t orig_bytepos = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7451 /* We need to prime the bidi iterator starting at the line's or
7452 string's beginning, before we will be able to produce the
7453 next element. */
7454 if (string_p)
7455 it->bidi_it.charpos = it->bidi_it.bytepos = 0;
7456 else
7458 it->bidi_it.charpos = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7459 -1);
7460 it->bidi_it.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->bidi_it.charpos);
7462 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7465 /* Now return to buffer/string position where we were asked
7466 to get the next display element, and produce that. */
7467 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7469 while (it->bidi_it.bytepos != orig_bytepos
7470 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob);
7473 /* Adjust IT's position information to where we ended up. */
7474 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7476 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7477 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7479 else
7481 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7482 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7485 if (STRINGP (it->string) || !it->s)
7487 ptrdiff_t stop, charpos, bytepos;
7489 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7491 eassert (!it->s);
7492 stop = SCHARS (it->string);
7493 if (stop > it->end_charpos)
7494 stop = it->end_charpos;
7495 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7496 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7498 else
7500 stop = it->end_charpos;
7501 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7502 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7504 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7505 stop = -1;
7506 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos, stop,
7507 it->string);
7511 /* Load IT with the next display element from Lisp string IT->string.
7512 IT->current.string_pos is the current position within the string.
7513 If IT->current.overlay_string_index >= 0, the Lisp string is an
7514 overlay string. */
7516 static int
7517 next_element_from_string (struct it *it)
7519 struct text_pos position;
7521 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
7522 eassert (!it->bidi_p || EQ (it->string, it->bidi_it.string.lstring));
7523 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
7524 position = it->current.string_pos;
7526 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7527 character at IT_STRING_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means
7528 that we were reseat()ed to a new string, whose paragraph
7529 direction is not known. */
7530 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7532 get_visually_first_element (it);
7533 SET_TEXT_POS (position, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7536 /* Time to check for invisible text? */
7537 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
7539 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7541 if (!(!it->bidi_p
7542 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7543 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7545 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find
7546 ourselves far beyond the last computed stop_charpos,
7547 with several other stop positions in between that we
7548 missed. Scan them all now, in buffer's logical
7549 order, until we find and handle the last stop_charpos
7550 that precedes our current position. */
7551 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7552 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7554 else
7556 if (it->bidi_p)
7558 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved
7559 across, for when we will move back across it. */
7560 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7561 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7562 note of the last stop position seen at this
7563 level. */
7564 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7565 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7567 handle_stop (it);
7569 /* Since a handler may have changed IT->method, we must
7570 recurse here. */
7571 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7574 else if (it->bidi_p
7575 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped
7576 on our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need
7577 to handle that stop_pos. */
7578 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7579 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7580 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7581 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7582 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7583 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7585 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we have no better
7586 place for handle_stop_backwards to start from than string
7587 beginning. This happens, e.g., when we were reseated to
7588 the previous screenful of text by vertical-motion. */
7589 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7590 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7591 it->base_level_stop = 0;
7592 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7593 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7597 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7599 /* Get the next character from an overlay string. In overlay
7600 strings, there is no field width or padding with spaces to
7601 do. */
7602 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7604 it->what = IT_EOB;
7605 return 0;
7607 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7608 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7609 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7610 ? -1
7611 : SCHARS (it->string))
7612 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7614 return 1;
7616 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7618 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7619 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7620 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7622 else
7624 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7625 it->len = 1;
7628 else
7630 /* Get the next character from a Lisp string that is not an
7631 overlay string. Such strings come from the mode line, for
7632 example. We may have to pad with spaces, or truncate the
7633 string. See also next_element_from_c_string. */
7634 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7636 it->what = IT_EOB;
7637 return 0;
7639 else if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7641 /* Pad with spaces. */
7642 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7643 CHARPOS (position) = BYTEPOS (position) = -1;
7645 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7646 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7647 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7648 ? -1
7649 : it->string_nchars)
7650 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7652 return 1;
7654 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7656 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7657 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7658 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7660 else
7662 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7663 it->len = 1;
7667 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
7668 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7669 it->object = it->string;
7670 it->position = position;
7671 return 1;
7675 /* Load IT with next display element from C string IT->s.
7676 IT->string_nchars is the maximum number of characters to return
7677 from the string. IT->end_charpos may be greater than
7678 IT->string_nchars when this function is called, in which case we
7679 may have to return padding spaces. Value is zero if end of string
7680 reached, including padding spaces. */
7682 static int
7683 next_element_from_c_string (struct it *it)
7685 int success_p = 1;
7687 eassert (it->s);
7688 eassert (!it->bidi_p || it->s == it->bidi_it.string.s);
7689 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7690 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = 0;
7691 it->object = Qnil;
7693 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7694 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7695 we were reseated to a new string, whose paragraph direction is
7696 not known. */
7697 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7698 get_visually_first_element (it);
7700 /* IT's position can be greater than IT->string_nchars in case a
7701 field width or precision has been specified when the iterator was
7702 initialized. */
7703 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7705 /* End of the game. */
7706 it->what = IT_EOB;
7707 success_p = 0;
7709 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7711 /* Pad with spaces. */
7712 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7713 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = -1;
7715 else if (it->multibyte_p)
7716 it->c = string_char_and_length (it->s + IT_BYTEPOS (*it), &it->len);
7717 else
7718 it->c = it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)], it->len = 1;
7720 return success_p;
7724 /* Set up IT to return characters from an ellipsis, if appropriate.
7725 The definition of the ellipsis glyphs may come from a display table
7726 entry. This function fills IT with the first glyph from the
7727 ellipsis if an ellipsis is to be displayed. */
7729 static int
7730 next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *it)
7732 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
7733 setup_for_ellipsis (it, it->len);
7734 else
7736 /* The face at the current position may be different from the
7737 face we find after the invisible text. Remember what it
7738 was in IT->saved_face_id, and signal that it's there by
7739 setting face_before_selective_p. */
7740 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
7741 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7742 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7743 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7744 it->face_before_selective_p = 1;
7747 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7751 /* Deliver an image display element. The iterator IT is already
7752 filled with image information (done in handle_display_prop). Value
7753 is always 1. */
7756 static int
7757 next_element_from_image (struct it *it)
7759 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
7760 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
7761 return 1;
7765 /* Fill iterator IT with next display element from a stretch glyph
7766 property. IT->object is the value of the text property. Value is
7767 always 1. */
7769 static int
7770 next_element_from_stretch (struct it *it)
7772 it->what = IT_STRETCH;
7773 return 1;
7776 /* Scan backwards from IT's current position until we find a stop
7777 position, or until BEGV. This is called when we find ourself
7778 before both the last known prev_stop and base_level_stop while
7779 reordering bidirectional text. */
7781 static void
7782 compute_stop_pos_backwards (struct it *it)
7784 const int SCAN_BACK_LIMIT = 1000;
7785 struct text_pos pos;
7786 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7787 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7788 ptrdiff_t charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7789 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = charpos;
7790 ptrdiff_t save_stop_pos = it->stop_charpos;
7791 ptrdiff_t save_end_pos = it->end_charpos;
7793 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7794 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7795 it->bidi_p = 0;
7798 it->end_charpos = min (charpos + 1, ZV);
7799 charpos = max (charpos - SCAN_BACK_LIMIT, BEGV);
7800 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7801 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
7802 compute_stop_pos (it);
7803 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7804 if (it->stop_charpos <= charpos)
7805 emacs_abort ();
7807 while (charpos > BEGV && it->stop_charpos >= it->end_charpos);
7809 if (it->stop_charpos <= where_we_are)
7810 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7811 else
7812 it->prev_stop = BEGV;
7813 it->bidi_p = 1;
7814 it->current = save_current;
7815 it->position = save_position;
7816 it->stop_charpos = save_stop_pos;
7817 it->end_charpos = save_end_pos;
7820 /* Scan forward from CHARPOS in the current buffer/string, until we
7821 find a stop position > current IT's position. Then handle the stop
7822 position before that. This is called when we bump into a stop
7823 position while reordering bidirectional text. CHARPOS should be
7824 the last previously processed stop_pos (or BEGV/0, if none were
7825 processed yet) whose position is less that IT's current
7826 position. */
7828 static void
7829 handle_stop_backwards (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
7831 int bufp = !STRINGP (it->string);
7832 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = (bufp ? IT_CHARPOS (*it) : IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
7833 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7834 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7835 struct text_pos pos1;
7836 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
7838 /* Scan in strict logical order. */
7839 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7840 it->bidi_p = 0;
7843 it->prev_stop = charpos;
7844 if (bufp)
7846 SET_TEXT_POS (pos1, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7847 reseat_1 (it, pos1, 0);
7849 else
7850 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
7851 compute_stop_pos (it);
7852 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7853 if (it->stop_charpos <= it->prev_stop)
7854 emacs_abort ();
7855 charpos = it->stop_charpos;
7857 while (charpos <= where_we_are);
7859 it->bidi_p = 1;
7860 it->current = save_current;
7861 it->position = save_position;
7862 next_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7863 it->stop_charpos = it->prev_stop;
7864 handle_stop (it);
7865 it->stop_charpos = next_stop;
7868 /* Load IT with the next display element from current_buffer. Value
7869 is zero if end of buffer reached. IT->stop_charpos is the next
7870 position at which to stop and check for text properties or buffer
7871 end. */
7873 static int
7874 next_element_from_buffer (struct it *it)
7876 int success_p = 1;
7878 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
7879 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7880 eassert (!it->bidi_p
7881 || (EQ (it->bidi_it.string.lstring, Qnil)
7882 && it->bidi_it.string.s == NULL));
7884 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7885 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7886 we were reseat()ed to a new buffer position, which is potentially
7887 a different paragraph. */
7888 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7890 get_visually_first_element (it);
7891 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7894 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7896 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7898 int overlay_strings_follow_p;
7900 /* End of the game, except when overlay strings follow that
7901 haven't been returned yet. */
7902 if (it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p)
7903 overlay_strings_follow_p = 0;
7904 else
7906 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
7907 overlay_strings_follow_p = get_overlay_strings (it, 0);
7910 if (overlay_strings_follow_p)
7911 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7912 else
7914 it->what = IT_EOB;
7915 it->position = it->current.pos;
7916 success_p = 0;
7919 else if (!(!it->bidi_p
7920 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7921 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7923 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find ourselves
7924 far beyond the last computed stop_charpos, with several
7925 other stop positions in between that we missed. Scan
7926 them all now, in buffer's logical order, until we find
7927 and handle the last stop_charpos that precedes our
7928 current position. */
7929 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7930 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7932 else
7934 if (it->bidi_p)
7936 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved across,
7937 for when we will move back across it. */
7938 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7939 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7940 note of the last stop position seen at this
7941 level. */
7942 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7943 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7945 handle_stop (it);
7946 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7949 else if (it->bidi_p
7950 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped on
7951 our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need to
7952 handle that stop_pos. */
7953 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7954 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7955 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7956 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7957 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7958 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7960 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7961 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7963 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we need to find
7964 prev_stop by looking backwards. This happens, e.g., when
7965 we were reseated to the previous screenful of text by
7966 vertical-motion. */
7967 it->base_level_stop = BEGV;
7968 compute_stop_pos_backwards (it);
7969 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->prev_stop);
7971 else
7972 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7973 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7975 else
7977 /* No face changes, overlays etc. in sight, so just return a
7978 character from current_buffer. */
7979 unsigned char *p;
7980 ptrdiff_t stop;
7982 /* Maybe run the redisplay end trigger hook. Performance note:
7983 This doesn't seem to cost measurable time. */
7984 if (it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
7985 && it->glyph_row
7986 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos)
7987 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (it);
7989 stop = it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0 ? -1 : it->end_charpos;
7990 if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
7991 stop)
7992 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7994 return 1;
7997 /* Get the next character, maybe multibyte. */
7998 p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7999 if (it->multibyte_p && !ASCII_BYTE_P (*p))
8000 it->c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it->len);
8001 else
8002 it->c = *p, it->len = 1;
8004 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
8005 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
8006 it->object = it->w->buffer;
8007 it->position = it->current.pos;
8009 /* Normally we return the character found above, except when we
8010 really want to return an ellipsis for selective display. */
8011 if (it->selective)
8013 if (it->c == '\n')
8015 /* A value of selective > 0 means hide lines indented more
8016 than that number of columns. */
8017 if (it->selective > 0
8018 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1 < ZV
8019 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1,
8020 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) + 1,
8021 it->selective))
8023 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
8024 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
8027 else if (it->c == '\r' && it->selective == -1)
8029 /* A value of selective == -1 means that everything from the
8030 CR to the end of the line is invisible, with maybe an
8031 ellipsis displayed for it. */
8032 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
8033 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
8038 /* Value is zero if end of buffer reached. */
8039 eassert (!success_p || it->what != IT_CHARACTER || it->len > 0);
8040 return success_p;
8044 /* Run the redisplay end trigger hook for IT. */
8046 static void
8047 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *it)
8049 Lisp_Object args[3];
8051 /* IT->glyph_row should be non-null, i.e. we should be actually
8052 displaying something, or otherwise we should not run the hook. */
8053 eassert (it->glyph_row);
8055 /* Set up hook arguments. */
8056 args[0] = Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
8057 args[1] = it->window;
8058 XSETINT (args[2], it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos);
8059 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos = 0;
8061 /* Since we are *trying* to run these functions, don't try to run
8062 them again, even if they get an error. */
8063 wset_redisplay_end_trigger (it->w, Qnil);
8064 Frun_hook_with_args (3, args);
8066 /* Notice if it changed the face of the character we are on. */
8067 handle_face_prop (it);
8071 /* Deliver a composition display element. Unlike the other
8072 next_element_from_XXX, this function is not registered in the array
8073 get_next_element[]. It is called from next_element_from_buffer and
8074 next_element_from_string when necessary. */
8076 static int
8077 next_element_from_composition (struct it *it)
8079 it->what = IT_COMPOSITION;
8080 it->len = it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8081 if (STRINGP (it->string))
8083 if (it->c < 0)
8085 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8086 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8087 return 0;
8089 it->position = it->current.string_pos;
8090 it->object = it->string;
8091 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
8092 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), it->string);
8094 else
8096 if (it->c < 0)
8098 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8099 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8100 if (it->bidi_p)
8102 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
8103 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
8104 /* Resync the bidi iterator with IT's new position.
8105 FIXME: this doesn't support bidirectional text. */
8106 while (it->bidi_it.charpos < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
8107 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
8109 return 0;
8111 it->position = it->current.pos;
8112 it->object = it->w->buffer;
8113 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
8114 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), Qnil);
8116 return 1;
8121 /***********************************************************************
8122 Moving an iterator without producing glyphs
8123 ***********************************************************************/
8125 /* Check if iterator is at a position corresponding to a valid buffer
8126 position after some move_it_ call. */
8128 #define IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P(it) \
8129 ((it)->method == GET_FROM_STRING \
8130 ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 \
8131 : 1)
8134 /* Move iterator IT to a specified buffer or X position within one
8135 line on the display without producing glyphs.
8137 OP should be a bit mask including some or all of these bits:
8138 MOVE_TO_X: Stop upon reaching x-position TO_X.
8139 MOVE_TO_POS: Stop upon reaching buffer or string position TO_CHARPOS.
8140 Regardless of OP's value, stop upon reaching the end of the display line.
8142 TO_X is normally a value 0 <= TO_X <= IT->last_visible_x.
8143 This means, in particular, that TO_X includes window's horizontal
8144 scroll amount.
8146 The return value has several possible values that
8147 say what condition caused the scan to stop:
8149 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV
8150 - when TO_POS or ZV was reached.
8152 MOVE_X_REACHED
8153 -when TO_X was reached before TO_POS or ZV were reached.
8155 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8156 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line must
8157 be continued.
8159 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED
8160 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line is
8161 truncated.
8163 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
8164 - when we stopped at a line end, i.e. a newline or a CR and selective
8165 display is on. */
8167 static enum move_it_result
8168 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *it,
8169 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8170 enum move_operation_enum op)
8172 enum move_it_result result = MOVE_UNDEFINED;
8173 struct glyph_row *saved_glyph_row;
8174 struct it wrap_it, atpos_it, atx_it, ppos_it;
8175 void *wrap_data = NULL, *atpos_data = NULL, *atx_data = NULL;
8176 void *ppos_data = NULL;
8177 int may_wrap = 0;
8178 enum it_method prev_method = it->method;
8179 ptrdiff_t prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8180 int saw_smaller_pos = prev_pos < to_charpos;
8182 /* Don't produce glyphs in produce_glyphs. */
8183 saved_glyph_row = it->glyph_row;
8184 it->glyph_row = NULL;
8186 /* Use wrap_it to save a copy of IT wherever a word wrap could
8187 occur. Use atpos_it to save a copy of IT at the desired buffer
8188 position, if found, so that we can scan ahead and check if the
8189 word later overshoots the window edge. Use atx_it similarly, for
8190 pixel positions. */
8191 wrap_it.sp = -1;
8192 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8193 atx_it.sp = -1;
8195 /* Use ppos_it under bidi reordering to save a copy of IT for the
8196 position > CHARPOS that is the closest to CHARPOS. We restore
8197 that position in IT when we have scanned the entire display line
8198 without finding a match for CHARPOS and all the character
8199 positions are greater than CHARPOS. */
8200 if (it->bidi_p)
8202 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8203 SET_TEXT_POS (ppos_it.current.pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
8204 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos)
8205 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8208 #define BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P() \
8209 ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0 \
8210 && BUFFERP (it->object) \
8211 && (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos \
8212 || ((!it->bidi_p \
8213 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)) \
8214 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos) \
8215 || (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION \
8216 && ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos \
8217 && to_charpos >= it->cmp_it.charpos) \
8218 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos \
8219 && to_charpos <= it->cmp_it.charpos)))) \
8220 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER \
8221 || (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR \
8222 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index + 1 >= it->dpend)))
8224 /* If there's a line-/wrap-prefix, handle it. */
8225 if (it->hpos == 0 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8226 && it->current_y < it->last_visible_y)
8227 handle_line_prefix (it);
8229 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8230 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8232 while (1)
8234 int x, i, ascent = 0, descent = 0;
8236 /* Utility macro to reset an iterator with x, ascent, and descent. */
8237 #define IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT(IT) \
8238 ((IT)->current_x = x, (IT)->max_ascent = ascent, \
8239 (IT)->max_descent = descent)
8241 /* Stop if we move beyond TO_CHARPOS (after an image or a
8242 display string or stretch glyph). */
8243 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8244 && BUFFERP (it->object)
8245 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8246 && (((!it->bidi_p
8247 /* When the iterator is at base embedding level, we
8248 are guaranteed that characters are delivered for
8249 display in strictly increasing order of their
8250 buffer positions. */
8251 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
8252 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8253 || (it->bidi_p
8254 && (prev_method == GET_FROM_IMAGE
8255 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRETCH
8256 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRING)
8257 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from left to right. */
8258 && ((prev_pos < to_charpos
8259 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8260 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from right to left. */
8261 || (prev_pos > to_charpos
8262 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)))))
8264 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8266 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8267 break;
8269 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8270 /* If wrap_it is valid, the current position might be in a
8271 word that is wrapped. So, save the iterator in
8272 atpos_it and continue to see if wrapping happens. */
8273 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8276 /* Stop when ZV reached.
8277 We used to stop here when TO_CHARPOS reached as well, but that is
8278 too soon if this glyph does not fit on this line. So we handle it
8279 explicitly below. */
8280 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8282 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8283 break;
8286 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
8288 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8290 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8291 break;
8294 else
8296 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8298 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
8299 may_wrap = 1;
8300 else if (may_wrap)
8302 /* We have reached a glyph that follows one or more
8303 whitespace characters. If the position is
8304 already found, we are done. */
8305 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8307 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8308 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8309 goto done;
8311 if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8313 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8314 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8315 goto done;
8317 /* Otherwise, we can wrap here. */
8318 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
8319 may_wrap = 0;
8324 /* Remember the line height for the current line, in case
8325 the next element doesn't fit on the line. */
8326 ascent = it->max_ascent;
8327 descent = it->max_descent;
8329 /* The call to produce_glyphs will get the metrics of the
8330 display element IT is loaded with. Record the x-position
8331 before this display element, in case it doesn't fit on the
8332 line. */
8333 x = it->current_x;
8335 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
8337 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
8339 prev_method = it->method;
8340 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8341 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8342 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8343 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8344 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8345 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8346 if (it->bidi_p
8347 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8348 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos
8349 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8350 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8351 continue;
8354 /* The number of glyphs we get back in IT->nglyphs will normally
8355 be 1 except when IT->c is (i) a TAB, or (ii) a multi-glyph
8356 character on a terminal frame, or (iii) a line end. For the
8357 second case, IT->nglyphs - 1 padding glyphs will be present.
8358 (On X frames, there is only one glyph produced for a
8359 composite character.)
8361 The behavior implemented below means, for continuation lines,
8362 that as many spaces of a TAB as fit on the current line are
8363 displayed there. For terminal frames, as many glyphs of a
8364 multi-glyph character are displayed in the current line, too.
8365 This is what the old redisplay code did, and we keep it that
8366 way. Under X, the whole shape of a complex character must
8367 fit on the line or it will be completely displayed in the
8368 next line.
8370 Note that both for tabs and padding glyphs, all glyphs have
8371 the same width. */
8372 if (it->nglyphs)
8374 /* More than one glyph or glyph doesn't fit on line. All
8375 glyphs have the same width. */
8376 int single_glyph_width = it->pixel_width / it->nglyphs;
8377 int new_x;
8378 int x_before_this_char = x;
8379 int hpos_before_this_char = it->hpos;
8381 for (i = 0; i < it->nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
8383 new_x = x + single_glyph_width;
8385 /* We want to leave anything reaching TO_X to the caller. */
8386 if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && new_x > to_x)
8388 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8390 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8391 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8392 if (atpos_it.sp < 0)
8394 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8395 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8398 else
8400 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8402 it->current_x = x;
8403 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8404 break;
8406 if (atx_it.sp < 0)
8408 SAVE_IT (atx_it, *it, atx_data);
8409 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atx_it);
8414 if (/* Lines are continued. */
8415 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
8416 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
8417 new_x > it->last_visible_x
8418 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
8419 system frame. */
8420 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8421 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8422 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8423 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8424 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
8426 if (/* IT->hpos == 0 means the very first glyph
8427 doesn't fit on the line, e.g. a wide image. */
8428 it->hpos == 0
8429 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8430 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)))
8432 ++it->hpos;
8433 it->current_x = new_x;
8435 /* The character's last glyph just barely fits
8436 in this row. */
8437 if (i == it->nglyphs - 1)
8439 /* If this is the destination position,
8440 return a position *before* it in this row,
8441 now that we know it fits in this row. */
8442 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8444 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP
8445 || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8447 it->hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8448 it->current_x = x_before_this_char;
8449 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8450 break;
8452 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8453 && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8455 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8456 atpos_it.current_x = x_before_this_char;
8457 atpos_it.hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8461 prev_method = it->method;
8462 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8463 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8464 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8465 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8466 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8467 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8468 /* On graphical terminals, newlines may
8469 "overflow" into the fringe if
8470 overflow-newline-into-fringe is non-nil.
8471 On text terminals, and on graphical
8472 terminals with no right margin, newlines
8473 may overflow into the last glyph on the
8474 display line.*/
8475 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8476 || ((it->bidi_p
8477 && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8478 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8479 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8480 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8482 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8484 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8485 break;
8487 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8489 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8490 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8491 else
8492 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8493 break;
8495 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8497 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8498 break;
8503 else
8504 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8506 if (wrap_it.sp >= 0)
8508 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
8509 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8510 atx_it.sp = -1;
8513 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_in: continued at %d\n",
8514 IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8515 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8516 break;
8519 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8521 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8522 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8523 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8525 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8526 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8530 if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
8532 /* Glyph is visible. Increment number of glyphs that
8533 would be displayed. */
8534 ++it->hpos;
8538 if (result != MOVE_UNDEFINED)
8539 break;
8541 else if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8543 buffer_pos_reached:
8544 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8545 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8546 break;
8548 else if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && it->current_x >= to_x)
8550 /* Stop when TO_X specified and reached. This check is
8551 necessary here because of lines consisting of a line end,
8552 only. The line end will not produce any glyphs and we
8553 would never get MOVE_X_REACHED. */
8554 eassert (it->nglyphs == 0);
8555 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8556 break;
8559 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're done. */
8560 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8562 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any character
8563 positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS, return
8564 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the unidirectional display
8565 did. */
8566 if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0)
8568 if (!saw_smaller_pos && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8570 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8572 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8573 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8575 else
8576 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8578 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp >= 0
8579 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8580 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8581 else
8582 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8584 else
8585 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8586 break;
8589 prev_method = it->method;
8590 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8591 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8592 /* The current display element has been consumed. Advance
8593 to the next. */
8594 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8595 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8596 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8597 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)
8598 saw_smaller_pos = 1;
8599 if (it->bidi_p
8600 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8601 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8602 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8603 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8605 /* Stop if lines are truncated and IT's current x-position is
8606 past the right edge of the window now. */
8607 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
8608 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
8610 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8611 || ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8612 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8613 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8614 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8616 int at_eob_p = 0;
8618 if ((at_eob_p = !get_next_display_element (it))
8619 || BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ()
8620 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any
8621 character positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS,
8622 return MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the
8623 unidirectional display did. */
8624 || (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8625 && !saw_smaller_pos
8626 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos))
8628 if (it->bidi_p
8629 && !at_eob_p && IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8630 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8631 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8632 break;
8634 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8636 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8637 break;
8640 else if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8641 && !saw_smaller_pos
8642 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8644 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8645 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8646 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8647 break;
8649 result = MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED;
8650 break;
8652 #undef IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT
8655 #undef BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P
8657 /* If we scanned beyond to_pos and didn't find a point to wrap at,
8658 restore the saved iterator. */
8659 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8660 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8661 else if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8662 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8664 done:
8666 if (atpos_data)
8667 bidi_unshelve_cache (atpos_data, 1);
8668 if (atx_data)
8669 bidi_unshelve_cache (atx_data, 1);
8670 if (wrap_data)
8671 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
8672 if (ppos_data)
8673 bidi_unshelve_cache (ppos_data, 1);
8675 /* Restore the iterator settings altered at the beginning of this
8676 function. */
8677 it->glyph_row = saved_glyph_row;
8678 return result;
8681 /* For external use. */
8682 void
8683 move_it_in_display_line (struct it *it,
8684 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8685 enum move_operation_enum op)
8687 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8688 && (op & MOVE_TO_X))
8690 struct it save_it;
8691 void *save_data = NULL;
8692 int skip;
8694 SAVE_IT (save_it, *it, save_data);
8695 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8696 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8697 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8698 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8699 space before the wrap point. */
8700 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
8702 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8703 RESTORE_IT (it, &save_it, save_data);
8704 move_it_in_display_line_to
8705 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8707 else
8708 bidi_unshelve_cache (save_data, 1);
8710 else
8711 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8715 /* Move IT forward until it satisfies one or more of the criteria in
8716 TO_CHARPOS, TO_X, TO_Y, and TO_VPOS.
8718 OP is a bit-mask that specifies where to stop, and in particular,
8719 which of those four position arguments makes a difference. See the
8720 description of enum move_operation_enum.
8722 If TO_CHARPOS is in invisible text, e.g. a truncated part of a
8723 screen line, this function will set IT to the next position that is
8724 displayed to the right of TO_CHARPOS on the screen. */
8726 void
8727 move_it_to (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x, int to_y, int to_vpos, int op)
8729 enum move_it_result skip, skip2 = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8730 int line_height, line_start_x = 0, reached = 0;
8731 void *backup_data = NULL;
8733 for (;;)
8735 if (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8737 /* If no TO_CHARPOS and no TO_X specified, stop at the
8738 start of the line TO_VPOS. */
8739 if ((op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)) == 0)
8741 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8743 reached = 1;
8744 break;
8746 else
8747 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
8749 else
8751 /* TO_VPOS >= 0 means stop at TO_X in the line at
8752 TO_VPOS, or at TO_POS, whichever comes first. */
8753 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8755 reached = 2;
8756 break;
8759 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8761 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV || it->vpos == to_vpos)
8763 reached = 3;
8764 break;
8766 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED && it->vpos != to_vpos)
8768 /* We have reached TO_X but not in the line we want. */
8769 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos,
8770 -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8771 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8773 reached = 4;
8774 break;
8779 else if (op & MOVE_TO_Y)
8781 struct it it_backup;
8783 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8784 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8786 /* TO_Y specified means stop at TO_X in the line containing
8787 TO_Y---or at TO_CHARPOS if this is reached first. The
8788 problem is that we can't really tell whether the line
8789 contains TO_Y before we have completely scanned it, and
8790 this may skip past TO_X. What we do is to first scan to
8791 TO_X.
8793 If TO_X is not specified, use a TO_X of zero. The reason
8794 is to make the outcome of this function more predictable.
8795 If we didn't use TO_X == 0, we would stop at the end of
8796 the line which is probably not what a caller would expect
8797 to happen. */
8798 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8799 (it, to_charpos, ((op & MOVE_TO_X) ? to_x : 0),
8800 (MOVE_TO_X | (op & MOVE_TO_POS)));
8802 /* If TO_CHARPOS is reached or ZV, we don't have to do more. */
8803 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8804 reached = 5;
8805 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED)
8807 /* If TO_X was reached, we want to know whether TO_Y is
8808 in the line. We know this is the case if the already
8809 scanned glyphs make the line tall enough. Otherwise,
8810 we must check by scanning the rest of the line. */
8811 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8812 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8813 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8815 reached = 6;
8816 break;
8818 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8819 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: from %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8820 skip2 = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1,
8821 op & MOVE_TO_POS);
8822 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8823 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8824 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8826 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8827 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8829 /* If TO_Y is in this line and TO_X was reached
8830 above, we scanned too far. We have to restore
8831 IT's settings to the ones before skipping. But
8832 keep the more accurate values of max_ascent and
8833 max_descent we've found while skipping the rest
8834 of the line, for the sake of callers, such as
8835 pos_visible_p, that need to know the line
8836 height. */
8837 int max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8838 int max_descent = it->max_descent;
8840 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8841 it->max_ascent = max_ascent;
8842 it->max_descent = max_descent;
8843 reached = 6;
8845 else
8847 skip = skip2;
8848 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8849 reached = 7;
8852 else
8854 /* Check whether TO_Y is in this line. */
8855 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8856 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8858 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8859 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8861 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8862 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8863 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8864 space before the wrap point. */
8865 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8866 && it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8868 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8869 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8870 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8871 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8873 reached = 6;
8877 if (reached)
8878 break;
8880 else if (BUFFERP (it->object)
8881 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8882 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH)
8883 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8884 /* Under bidi iteration, a call to set_iterator_to_next
8885 can scan far beyond to_charpos if the initial
8886 portion of the next line needs to be reordered. In
8887 that case, give move_it_in_display_line_to another
8888 chance below. */
8889 && !(it->bidi_p
8890 && it->bidi_it.scan_dir == -1))
8891 skip = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8892 else
8893 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8895 switch (skip)
8897 case MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV:
8898 reached = 8;
8899 goto out;
8901 case MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR:
8902 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8903 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8904 break;
8906 case MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED:
8907 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8908 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
8909 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8910 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8912 reached = 9;
8913 goto out;
8915 break;
8917 case MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED:
8918 /* For continued lines ending in a tab, some of the glyphs
8919 associated with the tab are displayed on the current
8920 line. Since it->current_x does not include these glyphs,
8921 we use it->last_visible_x instead. */
8922 if (it->c == '\t')
8924 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
8925 /* When moving by vpos, ensure that the iterator really
8926 advances to the next line (bug#847, bug#969). Fixme:
8927 do we need to do this in other circumstances? */
8928 if (it->current_x != it->last_visible_x
8929 && (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8930 && !(op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)))
8932 line_start_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width
8933 - it->last_visible_x;
8934 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
8937 else
8938 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8939 break;
8941 default:
8942 emacs_abort ();
8945 /* Reset/increment for the next run. */
8946 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
8947 it->current_x = line_start_x;
8948 line_start_x = 0;
8949 it->hpos = 0;
8950 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8951 ++it->vpos;
8952 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8953 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8954 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8957 out:
8959 /* On text terminals, we may stop at the end of a line in the middle
8960 of a multi-character glyph. If the glyph itself is continued,
8961 i.e. it is actually displayed on the next line, don't treat this
8962 stopping point as valid; move to the next line instead (unless
8963 that brings us offscreen). */
8964 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8965 && op & MOVE_TO_POS
8966 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos
8967 && it->what == IT_CHARACTER
8968 && it->nglyphs > 1
8969 && it->line_wrap == WINDOW_WRAP
8970 && it->current_x == it->last_visible_x - 1
8971 && it->c != '\n'
8972 && it->c != '\t'
8973 && it->vpos < XFASTINT (it->w->window_end_vpos))
8975 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8976 it->current_x = it->hpos = it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8977 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8978 ++it->vpos;
8979 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8980 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8983 if (backup_data)
8984 bidi_unshelve_cache (backup_data, 1);
8986 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_to: reached %d\n", reached));
8990 /* Move iterator IT backward by a specified y-distance DY, DY >= 0.
8992 If DY > 0, move IT backward at least that many pixels. DY = 0
8993 means move IT backward to the preceding line start or BEGV. This
8994 function may move over more than DY pixels if IT->current_y - DY
8995 ends up in the middle of a line; in this case IT->current_y will be
8996 set to the top of the line moved to. */
8998 void
8999 move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *it, int dy)
9001 int nlines, h;
9002 struct it it2, it3;
9003 void *it2data = NULL, *it3data = NULL;
9004 ptrdiff_t start_pos;
9006 move_further_back:
9007 eassert (dy >= 0);
9009 start_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
9011 /* Estimate how many newlines we must move back. */
9012 nlines = max (1, dy / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
9014 /* Set the iterator's position that many lines back. */
9015 while (nlines-- && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
9016 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9018 /* Reseat the iterator here. When moving backward, we don't want
9019 reseat to skip forward over invisible text, set up the iterator
9020 to deliver from overlay strings at the new position etc. So,
9021 use reseat_1 here. */
9022 reseat_1 (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9024 /* We are now surely at a line start. */
9025 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0; /* FIXME: this is incorrect when bidi
9026 reordering is in effect. */
9027 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
9029 /* Move forward and see what y-distance we moved. First move to the
9030 start of the next line so that we get its height. We need this
9031 height to be able to tell whether we reached the specified
9032 y-distance. */
9033 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9034 it2.max_ascent = it2.max_descent = 0;
9037 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, it2.vpos + 1,
9038 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9040 while (!(IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (&it2)
9041 /* If we are in a display string which starts at START_POS,
9042 and that display string includes a newline, and we are
9043 right after that newline (i.e. at the beginning of a
9044 display line), exit the loop, because otherwise we will
9045 infloop, since move_it_to will see that it is already at
9046 START_POS and will not move. */
9047 || (it2.method == GET_FROM_STRING
9048 && IT_CHARPOS (it2) == start_pos
9049 && SREF (it2.string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (it2) - 1) == '\n')));
9050 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9051 SAVE_IT (it3, it2, it3data);
9053 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9054 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9055 /* H is the actual vertical distance from the position in *IT
9056 and the starting position. */
9057 h = it2.current_y - it->current_y;
9058 /* NLINES is the distance in number of lines. */
9059 nlines = it2.vpos - it->vpos;
9061 /* Correct IT's y and vpos position
9062 so that they are relative to the starting point. */
9063 it->vpos -= nlines;
9064 it->current_y -= h;
9066 if (dy == 0)
9068 /* DY == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. The
9069 value of nlines is > 0 if continuation lines were involved,
9070 or if the original IT position was at start of a line. */
9071 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9072 if (nlines > 0)
9073 move_it_by_lines (it, nlines);
9074 /* The above code moves us to some position NLINES down,
9075 usually to its first glyph (leftmost in an L2R line), but
9076 that's not necessarily the start of the line, under bidi
9077 reordering. We want to get to the character position
9078 that is immediately after the newline of the previous
9079 line. */
9080 if (it->bidi_p
9081 && !it->continuation_lines_width
9082 && !STRINGP (it->string)
9083 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV
9084 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9086 ptrdiff_t nl_pos =
9087 find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
9089 move_it_to (it, nl_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9091 bidi_unshelve_cache (it3data, 1);
9093 else
9095 /* The y-position we try to reach, relative to *IT.
9096 Note that H has been subtracted in front of the if-statement. */
9097 int target_y = it->current_y + h - dy;
9098 int y0 = it3.current_y;
9099 int y1;
9100 int line_height;
9102 RESTORE_IT (&it3, &it3, it3data);
9103 y1 = line_bottom_y (&it3);
9104 line_height = y1 - y0;
9105 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9106 /* If we did not reach target_y, try to move further backward if
9107 we can. If we moved too far backward, try to move forward. */
9108 if (target_y < it->current_y
9109 /* This is heuristic. In a window that's 3 lines high, with
9110 a line height of 13 pixels each, recentering with point
9111 on the bottom line will try to move -39/2 = 19 pixels
9112 backward. Try to avoid moving into the first line. */
9113 && (it->current_y - target_y
9114 > min (window_box_height (it->w), line_height * 2 / 3))
9115 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
9117 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, " not far enough -> move_vert %d\n",
9118 target_y - it->current_y));
9119 dy = it->current_y - target_y;
9120 goto move_further_back;
9122 else if (target_y >= it->current_y + line_height
9123 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
9125 /* Should move forward by at least one line, maybe more.
9127 Note: Calling move_it_by_lines can be expensive on
9128 terminal frames, where compute_motion is used (via
9129 vmotion) to do the job, when there are very long lines
9130 and truncate-lines is nil. That's the reason for
9131 treating terminal frames specially here. */
9133 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9134 move_it_vertically (it, target_y - (it->current_y + line_height));
9135 else
9139 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
9141 while (target_y >= line_bottom_y (it) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV);
9148 /* Move IT by a specified amount of pixel lines DY. DY negative means
9149 move backwards. DY = 0 means move to start of screen line. At the
9150 end, IT will be on the start of a screen line. */
9152 void
9153 move_it_vertically (struct it *it, int dy)
9155 if (dy <= 0)
9156 move_it_vertically_backward (it, -dy);
9157 else
9159 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: from %d, %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it), dy));
9160 move_it_to (it, ZV, -1, it->current_y + dy, -1,
9161 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
9162 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
9164 /* If buffer ends in ZV without a newline, move to the start of
9165 the line to satisfy the post-condition. */
9166 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == ZV
9167 && ZV > BEGV
9168 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9169 move_it_by_lines (it, 0);
9174 /* Move iterator IT past the end of the text line it is in. */
9176 void
9177 move_it_past_eol (struct it *it)
9179 enum move_it_result rc;
9181 rc = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, Z, 0, MOVE_TO_POS);
9182 if (rc == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR)
9183 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
9187 /* Move IT by a specified number DVPOS of screen lines down. DVPOS
9188 negative means move up. DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the
9189 screen line.
9191 Optimization idea: If we would know that IT->f doesn't use
9192 a face with proportional font, we could be faster for
9193 truncate-lines nil. */
9195 void
9196 move_it_by_lines (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t dvpos)
9199 /* The commented-out optimization uses vmotion on terminals. This
9200 gives bad results, because elements like it->what, on which
9201 callers such as pos_visible_p rely, aren't updated. */
9202 /* struct position pos;
9203 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9205 struct text_pos textpos;
9207 pos = *vmotion (IT_CHARPOS (*it), dvpos, it->w);
9208 SET_TEXT_POS (textpos, pos.bufpos, pos.bytepos);
9209 reseat (it, textpos, 1);
9210 it->vpos += pos.vpos;
9211 it->current_y += pos.vpos;
9213 else */
9215 if (dvpos == 0)
9217 /* DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. */
9218 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9219 /* Let next call to line_bottom_y calculate real line height */
9220 last_height = 0;
9222 else if (dvpos > 0)
9224 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + dvpos, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9225 if (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9227 /* Only move to the next buffer position if we ended up in a
9228 string from display property, not in an overlay string
9229 (before-string or after-string). That is because the
9230 latter don't conceal the underlying buffer position, so
9231 we can ask to move the iterator to the exact position we
9232 are interested in. Note that, even if we are already at
9233 IT_CHARPOS (*it), the call below is not a no-op, as it
9234 will detect that we are at the end of the string, pop the
9235 iterator, and compute it->current_x and it->hpos
9236 correctly. */
9237 move_it_to (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it) + it->string_from_display_prop_p,
9238 -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9241 else
9243 struct it it2;
9244 void *it2data = NULL;
9245 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, i;
9247 /* Start at the beginning of the screen line containing IT's
9248 position. This may actually move vertically backwards,
9249 in case of overlays, so adjust dvpos accordingly. */
9250 dvpos += it->vpos;
9251 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9252 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9254 /* Go back -DVPOS visible lines and reseat the iterator there. */
9255 start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
9256 for (i = -dvpos; i > 0 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV; --i)
9257 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9258 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9260 /* Move further back if we end up in a string or an image. */
9261 while (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9263 /* First try to move to start of display line. */
9264 dvpos += it->vpos;
9265 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9266 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9267 if (IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9268 break;
9269 /* If start of line is still in string or image,
9270 move further back. */
9271 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9272 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9273 dvpos--;
9276 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9278 /* Above call may have moved too far if continuation lines
9279 are involved. Scan forward and see if it did. */
9280 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9281 it2.vpos = it2.current_y = 0;
9282 move_it_to (&it2, start_charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9283 it->vpos -= it2.vpos;
9284 it->current_y -= it2.current_y;
9285 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9287 /* If we moved too far back, move IT some lines forward. */
9288 if (it2.vpos > -dvpos)
9290 int delta = it2.vpos + dvpos;
9292 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
9293 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9294 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + delta, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9295 /* Move back again if we got too far ahead. */
9296 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= start_charpos)
9297 RESTORE_IT (it, &it2, it2data);
9298 else
9299 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
9301 else
9302 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9306 /* Return 1 if IT points into the middle of a display vector. */
9309 in_display_vector_p (struct it *it)
9311 return (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
9312 && it->current.dpvec_index > 0
9313 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index != it->dpend);
9317 /***********************************************************************
9318 Messages
9319 ***********************************************************************/
9322 /* Add a message with format string FORMAT and arguments ARG1 and ARG2
9323 to *Messages*. */
9325 void
9326 add_to_log (const char *format, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
9328 Lisp_Object args[3];
9329 Lisp_Object msg, fmt;
9330 char *buffer;
9331 ptrdiff_t len;
9332 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3, gcpro4;
9333 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9335 fmt = msg = Qnil;
9336 GCPRO4 (fmt, msg, arg1, arg2);
9338 args[0] = fmt = build_string (format);
9339 args[1] = arg1;
9340 args[2] = arg2;
9341 msg = Fformat (3, args);
9343 len = SBYTES (msg) + 1;
9344 buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (len);
9345 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (msg), len);
9347 message_dolog (buffer, len - 1, 1, 0);
9348 SAFE_FREE ();
9350 UNGCPRO;
9354 /* Output a newline in the *Messages* buffer if "needs" one. */
9356 void
9357 message_log_maybe_newline (void)
9359 if (message_log_need_newline)
9360 message_dolog ("", 0, 1, 0);
9364 /* Add a string M of length NBYTES to the message log, optionally
9365 terminated with a newline when NLFLAG is non-zero. MULTIBYTE, if
9366 nonzero, means interpret the contents of M as multibyte. This
9367 function calls low-level routines in order to bypass text property
9368 hooks, etc. which might not be safe to run.
9370 This may GC (insert may run before/after change hooks),
9371 so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9373 void
9374 message_dolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int nlflag, int multibyte)
9376 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) m;
9378 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
9379 return;
9381 if (!NILP (Vmessage_log_max))
9383 struct buffer *oldbuf;
9384 Lisp_Object oldpoint, oldbegv, oldzv;
9385 int old_windows_or_buffers_changed = windows_or_buffers_changed;
9386 ptrdiff_t point_at_end = 0;
9387 ptrdiff_t zv_at_end = 0;
9388 Lisp_Object old_deactivate_mark, tem;
9389 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9391 old_deactivate_mark = Vdeactivate_mark;
9392 oldbuf = current_buffer;
9393 Fset_buffer (Fget_buffer_create (Vmessages_buffer_name));
9394 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
9396 oldpoint = message_dolog_marker1;
9397 set_marker_restricted (oldpoint, make_number (PT), Qnil);
9398 oldbegv = message_dolog_marker2;
9399 set_marker_restricted (oldbegv, make_number (BEGV), Qnil);
9400 oldzv = message_dolog_marker3;
9401 set_marker_restricted (oldzv, make_number (ZV), Qnil);
9402 GCPRO1 (old_deactivate_mark);
9404 if (PT == Z)
9405 point_at_end = 1;
9406 if (ZV == Z)
9407 zv_at_end = 1;
9409 BEGV = BEG;
9410 BEGV_BYTE = BEG_BYTE;
9411 ZV = Z;
9412 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9413 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9415 /* Insert the string--maybe converting multibyte to single byte
9416 or vice versa, so that all the text fits the buffer. */
9417 if (multibyte
9418 && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9420 ptrdiff_t i;
9421 int c, char_bytes;
9422 char work[1];
9424 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte
9425 for the *Message* buffer. */
9426 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += char_bytes)
9428 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &char_bytes);
9429 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
9431 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
9432 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
9435 else if (! multibyte
9436 && ! NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9438 ptrdiff_t i;
9439 int c, char_bytes;
9440 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
9441 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte
9442 for the *Message* buffer. */
9443 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
9445 c = msg[i];
9446 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
9447 char_bytes = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
9448 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, char_bytes, 1, 0, 0);
9451 else if (nbytes)
9452 insert_1 (m, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
9454 if (nlflag)
9456 ptrdiff_t this_bol, this_bol_byte, prev_bol, prev_bol_byte;
9457 printmax_t dups;
9458 insert_1 ("\n", 1, 1, 0, 0);
9460 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9461 this_bol = PT;
9462 this_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9464 /* See if this line duplicates the previous one.
9465 If so, combine duplicates. */
9466 if (this_bol > BEG)
9468 scan_newline (PT, PT_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9469 prev_bol = PT;
9470 prev_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9472 dups = message_log_check_duplicate (prev_bol_byte,
9473 this_bol_byte);
9474 if (dups)
9476 del_range_both (prev_bol, prev_bol_byte,
9477 this_bol, this_bol_byte, 0);
9478 if (dups > 1)
9480 char dupstr[sizeof " [ times]"
9481 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (printmax_t)];
9483 /* If you change this format, don't forget to also
9484 change message_log_check_duplicate. */
9485 int duplen = sprintf (dupstr, " [%"pMd" times]", dups);
9486 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z - 1, Z_BYTE - 1);
9487 insert_1 (dupstr, duplen, 1, 0, 1);
9492 /* If we have more than the desired maximum number of lines
9493 in the *Messages* buffer now, delete the oldest ones.
9494 This is safe because we don't have undo in this buffer. */
9496 if (NATNUMP (Vmessage_log_max))
9498 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE,
9499 -XFASTINT (Vmessage_log_max) - 1, 0);
9500 del_range_both (BEG, BEG_BYTE, PT, PT_BYTE, 0);
9503 BEGV = XMARKER (oldbegv)->charpos;
9504 BEGV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldbegv);
9506 if (zv_at_end)
9508 ZV = Z;
9509 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9511 else
9513 ZV = XMARKER (oldzv)->charpos;
9514 ZV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldzv);
9517 if (point_at_end)
9518 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9519 else
9520 /* We can't do Fgoto_char (oldpoint) because it will run some
9521 Lisp code. */
9522 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (XMARKER (oldpoint)->charpos,
9523 XMARKER (oldpoint)->bytepos);
9525 UNGCPRO;
9526 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldpoint));
9527 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldbegv));
9528 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldzv));
9530 tem = Fget_buffer_window (Fcurrent_buffer (), Qt);
9531 set_buffer_internal (oldbuf);
9532 if (NILP (tem))
9533 windows_or_buffers_changed = old_windows_or_buffers_changed;
9534 message_log_need_newline = !nlflag;
9535 Vdeactivate_mark = old_deactivate_mark;
9540 /* We are at the end of the buffer after just having inserted a newline.
9541 (Note: We depend on the fact we won't be crossing the gap.)
9542 Check to see if the most recent message looks a lot like the previous one.
9543 Return 0 if different, 1 if the new one should just replace it, or a
9544 value N > 1 if we should also append " [N times]". */
9546 static intmax_t
9547 message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t prev_bol_byte, ptrdiff_t this_bol_byte)
9549 ptrdiff_t i;
9550 ptrdiff_t len = Z_BYTE - 1 - this_bol_byte;
9551 int seen_dots = 0;
9552 unsigned char *p1 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, prev_bol_byte);
9553 unsigned char *p2 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, this_bol_byte);
9555 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
9557 if (i >= 3 && p1[i-3] == '.' && p1[i-2] == '.' && p1[i-1] == '.')
9558 seen_dots = 1;
9559 if (p1[i] != p2[i])
9560 return seen_dots;
9562 p1 += len;
9563 if (*p1 == '\n')
9564 return 2;
9565 if (*p1++ == ' ' && *p1++ == '[')
9567 char *pend;
9568 intmax_t n = strtoimax ((char *) p1, &pend, 10);
9569 if (0 < n && n < INTMAX_MAX && strncmp (pend, " times]\n", 8) == 0)
9570 return n+1;
9572 return 0;
9576 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9577 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is 0, clear
9578 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show
9579 through.
9581 This may GC, so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9583 void
9584 message2 (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9586 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9587 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9588 if (m)
9589 message_dolog (m, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9590 message2_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9594 /* The non-logging counterpart of message2. */
9596 void
9597 message2_nolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9599 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9600 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9602 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9604 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9605 putc ('\n', stderr);
9606 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9607 if (m)
9608 fwrite (m, nbytes, 1, stderr);
9609 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9610 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9611 fflush (stderr);
9613 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9614 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9615 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9616 else if (INTERACTIVE
9617 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9618 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9620 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9621 struct frame *f;
9623 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9624 that the selected frame is using. */
9625 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9626 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9628 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9629 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9630 && ! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9631 Fmake_frame_visible (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9633 if (m)
9635 set_message (m, Qnil, nbytes, multibyte);
9636 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9637 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9639 else
9640 clear_message (1, 1);
9642 do_pending_window_change (0);
9643 echo_area_display (1);
9644 do_pending_window_change (0);
9645 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
9646 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9651 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9652 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is not a
9653 string, clear out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer
9654 text show through.
9656 This function cancels echoing. */
9658 void
9659 message3 (Lisp_Object m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9661 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9663 GCPRO1 (m);
9664 clear_message (1,1);
9665 cancel_echoing ();
9667 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9668 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9669 if (STRINGP (m))
9671 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9672 char *buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (nbytes);
9673 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (m), nbytes);
9674 message_dolog (buffer, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9675 SAFE_FREE ();
9677 message3_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9679 UNGCPRO;
9683 /* The non-logging version of message3.
9684 This does not cancel echoing, because it is used for echoing.
9685 Perhaps we need to make a separate function for echoing
9686 and make this cancel echoing. */
9688 void
9689 message3_nolog (Lisp_Object m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9691 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9692 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9694 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9696 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9697 putc ('\n', stderr);
9698 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9699 if (STRINGP (m))
9700 fwrite (SDATA (m), nbytes, 1, stderr);
9701 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9702 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9703 fflush (stderr);
9705 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9706 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9707 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9708 else if (INTERACTIVE
9709 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9710 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9712 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9713 Lisp_Object frame;
9714 struct frame *f;
9716 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9717 that the selected frame is using. */
9718 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9719 frame = XWINDOW (mini_window)->frame;
9720 f = XFRAME (frame);
9722 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9723 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9724 && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9725 Fmake_frame_visible (frame);
9727 if (STRINGP (m) && SCHARS (m) > 0)
9729 set_message (NULL, m, nbytes, multibyte);
9730 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9731 Fraise_frame (frame);
9732 /* Assume we are not echoing.
9733 (If we are, echo_now will override this.) */
9734 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
9736 else
9737 clear_message (1, 1);
9739 do_pending_window_change (0);
9740 echo_area_display (1);
9741 do_pending_window_change (0);
9742 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
9743 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9748 /* Display a null-terminated echo area message M. If M is 0, clear
9749 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through.
9751 The buffer M must continue to exist until after the echo area gets
9752 cleared or some other message gets displayed there. Do not pass
9753 text that is stored in a Lisp string. Do not pass text in a buffer
9754 that was alloca'd. */
9756 void
9757 message1 (const char *m)
9759 message2 (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9763 /* The non-logging counterpart of message1. */
9765 void
9766 message1_nolog (const char *m)
9768 message2_nolog (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9771 /* Display a message M which contains a single %s
9772 which gets replaced with STRING. */
9774 void
9775 message_with_string (const char *m, Lisp_Object string, int log)
9777 CHECK_STRING (string);
9779 if (noninteractive)
9781 if (m)
9783 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9784 putc ('\n', stderr);
9785 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9786 fprintf (stderr, m, SDATA (string));
9787 if (!cursor_in_echo_area)
9788 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9789 fflush (stderr);
9792 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9794 /* The frame whose minibuffer we're going to display the message on.
9795 It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need
9796 to use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9797 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9798 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9800 /* Get the frame containing the minibuffer
9801 that the selected frame is using. */
9802 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9803 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9805 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9806 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9807 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9808 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9810 Lisp_Object args[2], msg;
9811 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
9813 args[0] = build_string (m);
9814 args[1] = msg = string;
9815 GCPRO2 (args[0], msg);
9816 gcpro1.nvars = 2;
9818 msg = Fformat (2, args);
9820 if (log)
9821 message3 (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9822 else
9823 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9825 UNGCPRO;
9827 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9828 buffer next time. */
9829 message_buf_print = 0;
9835 /* Dump an informative message to the minibuf. If M is 0, clear out
9836 any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through. */
9838 static void
9839 vmessage (const char *m, va_list ap)
9841 if (noninteractive)
9843 if (m)
9845 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9846 putc ('\n', stderr);
9847 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9848 vfprintf (stderr, m, ap);
9849 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9850 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9851 fflush (stderr);
9854 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9856 /* The frame whose mini-buffer we're going to display the message
9857 on. It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need to
9858 use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9859 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9860 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9862 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9863 that the selected frame is using. */
9864 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9865 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9867 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9868 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9869 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss
9870 it. */
9871 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9873 if (m)
9875 ptrdiff_t len;
9877 len = doprnt (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f),
9878 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f), m, (char *)0, ap);
9880 message2 (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f), len, 1);
9882 else
9883 message1 (0);
9885 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9886 buffer next time. */
9887 message_buf_print = 0;
9892 void
9893 message (const char *m, ...)
9895 va_list ap;
9896 va_start (ap, m);
9897 vmessage (m, ap);
9898 va_end (ap);
9902 #if 0
9903 /* The non-logging version of message. */
9905 void
9906 message_nolog (const char *m, ...)
9908 Lisp_Object old_log_max;
9909 va_list ap;
9910 va_start (ap, m);
9911 old_log_max = Vmessage_log_max;
9912 Vmessage_log_max = Qnil;
9913 vmessage (m, ap);
9914 Vmessage_log_max = old_log_max;
9915 va_end (ap);
9917 #endif
9920 /* Display the current message in the current mini-buffer. This is
9921 only called from error handlers in process.c, and is not time
9922 critical. */
9924 void
9925 update_echo_area (void)
9927 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
9929 Lisp_Object string;
9930 string = Fcurrent_message ();
9931 message3 (string, SBYTES (string),
9932 !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)));
9937 /* Make sure echo area buffers in `echo_buffers' are live.
9938 If they aren't, make new ones. */
9940 static void
9941 ensure_echo_area_buffers (void)
9943 int i;
9945 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
9946 if (!BUFFERP (echo_buffer[i])
9947 || !BUFFER_LIVE_P (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])))
9949 char name[30];
9950 Lisp_Object old_buffer;
9951 int j;
9953 old_buffer = echo_buffer[i];
9954 echo_buffer[i] = Fget_buffer_create
9955 (make_formatted_string (name, " *Echo Area %d*", i));
9956 bset_truncate_lines (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i]), Qnil);
9957 /* to force word wrap in echo area -
9958 it was decided to postpone this*/
9959 /* XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])->word_wrap = Qt; */
9961 for (j = 0; j < 2; ++j)
9962 if (EQ (old_buffer, echo_area_buffer[j]))
9963 echo_area_buffer[j] = echo_buffer[i];
9968 /* Call FN with args A1..A4 with either the current or last displayed
9969 echo_area_buffer as current buffer.
9971 WHICH zero means use the current message buffer
9972 echo_area_buffer[0]. If that is nil, choose a suitable buffer
9973 from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9975 WHICH > 0 means use echo_area_buffer[1]. If that is nil, choose a
9976 suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9978 If WHICH < 0, set echo_area_buffer[1] to echo_area_buffer[0], so
9979 that the current message becomes the last displayed one, make
9980 choose a suitable buffer for echo_area_buffer[0], and clear it.
9982 Value is what FN returns. */
9984 static int
9985 with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *w, int which,
9986 int (*fn) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t),
9987 ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
9989 Lisp_Object buffer;
9990 int this_one, the_other, clear_buffer_p, rc;
9991 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
9993 /* If buffers aren't live, make new ones. */
9994 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
9996 clear_buffer_p = 0;
9998 if (which == 0)
9999 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
10000 else if (which > 0)
10001 this_one = 1, the_other = 0;
10002 else
10004 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
10005 clear_buffer_p = 1;
10007 /* We need a fresh one in case the current echo buffer equals
10008 the one containing the last displayed echo area message. */
10009 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one])
10010 && EQ (echo_area_buffer[this_one], echo_area_buffer[the_other]))
10011 echo_area_buffer[this_one] = Qnil;
10014 /* Choose a suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] is we don't
10015 have one. */
10016 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one]))
10018 echo_area_buffer[this_one]
10019 = (EQ (echo_area_buffer[the_other], echo_buffer[this_one])
10020 ? echo_buffer[the_other]
10021 : echo_buffer[this_one]);
10022 clear_buffer_p = 1;
10025 buffer = echo_area_buffer[this_one];
10027 /* Don't get confused by reusing the buffer used for echoing
10028 for a different purpose. */
10029 if (echo_kboard == NULL && EQ (buffer, echo_message_buffer))
10030 cancel_echoing ();
10032 record_unwind_protect (unwind_with_echo_area_buffer,
10033 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (w));
10035 /* Make the echo area buffer current. Note that for display
10036 purposes, it is not necessary that the displayed window's buffer
10037 == current_buffer, except for text property lookup. So, let's
10038 only set that buffer temporarily here without doing a full
10039 Fset_window_buffer. We must also change w->pointm, though,
10040 because otherwise an assertions in unshow_buffer fails, and Emacs
10041 aborts. */
10042 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
10043 if (w)
10045 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10046 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer, BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10049 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
10050 bset_read_only (current_buffer, Qnil);
10051 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10052 specbind (Qinhibit_modification_hooks, Qt);
10054 if (clear_buffer_p && Z > BEG)
10055 del_range (BEG, Z);
10057 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10058 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10060 rc = fn (a1, a2, a3, a4);
10062 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10063 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10065 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10066 return rc;
10070 /* Save state that should be preserved around the call to the function
10071 FN called in with_echo_area_buffer. */
10073 static Lisp_Object
10074 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *w)
10076 int i = 0;
10077 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10079 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10080 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10081 vector = Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
10082 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
10084 if (NILP (vector))
10085 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (7), Qnil);
10087 XSETBUFFER (tmp, current_buffer); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10088 ASET (vector, i, Vdeactivate_mark); ++i;
10089 ASET (vector, i, make_number (windows_or_buffers_changed)); ++i;
10091 if (w)
10093 XSETWINDOW (tmp, w); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10094 ASET (vector, i, w->buffer); ++i;
10095 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos)); ++i;
10096 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->bytepos)); ++i;
10098 else
10100 int end = i + 4;
10101 for (; i < end; ++i)
10102 ASET (vector, i, Qnil);
10105 eassert (i == ASIZE (vector));
10106 return vector;
10110 /* Restore global state from VECTOR which was created by
10111 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data. */
10113 static Lisp_Object
10114 unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object vector)
10116 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 0)));
10117 Vdeactivate_mark = AREF (vector, 1);
10118 windows_or_buffers_changed = XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 2));
10120 if (WINDOWP (AREF (vector, 3)))
10122 struct window *w;
10123 Lisp_Object buffer, charpos, bytepos;
10125 w = XWINDOW (AREF (vector, 3));
10126 buffer = AREF (vector, 4);
10127 charpos = AREF (vector, 5);
10128 bytepos = AREF (vector, 6);
10130 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10131 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer,
10132 XFASTINT (charpos), XFASTINT (bytepos));
10135 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = vector;
10136 return Qnil;
10140 /* Set up the echo area for use by print functions. MULTIBYTE_P
10141 non-zero means we will print multibyte. */
10143 void
10144 setup_echo_area_for_printing (int multibyte_p)
10146 /* If we can't find an echo area any more, exit. */
10147 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10148 Fkill_emacs (Qnil);
10150 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
10152 if (!message_buf_print)
10154 /* A message has been output since the last time we printed.
10155 Choose a fresh echo area buffer. */
10156 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10157 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10158 else
10159 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10161 /* Switch to that buffer and clear it. */
10162 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10163 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10165 if (Z > BEG)
10167 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10168 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10169 /* Note that undo recording is always disabled. */
10170 del_range (BEG, Z);
10171 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10173 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10175 /* Set up the buffer for the multibyteness we need. */
10176 if (multibyte_p
10177 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10178 Fset_buffer_multibyte (multibyte_p ? Qt : Qnil);
10180 /* Raise the frame containing the echo area. */
10181 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
10183 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10184 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10185 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10186 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
10189 message_log_maybe_newline ();
10190 message_buf_print = 1;
10192 else
10194 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10196 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10197 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10198 else
10199 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10202 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10204 /* Someone switched buffers between print requests. */
10205 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10206 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10212 /* Display an echo area message in window W. Value is non-zero if W's
10213 height is changed. If display_last_displayed_message_p is
10214 non-zero, display the message that was last displayed, otherwise
10215 display the current message. */
10217 static int
10218 display_echo_area (struct window *w)
10220 int i, no_message_p, window_height_changed_p;
10222 /* Temporarily disable garbage collections while displaying the echo
10223 area. This is done because a GC can print a message itself.
10224 That message would modify the echo area buffer's contents while a
10225 redisplay of the buffer is going on, and seriously confuse
10226 redisplay. */
10227 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
10229 /* If there is no message, we must call display_echo_area_1
10230 nevertheless because it resizes the window. But we will have to
10231 reset the echo_area_buffer in question to nil at the end because
10232 with_echo_area_buffer will sets it to an empty buffer. */
10233 i = display_last_displayed_message_p ? 1 : 0;
10234 no_message_p = NILP (echo_area_buffer[i]);
10236 window_height_changed_p
10237 = with_echo_area_buffer (w, display_last_displayed_message_p,
10238 display_echo_area_1,
10239 (intptr_t) w, Qnil, 0, 0);
10241 if (no_message_p)
10242 echo_area_buffer[i] = Qnil;
10244 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10245 return window_height_changed_p;
10249 /* Helper for display_echo_area. Display the current buffer which
10250 contains the current echo area message in window W, a mini-window,
10251 a pointer to which is passed in A1. A2..A4 are currently not used.
10252 Change the height of W so that all of the message is displayed.
10253 Value is non-zero if height of W was changed. */
10255 static int
10256 display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10258 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10259 struct window *w = (struct window *) i1;
10260 Lisp_Object window;
10261 struct text_pos start;
10262 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10264 /* Do this before displaying, so that we have a large enough glyph
10265 matrix for the display. If we can't get enough space for the
10266 whole text, display the last N lines. That works by setting w->start. */
10267 window_height_changed_p = resize_mini_window (w, 0);
10269 /* Use the starting position chosen by resize_mini_window. */
10270 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
10272 /* Display. */
10273 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
10274 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
10275 try_window (window, start, 0);
10277 return window_height_changed_p;
10281 /* Resize the echo area window to exactly the size needed for the
10282 currently displayed message, if there is one. If a mini-buffer
10283 is active, don't shrink it. */
10285 void
10286 resize_echo_area_exactly (void)
10288 if (BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0])
10289 && WINDOWP (echo_area_window))
10291 struct window *w = XWINDOW (echo_area_window);
10292 int resized_p;
10293 Lisp_Object resize_exactly;
10295 if (minibuf_level == 0)
10296 resize_exactly = Qt;
10297 else
10298 resize_exactly = Qnil;
10300 resized_p = with_echo_area_buffer (w, 0, resize_mini_window_1,
10301 (intptr_t) w, resize_exactly,
10302 0, 0);
10303 if (resized_p)
10305 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10306 ++update_mode_lines;
10307 redisplay_internal ();
10313 /* Callback function for with_echo_area_buffer, when used from
10314 resize_echo_area_exactly. A1 contains a pointer to the window to
10315 resize, EXACTLY non-nil means resize the mini-window exactly to the
10316 size of the text displayed. A3 and A4 are not used. Value is what
10317 resize_mini_window returns. */
10319 static int
10320 resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object exactly, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10322 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10323 return resize_mini_window ((struct window *) i1, !NILP (exactly));
10327 /* Resize mini-window W to fit the size of its contents. EXACT_P
10328 means size the window exactly to the size needed. Otherwise, it's
10329 only enlarged until W's buffer is empty.
10331 Set W->start to the right place to begin display. If the whole
10332 contents fit, start at the beginning. Otherwise, start so as
10333 to make the end of the contents appear. This is particularly
10334 important for y-or-n-p, but seems desirable generally.
10336 Value is non-zero if the window height has been changed. */
10339 resize_mini_window (struct window *w, int exact_p)
10341 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
10342 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10344 eassert (MINI_WINDOW_P (w));
10346 /* By default, start display at the beginning. */
10347 set_marker_both (w->start, w->buffer,
10348 BUF_BEGV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)),
10349 BUF_BEGV_BYTE (XBUFFER (w->buffer)));
10351 /* Don't resize windows while redisplaying a window; it would
10352 confuse redisplay functions when the size of the window they are
10353 displaying changes from under them. Such a resizing can happen,
10354 for instance, when which-func prints a long message while
10355 we are running fontification-functions. We're running these
10356 functions with safe_call which binds inhibit-redisplay to t. */
10357 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
10358 return 0;
10360 /* Nil means don't try to resize. */
10361 if (NILP (Vresize_mini_windows)
10362 || (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f) == NULL))
10363 return 0;
10365 if (!FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f))
10367 struct it it;
10368 struct window *root = XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
10369 int total_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (root) + WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10370 int height;
10371 EMACS_INT max_height;
10372 int unit = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10373 struct text_pos start;
10374 struct buffer *old_current_buffer = NULL;
10376 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
10378 old_current_buffer = current_buffer;
10379 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
10382 init_iterator (&it, w, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10384 /* Compute the max. number of lines specified by the user. */
10385 if (FLOATP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10386 max_height = XFLOATINT (Vmax_mini_window_height) * FRAME_LINES (f);
10387 else if (INTEGERP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10388 max_height = XINT (Vmax_mini_window_height);
10389 else
10390 max_height = total_height / 4;
10392 /* Correct that max. height if it's bogus. */
10393 max_height = max (1, max_height);
10394 max_height = min (total_height, max_height);
10396 /* Find out the height of the text in the window. */
10397 if (it.line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
10398 height = 1;
10399 else
10401 last_height = 0;
10402 move_it_to (&it, ZV, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
10403 if (it.max_ascent == 0 && it.max_descent == 0)
10404 height = it.current_y + last_height;
10405 else
10406 height = it.current_y + it.max_ascent + it.max_descent;
10407 height -= min (it.extra_line_spacing, it.max_extra_line_spacing);
10408 height = (height + unit - 1) / unit;
10411 /* Compute a suitable window start. */
10412 if (height > max_height)
10414 height = max_height;
10415 init_iterator (&it, w, ZV, ZV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10416 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, (height - 1) * unit);
10417 start = it.current.pos;
10419 else
10420 SET_TEXT_POS (start, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
10421 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, start);
10423 if (EQ (Vresize_mini_windows, Qgrow_only))
10425 /* Let it grow only, until we display an empty message, in which
10426 case the window shrinks again. */
10427 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10429 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10430 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10431 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10432 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10434 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)
10435 && (exact_p || BEGV == ZV))
10437 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10438 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10439 shrink_mini_window (w);
10440 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10443 else
10445 /* Always resize to exact size needed. */
10446 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10448 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10449 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10450 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10451 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10453 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10455 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10456 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10457 shrink_mini_window (w);
10459 if (height)
10461 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10462 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10465 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10469 if (old_current_buffer)
10470 set_buffer_internal (old_current_buffer);
10473 return window_height_changed_p;
10477 /* Value is the current message, a string, or nil if there is no
10478 current message. */
10480 Lisp_Object
10481 current_message (void)
10483 Lisp_Object msg;
10485 if (!BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10486 msg = Qnil;
10487 else
10489 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, current_message_1,
10490 (intptr_t) &msg, Qnil, 0, 0);
10491 if (NILP (msg))
10492 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10495 return msg;
10499 static int
10500 current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10502 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10503 Lisp_Object *msg = (Lisp_Object *) i1;
10505 if (Z > BEG)
10506 *msg = make_buffer_string (BEG, Z, 1);
10507 else
10508 *msg = Qnil;
10509 return 0;
10513 /* Push the current message on Vmessage_stack for later restoration
10514 by restore_message. Value is non-zero if the current message isn't
10515 empty. This is a relatively infrequent operation, so it's not
10516 worth optimizing. */
10518 bool
10519 push_message (void)
10521 Lisp_Object msg = current_message ();
10522 Vmessage_stack = Fcons (msg, Vmessage_stack);
10523 return STRINGP (msg);
10527 /* Restore message display from the top of Vmessage_stack. */
10529 void
10530 restore_message (void)
10532 Lisp_Object msg;
10534 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10535 msg = XCAR (Vmessage_stack);
10536 if (STRINGP (msg))
10537 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
10538 else
10539 message3_nolog (msg, 0, 0);
10543 /* Handler for record_unwind_protect calling pop_message. */
10545 Lisp_Object
10546 pop_message_unwind (Lisp_Object dummy)
10548 pop_message ();
10549 return Qnil;
10552 /* Pop the top-most entry off Vmessage_stack. */
10554 static void
10555 pop_message (void)
10557 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10558 Vmessage_stack = XCDR (Vmessage_stack);
10562 /* Check that Vmessage_stack is nil. Called from emacs.c when Emacs
10563 exits. If the stack is not empty, we have a missing pop_message
10564 somewhere. */
10566 void
10567 check_message_stack (void)
10569 if (!NILP (Vmessage_stack))
10570 emacs_abort ();
10574 /* Truncate to NCHARS what will be displayed in the echo area the next
10575 time we display it---but don't redisplay it now. */
10577 void
10578 truncate_echo_area (ptrdiff_t nchars)
10580 if (nchars == 0)
10581 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10582 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
10583 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
10584 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
10585 else if (!noninteractive
10586 && INTERACTIVE
10587 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10589 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10590 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
10591 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, truncate_message_1, nchars, Qnil, 0, 0);
10596 /* Helper function for truncate_echo_area. Truncate the current
10597 message to at most NCHARS characters. */
10599 static int
10600 truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t nchars, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10602 if (BEG + nchars < Z)
10603 del_range (BEG + nchars, Z);
10604 if (Z == BEG)
10605 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10606 return 0;
10609 /* Set the current message to a substring of S or STRING.
10611 If STRING is a Lisp string, set the message to the first NBYTES
10612 bytes from STRING. NBYTES zero means use the whole string. If
10613 STRING is multibyte, the message will be displayed multibyte.
10615 If S is not null, set the message to the first LEN bytes of S. LEN
10616 zero means use the whole string. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero means S is
10617 multibyte. Display the message multibyte in that case.
10619 Doesn't GC, as with_echo_area_buffer binds Qinhibit_modification_hooks
10620 to t before calling set_message_1 (which calls insert).
10623 static void
10624 set_message (const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
10625 ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte_p)
10627 message_enable_multibyte
10628 = ((s && multibyte_p)
10629 || (STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string)));
10631 with_echo_area_buffer (0, -1, set_message_1,
10632 (intptr_t) s, string, nbytes, multibyte_p);
10633 message_buf_print = 0;
10634 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
10636 if (STRINGP (Vdebug_on_message)
10637 && fast_string_match (Vdebug_on_message, string) >= 0)
10638 call_debugger (list2 (Qerror, string));
10642 /* Helper function for set_message. Arguments have the same meaning
10643 as there, with A1 corresponding to S and A2 corresponding to STRING
10644 This function is called with the echo area buffer being
10645 current. */
10647 static int
10648 set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t nbytes, ptrdiff_t multibyte_p)
10650 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10651 const char *s = (const char *) i1;
10652 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) s;
10653 Lisp_Object string = a2;
10655 /* Change multibyteness of the echo buffer appropriately. */
10656 if (message_enable_multibyte
10657 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10658 Fset_buffer_multibyte (message_enable_multibyte ? Qt : Qnil);
10660 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, message_truncate_lines ? Qt : Qnil);
10661 if (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering)))
10662 bset_bidi_paragraph_direction (current_buffer, Qleft_to_right);
10664 /* Insert new message at BEG. */
10665 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10667 if (STRINGP (string))
10669 ptrdiff_t nchars;
10671 if (nbytes == 0)
10672 nbytes = SBYTES (string);
10673 nchars = string_byte_to_char (string, nbytes);
10675 /* This function takes care of single/multibyte conversion. We
10676 just have to ensure that the echo area buffer has the right
10677 setting of enable_multibyte_characters. */
10678 insert_from_string (string, 0, 0, nchars, nbytes, 1);
10680 else if (s)
10682 if (nbytes == 0)
10683 nbytes = strlen (s);
10685 if (multibyte_p && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10687 /* Convert from multi-byte to single-byte. */
10688 ptrdiff_t i;
10689 int c, n;
10690 char work[1];
10692 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte. */
10693 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += n)
10695 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &n);
10696 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
10698 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
10699 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
10702 else if (!multibyte_p
10703 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10705 /* Convert from single-byte to multi-byte. */
10706 ptrdiff_t i;
10707 int c, n;
10708 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
10710 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte. */
10711 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
10713 c = msg[i];
10714 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
10715 n = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
10716 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, n, 1, 0, 0);
10719 else
10720 insert_1 (s, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
10723 return 0;
10727 /* Clear messages. CURRENT_P non-zero means clear the current
10728 message. LAST_DISPLAYED_P non-zero means clear the message
10729 last displayed. */
10731 void
10732 clear_message (int current_p, int last_displayed_p)
10734 if (current_p)
10736 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10737 message_cleared_p = 1;
10740 if (last_displayed_p)
10741 echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
10743 message_buf_print = 0;
10746 /* Clear garbaged frames.
10748 This function is used where the old redisplay called
10749 redraw_garbaged_frames which in turn called redraw_frame which in
10750 turn called clear_frame. The call to clear_frame was a source of
10751 flickering. I believe a clear_frame is not necessary. It should
10752 suffice in the new redisplay to invalidate all current matrices,
10753 and ensure a complete redisplay of all windows. */
10755 static void
10756 clear_garbaged_frames (void)
10758 if (frame_garbaged)
10760 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
10761 int changed_count = 0;
10763 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
10765 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
10767 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
10769 if (f->resized_p)
10771 redraw_frame (f);
10772 f->force_flush_display_p = 1;
10774 clear_current_matrices (f);
10775 changed_count++;
10776 f->garbaged = 0;
10777 f->resized_p = 0;
10781 frame_garbaged = 0;
10782 if (changed_count)
10783 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10788 /* Redisplay the echo area of the selected frame. If UPDATE_FRAME_P
10789 is non-zero update selected_frame. Value is non-zero if the
10790 mini-windows height has been changed. */
10792 static int
10793 echo_area_display (int update_frame_p)
10795 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10796 struct window *w;
10797 struct frame *f;
10798 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10799 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10801 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10802 w = XWINDOW (mini_window);
10803 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
10805 /* Don't display if frame is invisible or not yet initialized. */
10806 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
10807 return 0;
10809 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10810 /* When Emacs starts, selected_frame may be the initial terminal
10811 frame. If we let this through, a message would be displayed on
10812 the terminal. */
10813 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10814 return 0;
10815 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
10817 /* Redraw garbaged frames. */
10818 clear_garbaged_frames ();
10820 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) || minibuf_level == 0)
10822 echo_area_window = mini_window;
10823 window_height_changed_p = display_echo_area (w);
10824 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
10826 /* Update the display, unless called from redisplay_internal.
10827 Also don't update the screen during redisplay itself. The
10828 update will happen at the end of redisplay, and an update
10829 here could cause confusion. */
10830 if (update_frame_p && !redisplaying_p)
10832 int n = 0;
10834 /* If the display update has been interrupted by pending
10835 input, update mode lines in the frame. Due to the
10836 pending input, it might have been that redisplay hasn't
10837 been called, so that mode lines above the echo area are
10838 garbaged. This looks odd, so we prevent it here. */
10839 if (!display_completed)
10840 n = redisplay_mode_lines (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), 0);
10842 if (window_height_changed_p
10843 /* Don't do this if Emacs is shutting down. Redisplay
10844 needs to run hooks. */
10845 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks))
10847 /* Must update other windows. Likewise as in other
10848 cases, don't let this update be interrupted by
10849 pending input. */
10850 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10851 specbind (Qredisplay_dont_pause, Qt);
10852 windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
10853 redisplay_internal ();
10854 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10856 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && n == 0)
10858 /* Window configuration is the same as before.
10859 Can do with a display update of the echo area,
10860 unless we displayed some mode lines. */
10861 update_single_window (w, 1);
10862 FRAME_RIF (f)->flush_display (f);
10864 else
10865 update_frame (f, 1, 1);
10867 /* If cursor is in the echo area, make sure that the next
10868 redisplay displays the minibuffer, so that the cursor will
10869 be replaced with what the minibuffer wants. */
10870 if (cursor_in_echo_area)
10871 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10874 else if (!EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10875 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
10877 /* Last displayed message is now the current message. */
10878 echo_area_buffer[1] = echo_area_buffer[0];
10879 /* Inform read_char that we're not echoing. */
10880 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
10882 /* Prevent redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal by resetting
10883 this_line_start_pos. This is done because the mini-buffer now
10884 displays the message instead of its buffer text. */
10885 if (EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10886 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
10888 return window_height_changed_p;
10891 /* Nonzero if the current buffer is shown in more than
10892 one window and was modified since last display. */
10894 static int
10895 buffer_shared_and_changed (void)
10897 return (buffer_shared > 1 && UNCHANGED_MODIFIED < MODIFF);
10900 /* Nonzero if W doesn't reflect the actual state of
10901 current buffer due to its text or overlays change. */
10903 static int
10904 window_outdated (struct window *w)
10906 eassert (XBUFFER (w->buffer) == current_buffer);
10907 return (w->last_modified < MODIFF
10908 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF);
10911 /* Nonzero if W's buffer was changed but not saved or Transient Mark mode
10912 is enabled and mark of W's buffer was changed since last W's update. */
10914 static int
10915 window_buffer_changed (struct window *w)
10917 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
10919 eassert (BUFFER_LIVE_P (b));
10921 return (((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b) < BUF_MODIFF (b)) != w->last_had_star)
10922 || ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode) && !NILP (BVAR (b, mark_active)))
10923 != !NILP (w->region_showing)));
10926 /***********************************************************************
10927 Mode Lines and Frame Titles
10928 ***********************************************************************/
10930 /* A buffer for constructing non-propertized mode-line strings and
10931 frame titles in it; allocated from the heap in init_xdisp and
10932 resized as needed in store_mode_line_noprop_char. */
10934 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf;
10936 /* The buffer's end, and a current output position in it. */
10938 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf_end;
10939 static char *mode_line_noprop_ptr;
10941 #define MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN(start) \
10942 ((mode_line_noprop_ptr - mode_line_noprop_buf) - start)
10944 static enum {
10945 MODE_LINE_DISPLAY = 0,
10946 MODE_LINE_TITLE,
10947 MODE_LINE_NOPROP,
10948 MODE_LINE_STRING
10949 } mode_line_target;
10951 /* Alist that caches the results of :propertize.
10952 Each element is (PROPERTIZED-STRING . PROPERTY-LIST). */
10953 static Lisp_Object mode_line_proptrans_alist;
10955 /* List of strings making up the mode-line. */
10956 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_list;
10958 /* Base face property when building propertized mode line string. */
10959 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face;
10960 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face_prop;
10963 /* Unwind data for mode line strings */
10965 static Lisp_Object Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10967 static Lisp_Object
10968 format_mode_line_unwind_data (struct frame *target_frame,
10969 struct buffer *obuf,
10970 Lisp_Object owin,
10971 int save_proptrans)
10973 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10975 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10976 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10977 vector = Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10978 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
10980 if (NILP (vector))
10981 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (10), Qnil);
10983 ASET (vector, 0, make_number (mode_line_target));
10984 ASET (vector, 1, make_number (MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0)));
10985 ASET (vector, 2, mode_line_string_list);
10986 ASET (vector, 3, save_proptrans ? mode_line_proptrans_alist : Qt);
10987 ASET (vector, 4, mode_line_string_face);
10988 ASET (vector, 5, mode_line_string_face_prop);
10990 if (obuf)
10991 XSETBUFFER (tmp, obuf);
10992 else
10993 tmp = Qnil;
10994 ASET (vector, 6, tmp);
10995 ASET (vector, 7, owin);
10996 if (target_frame)
10998 /* Similarly to `with-selected-window', if the operation selects
10999 a window on another frame, we must restore that frame's
11000 selected window, and (for a tty) the top-frame. */
11001 ASET (vector, 8, target_frame->selected_window);
11002 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (target_frame))
11003 ASET (vector, 9, FRAME_TTY (target_frame)->top_frame);
11006 return vector;
11009 static Lisp_Object
11010 unwind_format_mode_line (Lisp_Object vector)
11012 Lisp_Object old_window = AREF (vector, 7);
11013 Lisp_Object target_frame_window = AREF (vector, 8);
11014 Lisp_Object old_top_frame = AREF (vector, 9);
11016 mode_line_target = XINT (AREF (vector, 0));
11017 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + XINT (AREF (vector, 1));
11018 mode_line_string_list = AREF (vector, 2);
11019 if (! EQ (AREF (vector, 3), Qt))
11020 mode_line_proptrans_alist = AREF (vector, 3);
11021 mode_line_string_face = AREF (vector, 4);
11022 mode_line_string_face_prop = AREF (vector, 5);
11024 /* Select window before buffer, since it may change the buffer. */
11025 if (!NILP (old_window))
11027 /* If the operation that we are unwinding had selected a window
11028 on a different frame, reset its frame-selected-window. For a
11029 text terminal, reset its top-frame if necessary. */
11030 if (!NILP (target_frame_window))
11032 Lisp_Object frame
11033 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (target_frame_window));
11035 if (!EQ (frame, WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (old_window))))
11036 Fselect_window (target_frame_window, Qt);
11038 if (!NILP (old_top_frame) && !EQ (old_top_frame, frame))
11039 Fselect_frame (old_top_frame, Qt);
11042 Fselect_window (old_window, Qt);
11045 if (!NILP (AREF (vector, 6)))
11047 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 6)));
11048 ASET (vector, 6, Qnil);
11051 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = vector;
11052 return Qnil;
11056 /* Store a single character C for the frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf.
11057 Re-allocate mode_line_noprop_buf if necessary. */
11059 static void
11060 store_mode_line_noprop_char (char c)
11062 /* If output position has reached the end of the allocated buffer,
11063 increase the buffer's size. */
11064 if (mode_line_noprop_ptr == mode_line_noprop_buf_end)
11066 ptrdiff_t len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
11067 ptrdiff_t size = len;
11068 mode_line_noprop_buf =
11069 xpalloc (mode_line_noprop_buf, &size, 1, STRING_BYTES_BOUND, 1);
11070 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
11071 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + len;
11074 *mode_line_noprop_ptr++ = c;
11078 /* Store part of a frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf, beginning at
11079 mode_line_noprop_ptr. STRING is the string to store. Do not copy
11080 characters that yield more columns than PRECISION; PRECISION <= 0
11081 means copy the whole string. Pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
11082 number of characters have been copied; FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't
11083 pad. Called from display_mode_element when it is used to build a
11084 frame title. */
11086 static int
11087 store_mode_line_noprop (const char *string, int field_width, int precision)
11089 const unsigned char *str = (const unsigned char *) string;
11090 int n = 0;
11091 ptrdiff_t dummy, nbytes;
11093 /* Copy at most PRECISION chars from STR. */
11094 nbytes = strlen (string);
11095 n += c_string_width (str, nbytes, precision, &dummy, &nbytes);
11096 while (nbytes--)
11097 store_mode_line_noprop_char (*str++);
11099 /* Fill up with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH reached. */
11100 while (field_width > 0
11101 && n < field_width)
11103 store_mode_line_noprop_char (' ');
11104 ++n;
11107 return n;
11110 /***********************************************************************
11111 Frame Titles
11112 ***********************************************************************/
11114 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11116 /* Set the title of FRAME, if it has changed. The title format is
11117 Vicon_title_format if FRAME is iconified, otherwise it is
11118 frame_title_format. */
11120 static void
11121 x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object frame)
11123 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
11125 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11126 || FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f)
11127 || f->explicit_name)
11129 /* Do we have more than one visible frame on this X display? */
11130 Lisp_Object tail, other_frame, fmt;
11131 ptrdiff_t title_start;
11132 char *title;
11133 ptrdiff_t len;
11134 struct it it;
11135 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11137 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, other_frame)
11139 struct frame *tf = XFRAME (other_frame);
11141 if (tf != f
11142 && FRAME_KBOARD (tf) == FRAME_KBOARD (f)
11143 && !FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (tf)
11144 && !EQ (other_frame, tip_frame)
11145 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (tf) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (tf)))
11146 break;
11149 /* Set global variable indicating that multiple frames exist. */
11150 multiple_frames = CONSP (tail);
11152 /* Switch to the buffer of selected window of the frame. Set up
11153 mode_line_target so that display_mode_element will output into
11154 mode_line_noprop_buf; then display the title. */
11155 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
11156 format_mode_line_unwind_data
11157 (f, current_buffer, selected_window, 0));
11159 Fselect_window (f->selected_window, Qt);
11160 set_buffer_internal_1
11161 (XBUFFER (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
11162 fmt = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) ? Vicon_title_format : Vframe_title_format;
11164 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_TITLE;
11165 title_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
11166 init_iterator (&it, XWINDOW (f->selected_window), -1, -1,
11167 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
11168 display_mode_element (&it, 0, -1, -1, fmt, Qnil, 0);
11169 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (title_start);
11170 title = mode_line_noprop_buf + title_start;
11171 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11173 /* Set the title only if it's changed. This avoids consing in
11174 the common case where it hasn't. (If it turns out that we've
11175 already wasted too much time by walking through the list with
11176 display_mode_element, then we might need to optimize at a
11177 higher level than this.) */
11178 if (! STRINGP (f->name)
11179 || SBYTES (f->name) != len
11180 || memcmp (title, SDATA (f->name), len) != 0)
11181 x_implicitly_set_name (f, make_string (title, len), Qnil);
11185 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11188 /***********************************************************************
11189 Menu Bars
11190 ***********************************************************************/
11193 /* Prepare for redisplay by updating menu-bar item lists when
11194 appropriate. This can call eval. */
11196 void
11197 prepare_menu_bars (void)
11199 int all_windows;
11200 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
11201 struct frame *f;
11202 Lisp_Object tooltip_frame;
11204 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11205 tooltip_frame = tip_frame;
11206 #else
11207 tooltip_frame = Qnil;
11208 #endif
11210 /* Update all frame titles based on their buffer names, etc. We do
11211 this before the menu bars so that the buffer-menu will show the
11212 up-to-date frame titles. */
11213 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11214 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || update_mode_lines)
11216 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11218 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11220 f = XFRAME (frame);
11221 if (!EQ (frame, tooltip_frame)
11222 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)))
11223 x_consider_frame_title (frame);
11226 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11228 /* Update the menu bar item lists, if appropriate. This has to be
11229 done before any actual redisplay or generation of display lines. */
11230 all_windows = (update_mode_lines
11231 || buffer_shared_and_changed ()
11232 || windows_or_buffers_changed);
11233 if (all_windows)
11235 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11236 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11237 /* 1 means that update_menu_bar has run its hooks
11238 so any further calls to update_menu_bar shouldn't do so again. */
11239 int menu_bar_hooks_run = 0;
11241 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11243 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11245 f = XFRAME (frame);
11247 /* Ignore tooltip frame. */
11248 if (EQ (frame, tooltip_frame))
11249 continue;
11251 /* If a window on this frame changed size, report that to
11252 the user and clear the size-change flag. */
11253 if (FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f))
11255 Lisp_Object functions;
11257 /* Clear flag first in case we get an error below. */
11258 FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f) = 0;
11259 functions = Vwindow_size_change_functions;
11260 GCPRO2 (tail, functions);
11262 while (CONSP (functions))
11264 if (!EQ (XCAR (functions), Qt))
11265 call1 (XCAR (functions), frame);
11266 functions = XCDR (functions);
11268 UNGCPRO;
11271 GCPRO1 (tail);
11272 menu_bar_hooks_run = update_menu_bar (f, 0, menu_bar_hooks_run);
11273 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11274 update_tool_bar (f, 0);
11275 #endif
11276 #ifdef HAVE_NS
11277 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11278 && FRAME_NS_P (f))
11279 ns_set_doc_edited
11280 (f, Fbuffer_modified_p (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
11281 #endif
11282 UNGCPRO;
11285 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11287 else
11289 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
11290 update_menu_bar (sf, 1, 0);
11291 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11292 update_tool_bar (sf, 1);
11293 #endif
11298 /* Update the menu bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11299 before we start to fill in any display lines, because it can call
11300 eval.
11302 If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save and restore it here.
11304 If HOOKS_RUN is 1, that means a previous call to update_menu_bar
11305 already ran the menu bar hooks for this redisplay, so there
11306 is no need to run them again. The return value is the
11307 updated value of this flag, to pass to the next call. */
11309 static int
11310 update_menu_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data, int hooks_run)
11312 Lisp_Object window;
11313 register struct window *w;
11315 /* If called recursively during a menu update, do nothing. This can
11316 happen when, for instance, an activate-menubar-hook causes a
11317 redisplay. */
11318 if (inhibit_menubar_update)
11319 return hooks_run;
11321 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11322 w = XWINDOW (window);
11324 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11326 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11327 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11328 FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f)
11329 #else
11330 FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
11331 #endif
11332 : FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0)
11334 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11335 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11336 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11337 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11338 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11339 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11340 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11341 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11342 /* This used to test w->update_mode_line, but we believe
11343 there is no need to recompute the menu in that case. */
11344 || update_mode_lines
11345 || window_buffer_changed (w))
11347 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11348 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11350 specbind (Qinhibit_menubar_update, Qt);
11352 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11353 if (save_match_data)
11354 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11355 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11357 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11358 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11361 if (!hooks_run)
11363 /* Run the Lucid hook. */
11364 safe_run_hooks (Qactivate_menubar_hook);
11366 /* If it has changed current-menubar from previous value,
11367 really recompute the menu-bar from the value. */
11368 if (! NILP (Vlucid_menu_bar_dirty_flag))
11369 call0 (Qrecompute_lucid_menubar);
11371 safe_run_hooks (Qmenu_bar_update_hook);
11373 hooks_run = 1;
11376 XSETFRAME (Vmenu_updating_frame, f);
11377 fset_menu_bar_items (f, menu_bar_items (FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (f)));
11379 /* Redisplay the menu bar in case we changed it. */
11380 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11381 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11382 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
11384 #if defined (HAVE_NS)
11385 /* All frames on Mac OS share the same menubar. So only
11386 the selected frame should be allowed to set it. */
11387 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
11388 #endif
11389 set_frame_menubar (f, 0, 0);
11391 else
11392 /* On a terminal screen, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11393 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11394 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11395 #else /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11396 /* In the non-toolkit version, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11397 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11398 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11399 #endif /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11401 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11402 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11406 return hooks_run;
11411 /***********************************************************************
11412 Output Cursor
11413 ***********************************************************************/
11415 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11417 /* EXPORT:
11418 Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
11419 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
11420 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
11422 struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
11425 /* EXPORT:
11426 Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
11427 positions are relative to updated_window. */
11429 void
11430 set_output_cursor (struct cursor_pos *cursor)
11432 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
11433 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
11434 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
11435 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
11439 /* EXPORT for RIF:
11440 Set a nominal cursor position.
11442 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
11443 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
11445 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
11446 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
11447 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
11448 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
11450 void
11451 x_cursor_to (int vpos, int hpos, int y, int x)
11453 struct window *w;
11455 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
11456 if (updated_window)
11457 w = updated_window;
11458 else
11459 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
11461 /* Set the output cursor. */
11462 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
11463 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
11464 output_cursor.x = x;
11465 output_cursor.y = y;
11467 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
11468 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
11469 if (updated_window == NULL)
11471 block_input ();
11472 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
11473 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
11474 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (SELECTED_FRAME ());
11475 unblock_input ();
11479 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11482 /***********************************************************************
11483 Tool-bars
11484 ***********************************************************************/
11486 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11488 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
11490 FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
11492 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
11493 or -1. */
11495 int last_tool_bar_item;
11497 /* Select `frame' temporarily without running all the code in
11498 do_switch_frame.
11499 FIXME: Maybe do_switch_frame should be trimmed down similarly
11500 when `norecord' is set. */
11501 static Lisp_Object
11502 fast_set_selected_frame (Lisp_Object frame)
11504 if (!EQ (selected_frame, frame))
11506 selected_frame = frame;
11507 selected_window = XFRAME (frame)->selected_window;
11509 return Qnil;
11512 /* Update the tool-bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11513 before we start to fill in any display lines. Called from
11514 prepare_menu_bars. If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save
11515 and restore it here. */
11517 static void
11518 update_tool_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data)
11520 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11521 int do_update = FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f);
11522 #else
11523 int do_update = WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11524 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)) > 0;
11525 #endif
11527 if (do_update)
11529 Lisp_Object window;
11530 struct window *w;
11532 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11533 w = XWINDOW (window);
11535 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11536 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11537 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11538 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11539 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11540 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11541 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11542 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11543 || w->update_mode_line
11544 || update_mode_lines
11545 || window_buffer_changed (w))
11547 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11548 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11549 Lisp_Object frame, new_tool_bar;
11550 int new_n_tool_bar;
11551 struct gcpro gcpro1;
11553 /* Set current_buffer to the buffer of the selected
11554 window of the frame, so that we get the right local
11555 keymaps. */
11556 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11558 /* Save match data, if we must. */
11559 if (save_match_data)
11560 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11562 /* Make sure that we don't accidentally use bogus keymaps. */
11563 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11565 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11566 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11569 GCPRO1 (new_tool_bar);
11571 /* We must temporarily set the selected frame to this frame
11572 before calling tool_bar_items, because the calculation of
11573 the tool-bar keymap uses the selected frame (see
11574 `tool-bar-make-keymap' in tool-bar.el). */
11575 eassert (EQ (selected_window,
11576 /* Since we only explicitly preserve selected_frame,
11577 check that selected_window would be redundant. */
11578 XFRAME (selected_frame)->selected_window));
11579 record_unwind_protect (fast_set_selected_frame, selected_frame);
11580 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11581 fast_set_selected_frame (frame);
11583 /* Build desired tool-bar items from keymaps. */
11584 new_tool_bar
11585 = tool_bar_items (Fcopy_sequence (f->tool_bar_items),
11586 &new_n_tool_bar);
11588 /* Redisplay the tool-bar if we changed it. */
11589 if (new_n_tool_bar != f->n_tool_bar_items
11590 || NILP (Fequal (new_tool_bar, f->tool_bar_items)))
11592 /* Redisplay that happens asynchronously due to an expose event
11593 may access f->tool_bar_items. Make sure we update both
11594 variables within BLOCK_INPUT so no such event interrupts. */
11595 block_input ();
11596 fset_tool_bar_items (f, new_tool_bar);
11597 f->n_tool_bar_items = new_n_tool_bar;
11598 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11599 unblock_input ();
11602 UNGCPRO;
11604 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11605 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11611 /* Set F->desired_tool_bar_string to a Lisp string representing frame
11612 F's desired tool-bar contents. F->tool_bar_items must have
11613 been set up previously by calling prepare_menu_bars. */
11615 static void
11616 build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f)
11618 int i, size, size_needed;
11619 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3;
11620 Lisp_Object image, plist, props;
11622 image = plist = props = Qnil;
11623 GCPRO3 (image, plist, props);
11625 /* Prepare F->desired_tool_bar_string. If we can reuse it, do so.
11626 Otherwise, make a new string. */
11628 /* The size of the string we might be able to reuse. */
11629 size = (STRINGP (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11630 ? SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11631 : 0);
11633 /* We need one space in the string for each image. */
11634 size_needed = f->n_tool_bar_items;
11636 /* Reuse f->desired_tool_bar_string, if possible. */
11637 if (size < size_needed || NILP (f->desired_tool_bar_string))
11638 fset_desired_tool_bar_string
11639 (f, Fmake_string (make_number (size_needed), make_number (' ')));
11640 else
11642 props = list4 (Qdisplay, Qnil, Qmenu_item, Qnil);
11643 Fremove_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (size),
11644 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11647 /* Put a `display' property on the string for the images to display,
11648 put a `menu_item' property on tool-bar items with a value that
11649 is the index of the item in F's tool-bar item vector. */
11650 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i)
11652 #define PROP(IDX) \
11653 AREF (f->tool_bar_items, i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS + (IDX))
11655 int enabled_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P));
11656 int selected_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_SELECTED_P));
11657 int hmargin, vmargin, relief, idx, end;
11659 /* If image is a vector, choose the image according to the
11660 button state. */
11661 image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES);
11662 if (VECTORP (image))
11664 if (enabled_p)
11665 idx = (selected_p
11666 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_SELECTED
11667 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_DESELECTED);
11668 else
11669 idx = (selected_p
11670 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_SELECTED
11671 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_DESELECTED);
11673 eassert (ASIZE (image) >= idx);
11674 image = AREF (image, idx);
11676 else
11677 idx = -1;
11679 /* Ignore invalid image specifications. */
11680 if (!valid_image_p (image))
11681 continue;
11683 /* Display the tool-bar button pressed, or depressed. */
11684 plist = Fcopy_sequence (XCDR (image));
11686 /* Compute margin and relief to draw. */
11687 relief = (tool_bar_button_relief >= 0
11688 ? tool_bar_button_relief
11689 : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF);
11690 hmargin = vmargin = relief;
11692 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, Vtool_bar_button_margin,
11693 INT_MAX - max (hmargin, vmargin)))
11695 hmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11696 vmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11698 else if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
11700 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11701 INT_MAX - hmargin))
11702 hmargin += XFASTINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11704 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11705 INT_MAX - vmargin))
11706 vmargin += XFASTINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11709 if (auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p)
11711 /* Add a `:relief' property to the image spec if the item is
11712 selected. */
11713 if (selected_p)
11715 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief, make_number (-relief));
11716 hmargin -= relief;
11717 vmargin -= relief;
11720 else
11722 /* If image is selected, display it pressed, i.e. with a
11723 negative relief. If it's not selected, display it with a
11724 raised relief. */
11725 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief,
11726 (selected_p
11727 ? make_number (-relief)
11728 : make_number (relief)));
11729 hmargin -= relief;
11730 vmargin -= relief;
11733 /* Put a margin around the image. */
11734 if (hmargin || vmargin)
11736 if (hmargin == vmargin)
11737 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin, make_number (hmargin));
11738 else
11739 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin,
11740 Fcons (make_number (hmargin),
11741 make_number (vmargin)));
11744 /* If button is not enabled, and we don't have special images
11745 for the disabled state, make the image appear disabled by
11746 applying an appropriate algorithm to it. */
11747 if (!enabled_p && idx < 0)
11748 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCconversion, Qdisabled);
11750 /* Put a `display' text property on the string for the image to
11751 display. Put a `menu-item' property on the string that gives
11752 the start of this item's properties in the tool-bar items
11753 vector. */
11754 image = Fcons (Qimage, plist);
11755 props = list4 (Qdisplay, image,
11756 Qmenu_item, make_number (i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS));
11758 /* Let the last image hide all remaining spaces in the tool bar
11759 string. The string can be longer than needed when we reuse a
11760 previous string. */
11761 if (i + 1 == f->n_tool_bar_items)
11762 end = SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11763 else
11764 end = i + 1;
11765 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (i), make_number (end),
11766 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11767 #undef PROP
11770 UNGCPRO;
11774 /* Display one line of the tool-bar of frame IT->f.
11776 HEIGHT specifies the desired height of the tool-bar line.
11777 If the actual height of the glyph row is less than HEIGHT, the
11778 row's height is increased to HEIGHT, and the icons are centered
11779 vertically in the new height.
11781 If HEIGHT is -1, we are counting needed tool-bar lines, so don't
11782 count a final empty row in case the tool-bar width exactly matches
11783 the window width.
11786 static void
11787 display_tool_bar_line (struct it *it, int height)
11789 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
11790 int max_x = it->last_visible_x;
11791 struct glyph *last;
11793 prepare_desired_row (row);
11794 row->y = it->current_y;
11796 /* Note that this isn't made use of if the face hasn't a box,
11797 so there's no need to check the face here. */
11798 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
11800 while (it->current_x < max_x)
11802 int x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
11803 struct it it_before;
11805 /* Get the next display element. */
11806 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
11808 /* Don't count empty row if we are counting needed tool-bar lines. */
11809 if (height < 0 && !it->hpos)
11810 return;
11811 break;
11814 /* Produce glyphs. */
11815 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
11816 it_before = *it;
11818 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
11820 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
11821 i = 0;
11822 x = it_before.current_x;
11823 while (i < nglyphs)
11825 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
11827 if (x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
11829 /* Glyph doesn't fit on line. Backtrack. */
11830 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
11831 *it = it_before;
11832 /* If this is the only glyph on this line, it will never fit on the
11833 tool-bar, so skip it. But ensure there is at least one glyph,
11834 so we don't accidentally disable the tool-bar. */
11835 if (n_glyphs_before == 0
11836 && (it->vpos > 0 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos-1))
11837 break;
11838 goto out;
11841 ++it->hpos;
11842 x += glyph->pixel_width;
11843 ++i;
11846 /* Stop at line end. */
11847 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
11848 break;
11850 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
11853 out:;
11855 row->displays_text_p = row->used[TEXT_AREA] != 0;
11857 /* Use default face for the border below the tool bar.
11859 FIXME: When auto-resize-tool-bars is grow-only, there is
11860 no additional border below the possibly empty tool-bar lines.
11861 So to make the extra empty lines look "normal", we have to
11862 use the tool-bar face for the border too. */
11863 if (!row->displays_text_p && !EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only))
11864 it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
11866 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
11867 last = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
11868 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
11869 if (last == row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])
11870 last->left_box_line_p = 1;
11872 /* Make line the desired height and center it vertically. */
11873 if ((height -= it->max_ascent + it->max_descent) > 0)
11875 /* Don't add more than one line height. */
11876 height %= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
11877 it->max_ascent += height / 2;
11878 it->max_descent += (height + 1) / 2;
11881 compute_line_metrics (it);
11883 /* If line is empty, make it occupy the rest of the tool-bar. */
11884 if (!row->displays_text_p)
11886 row->height = row->phys_height = it->last_visible_y - row->y;
11887 row->visible_height = row->height;
11888 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
11889 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
11892 row->full_width_p = 1;
11893 row->continued_p = 0;
11894 row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
11895 row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
11897 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
11898 it->current_y += row->height;
11899 ++it->vpos;
11900 ++it->glyph_row;
11904 /* Max tool-bar height. */
11906 #define MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT(f) \
11907 ((FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f)))
11909 /* Value is the number of screen lines needed to make all tool-bar
11910 items of frame F visible. The number of actual rows needed is
11911 returned in *N_ROWS if non-NULL. */
11913 static int
11914 tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *f, int *n_rows)
11916 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
11917 struct it it;
11918 /* tool_bar_lines_needed is called from redisplay_tool_bar after building
11919 the desired matrix, so use (unused) mode-line row as temporary row to
11920 avoid destroying the first tool-bar row. */
11921 struct glyph_row *temp_row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
11923 /* Initialize an iterator for iteration over
11924 F->desired_tool_bar_string in the tool-bar window of frame F. */
11925 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, temp_row, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
11926 it.first_visible_x = 0;
11927 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11928 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
11929 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
11931 while (!ITERATOR_AT_END_P (&it))
11933 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11934 it.glyph_row = temp_row;
11935 display_tool_bar_line (&it, -1);
11937 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11939 /* f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0 means "unknown"; -1 means no tool-bar. */
11940 if (n_rows)
11941 *n_rows = it.vpos > 0 ? it.vpos : -1;
11943 return (it.current_y + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1) / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
11947 DEFUN ("tool-bar-lines-needed", Ftool_bar_lines_needed, Stool_bar_lines_needed,
11948 0, 1, 0,
11949 doc: /* Return the number of lines occupied by the tool bar of FRAME.
11950 If FRAME is nil or omitted, use the selected frame. */)
11951 (Lisp_Object frame)
11953 struct frame *f = decode_any_frame (frame);
11954 struct window *w;
11955 int nlines = 0;
11957 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11958 && (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11959 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > 0))
11961 update_tool_bar (f, 1);
11962 if (f->n_tool_bar_items)
11964 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
11965 nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, NULL);
11969 return make_number (nlines);
11973 /* Display the tool-bar of frame F. Value is non-zero if tool-bar's
11974 height should be changed. */
11976 static int
11977 redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *f)
11979 struct window *w;
11980 struct it it;
11981 struct glyph_row *row;
11983 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11984 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
11985 update_frame_tool_bar (f);
11986 return 0;
11987 #endif
11989 /* If frame hasn't a tool-bar window or if it is zero-height, don't
11990 do anything. This means you must start with tool-bar-lines
11991 non-zero to get the auto-sizing effect. Or in other words, you
11992 can turn off tool-bars by specifying tool-bar-lines zero. */
11993 if (!WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11994 || (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11995 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) == 0))
11996 return 0;
11998 /* Set up an iterator for the tool-bar window. */
11999 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, w->desired_matrix->rows, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
12000 it.first_visible_x = 0;
12001 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
12002 row = it.glyph_row;
12004 /* Build a string that represents the contents of the tool-bar. */
12005 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
12006 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
12007 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But it
12008 doesn't make sense to have an R2L tool bar if the menu bar cannot
12009 be drawn also R2L, and making the menu bar R2L is tricky due
12010 toolkit-specific code that implements it. If an R2L tool bar is
12011 ever supported, display_tool_bar_line should also be augmented to
12012 call unproduce_glyphs like display_line and display_string
12013 do. */
12014 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
12016 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0)
12018 int nlines;
12020 if ((nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &f->n_tool_bar_rows),
12021 nlines != WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)))
12023 Lisp_Object frame;
12024 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
12026 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12027 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12028 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
12029 make_number (nlines)),
12030 Qnil));
12031 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
12033 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
12034 fonts_changed_p = 1;
12035 return 1;
12040 /* Display as many lines as needed to display all tool-bar items. */
12042 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows > 0)
12044 int border, rows, height, extra;
12046 if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vtool_bar_border))
12047 border = XINT (Vtool_bar_border);
12048 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qinternal_border_width))
12049 border = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
12050 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qborder_width))
12051 border = f->border_width;
12052 else
12053 border = 0;
12054 if (border < 0)
12055 border = 0;
12057 rows = f->n_tool_bar_rows;
12058 height = max (1, (it.last_visible_y - border) / rows);
12059 extra = it.last_visible_y - border - height * rows;
12061 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12063 int h = 0;
12064 if (extra > 0 && rows-- > 0)
12066 h = (extra + rows - 1) / rows;
12067 extra -= h;
12069 display_tool_bar_line (&it, height + h);
12072 else
12074 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12075 display_tool_bar_line (&it, 0);
12078 /* It doesn't make much sense to try scrolling in the tool-bar
12079 window, so don't do it. */
12080 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
12081 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
12083 if (!NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
12085 int max_tool_bar_height = MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
12086 int change_height_p = 0;
12088 /* If we couldn't display everything, change the tool-bar's
12089 height if there is room for more. */
12090 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it) < it.end_charpos
12091 && it.current_y < max_tool_bar_height)
12092 change_height_p = 1;
12094 row = it.glyph_row - 1;
12096 /* If there are blank lines at the end, except for a partially
12097 visible blank line at the end that is smaller than
12098 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT, change the tool-bar's height. */
12099 if (!row->displays_text_p
12100 && row->height >= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
12101 change_height_p = 1;
12103 /* If row displays tool-bar items, but is partially visible,
12104 change the tool-bar's height. */
12105 if (row->displays_text_p
12106 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > it.last_visible_y
12107 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < max_tool_bar_height)
12108 change_height_p = 1;
12110 /* Resize windows as needed by changing the `tool-bar-lines'
12111 frame parameter. */
12112 if (change_height_p)
12114 Lisp_Object frame;
12115 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
12116 int nrows;
12117 int nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &nrows);
12119 change_height_p = ((EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only)
12120 && !f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p)
12121 ? (nlines > old_height)
12122 : (nlines != old_height));
12123 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12125 if (change_height_p)
12127 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12128 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12129 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
12130 make_number (nlines)),
12131 Qnil));
12132 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
12134 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
12135 f->n_tool_bar_rows = nrows;
12136 fonts_changed_p = 1;
12137 return 1;
12143 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12144 return 0;
12148 /* Get information about the tool-bar item which is displayed in GLYPH
12149 on frame F. Return in *PROP_IDX the index where tool-bar item
12150 properties start in F->tool_bar_items. Value is zero if
12151 GLYPH doesn't display a tool-bar item. */
12153 static int
12154 tool_bar_item_info (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph, int *prop_idx)
12156 Lisp_Object prop;
12157 int success_p;
12158 int charpos;
12160 /* This function can be called asynchronously, which means we must
12161 exclude any possibility that Fget_text_property signals an
12162 error. */
12163 charpos = min (SCHARS (f->current_tool_bar_string), glyph->charpos);
12164 charpos = max (0, charpos);
12166 /* Get the text property `menu-item' at pos. The value of that
12167 property is the start index of this item's properties in
12168 F->tool_bar_items. */
12169 prop = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
12170 Qmenu_item, f->current_tool_bar_string);
12171 if (INTEGERP (prop))
12173 *prop_idx = XINT (prop);
12174 success_p = 1;
12176 else
12177 success_p = 0;
12179 return success_p;
12183 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
12184 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
12185 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
12186 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
12187 item in F->tool_bar_items. Value is
12189 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
12190 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
12191 1 otherwise. */
12193 static int
12194 get_tool_bar_item (struct frame *f, int x, int y, struct glyph **glyph,
12195 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *prop_idx)
12197 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12198 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12199 int area;
12201 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
12202 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, 0, 0, &area);
12203 if (*glyph == NULL)
12204 return -1;
12206 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
12207 f->tool_bar_items. */
12208 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
12209 return -1;
12211 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
12212 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
12213 && *vpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12214 && *vpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12215 && (*vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12216 || *hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
12217 && (*vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12218 || *hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
12219 || hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
12220 return 0;
12222 return 1;
12226 /* EXPORT:
12227 Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
12228 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. DOWN_P is 1 for a button press,
12229 0 for button release. MODIFIERS is event modifiers for button
12230 release. */
12232 void
12233 handle_tool_bar_click (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int down_p,
12234 int modifiers)
12236 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12237 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12238 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
12239 struct glyph *glyph;
12240 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12242 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
12243 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
12244 if (get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
12245 return;
12247 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
12248 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12249 if (NILP (enabled_p))
12250 return;
12252 if (down_p)
12254 /* Show item in pressed state. */
12255 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
12256 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
12257 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
12259 else
12261 Lisp_Object key, frame;
12262 struct input_event event;
12263 EVENT_INIT (event);
12265 /* Show item in released state. */
12266 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
12267 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12269 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY);
12271 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12272 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12273 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12274 event.arg = frame;
12275 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12277 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12278 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12279 event.arg = key;
12280 event.modifiers = modifiers;
12281 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12282 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
12287 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
12288 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
12289 note_mouse_highlight. */
12291 static void
12292 note_tool_bar_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
12294 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
12295 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12296 Display_Info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12297 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12298 int hpos, vpos;
12299 struct glyph *glyph;
12300 struct glyph_row *row;
12301 int i;
12302 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12303 int prop_idx;
12304 enum draw_glyphs_face draw = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12305 int mouse_down_p, rc;
12307 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative X/Y
12308 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
12309 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
12311 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12312 return;
12315 rc = get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
12316 if (rc < 0)
12318 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
12319 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12320 return;
12322 else if (rc == 0)
12323 /* On same tool-bar item as before. */
12324 goto set_help_echo;
12326 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12328 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
12329 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
12330 && f == last_mouse_frame
12331 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
12332 if (mouse_down_p
12333 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
12334 return;
12336 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
12337 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12339 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
12340 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12341 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
12343 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
12344 image is a space. We include this in the highlighted area. */
12345 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
12346 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
12347 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
12349 /* Record this as the current active region. */
12350 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
12351 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
12352 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
12353 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
12354 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
12356 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
12357 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
12358 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
12359 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
12360 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
12361 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
12363 /* Display it as active. */
12364 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, draw);
12365 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
12368 set_help_echo:
12370 /* Set help_echo_string to a help string to display for this tool-bar item.
12371 XTread_socket does the rest. */
12372 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
12373 help_echo_pos = -1;
12374 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP);
12375 if (NILP (help_echo_string))
12376 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION);
12379 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
12383 /************************************************************************
12384 Horizontal scrolling
12385 ************************************************************************/
12387 static int hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object);
12388 static int hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object);
12390 /* For all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW, set their
12391 hscroll value so that PT is (i) visible in the window, and (ii) so
12392 that it is not within a certain margin at the window's left and
12393 right border. Value is non-zero if any window's hscroll has been
12394 changed. */
12396 static int
12397 hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object window)
12399 int hscrolled_p = 0;
12400 int hscroll_relative_p = FLOATP (Vhscroll_step);
12401 int hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12402 double hscroll_step_rel = 0;
12404 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12406 hscroll_step_rel = XFLOAT_DATA (Vhscroll_step);
12407 if (hscroll_step_rel < 0)
12409 hscroll_relative_p = 0;
12410 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12413 else if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vhscroll_step))
12415 hscroll_step_abs = XINT (Vhscroll_step);
12416 if (hscroll_step_abs < 0)
12417 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12419 else
12420 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12422 while (WINDOWP (window))
12424 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12426 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
12427 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->hchild);
12428 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
12429 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->vchild);
12430 else if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
12432 int h_margin;
12433 int text_area_width;
12434 struct glyph_row *current_cursor_row
12435 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12436 struct glyph_row *desired_cursor_row
12437 = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12438 struct glyph_row *cursor_row
12439 = (desired_cursor_row->enabled_p
12440 ? desired_cursor_row
12441 : current_cursor_row);
12442 int row_r2l_p = cursor_row->reversed_p;
12444 text_area_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
12446 /* Scroll when cursor is inside this scroll margin. */
12447 h_margin = hscroll_margin * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
12449 if (!NILP (Fbuffer_local_value (Qauto_hscroll_mode, w->buffer))
12450 /* For left-to-right rows, hscroll when cursor is either
12451 (i) inside the right hscroll margin, or (ii) if it is
12452 inside the left margin and the window is already
12453 hscrolled. */
12454 && ((!row_r2l_p
12455 && ((w->hscroll
12456 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12457 || (cursor_row->enabled_p
12458 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12459 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))
12460 /* For right-to-left rows, the logic is similar,
12461 except that rules for scrolling to left and right
12462 are reversed. E.g., if cursor.x <= h_margin, we
12463 need to hscroll "to the right" unconditionally,
12464 and that will scroll the screen to the left so as
12465 to reveal the next portion of the row. */
12466 || (row_r2l_p
12467 && ((cursor_row->enabled_p
12468 /* FIXME: It is confusing to set the
12469 truncated_on_right_p flag when R2L rows
12470 are actually truncated on the left. */
12471 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12472 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12473 || (w->hscroll
12474 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))))
12476 struct it it;
12477 ptrdiff_t hscroll;
12478 struct buffer *saved_current_buffer;
12479 ptrdiff_t pt;
12480 int wanted_x;
12482 /* Find point in a display of infinite width. */
12483 saved_current_buffer = current_buffer;
12484 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
12486 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12487 pt = PT;
12488 else
12490 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12491 pt = max (BEGV, pt);
12492 pt = min (ZV, pt);
12495 /* Move iterator to pt starting at cursor_row->start in
12496 a line with infinite width. */
12497 init_to_row_start (&it, w, cursor_row);
12498 it.last_visible_x = INFINITY;
12499 move_it_in_display_line_to (&it, pt, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
12500 current_buffer = saved_current_buffer;
12502 /* Position cursor in window. */
12503 if (!hscroll_relative_p && hscroll_step_abs == 0)
12504 hscroll = max (0, (it.current_x
12505 - (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it)
12506 ? (text_area_width - 4 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f))
12507 : (text_area_width / 2))))
12508 / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12509 else if ((!row_r2l_p
12510 && w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin)
12511 || (row_r2l_p && w->cursor.x <= h_margin))
12513 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12514 wanted_x = text_area_width * (1 - hscroll_step_rel)
12515 - h_margin;
12516 else
12517 wanted_x = text_area_width
12518 - hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12519 - h_margin;
12520 hscroll
12521 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12523 else
12525 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12526 wanted_x = text_area_width * hscroll_step_rel
12527 + h_margin;
12528 else
12529 wanted_x = hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12530 + h_margin;
12531 hscroll
12532 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12534 hscroll = max (hscroll, w->min_hscroll);
12536 /* Don't prevent redisplay optimizations if hscroll
12537 hasn't changed, as it will unnecessarily slow down
12538 redisplay. */
12539 if (w->hscroll != hscroll)
12541 XBUFFER (w->buffer)->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 1;
12542 w->hscroll = hscroll;
12543 hscrolled_p = 1;
12548 window = w->next;
12551 /* Value is non-zero if hscroll of any leaf window has been changed. */
12552 return hscrolled_p;
12556 /* Set hscroll so that cursor is visible and not inside horizontal
12557 scroll margins for all windows in the tree rooted at WINDOW. See
12558 also hscroll_window_tree above. Value is non-zero if any window's
12559 hscroll has been changed. If it has, desired matrices on the frame
12560 of WINDOW are cleared. */
12562 static int
12563 hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object window)
12565 int hscrolled_p = hscroll_window_tree (window);
12566 if (hscrolled_p)
12567 clear_desired_matrices (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))));
12568 return hscrolled_p;
12573 /************************************************************************
12574 Redisplay
12575 ************************************************************************/
12577 /* Variables holding some state of redisplay if GLYPH_DEBUG is defined
12578 to a non-zero value. This is sometimes handy to have in a debugger
12579 session. */
12581 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
12583 /* First and last unchanged row for try_window_id. */
12585 static int debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
12586 static int debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos;
12588 /* Delta vpos and y. */
12590 static int debug_dvpos, debug_dy;
12592 /* Delta in characters and bytes for try_window_id. */
12594 static ptrdiff_t debug_delta, debug_delta_bytes;
12596 /* Values of window_end_pos and window_end_vpos at the end of
12597 try_window_id. */
12599 static ptrdiff_t debug_end_vpos;
12601 /* Append a string to W->desired_matrix->method. FMT is a printf
12602 format string. If trace_redisplay_p is non-zero also printf the
12603 resulting string to stderr. */
12605 static void debug_method_add (struct window *, char const *, ...)
12606 ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (2, 3);
12608 static void
12609 debug_method_add (struct window *w, char const *fmt, ...)
12611 char *method = w->desired_matrix->method;
12612 int len = strlen (method);
12613 int size = sizeof w->desired_matrix->method;
12614 int remaining = size - len - 1;
12615 va_list ap;
12617 if (len && remaining)
12619 method[len] = '|';
12620 --remaining, ++len;
12623 va_start (ap, fmt);
12624 vsnprintf (method + len, remaining + 1, fmt, ap);
12625 va_end (ap);
12627 if (trace_redisplay_p)
12628 fprintf (stderr, "%p (%s): %s\n",
12630 ((BUFFERP (w->buffer)
12631 && STRINGP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name)))
12632 ? SSDATA (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name))
12633 : "no buffer"),
12634 method + len);
12637 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
12640 /* Value is non-zero if all changes in window W, which displays
12641 current_buffer, are in the text between START and END. START is a
12642 buffer position, END is given as a distance from Z. Used in
12643 redisplay_internal for display optimization. */
12645 static int
12646 text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *w,
12647 ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end)
12649 int unchanged_p = 1;
12651 /* If text or overlays have changed, see where. */
12652 if (window_outdated (w))
12654 /* Gap in the line? */
12655 if (GPT < start || Z - GPT < end)
12656 unchanged_p = 0;
12658 /* Changes start in front of the line, or end after it? */
12659 if (unchanged_p
12660 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start - 1
12661 || END_UNCHANGED < end))
12662 unchanged_p = 0;
12664 /* If selective display, can't optimize if changes start at the
12665 beginning of the line. */
12666 if (unchanged_p
12667 && INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
12668 && XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)) > 0
12669 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start || GPT <= start))
12670 unchanged_p = 0;
12672 /* If there are overlays at the start or end of the line, these
12673 may have overlay strings with newlines in them. A change at
12674 START, for instance, may actually concern the display of such
12675 overlay strings as well, and they are displayed on different
12676 lines. So, quickly rule out this case. (For the future, it
12677 might be desirable to implement something more telling than
12678 just BEG/END_UNCHANGED.) */
12679 if (unchanged_p)
12681 if (BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED == start
12682 && overlay_touches_p (start))
12683 unchanged_p = 0;
12684 if (END_UNCHANGED == end
12685 && overlay_touches_p (Z - end))
12686 unchanged_p = 0;
12689 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
12690 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
12691 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
12692 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
12693 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
12694 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
12695 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization. */
12696 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
12697 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
12698 unchanged_p = 0;
12701 return unchanged_p;
12705 /* Do a frame update, taking possible shortcuts into account. This is
12706 the main external entry point for redisplay.
12708 If the last redisplay displayed an echo area message and that message
12709 is no longer requested, we clear the echo area or bring back the
12710 mini-buffer if that is in use. */
12712 void
12713 redisplay (void)
12715 redisplay_internal ();
12719 static Lisp_Object
12720 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (Lisp_Object var)
12722 Lisp_Object val;
12724 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_string), STRINGP (val))
12725 return val;
12727 return Voverlay_arrow_string;
12730 /* Return 1 if there are any overlay-arrows in current_buffer. */
12731 static int
12732 overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p (void)
12734 Lisp_Object vlist;
12736 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12737 CONSP (vlist);
12738 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12740 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12741 Lisp_Object val;
12743 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12744 continue;
12745 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12746 if (MARKERP (val)
12747 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer)
12748 return 1;
12750 return 0;
12754 /* Return 1 if any overlay_arrows have moved or overlay-arrow-string
12755 has changed. */
12757 static int
12758 overlay_arrows_changed_p (void)
12760 Lisp_Object vlist;
12762 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12763 CONSP (vlist);
12764 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12766 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12767 Lisp_Object val, pstr;
12769 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12770 continue;
12771 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12772 if (!MARKERP (val))
12773 continue;
12774 if (! EQ (COERCE_MARKER (val),
12775 Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position))
12776 || ! (pstr = overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var),
12777 EQ (pstr, Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_string))))
12778 return 1;
12780 return 0;
12783 /* Mark overlay arrows to be updated on next redisplay. */
12785 static void
12786 update_overlay_arrows (int up_to_date)
12788 Lisp_Object vlist;
12790 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12791 CONSP (vlist);
12792 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12794 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12796 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12797 continue;
12799 if (up_to_date > 0)
12801 Lisp_Object val = find_symbol_value (var);
12802 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position,
12803 COERCE_MARKER (val));
12804 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string,
12805 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var));
12807 else if (up_to_date < 0
12808 || !NILP (Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position)))
12810 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position, Qt);
12811 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string, Qt);
12817 /* Return overlay arrow string to display at row.
12818 Return integer (bitmap number) for arrow bitmap in left fringe.
12819 Return nil if no overlay arrow. */
12821 static Lisp_Object
12822 overlay_arrow_at_row (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row)
12824 Lisp_Object vlist;
12826 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12827 CONSP (vlist);
12828 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12830 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12831 Lisp_Object val;
12833 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12834 continue;
12836 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12838 if (MARKERP (val)
12839 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer
12840 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == marker_position (val)))
12842 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
12843 /* FIXME: if ROW->reversed_p is set, this should test
12844 the right fringe, not the left one. */
12845 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) > 0)
12847 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
12848 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap), SYMBOLP (val))
12850 int fringe_bitmap;
12851 if ((fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (val)) != 0)
12852 return make_number (fringe_bitmap);
12854 #endif
12855 return make_number (-1); /* Use default arrow bitmap. */
12857 return overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var);
12861 return Qnil;
12864 /* Return 1 if point moved out of or into a composition. Otherwise
12865 return 0. PREV_BUF and PREV_PT are the last point buffer and
12866 position. BUF and PT are the current point buffer and position. */
12868 static int
12869 check_point_in_composition (struct buffer *prev_buf, ptrdiff_t prev_pt,
12870 struct buffer *buf, ptrdiff_t pt)
12872 ptrdiff_t start, end;
12873 Lisp_Object prop;
12874 Lisp_Object buffer;
12876 XSETBUFFER (buffer, buf);
12877 /* Check a composition at the last point if point moved within the
12878 same buffer. */
12879 if (prev_buf == buf)
12881 if (prev_pt == pt)
12882 /* Point didn't move. */
12883 return 0;
12885 if (prev_pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && prev_pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12886 && find_composition (prev_pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12887 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12888 && start < prev_pt && end > prev_pt)
12889 /* The last point was within the composition. Return 1 iff
12890 point moved out of the composition. */
12891 return (pt <= start || pt >= end);
12894 /* Check a composition at the current point. */
12895 return (pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12896 && find_composition (pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12897 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12898 && start < pt && end > pt);
12902 /* Reconsider the setting of B->clip_changed which is displayed
12903 in window W. */
12905 static void
12906 reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *w, struct buffer *b)
12908 if (b->clip_changed
12909 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid)
12910 && w->current_matrix->buffer == b
12911 && w->current_matrix->zv == BUF_ZV (b)
12912 && w->current_matrix->begv == BUF_BEGV (b))
12913 b->clip_changed = 0;
12915 /* If display wasn't paused, and W is not a tool bar window, see if
12916 point has been moved into or out of a composition. In that case,
12917 we set b->clip_changed to 1 to force updating the screen. If
12918 b->clip_changed has already been set to 1, we can skip this
12919 check. */
12920 if (!b->clip_changed
12921 && BUFFERP (w->buffer) && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
12923 ptrdiff_t pt;
12925 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12926 pt = PT;
12927 else
12928 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12930 if ((w->current_matrix->buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer)
12931 || pt != w->last_point)
12932 && check_point_in_composition (w->current_matrix->buffer,
12933 w->last_point,
12934 XBUFFER (w->buffer), pt))
12935 b->clip_changed = 1;
12940 /* Select FRAME to forward the values of frame-local variables into C
12941 variables so that the redisplay routines can access those values
12942 directly. */
12944 static void
12945 select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object frame)
12947 Lisp_Object tail, tem;
12948 Lisp_Object old = selected_frame;
12949 struct Lisp_Symbol *sym;
12951 eassert (FRAMEP (frame) && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (frame)));
12953 selected_frame = frame;
12955 do {
12956 for (tail = XFRAME (frame)->param_alist;
12957 CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
12958 if (CONSP (XCAR (tail))
12959 && (tem = XCAR (XCAR (tail)),
12960 SYMBOLP (tem))
12961 && (sym = indirect_variable (XSYMBOL (tem)),
12962 sym->redirect == SYMBOL_LOCALIZED)
12963 && sym->val.blv->frame_local)
12964 /* Use find_symbol_value rather than Fsymbol_value
12965 to avoid an error if it is void. */
12966 find_symbol_value (tem);
12967 } while (!EQ (frame, old) && (frame = old, 1));
12971 #define STOP_POLLING \
12972 do { if (! polling_stopped_here) stop_polling (); \
12973 polling_stopped_here = 1; } while (0)
12975 #define RESUME_POLLING \
12976 do { if (polling_stopped_here) start_polling (); \
12977 polling_stopped_here = 0; } while (0)
12980 /* Perhaps in the future avoid recentering windows if it
12981 is not necessary; currently that causes some problems. */
12983 static void
12984 redisplay_internal (void)
12986 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
12987 struct window *sw;
12988 struct frame *fr;
12989 int pending;
12990 int must_finish = 0;
12991 struct text_pos tlbufpos, tlendpos;
12992 int number_of_visible_frames;
12993 ptrdiff_t count, count1;
12994 struct frame *sf;
12995 int polling_stopped_here = 0;
12996 Lisp_Object tail, frame, old_frame = selected_frame;
12997 struct backtrace backtrace;
12999 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to consider all windows on all
13000 frames. Zero means, only selected_window is considered. */
13001 int consider_all_windows_p;
13003 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to redisplay the miniwindow. */
13004 int update_miniwindow_p = 0;
13006 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_internal %d\n", redisplaying_p));
13008 /* No redisplay if running in batch mode or frame is not yet fully
13009 initialized, or redisplay is explicitly turned off by setting
13010 Vinhibit_redisplay. */
13011 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (SELECTED_FRAME ())
13012 || !NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
13013 return;
13015 /* Don't examine these until after testing Vinhibit_redisplay.
13016 When Emacs is shutting down, perhaps because its connection to
13017 X has dropped, we should not look at them at all. */
13018 fr = XFRAME (w->frame);
13019 sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
13021 if (!fr->glyphs_initialized_p)
13022 return;
13024 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
13025 if (popup_activated ())
13026 return;
13027 #endif
13029 /* I don't think this happens but let's be paranoid. */
13030 if (redisplaying_p)
13031 return;
13033 /* Record a function that clears redisplaying_p
13034 when we leave this function. */
13035 count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
13036 record_unwind_protect (unwind_redisplay, selected_frame);
13037 redisplaying_p = 1;
13038 specbind (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, Qnil);
13040 /* Record this function, so it appears on the profiler's backtraces. */
13041 backtrace.next = backtrace_list;
13042 backtrace.function = Qredisplay_internal;
13043 backtrace.args = &Qnil;
13044 backtrace.nargs = 0;
13045 backtrace.debug_on_exit = 0;
13046 backtrace_list = &backtrace;
13048 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13049 XFRAME (frame)->already_hscrolled_p = 0;
13051 retry:
13052 /* Remember the currently selected window. */
13053 sw = w;
13055 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13056 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13057 /* When running redisplay, we play a bit fast-and-loose and allow e.g.
13058 selected_frame and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync so
13059 when we come back here via `goto retry', we need to resync because we
13060 may need to run Elisp code (via prepare_menu_bars). */
13061 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13063 pending = 0;
13064 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
13065 last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
13066 last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13067 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
13068 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13070 /* If new fonts have been loaded that make a glyph matrix adjustment
13071 necessary, do it. */
13072 if (fonts_changed_p)
13074 adjust_glyphs (NULL);
13075 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13076 fonts_changed_p = 0;
13079 /* If face_change_count is non-zero, init_iterator will free all
13080 realized faces, which includes the faces referenced from current
13081 matrices. So, we can't reuse current matrices in this case. */
13082 if (face_change_count)
13083 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13085 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (sf) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (sf))
13086 && FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame != sf)
13088 /* Since frames on a single ASCII terminal share the same
13089 display area, displaying a different frame means redisplay
13090 the whole thing. */
13091 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13092 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (sf);
13093 #ifndef DOS_NT
13094 set_tty_color_mode (FRAME_TTY (sf), sf);
13095 #endif
13096 FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame = sf;
13099 /* Set the visible flags for all frames. Do this before checking for
13100 resized or garbaged frames; they want to know if their frames are
13101 visible. See the comment in frame.h for FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY. */
13102 number_of_visible_frames = 0;
13104 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13106 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13108 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13109 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13110 ++number_of_visible_frames;
13111 clear_desired_matrices (f);
13114 /* Notice any pending interrupt request to change frame size. */
13115 do_pending_window_change (1);
13117 /* do_pending_window_change could change the selected_window due to
13118 frame resizing which makes the selected window too small. */
13119 if (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13121 sw = w;
13122 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
13125 /* Clear frames marked as garbaged. */
13126 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13128 /* Build menubar and tool-bar items. */
13129 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
13130 prepare_menu_bars ();
13132 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
13133 update_mode_lines++;
13135 /* Detect case that we need to write or remove a star in the mode line. */
13136 if ((SAVE_MODIFF < MODIFF) != w->last_had_star)
13138 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13139 if (buffer_shared_and_changed ())
13140 update_mode_lines++;
13143 /* Avoid invocation of point motion hooks by `current_column' below. */
13144 count1 = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
13145 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
13147 /* If %c is in the mode line, update it if needed. */
13148 if (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
13149 /* This alternative quickly identifies a common case
13150 where no change is needed. */
13151 && !(PT == w->last_point && !window_outdated (w))
13152 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()))
13153 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13155 unbind_to (count1, Qnil);
13157 FRAME_SCROLL_BOTTOM_VPOS (XFRAME (w->frame)) = -1;
13159 /* The variable buffer_shared is set in redisplay_window and
13160 indicates that we redisplay a buffer in different windows. See
13161 there. */
13162 consider_all_windows_p = (update_mode_lines
13163 || buffer_shared_and_changed ()
13164 || cursor_type_changed);
13166 /* If specs for an arrow have changed, do thorough redisplay
13167 to ensure we remove any arrow that should no longer exist. */
13168 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
13169 consider_all_windows_p = windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
13171 /* Normally the message* functions will have already displayed and
13172 updated the echo area, but the frame may have been trashed, or
13173 the update may have been preempted, so display the echo area
13174 again here. Checking message_cleared_p captures the case that
13175 the echo area should be cleared. */
13176 if ((!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) && !display_last_displayed_message_p)
13177 || (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]) && display_last_displayed_message_p)
13178 || (message_cleared_p
13179 && minibuf_level == 0
13180 /* If the mini-window is currently selected, this means the
13181 echo-area doesn't show through. */
13182 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))))
13184 int window_height_changed_p = echo_area_display (0);
13186 if (message_cleared_p)
13187 update_miniwindow_p = 1;
13189 must_finish = 1;
13191 /* If we don't display the current message, don't clear the
13192 message_cleared_p flag, because, if we did, we wouldn't clear
13193 the echo area in the next redisplay which doesn't preserve
13194 the echo area. */
13195 if (!display_last_displayed_message_p)
13196 message_cleared_p = 0;
13198 if (fonts_changed_p)
13199 goto retry;
13200 else if (window_height_changed_p)
13202 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
13203 ++update_mode_lines;
13204 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13206 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13207 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13208 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13209 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13212 else if (EQ (selected_window, minibuf_window)
13213 && (current_buffer->clip_changed || window_outdated (w))
13214 && resize_mini_window (w, 0))
13216 /* Resized active mini-window to fit the size of what it is
13217 showing if its contents might have changed. */
13218 must_finish = 1;
13219 /* FIXME: this causes all frames to be updated, which seems unnecessary
13220 since only the current frame needs to be considered. This function
13221 needs to be rewritten with two variables, consider_all_windows and
13222 consider_all_frames. */
13223 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
13224 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13225 ++update_mode_lines;
13227 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13228 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13229 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13230 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13234 /* If showing the region, and mark has changed, we must redisplay
13235 the whole window. The assignment to this_line_start_pos prevents
13236 the optimization directly below this if-statement. */
13237 if (((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13238 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
13239 != !NILP (w->region_showing))
13240 || (!NILP (w->region_showing)
13241 && !EQ (w->region_showing,
13242 Fmarker_position (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark)))))
13243 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13245 /* Optimize the case that only the line containing the cursor in the
13246 selected window has changed. Variables starting with this_ are
13247 set in display_line and record information about the line
13248 containing the cursor. */
13249 tlbufpos = this_line_start_pos;
13250 tlendpos = this_line_end_pos;
13251 if (!consider_all_windows_p
13252 && CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > 0
13253 && !w->update_mode_line
13254 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
13255 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
13256 && FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13257 && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13258 /* Make sure recorded data applies to current buffer, etc. */
13259 && this_line_buffer == current_buffer
13260 && current_buffer == XBUFFER (w->buffer)
13261 && !w->force_start
13262 && !w->optional_new_start
13263 /* Point must be on the line that we have info recorded about. */
13264 && PT >= CHARPOS (tlbufpos)
13265 && PT <= Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13266 /* All text outside that line, including its final newline,
13267 must be unchanged. */
13268 && text_outside_line_unchanged_p (w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos),
13269 CHARPOS (tlendpos)))
13271 if (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > BEGV
13272 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos) - 1) != '\n'
13273 && (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) == ZV
13274 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos)) == '\n'))
13275 /* Former continuation line has disappeared by becoming empty. */
13276 goto cancel;
13277 else if (window_outdated (w) || MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
13279 /* We have to handle the case of continuation around a
13280 wide-column character (see the comment in indent.c around
13281 line 1340).
13283 For instance, in the following case:
13285 -------- Insert --------
13286 K_A_N_\\ `a' K_A_N_a\ `X_' are wide-column chars.
13287 J_I_ ==> J_I_ `^^' are cursors.
13288 ^^ ^^
13289 -------- --------
13291 As we have to redraw the line above, we cannot use this
13292 optimization. */
13294 struct it it;
13295 int line_height_before = this_line_pixel_height;
13297 /* Note that start_display will handle the case that the
13298 line starting at tlbufpos is a continuation line. */
13299 start_display (&it, w, tlbufpos);
13301 /* Implementation note: It this still necessary? */
13302 if (it.current_x != this_line_start_x)
13303 goto cancel;
13305 TRACE ((stderr, "trying display optimization 1\n"));
13306 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
13307 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
13308 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13309 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13310 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos);
13311 display_line (&it);
13313 /* If line contains point, is not continued,
13314 and ends at same distance from eob as before, we win. */
13315 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0
13316 /* Line is not continued, otherwise this_line_start_pos
13317 would have been set to 0 in display_line. */
13318 && CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
13319 /* Line ends as before. */
13320 && CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos) == CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13321 /* Line has same height as before. Otherwise other lines
13322 would have to be shifted up or down. */
13323 && this_line_pixel_height == line_height_before)
13325 /* If this is not the window's last line, we must adjust
13326 the charstarts of the lines below. */
13327 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
13329 struct glyph_row *row
13330 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos + 1);
13331 ptrdiff_t delta, delta_bytes;
13333 /* We used to distinguish between two cases here,
13334 conditioned by Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos) == ZV, for
13335 when the line ends in a newline or the end of the
13336 buffer's accessible portion. But both cases did
13337 the same, so they were collapsed. */
13338 delta = (Z
13339 - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13340 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row));
13341 delta_bytes = (Z_BYTE
13342 - BYTEPOS (tlendpos)
13343 - MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
13345 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
13346 this_line_vpos + 1,
13347 w->current_matrix->nrows,
13348 delta, delta_bytes);
13351 /* If this row displays text now but previously didn't,
13352 or vice versa, w->window_end_vpos may have to be
13353 adjusted. */
13354 if ((it.glyph_row - 1)->displays_text_p)
13356 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < this_line_vpos)
13357 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (this_line_vpos));
13359 else if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) == this_line_vpos
13360 && this_line_vpos > 0)
13361 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (this_line_vpos - 1));
13362 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
13364 /* Update hint: No need to try to scroll in update_window. */
13365 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
13367 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13368 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13369 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 1");
13370 #endif
13371 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13372 update_window_fringes (w, 0);
13373 #endif
13374 goto update;
13376 else
13377 goto cancel;
13379 else if (/* Cursor position hasn't changed. */
13380 PT == w->last_point
13381 /* Make sure the cursor was last displayed
13382 in this window. Otherwise we have to reposition it. */
13383 && 0 <= w->cursor.vpos
13384 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > w->cursor.vpos)
13386 if (!must_finish)
13388 do_pending_window_change (1);
13389 /* If selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13390 if (WINDOWP (selected_window)
13391 && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13392 goto retry;
13394 /* We used to always goto end_of_redisplay here, but this
13395 isn't enough if we have a blinking cursor. */
13396 if (w->cursor_off_p == w->last_cursor_off_p)
13397 goto end_of_redisplay;
13399 goto update;
13401 /* If highlighting the region, or if the cursor is in the echo area,
13402 then we can't just move the cursor. */
13403 else if (! (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13404 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
13405 && (EQ (selected_window,
13406 BVAR (current_buffer, last_selected_window))
13407 || highlight_nonselected_windows)
13408 && NILP (w->region_showing)
13409 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
13410 && !cursor_in_echo_area)
13412 struct it it;
13413 struct glyph_row *row;
13415 /* Skip from tlbufpos to PT and see where it is. Note that
13416 PT may be in invisible text. If so, we will end at the
13417 next visible position. */
13418 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos), BYTEPOS (tlbufpos),
13419 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
13420 it.current_x = this_line_start_x;
13421 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13422 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13424 /* The call to move_it_to stops in front of PT, but
13425 moves over before-strings. */
13426 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
13428 if (it.vpos == this_line_vpos
13429 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos),
13430 row->enabled_p))
13432 eassert (this_line_vpos == it.vpos);
13433 eassert (this_line_y == it.current_y);
13434 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
13435 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13436 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13437 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 3");
13438 #endif
13439 goto update;
13441 else
13442 goto cancel;
13445 cancel:
13446 /* Text changed drastically or point moved off of line. */
13447 SET_MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos, 0);
13450 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13451 consider_all_windows_p |= buffer_shared_and_changed ();
13452 ++clear_face_cache_count;
13453 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13454 ++clear_image_cache_count;
13455 #endif
13457 /* Build desired matrices, and update the display. If
13458 consider_all_windows_p is non-zero, do it for all windows on all
13459 frames. Otherwise do it for selected_window, only. */
13461 if (consider_all_windows_p)
13463 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13464 XFRAME (frame)->updated_p = 0;
13466 /* Recompute # windows showing selected buffer. This will be
13467 incremented each time such a window is displayed. */
13468 buffer_shared = 0;
13470 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13472 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13474 /* We don't have to do anything for unselected terminal
13475 frames. */
13476 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (f))
13477 && !EQ (FRAME_TTY (f)->top_frame, frame))
13478 continue;
13480 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) || FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || f == sf)
13482 if (! EQ (frame, selected_frame))
13483 /* Select the frame, for the sake of frame-local
13484 variables. */
13485 select_frame_for_redisplay (frame);
13487 /* Mark all the scroll bars to be removed; we'll redeem
13488 the ones we want when we redisplay their windows. */
13489 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook)
13490 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13492 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13493 redisplay_windows (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
13495 /* The X error handler may have deleted that frame. */
13496 if (!FRAME_LIVE_P (f))
13497 continue;
13499 /* Any scroll bars which redisplay_windows should have
13500 nuked should now go away. */
13501 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook)
13502 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13504 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13505 /* ??? rms: I suspect it is a mistake to jump all the way
13506 back to retry here. It should just retry this frame. */
13507 if (fonts_changed_p)
13508 goto retry;
13510 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13512 /* See if we have to hscroll. */
13513 if (!f->already_hscrolled_p)
13515 f->already_hscrolled_p = 1;
13516 if (hscroll_windows (f->root_window))
13517 goto retry;
13520 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display
13521 update. stdio is not robust about handling
13522 signals, which can cause an apparent I/O
13523 error. */
13524 if (interrupt_input)
13525 unrequest_sigio ();
13526 STOP_POLLING;
13528 /* Update the display. */
13529 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (f->root_window), 1);
13530 pending |= update_frame (f, 0, 0);
13531 f->updated_p = 1;
13536 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13537 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13538 /* We played a bit fast-and-loose above and allowed selected_frame
13539 and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync but let's make
13540 sure this stays contained. */
13541 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13542 eassert (EQ (XFRAME (selected_frame)->selected_window,
13543 selected_window));
13545 if (!pending)
13547 /* Do the mark_window_display_accurate after all windows have
13548 been redisplayed because this call resets flags in buffers
13549 which are needed for proper redisplay. */
13550 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13552 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13553 if (f->updated_p)
13555 mark_window_display_accurate (f->root_window, 1);
13556 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
13557 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook (f);
13562 else if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13564 Lisp_Object mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13565 struct frame *mini_frame;
13567 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
13568 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13569 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13570 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, selected_window,
13571 list_of_error,
13572 redisplay_window_error);
13573 if (update_miniwindow_p)
13574 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, mini_window,
13575 list_of_error,
13576 redisplay_window_error);
13578 /* Compare desired and current matrices, perform output. */
13580 update:
13581 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13582 if (fonts_changed_p)
13583 goto retry;
13585 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display update.
13586 stdio is not robust about handling signals,
13587 which can cause an apparent I/O error. */
13588 if (interrupt_input)
13589 unrequest_sigio ();
13590 STOP_POLLING;
13592 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13594 if (hscroll_windows (selected_window))
13595 goto retry;
13597 XWINDOW (selected_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13598 pending = update_frame (sf, 0, 0);
13601 /* We may have called echo_area_display at the top of this
13602 function. If the echo area is on another frame, that may
13603 have put text on a frame other than the selected one, so the
13604 above call to update_frame would not have caught it. Catch
13605 it here. */
13606 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13607 mini_frame = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
13609 if (mini_frame != sf && FRAME_WINDOW_P (mini_frame))
13611 XWINDOW (mini_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13612 pending |= update_frame (mini_frame, 0, 0);
13613 if (!pending && hscroll_windows (mini_window))
13614 goto retry;
13618 /* If display was paused because of pending input, make sure we do a
13619 thorough update the next time. */
13620 if (pending)
13622 /* Prevent the optimization at the beginning of
13623 redisplay_internal that tries a single-line update of the
13624 line containing the cursor in the selected window. */
13625 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13627 /* Let the overlay arrow be updated the next time. */
13628 update_overlay_arrows (0);
13630 /* If we pause after scrolling, some rows in the current
13631 matrices of some windows are not valid. */
13632 if (!WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)
13633 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
13634 update_mode_lines = 1;
13636 else
13638 if (!consider_all_windows_p)
13640 /* This has already been done above if
13641 consider_all_windows_p is set. */
13642 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, 1);
13644 /* Say overlay arrows are up to date. */
13645 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13647 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0)
13648 FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook (sf);
13651 update_mode_lines = 0;
13652 windows_or_buffers_changed = 0;
13653 cursor_type_changed = 0;
13656 /* Start SIGIO interrupts coming again. Having them off during the
13657 code above makes it less likely one will discard output, but not
13658 impossible, since there might be stuff in the system buffer here.
13659 But it is much hairier to try to do anything about that. */
13660 if (interrupt_input)
13661 request_sigio ();
13662 RESUME_POLLING;
13664 /* If a frame has become visible which was not before, redisplay
13665 again, so that we display it. Expose events for such a frame
13666 (which it gets when becoming visible) don't call the parts of
13667 redisplay constructing glyphs, so simply exposing a frame won't
13668 display anything in this case. So, we have to display these
13669 frames here explicitly. */
13670 if (!pending)
13672 int new_count = 0;
13674 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13676 int this_is_visible = 0;
13678 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13679 this_is_visible = 1;
13680 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (XFRAME (frame));
13681 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13682 this_is_visible = 1;
13684 if (this_is_visible)
13685 new_count++;
13688 if (new_count != number_of_visible_frames)
13689 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13692 /* Change frame size now if a change is pending. */
13693 do_pending_window_change (1);
13695 /* If we just did a pending size change, or have additional
13696 visible frames, or selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13697 if ((windows_or_buffers_changed && !pending)
13698 || (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw))
13699 goto retry;
13701 /* Clear the face and image caches.
13703 We used to do this only if consider_all_windows_p. But the cache
13704 needs to be cleared if a timer creates images in the current
13705 buffer (e.g. the test case in Bug#6230). */
13707 if (clear_face_cache_count > CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT)
13709 clear_face_cache (0);
13710 clear_face_cache_count = 0;
13713 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13714 if (clear_image_cache_count > CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT)
13716 clear_image_caches (Qnil);
13717 clear_image_cache_count = 0;
13719 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
13721 end_of_redisplay:
13722 backtrace_list = backtrace.next;
13723 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
13724 RESUME_POLLING;
13728 /* Redisplay, but leave alone any recent echo area message unless
13729 another message has been requested in its place.
13731 This is useful in situations where you need to redisplay but no
13732 user action has occurred, making it inappropriate for the message
13733 area to be cleared. See tracking_off and
13734 wait_reading_process_output for examples of these situations.
13736 FROM_WHERE is an integer saying from where this function was
13737 called. This is useful for debugging. */
13739 void
13740 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (int from_where)
13742 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_preserve_echo_area (%d)\n", from_where));
13744 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]))
13746 /* We have a previously displayed message, but no current
13747 message. Redisplay the previous message. */
13748 display_last_displayed_message_p = 1;
13749 redisplay_internal ();
13750 display_last_displayed_message_p = 0;
13752 else
13753 redisplay_internal ();
13755 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ()) != NULL
13756 && FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
13757 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (NULL);
13761 /* Function registered with record_unwind_protect in redisplay_internal.
13762 Clear redisplaying_p. Also, select the previously
13763 selected frame, unless it has been deleted (by an X connection
13764 failure during redisplay, for example). */
13766 static Lisp_Object
13767 unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object old_frame)
13769 redisplaying_p = 0;
13770 if (! EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13771 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13772 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13773 return Qnil;
13777 /* Mark the display of window W as accurate or inaccurate. If
13778 ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of W as accurate. If
13779 ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for W to be redisplayed the next time
13780 redisplay_internal is called. */
13782 static void
13783 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *w, int accurate_p)
13785 if (BUFFERP (w->buffer))
13787 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13789 w->last_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_MODIFF(b) : 0;
13790 w->last_overlay_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF(b) : 0;
13791 w->last_had_star
13792 = BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b);
13794 if (accurate_p)
13796 b->clip_changed = 0;
13797 b->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 0;
13799 BUF_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_MODIFF (b);
13800 BUF_OVERLAY_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b);
13801 BUF_BEG_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_GPT (b) - BUF_BEG (b);
13802 BUF_END_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_Z (b) - BUF_GPT (b);
13804 w->current_matrix->buffer = b;
13805 w->current_matrix->begv = BUF_BEGV (b);
13806 w->current_matrix->zv = BUF_ZV (b);
13808 w->last_cursor = w->cursor;
13809 w->last_cursor_off_p = w->cursor_off_p;
13811 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
13812 w->last_point = BUF_PT (b);
13813 else
13814 w->last_point = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
13818 if (accurate_p)
13820 wset_window_end_valid (w, w->buffer);
13821 w->update_mode_line = 0;
13826 /* Mark the display of windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW as
13827 accurate or inaccurate. If ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of
13828 windows as accurate. If ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for windows to
13829 be redisplayed the next time redisplay_internal is called. */
13831 void
13832 mark_window_display_accurate (Lisp_Object window, int accurate_p)
13834 struct window *w;
13836 for (; !NILP (window); window = w->next)
13838 w = XWINDOW (window);
13839 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, accurate_p);
13841 if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13842 mark_window_display_accurate (w->vchild, accurate_p);
13843 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13844 mark_window_display_accurate (w->hchild, accurate_p);
13847 if (accurate_p)
13849 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13851 else
13853 /* Force a thorough redisplay the next time by setting
13854 last_arrow_position and last_arrow_string to t, which is
13855 unequal to any useful value of Voverlay_arrow_... */
13856 update_overlay_arrows (-1);
13861 /* Return value in display table DP (Lisp_Char_Table *) for character
13862 C. Since a display table doesn't have any parent, we don't have to
13863 follow parent. Do not call this function directly but use the
13864 macro DISP_CHAR_VECTOR. */
13866 Lisp_Object
13867 disp_char_vector (struct Lisp_Char_Table *dp, int c)
13869 Lisp_Object val;
13871 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
13873 val = dp->ascii;
13874 if (SUB_CHAR_TABLE_P (val))
13875 val = XSUB_CHAR_TABLE (val)->contents[c];
13877 else
13879 Lisp_Object table;
13881 XSETCHAR_TABLE (table, dp);
13882 val = char_table_ref (table, c);
13884 if (NILP (val))
13885 val = dp->defalt;
13886 return val;
13891 /***********************************************************************
13892 Window Redisplay
13893 ***********************************************************************/
13895 /* Redisplay all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW. */
13897 static void
13898 redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object window)
13900 while (!NILP (window))
13902 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
13904 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13905 redisplay_windows (w->hchild);
13906 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13907 redisplay_windows (w->vchild);
13908 else if (!NILP (w->buffer))
13910 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13911 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13912 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13913 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_0, window,
13914 list_of_error,
13915 redisplay_window_error);
13918 window = w->next;
13922 static Lisp_Object
13923 redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object ignore)
13925 displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff = BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer);
13926 return Qnil;
13929 static Lisp_Object
13930 redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object window)
13932 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13933 redisplay_window (window, 0);
13934 return Qnil;
13937 static Lisp_Object
13938 redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object window)
13940 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13941 redisplay_window (window, 1);
13942 return Qnil;
13946 /* Set cursor position of W. PT is assumed to be displayed in ROW.
13947 DELTA and DELTA_BYTES are the numbers of characters and bytes by
13948 which positions recorded in ROW differ from current buffer
13949 positions.
13951 Return 0 if cursor is not on this row, 1 otherwise. */
13953 static int
13954 set_cursor_from_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
13955 struct glyph_matrix *matrix,
13956 ptrdiff_t delta, ptrdiff_t delta_bytes,
13957 int dy, int dvpos)
13959 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
13960 struct glyph *end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
13961 struct glyph *cursor = NULL;
13962 /* The last known character position in row. */
13963 ptrdiff_t last_pos = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13964 int x = row->x;
13965 ptrdiff_t pt_old = PT - delta;
13966 ptrdiff_t pos_before = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13967 ptrdiff_t pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13968 struct glyph *glyph_before = glyph - 1, *glyph_after = end;
13969 /* A glyph beyond the edge of TEXT_AREA which we should never
13970 touch. */
13971 struct glyph *glyphs_end = end;
13972 /* Non-zero means we've found a match for cursor position, but that
13973 glyph has the avoid_cursor_p flag set. */
13974 int match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
13975 /* Non-zero means we've seen at least one glyph that came from a
13976 display string. */
13977 int string_seen = 0;
13978 /* Largest and smallest buffer positions seen so far during scan of
13979 glyph row. */
13980 ptrdiff_t bpos_max = pos_before;
13981 ptrdiff_t bpos_min = pos_after;
13982 /* Last buffer position covered by an overlay string with an integer
13983 `cursor' property. */
13984 ptrdiff_t bpos_covered = 0;
13985 /* Non-zero means the display string on which to display the cursor
13986 comes from a text property, not from an overlay. */
13987 int string_from_text_prop = 0;
13989 /* Don't even try doing anything if called for a mode-line or
13990 header-line row, since the rest of the code isn't prepared to
13991 deal with such calamities. */
13992 eassert (!row->mode_line_p);
13993 if (row->mode_line_p)
13994 return 0;
13996 /* Skip over glyphs not having an object at the start and the end of
13997 the row. These are special glyphs like truncation marks on
13998 terminal frames. */
13999 if (row->displays_text_p)
14001 if (!row->reversed_p)
14003 while (glyph < end
14004 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14005 && glyph->charpos < 0)
14007 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14008 ++glyph;
14010 while (end > glyph
14011 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
14012 /* CHARPOS is zero for blanks and stretch glyphs
14013 inserted by extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
14014 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
14015 --end;
14016 glyph_before = glyph - 1;
14017 glyph_after = end;
14019 else
14021 struct glyph *g;
14023 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to process it from back
14024 to front, so swap the edge pointers. */
14025 glyphs_end = end = glyph - 1;
14026 glyph += row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
14028 while (glyph > end + 1
14029 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14030 && glyph->charpos < 0)
14032 --glyph;
14033 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14035 if (INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos < 0)
14036 --glyph;
14037 /* By default, in reversed rows we put the cursor on the
14038 rightmost (first in the reading order) glyph. */
14039 for (g = end + 1; g < glyph; g++)
14040 x += g->pixel_width;
14041 while (end < glyph
14042 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
14043 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
14044 ++end;
14045 glyph_before = glyph + 1;
14046 glyph_after = end;
14049 else if (row->reversed_p)
14051 /* In R2L rows that don't display text, put the cursor on the
14052 rightmost glyph. Case in point: an empty last line that is
14053 part of an R2L paragraph. */
14054 cursor = end - 1;
14055 /* Avoid placing the cursor on the last glyph of the row, where
14056 on terminal frames we hold the vertical border between
14057 adjacent windows. */
14058 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
14059 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
14060 && cursor == row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - 1)
14061 cursor--;
14062 x = -1; /* will be computed below, at label compute_x */
14065 /* Step 1: Try to find the glyph whose character position
14066 corresponds to point. If that's not possible, find 2 glyphs
14067 whose character positions are the closest to point, one before
14068 point, the other after it. */
14069 if (!row->reversed_p)
14070 while (/* not marched to end of glyph row */
14071 glyph < end
14072 /* glyph was not inserted by redisplay for internal purposes */
14073 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14075 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14077 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14079 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14080 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14081 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14082 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14083 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14085 /* If we hit point, we've found the glyph on which to
14086 display the cursor. */
14087 if (dpos == 0)
14089 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14090 break;
14092 /* See if we've found a better approximation to
14093 POS_BEFORE or to POS_AFTER. */
14094 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14096 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14097 glyph_before = glyph;
14099 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14101 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14102 glyph_after = glyph;
14105 else if (dpos == 0)
14106 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14108 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14110 Lisp_Object chprop;
14111 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14113 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14114 glyph->object);
14115 if (!NILP (chprop))
14117 /* If the string came from a `display' text property,
14118 look up the buffer position of that property and
14119 use that position to update bpos_max, as if we
14120 actually saw such a position in one of the row's
14121 glyphs. This helps with supporting integer values
14122 of `cursor' property on the display string in
14123 situations where most or all of the row's buffer
14124 text is completely covered by display properties,
14125 so that no glyph with valid buffer positions is
14126 ever seen in the row. */
14127 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14128 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14129 pos_after, 0);
14131 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14132 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14134 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14136 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14137 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14138 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14139 this glyph. Note that, if a `cursor' property on one
14140 of the string's characters has an integer value, we
14141 will break out of the loop below _before_ we get to
14142 the position match above. IOW, integer values of
14143 the `cursor' property override the "exact match for
14144 point" strategy of positioning the cursor. */
14145 /* Implementation note: bpos_max == pt_old when, e.g.,
14146 we are in an empty line, where bpos_max is set to
14147 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS, see above. */
14148 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14150 cursor = glyph;
14151 break;
14155 string_seen = 1;
14157 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14158 ++glyph;
14160 else if (glyph > end) /* row is reversed */
14161 while (!INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14163 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14165 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14167 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14168 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14169 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14170 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14171 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14173 if (dpos == 0)
14175 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14176 break;
14178 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14180 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14181 glyph_before = glyph;
14183 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14185 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14186 glyph_after = glyph;
14189 else if (dpos == 0)
14190 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14192 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14194 Lisp_Object chprop;
14195 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14197 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14198 glyph->object);
14199 if (!NILP (chprop))
14201 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14202 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14203 pos_after, 0);
14205 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14206 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14208 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14210 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14211 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14212 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14213 this glyph. */
14214 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14216 cursor = glyph;
14217 break;
14220 string_seen = 1;
14222 --glyph;
14223 if (glyph == glyphs_end) /* don't dereference outside TEXT_AREA */
14225 x--; /* can't use any pixel_width */
14226 break;
14228 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14231 /* Step 2: If we didn't find an exact match for point, we need to
14232 look for a proper place to put the cursor among glyphs between
14233 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER. */
14234 if (!((row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14235 && BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14236 && !(bpos_max < pt_old && pt_old <= bpos_covered))
14238 /* An empty line has a single glyph whose OBJECT is zero and
14239 whose CHARPOS is the position of a newline on that line.
14240 Note that on a TTY, there are more glyphs after that, which
14241 were produced by extend_face_to_end_of_line, but their
14242 CHARPOS is zero or negative. */
14243 int empty_line_p =
14244 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14245 && INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos > 0;
14247 if (row->ends_in_ellipsis_p && pos_after == last_pos)
14249 ptrdiff_t ellipsis_pos;
14251 /* Scan back over the ellipsis glyphs. */
14252 if (!row->reversed_p)
14254 ellipsis_pos = (glyph - 1)->charpos;
14255 while (glyph > row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
14256 && (glyph - 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14257 glyph--, x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14258 /* That loop always goes one position too far, including
14259 the glyph before the ellipsis. So scan forward over
14260 that one. */
14261 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14262 glyph++;
14264 else /* row is reversed */
14266 ellipsis_pos = (glyph + 1)->charpos;
14267 while (glyph < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14268 && (glyph + 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14269 glyph++, x += glyph->pixel_width;
14270 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14271 glyph--;
14274 else if (match_with_avoid_cursor)
14276 cursor = glyph_after;
14277 x = -1;
14279 else if (string_seen)
14281 int incr = row->reversed_p ? -1 : +1;
14283 /* Need to find the glyph that came out of a string which is
14284 present at point. That glyph is somewhere between
14285 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER, and it came from a string
14286 positioned between POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER in the
14287 buffer. */
14288 struct glyph *start, *stop;
14289 ptrdiff_t pos = pos_before;
14291 x = -1;
14293 /* If the row ends in a newline from a display string,
14294 reordering could have moved the glyphs belonging to the
14295 string out of the [GLYPH_BEFORE..GLYPH_AFTER] range. So
14296 in this case we extend the search to the last glyph in
14297 the row that was not inserted by redisplay. */
14298 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
14300 glyph_after = end;
14301 pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14304 /* GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER are the glyphs that
14305 correspond to POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER, respectively. We
14306 need START and STOP in the order that corresponds to the
14307 row's direction as given by its reversed_p flag. If the
14308 directionality of characters between POS_BEFORE and
14309 POS_AFTER is the opposite of the row's base direction,
14310 these characters will have been reordered for display,
14311 and we need to reverse START and STOP. */
14312 if (!row->reversed_p)
14314 start = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14315 stop = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14317 else
14319 start = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14320 stop = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14322 for (glyph = start + incr;
14323 row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop; )
14326 /* Any glyphs that come from the buffer are here because
14327 of bidi reordering. Skip them, and only pay
14328 attention to glyphs that came from some string. */
14329 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14331 Lisp_Object str;
14332 ptrdiff_t tem;
14333 /* If the display property covers the newline, we
14334 need to search for it one position farther. */
14335 ptrdiff_t lim = pos_after
14336 + (pos_after == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14338 string_from_text_prop = 0;
14339 str = glyph->object;
14340 tem = string_buffer_position_lim (str, pos, lim, 0);
14341 if (tem == 0 /* from overlay */
14342 || pos <= tem)
14344 /* If the string from which this glyph came is
14345 found in the buffer at point, or at position
14346 that is closer to point than pos_after, then
14347 we've found the glyph we've been looking for.
14348 If it comes from an overlay (tem == 0), and
14349 it has the `cursor' property on one of its
14350 glyphs, record that glyph as a candidate for
14351 displaying the cursor. (As in the
14352 unidirectional version, we will display the
14353 cursor on the last candidate we find.) */
14354 if (tem == 0
14355 || tem == pt_old
14356 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14358 /* The glyphs from this string could have
14359 been reordered. Find the one with the
14360 smallest string position. Or there could
14361 be a character in the string with the
14362 `cursor' property, which means display
14363 cursor on that character's glyph. */
14364 ptrdiff_t strpos = glyph->charpos;
14366 if (tem)
14368 cursor = glyph;
14369 string_from_text_prop = 1;
14371 for ( ;
14372 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14373 && EQ (glyph->object, str);
14374 glyph += incr)
14376 Lisp_Object cprop;
14377 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
14379 cprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
14380 Qcursor,
14381 glyph->object);
14382 if (!NILP (cprop))
14384 cursor = glyph;
14385 break;
14387 if (tem && glyph->charpos < strpos)
14389 strpos = glyph->charpos;
14390 cursor = glyph;
14394 if (tem == pt_old
14395 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14396 goto compute_x;
14398 if (tem)
14399 pos = tem + 1; /* don't find previous instances */
14401 /* This string is not what we want; skip all of the
14402 glyphs that came from it. */
14403 while ((row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14404 && EQ (glyph->object, str))
14405 glyph += incr;
14407 else
14408 glyph += incr;
14411 /* If we reached the end of the line, and END was from a string,
14412 the cursor is not on this line. */
14413 if (cursor == NULL
14414 && (row->reversed_p ? glyph <= end : glyph >= end)
14415 && (row->reversed_p ? end > glyphs_end : end < glyphs_end)
14416 && STRINGP (end->object)
14417 && row->continued_p)
14418 return 0;
14420 /* A truncated row may not include PT among its character positions.
14421 Setting the cursor inside the scroll margin will trigger
14422 recalculation of hscroll in hscroll_window_tree. But if a
14423 display string covers point, defer to the string-handling
14424 code below to figure this out. */
14425 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p && pt_old < bpos_min)
14427 cursor = glyph_before;
14428 x = -1;
14430 else if ((row->truncated_on_right_p && pt_old > bpos_max)
14431 /* Zero-width characters produce no glyphs. */
14432 || (!empty_line_p
14433 && (row->reversed_p
14434 ? glyph_after > glyphs_end
14435 : glyph_after < glyphs_end)))
14437 cursor = glyph_after;
14438 x = -1;
14442 compute_x:
14443 if (cursor != NULL)
14444 glyph = cursor;
14445 else if (glyph == glyphs_end
14446 && pos_before == pos_after
14447 && STRINGP ((row->reversed_p
14448 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14449 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])->object))
14451 /* If all the glyphs of this row came from strings, put the
14452 cursor on the first glyph of the row. This avoids having the
14453 cursor outside of the text area in this very rare and hard
14454 use case. */
14455 glyph =
14456 row->reversed_p
14457 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14458 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14460 if (x < 0)
14462 struct glyph *g;
14464 /* Need to compute x that corresponds to GLYPH. */
14465 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = row->x; g < glyph; g++)
14467 if (g >= row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA])
14468 emacs_abort ();
14469 x += g->pixel_width;
14473 /* ROW could be part of a continued line, which, under bidi
14474 reordering, might have other rows whose start and end charpos
14475 occlude point. Only set w->cursor if we found a better
14476 approximation to the cursor position than we have from previously
14477 examined candidate rows belonging to the same continued line. */
14478 if (/* we already have a candidate row */
14479 w->cursor.vpos >= 0
14480 /* that candidate is not the row we are processing */
14481 && MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) != row
14482 /* Make sure cursor.vpos specifies a row whose start and end
14483 charpos occlude point, and it is valid candidate for being a
14484 cursor-row. This is because some callers of this function
14485 leave cursor.vpos at the row where the cursor was displayed
14486 during the last redisplay cycle. */
14487 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)) <= pt_old
14488 && pt_old <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14489 && cursor_row_p (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)))
14491 struct glyph *g1 =
14492 MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) + w->cursor.hpos;
14494 /* Don't consider glyphs that are outside TEXT_AREA. */
14495 if (!(row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end))
14496 return 0;
14497 /* Keep the candidate whose buffer position is the closest to
14498 point or has the `cursor' property. */
14499 if (/* previous candidate is a glyph in TEXT_AREA of that row */
14500 w->cursor.hpos >= 0
14501 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)
14502 && ((BUFFERP (g1->object)
14503 && (g1->charpos == pt_old /* an exact match always wins */
14504 || (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
14505 && eabs (g1->charpos - pt_old)
14506 < eabs (glyph->charpos - pt_old))))
14507 /* previous candidate is a glyph from a string that has
14508 a non-nil `cursor' property */
14509 || (STRINGP (g1->object)
14510 && (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (g1->charpos),
14511 Qcursor, g1->object))
14512 /* previous candidate is from the same display
14513 string as this one, and the display string
14514 came from a text property */
14515 || (EQ (g1->object, glyph->object)
14516 && string_from_text_prop)
14517 /* this candidate is from newline and its
14518 position is not an exact match */
14519 || (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14520 && glyph->charpos != pt_old)))))
14521 return 0;
14522 /* If this candidate gives an exact match, use that. */
14523 if (!((BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14524 /* If this candidate is a glyph created for the
14525 terminating newline of a line, and point is on that
14526 newline, it wins because it's an exact match. */
14527 || (!row->continued_p
14528 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14529 && glyph->charpos == 0
14530 && pt_old == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1))
14531 /* Otherwise, keep the candidate that comes from a row
14532 spanning less buffer positions. This may win when one or
14533 both candidate positions are on glyphs that came from
14534 display strings, for which we cannot compare buffer
14535 positions. */
14536 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14537 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14538 < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
14539 return 0;
14541 w->cursor.hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14542 w->cursor.x = x;
14543 w->cursor.vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, matrix) + dvpos;
14544 w->cursor.y = row->y + dy;
14546 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
14548 if (!row->continued_p
14549 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
14550 && row->x == 0)
14552 this_line_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
14554 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14555 = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14556 BYTEPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14557 = MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes;
14559 CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14560 = Z - (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14561 BYTEPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14562 = Z_BYTE - (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes);
14564 this_line_y = w->cursor.y;
14565 this_line_pixel_height = row->height;
14566 this_line_vpos = w->cursor.vpos;
14567 this_line_start_x = row->x;
14569 else
14570 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
14573 return 1;
14577 /* Run window scroll functions, if any, for WINDOW with new window
14578 start STARTP. Sets the window start of WINDOW to that position.
14580 We assume that the window's buffer is really current. */
14582 static struct text_pos
14583 run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp)
14585 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14586 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, startp);
14588 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
14589 emacs_abort ();
14591 if (!NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
14593 run_hook_with_args_2 (Qwindow_scroll_functions, window,
14594 make_number (CHARPOS (startp)));
14595 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14596 /* In case the hook functions switch buffers. */
14597 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
14600 return startp;
14604 /* Make sure the line containing the cursor is fully visible.
14605 A value of 1 means there is nothing to be done.
14606 (Either the line is fully visible, or it cannot be made so,
14607 or we cannot tell.)
14609 If FORCE_P is non-zero, return 0 even if partial visible cursor row
14610 is higher than window.
14612 A value of 0 means the caller should do scrolling
14613 as if point had gone off the screen. */
14615 static int
14616 cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *w, int force_p, int current_matrix_p)
14618 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
14619 struct glyph_row *row;
14620 int window_height;
14622 if (!make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
14623 return 1;
14625 /* It's not always possible to find the cursor, e.g, when a window
14626 is full of overlay strings. Don't do anything in that case. */
14627 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14628 return 1;
14630 matrix = current_matrix_p ? w->current_matrix : w->desired_matrix;
14631 row = MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
14633 /* If the cursor row is not partially visible, there's nothing to do. */
14634 if (!MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row))
14635 return 1;
14637 /* If the row the cursor is in is taller than the window's height,
14638 it's not clear what to do, so do nothing. */
14639 window_height = window_box_height (w);
14640 if (row->height >= window_height)
14642 if (!force_p || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
14643 || w->vscroll || w->cursor.vpos == 0)
14644 return 1;
14646 return 0;
14650 /* Try scrolling PT into view in window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P
14651 non-zero means only WINDOW is redisplayed in redisplay_internal.
14652 TEMP_SCROLL_STEP has the same meaning as emacs_scroll_step, and is used
14653 in redisplay_window to bring a partially visible line into view in
14654 the case that only the cursor has moved.
14656 LAST_LINE_MISFIT should be nonzero if we're scrolling because the
14657 last screen line's vertical height extends past the end of the screen.
14659 Value is
14661 1 if scrolling succeeded
14663 0 if scrolling didn't find point.
14665 -1 if new fonts have been loaded so that we must interrupt
14666 redisplay, adjust glyph matrices, and try again. */
14668 enum
14670 SCROLLING_SUCCESS,
14671 SCROLLING_FAILED,
14672 SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
14675 /* If scroll-conservatively is more than this, never recenter.
14677 If you change this, don't forget to update the doc string of
14678 `scroll-conservatively' and the Emacs manual. */
14679 #define SCROLL_LIMIT 100
14681 static int
14682 try_scrolling (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p,
14683 ptrdiff_t arg_scroll_conservatively, ptrdiff_t scroll_step,
14684 int temp_scroll_step, int last_line_misfit)
14686 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14687 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
14688 struct text_pos pos, startp;
14689 struct it it;
14690 int this_scroll_margin, scroll_max, rc, height;
14691 int dy = 0, amount_to_scroll = 0, scroll_down_p = 0;
14692 int extra_scroll_margin_lines = last_line_misfit ? 1 : 0;
14693 Lisp_Object aggressive;
14694 /* We will never try scrolling more than this number of lines. */
14695 int scroll_limit = SCROLL_LIMIT;
14697 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
14698 debug_method_add (w, "try_scrolling");
14699 #endif
14701 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14703 /* Compute scroll margin height in pixels. We scroll when point is
14704 within this distance from the top or bottom of the window. */
14705 if (scroll_margin > 0)
14706 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
14707 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14708 else
14709 this_scroll_margin = 0;
14711 /* Force arg_scroll_conservatively to have a reasonable value, to
14712 avoid scrolling too far away with slow move_it_* functions. Note
14713 that the user can supply scroll-conservatively equal to
14714 `most-positive-fixnum', which can be larger than INT_MAX. */
14715 if (arg_scroll_conservatively > scroll_limit)
14717 arg_scroll_conservatively = scroll_limit + 1;
14718 scroll_max = scroll_limit * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14720 else if (scroll_step || arg_scroll_conservatively || temp_scroll_step)
14721 /* Compute how much we should try to scroll maximally to bring
14722 point into view. */
14723 scroll_max = (max (scroll_step,
14724 max (arg_scroll_conservatively, temp_scroll_step))
14725 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14726 else if (NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively))
14727 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)))
14728 /* We're trying to scroll because of aggressive scrolling but no
14729 scroll_step is set. Choose an arbitrary one. */
14730 scroll_max = 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14731 else
14732 scroll_max = 0;
14734 too_near_end:
14736 /* Decide whether to scroll down. */
14737 if (PT > CHARPOS (startp))
14739 int scroll_margin_y;
14741 /* Compute the pixel ypos of the scroll margin, then move IT to
14742 either that ypos or PT, whichever comes first. */
14743 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14744 scroll_margin_y = it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin
14745 - FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14746 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, scroll_margin_y - 1, -1,
14747 (MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y));
14749 if (PT > CHARPOS (it.current.pos))
14751 int y0 = line_bottom_y (&it);
14752 /* Compute how many pixels below window bottom to stop searching
14753 for PT. This avoids costly search for PT that is far away if
14754 the user limited scrolling by a small number of lines, but
14755 always finds PT if scroll_conservatively is set to a large
14756 number, such as most-positive-fixnum. */
14757 int slack = max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14758 int y_to_move = it.last_visible_y + slack;
14760 /* Compute the distance from the scroll margin to PT or to
14761 the scroll limit, whichever comes first. This should
14762 include the height of the cursor line, to make that line
14763 fully visible. */
14764 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, y_to_move,
14765 -1, MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
14766 dy = line_bottom_y (&it) - y0;
14768 if (dy > scroll_max)
14769 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14771 if (dy > 0)
14772 scroll_down_p = 1;
14776 if (scroll_down_p)
14778 /* Point is in or below the bottom scroll margin, so move the
14779 window start down. If scrolling conservatively, move it just
14780 enough down to make point visible. If scroll_step is set,
14781 move it down by scroll_step. */
14782 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14783 amount_to_scroll
14784 = min (max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
14785 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * arg_scroll_conservatively);
14786 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14787 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14788 else
14790 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively);
14791 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14792 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14794 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14795 int aggressive_scroll = float_amount;
14796 if (aggressive_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14797 aggressive_scroll = 1;
14798 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
14799 the window. This could happen if the value of
14800 scroll_up_aggressively is too large and there are
14801 non-zero margins, because scroll_up_aggressively
14802 means put point that fraction of window height
14803 _from_the_bottom_margin_. */
14804 if (aggressive_scroll + 2*this_scroll_margin > height)
14805 aggressive_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin;
14806 amount_to_scroll = dy + aggressive_scroll;
14810 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14811 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14813 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14814 if (arg_scroll_conservatively <= scroll_limit)
14815 move_it_vertically (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14816 else
14818 /* Extra precision for users who set scroll-conservatively
14819 to a large number: make sure the amount we scroll
14820 the window start is never less than amount_to_scroll,
14821 which was computed as distance from window bottom to
14822 point. This matters when lines at window top and lines
14823 below window bottom have different height. */
14824 struct it it1;
14825 void *it1data = NULL;
14826 /* We use a temporary it1 because line_bottom_y can modify
14827 its argument, if it moves one line down; see there. */
14828 int start_y;
14830 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14831 start_y = line_bottom_y (&it1);
14832 do {
14833 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
14834 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14835 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14836 } while (line_bottom_y (&it1) - start_y < amount_to_scroll);
14839 /* If STARTP is unchanged, move it down another screen line. */
14840 if (CHARPOS (it.current.pos) == CHARPOS (startp))
14841 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14842 startp = it.current.pos;
14844 else
14846 struct text_pos scroll_margin_pos = startp;
14848 /* See if point is inside the scroll margin at the top of the
14849 window. */
14850 if (this_scroll_margin)
14852 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14853 move_it_vertically (&it, this_scroll_margin);
14854 scroll_margin_pos = it.current.pos;
14857 if (PT < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14859 /* Point is in the scroll margin at the top of the window or
14860 above what is displayed in the window. */
14861 int y0, y_to_move;
14863 /* Compute the vertical distance from PT to the scroll
14864 margin position. Move as far as scroll_max allows, or
14865 one screenful, or 10 screen lines, whichever is largest.
14866 Give up if distance is greater than scroll_max or if we
14867 didn't reach the scroll margin position. */
14868 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, PT, PT_BYTE);
14869 start_display (&it, w, pos);
14870 y0 = it.current_y;
14871 y_to_move = max (it.last_visible_y,
14872 max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)));
14873 move_it_to (&it, CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos), 0,
14874 y_to_move, -1,
14875 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
14876 dy = it.current_y - y0;
14877 if (dy > scroll_max
14878 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14879 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14881 /* Compute new window start. */
14882 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14884 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14885 amount_to_scroll = max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) *
14886 max (scroll_step, temp_scroll_step));
14887 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14888 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14889 else
14891 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
14892 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14893 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14895 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14896 int aggressive_scroll = float_amount;
14897 if (aggressive_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14898 aggressive_scroll = 1;
14899 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near
14900 bottom of the window, if the value of
14901 scroll_down_aggressively happens to be too
14902 large. */
14903 if (aggressive_scroll + 2*this_scroll_margin > height)
14904 aggressive_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin;
14905 amount_to_scroll = dy + aggressive_scroll;
14909 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14910 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14912 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14913 startp = it.current.pos;
14917 /* Run window scroll functions. */
14918 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
14920 /* Display the window. Give up if new fonts are loaded, or if point
14921 doesn't appear. */
14922 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
14923 rc = SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES;
14924 else if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14926 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14927 rc = SCROLLING_FAILED;
14929 else
14931 /* Maybe forget recorded base line for line number display. */
14932 if (!just_this_one_p
14933 || current_buffer->clip_changed
14934 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
14935 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
14937 /* If cursor ends up on a partially visible line,
14938 treat that as being off the bottom of the screen. */
14939 if (! cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, extra_scroll_margin_lines <= 1, 0)
14940 /* It's possible that the cursor is on the first line of the
14941 buffer, which is partially obscured due to a vscroll
14942 (Bug#7537). In that case, avoid looping forever . */
14943 && extra_scroll_margin_lines < w->desired_matrix->nrows - 1)
14945 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14946 ++extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14947 goto too_near_end;
14949 rc = SCROLLING_SUCCESS;
14952 return rc;
14956 /* Compute a suitable window start for window W if display of W starts
14957 on a continuation line. Value is non-zero if a new window start
14958 was computed.
14960 The new window start will be computed, based on W's width, starting
14961 from the start of the continued line. It is the start of the
14962 screen line with the minimum distance from the old start W->start. */
14964 static int
14965 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *w)
14967 struct text_pos pos, start_pos;
14968 int window_start_changed_p = 0;
14970 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start_pos, w->start);
14972 /* If window start is on a continuation line... Window start may be
14973 < BEGV in case there's invisible text at the start of the
14974 buffer (M-x rmail, for example). */
14975 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > BEGV
14976 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start_pos) - 1) != '\n')
14978 struct it it;
14979 struct glyph_row *row;
14981 /* Handle the case that the window start is out of range. */
14982 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) < BEGV)
14983 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
14984 else if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > ZV)
14985 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
14987 /* Find the start of the continued line. This should be fast
14988 because scan_buffer is fast (newline cache). */
14989 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0);
14990 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (start_pos), BYTEPOS (start_pos),
14991 row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
14992 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (&it);
14994 /* If the line start is "too far" away from the window start,
14995 say it takes too much time to compute a new window start. */
14996 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it)
14997 < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (w))
14999 int min_distance, distance;
15001 /* Move forward by display lines to find the new window
15002 start. If window width was enlarged, the new start can
15003 be expected to be > the old start. If window width was
15004 decreased, the new window start will be < the old start.
15005 So, we're looking for the display line start with the
15006 minimum distance from the old window start. */
15007 pos = it.current.pos;
15008 min_distance = INFINITY;
15009 while ((distance = eabs (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it))),
15010 distance < min_distance)
15012 min_distance = distance;
15013 pos = it.current.pos;
15014 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
15017 /* Set the window start there. */
15018 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, pos);
15019 window_start_changed_p = 1;
15023 return window_start_changed_p;
15027 /* Try cursor movement in case text has not changed in window WINDOW,
15028 with window start STARTP. Value is
15030 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS if successful
15032 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED if this method cannot be used
15034 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL if we know we have to scroll the
15035 display. *SCROLL_STEP is set to 1, under certain circumstances, if
15036 we want to scroll as if scroll-step were set to 1. See the code.
15038 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES if we need larger matrices, in
15039 which case we have to abort this redisplay, and adjust matrices
15040 first. */
15042 enum
15044 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS,
15045 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED,
15046 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL,
15047 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
15050 static int
15051 try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp, int *scroll_step)
15053 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15054 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15055 int rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED;
15057 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15058 if (inhibit_try_cursor_movement)
15059 return rc;
15060 #endif
15062 /* Previously, there was a check for Lisp integer in the
15063 if-statement below. Now, this field is converted to
15064 ptrdiff_t, thus zero means invalid position in a buffer. */
15065 eassert (w->last_point > 0);
15067 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15068 not moved off the frame. */
15069 if (/* Point may be in this window. */
15070 PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15071 /* Selective display hasn't changed. */
15072 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15073 /* Function force-mode-line-update is used to force a thorough
15074 redisplay. It sets either windows_or_buffers_changed or
15075 update_mode_lines. So don't take a shortcut here for these
15076 cases. */
15077 && !update_mode_lines
15078 && !windows_or_buffers_changed
15079 && !cursor_type_changed
15080 /* Can't use this case if highlighting a region. When a
15081 region exists, cursor movement has to do more than just
15082 set the cursor. */
15083 && !(!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15084 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15085 && NILP (w->region_showing)
15086 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
15087 /* This code is not used for mini-buffer for the sake of the case
15088 of redisplaying to replace an echo area message; since in
15089 that case the mini-buffer contents per se are usually
15090 unchanged. This code is of no real use in the mini-buffer
15091 since the handling of this_line_start_pos, etc., in redisplay
15092 handles the same cases. */
15093 && !EQ (window, minibuf_window)
15094 /* When splitting windows or for new windows, it happens that
15095 redisplay is called with a nil window_end_vpos or one being
15096 larger than the window. This should really be fixed in
15097 window.c. I don't have this on my list, now, so we do
15098 approximately the same as the old redisplay code. --gerd. */
15099 && INTEGERP (w->window_end_vpos)
15100 && XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < w->current_matrix->nrows
15101 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
15102 || !overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p ()))
15104 int this_scroll_margin, top_scroll_margin;
15105 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
15107 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15108 debug_method_add (w, "cursor movement");
15109 #endif
15111 /* Scroll if point within this distance from the top or bottom
15112 of the window. This is a pixel value. */
15113 if (scroll_margin > 0)
15115 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
15116 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
15118 else
15119 this_scroll_margin = 0;
15121 top_scroll_margin = this_scroll_margin;
15122 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
15123 top_scroll_margin += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15125 /* Start with the row the cursor was displayed during the last
15126 not paused redisplay. Give up if that row is not valid. */
15127 if (w->last_cursor.vpos < 0
15128 || w->last_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows)
15129 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15130 else
15132 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->last_cursor.vpos);
15133 if (row->mode_line_p)
15134 ++row;
15135 if (!row->enabled_p)
15136 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15139 if (rc == CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED)
15141 int scroll_p = 0, must_scroll = 0;
15142 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - this_scroll_margin;
15144 if (PT > w->last_point)
15146 /* Point has moved forward. */
15147 while (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < PT
15148 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y)
15150 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15151 ++row;
15154 /* If the end position of a row equals the start
15155 position of the next row, and PT is at that position,
15156 we would rather display cursor in the next line. */
15157 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15158 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15159 && row < w->current_matrix->rows
15160 + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1
15161 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row+1) == PT
15162 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15163 ++row;
15165 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. Note that
15166 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y gives the pixel position at which
15167 the next line would be drawn, and that
15168 this_scroll_margin can be zero. */
15169 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y
15170 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15171 /* Line is completely visible last line in window
15172 and PT is to be set in the next line. */
15173 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y
15174 && PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15175 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15176 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
15177 scroll_p = 1;
15179 else if (PT < w->last_point)
15181 /* Cursor has to be moved backward. Note that PT >=
15182 CHARPOS (startp) because of the outer if-statement. */
15183 while (!row->mode_line_p
15184 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) > PT
15185 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15186 && (MATRIX_ROW_STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)
15187 || (/* STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_STRING_P (row) */
15188 row > w->current_matrix->rows
15189 && (row-1)->ends_in_newline_from_string_p))))
15190 && (row->y > top_scroll_margin
15191 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV))
15193 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15194 --row;
15197 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV,
15198 there is invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that
15199 display starts at some point START > BEGV. It can
15200 happen that we are called with PT somewhere between
15201 BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
15202 if (row < w->current_matrix->rows
15203 || row->mode_line_p)
15205 row = w->current_matrix->rows;
15206 if (row->mode_line_p)
15207 ++row;
15210 /* Due to newlines in overlay strings, we may have to
15211 skip forward over overlay strings. */
15212 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15213 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15214 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15215 ++row;
15217 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. */
15218 if (row->y < top_scroll_margin
15219 && CHARPOS (startp) != BEGV)
15220 scroll_p = 1;
15222 else
15224 /* Cursor did not move. So don't scroll even if cursor line
15225 is partially visible, as it was so before. */
15226 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15229 if (PT < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
15230 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
15232 /* if PT is not in the glyph row, give up. */
15233 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15234 must_scroll = 1;
15236 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15237 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
15239 struct glyph_row *row1;
15241 /* If rows are bidi-reordered and point moved, back up
15242 until we find a row that does not belong to a
15243 continuation line. This is because we must consider
15244 all rows of a continued line as candidates for the
15245 new cursor positioning, since row start and end
15246 positions change non-linearly with vertical position
15247 in such rows. */
15248 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15249 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15250 bidi-reordered rows. */
15251 for (row1 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
15252 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row);
15253 --row)
15255 /* If we hit the beginning of the displayed portion
15256 without finding the first row of a continued
15257 line, give up. */
15258 if (row <= row1)
15260 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15261 break;
15263 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15266 if (must_scroll)
15268 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15269 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row)
15270 /* Make sure this isn't a header line by any chance, since
15271 then MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P might yield non-zero. */
15272 && !row->mode_line_p
15273 && make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
15275 if (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15276 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15277 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
15278 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15279 else if (row->height > window_box_height (w))
15281 /* If we end up in a partially visible line, let's
15282 make it fully visible, except when it's taller
15283 than the window, in which case we can't do much
15284 about it. */
15285 *scroll_step = 1;
15286 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15288 else
15290 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15291 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 1))
15292 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15293 else
15294 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15297 else if (scroll_p)
15298 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15299 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15300 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
15302 /* With bidi-reordered rows, there could be more than
15303 one candidate row whose start and end positions
15304 occlude point. We need to let set_cursor_from_row
15305 find the best candidate. */
15306 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15307 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15308 bidi-reordered rows. */
15309 int rv = 0;
15313 int at_zv_p = 0, exact_match_p = 0;
15315 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) <= PT
15316 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15317 && cursor_row_p (row))
15318 rv |= set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
15319 0, 0, 0, 0);
15320 /* As soon as we've found the exact match for point,
15321 or the first suitable row whose ends_at_zv_p flag
15322 is set, we are done. */
15323 at_zv_p =
15324 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->ends_at_zv_p;
15325 if (rv && !at_zv_p
15326 && w->cursor.hpos >= 0
15327 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (w->current_matrix,
15328 w->cursor.vpos))
15330 struct glyph_row *candidate =
15331 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
15332 struct glyph *g =
15333 candidate->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
15334 ptrdiff_t endpos = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (candidate);
15336 exact_match_p =
15337 (BUFFERP (g->object) && g->charpos == PT)
15338 || (INTEGERP (g->object)
15339 && (g->charpos == PT
15340 || (g->charpos == 0 && endpos - 1 == PT)));
15342 if (rv && (at_zv_p || exact_match_p))
15344 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15345 break;
15347 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y)
15348 break;
15349 ++row;
15351 while (((MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15352 || row->continued_p)
15353 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y)
15354 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15355 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y));
15356 /* If we didn't find any candidate rows, or exited the
15357 loop before all the candidates were examined, signal
15358 to the caller that this method failed. */
15359 if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15360 && !(rv
15361 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15362 && !row->continued_p))
15363 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15364 else if (rv)
15365 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15367 else
15371 if (set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0))
15373 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15374 break;
15376 ++row;
15378 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15379 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15380 && cursor_row_p (row));
15385 return rc;
15388 #if !defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS || defined USE_GTK
15389 static
15390 #endif
15391 void
15392 set_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w)
15394 ptrdiff_t start, end, whole;
15396 /* Calculate the start and end positions for the current window.
15397 At some point, it would be nice to choose between scrollbars
15398 which reflect the whole buffer size, with special markers
15399 indicating narrowing, and scrollbars which reflect only the
15400 visible region.
15402 Note that mini-buffers sometimes aren't displaying any text. */
15403 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15404 || (w == XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15405 && NILP (echo_area_buffer[0])))
15407 struct buffer *buf = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15408 whole = BUF_ZV (buf) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15409 start = marker_position (w->start) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15410 /* I don't think this is guaranteed to be right. For the
15411 moment, we'll pretend it is. */
15412 end = BUF_Z (buf) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15414 if (end < start)
15415 end = start;
15416 if (whole < (end - start))
15417 whole = end - start;
15419 else
15420 start = end = whole = 0;
15422 /* Indicate what this scroll bar ought to be displaying now. */
15423 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15424 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15425 (w, end - start, whole, start);
15429 /* Redisplay leaf window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P non-zero means only
15430 selected_window is redisplayed.
15432 We can return without actually redisplaying the window if
15433 fonts_changed_p. In that case, redisplay_internal will
15434 retry. */
15436 static void
15437 redisplay_window (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p)
15439 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15440 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15441 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15442 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
15443 struct text_pos lpoint, opoint, startp;
15444 int update_mode_line;
15445 int tem;
15446 struct it it;
15447 /* Record it now because it's overwritten. */
15448 int current_matrix_up_to_date_p = 0;
15449 int used_current_matrix_p = 0;
15450 /* This is less strict than current_matrix_up_to_date_p.
15451 It indicates that the buffer contents and narrowing are unchanged. */
15452 int buffer_unchanged_p = 0;
15453 int temp_scroll_step = 0;
15454 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
15455 int rc;
15456 int centering_position = -1;
15457 int last_line_misfit = 0;
15458 ptrdiff_t beg_unchanged, end_unchanged;
15460 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15461 opoint = lpoint;
15463 /* W must be a leaf window here. */
15464 eassert (!NILP (w->buffer));
15465 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15466 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
15467 #endif
15469 restart:
15470 reconsider_clip_changes (w, buffer);
15472 /* Has the mode line to be updated? */
15473 update_mode_line = (w->update_mode_line
15474 || update_mode_lines
15475 || buffer->clip_changed
15476 || buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p);
15478 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
15480 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window)
15481 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
15483 if (update_mode_line)
15484 /* We may have to update a tty frame's menu bar or a
15485 tool-bar. Example `M-x C-h C-h C-g'. */
15486 goto finish_menu_bars;
15487 else
15488 /* We've already displayed the echo area glyphs in this window. */
15489 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15491 else if ((w != XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15492 || minibuf_level == 0)
15493 /* When buffer is nonempty, redisplay window normally. */
15494 && BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) == BUF_BEG (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
15495 /* Quail displays non-mini buffers in minibuffer window.
15496 In that case, redisplay the window normally. */
15497 && !NILP (Fmemq (w->buffer, Vminibuffer_list)))
15499 /* W is a mini-buffer window, but it's not active, so clear
15500 it. */
15501 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
15502 struct glyph_row *row;
15503 int y;
15505 for (y = 0, row = w->desired_matrix->rows;
15506 y < yb;
15507 y += row->height, ++row)
15508 blank_row (w, row, y);
15509 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15512 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15515 /* Otherwise set up data on this window; select its buffer and point
15516 value. */
15517 /* Really select the buffer, for the sake of buffer-local
15518 variables. */
15519 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
15521 current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15522 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15523 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15524 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
15525 && !window_outdated (w));
15527 /* Run the window-bottom-change-functions
15528 if it is possible that the text on the screen has changed
15529 (either due to modification of the text, or any other reason). */
15530 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15531 && !NILP (Vwindow_text_change_functions))
15533 safe_run_hooks (Qwindow_text_change_functions);
15534 goto restart;
15537 beg_unchanged = BEG_UNCHANGED;
15538 end_unchanged = END_UNCHANGED;
15540 SET_TEXT_POS (opoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15542 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
15544 buffer_unchanged_p
15545 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15546 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15547 && !window_outdated (w));
15549 /* When windows_or_buffers_changed is non-zero, we can't rely on
15550 the window end being valid, so set it to nil there. */
15551 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
15553 /* If window starts on a continuation line, maybe adjust the
15554 window start in case the window's width changed. */
15555 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer)
15556 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w);
15558 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
15561 /* Some sanity checks. */
15562 CHECK_WINDOW_END (w);
15563 if (Z == Z_BYTE && CHARPOS (opoint) != BYTEPOS (opoint))
15564 emacs_abort ();
15565 if (BYTEPOS (opoint) < CHARPOS (opoint))
15566 emacs_abort ();
15568 /* If %c is in mode line, update it if needed. */
15569 if (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
15570 /* This alternative quickly identifies a common case
15571 where no change is needed. */
15572 && !(PT == w->last_point && !window_outdated (w))
15573 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()))
15574 update_mode_line = 1;
15576 /* Count number of windows showing the selected buffer. An indirect
15577 buffer counts as its base buffer. */
15578 if (!just_this_one_p)
15580 struct buffer *current_base, *window_base;
15581 current_base = current_buffer;
15582 window_base = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
15583 if (current_base->base_buffer)
15584 current_base = current_base->base_buffer;
15585 if (window_base->base_buffer)
15586 window_base = window_base->base_buffer;
15587 if (current_base == window_base)
15588 buffer_shared++;
15591 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any other
15592 window, set up appropriate value. */
15593 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
15595 ptrdiff_t new_pt = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
15596 ptrdiff_t new_pt_byte = marker_byte_position (w->pointm);
15597 if (new_pt < BEGV)
15599 new_pt = BEGV;
15600 new_pt_byte = BEGV_BYTE;
15601 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15603 else if (new_pt > (ZV - 1))
15605 new_pt = ZV;
15606 new_pt_byte = ZV_BYTE;
15607 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15610 /* We don't use SET_PT so that the point-motion hooks don't run. */
15611 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (new_pt, new_pt_byte);
15614 /* If any of the character widths specified in the display table
15615 have changed, invalidate the width run cache. It's true that
15616 this may be a bit late to catch such changes, but the rest of
15617 redisplay goes (non-fatally) haywire when the display table is
15618 changed, so why should we worry about doing any better? */
15619 if (current_buffer->width_run_cache)
15621 struct Lisp_Char_Table *disptab = buffer_display_table ();
15623 if (! disptab_matches_widthtab
15624 (disptab, XVECTOR (BVAR (current_buffer, width_table))))
15626 invalidate_region_cache (current_buffer,
15627 current_buffer->width_run_cache,
15628 BEG, Z);
15629 recompute_width_table (current_buffer, disptab);
15633 /* If window-start is screwed up, choose a new one. */
15634 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer != current_buffer)
15635 goto recenter;
15637 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15639 /* If someone specified a new starting point but did not insist,
15640 check whether it can be used. */
15641 if (w->optional_new_start
15642 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15643 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15645 w->optional_new_start = 0;
15646 start_display (&it, w, startp);
15647 move_it_to (&it, PT, 0, it.last_visible_y, -1,
15648 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
15649 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == PT)
15650 w->force_start = 1;
15651 /* IT may overshoot PT if text at PT is invisible. */
15652 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) > PT && CHARPOS (startp) <= PT)
15653 w->force_start = 1;
15656 force_start:
15658 /* Handle case where place to start displaying has been specified,
15659 unless the specified location is outside the accessible range. */
15660 if (w->force_start || w->frozen_window_start_p)
15662 /* We set this later on if we have to adjust point. */
15663 int new_vpos = -1;
15665 w->force_start = 0;
15666 w->vscroll = 0;
15667 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
15669 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15670 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15671 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15673 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that.
15674 Also, run the hook window-scroll-functions
15675 because we have scrolled. */
15676 /* Note, we do this after clearing force_start because
15677 if there's an error, it is better to forget about force_start
15678 than to get into an infinite loop calling the hook functions
15679 and having them get more errors. */
15680 if (!update_mode_line
15681 || ! NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
15683 update_mode_line = 1;
15684 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15685 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
15688 w->last_modified = 0;
15689 w->last_overlay_modified = 0;
15690 if (CHARPOS (startp) < BEGV)
15691 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15692 else if (CHARPOS (startp) > ZV)
15693 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15695 /* Redisplay, then check if cursor has been set during the
15696 redisplay. Give up if new fonts were loaded. */
15697 /* We used to issue a CHECK_MARGINS argument to try_window here,
15698 but this causes scrolling to fail when point begins inside
15699 the scroll margin (bug#148) -- cyd */
15700 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15702 w->force_start = 1;
15703 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15704 goto need_larger_matrices;
15707 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0 && !w->frozen_window_start_p)
15709 /* If point does not appear, try to move point so it does
15710 appear. The desired matrix has been built above, so we
15711 can use it here. */
15712 new_vpos = window_box_height (w) / 2;
15715 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
15717 /* Point does appear, but on a line partly visible at end of window.
15718 Move it back to a fully-visible line. */
15719 new_vpos = window_box_height (w);
15722 /* If we need to move point for either of the above reasons,
15723 now actually do it. */
15724 if (new_vpos >= 0)
15726 struct glyph_row *row;
15728 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
15729 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < new_vpos)
15730 ++row;
15732 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
15733 MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
15735 if (w != XWINDOW (selected_window))
15736 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, PT, PT_BYTE);
15737 else if (current_buffer == old)
15738 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15740 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15742 /* If we are highlighting the region, then we just changed
15743 the region, so redisplay to show it. */
15744 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15745 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15747 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15748 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15749 goto need_larger_matrices;
15753 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15754 debug_method_add (w, "forced window start");
15755 #endif
15756 goto done;
15759 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15760 not moved off the frame, and we are not retrying after hscroll.
15761 (current_matrix_up_to_date_p is nonzero when retrying.) */
15762 if (current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15763 && (rc = try_cursor_movement (window, startp, &temp_scroll_step),
15764 rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED))
15766 switch (rc)
15768 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS:
15769 used_current_matrix_p = 1;
15770 goto done;
15772 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL:
15773 goto try_to_scroll;
15775 default:
15776 emacs_abort ();
15779 /* If current starting point was originally the beginning of a line
15780 but no longer is, find a new starting point. */
15781 else if (w->start_at_line_beg
15782 && !(CHARPOS (startp) <= BEGV
15783 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n'))
15785 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15786 debug_method_add (w, "recenter 1");
15787 #endif
15788 goto recenter;
15791 /* Try scrolling with try_window_id. Value is > 0 if update has
15792 been done, it is -1 if we know that the same window start will
15793 not work. It is 0 if unsuccessful for some other reason. */
15794 else if ((tem = try_window_id (w)) != 0)
15796 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15797 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_id %d", tem);
15798 #endif
15800 if (fonts_changed_p)
15801 goto need_larger_matrices;
15802 if (tem > 0)
15803 goto done;
15805 /* Otherwise try_window_id has returned -1 which means that we
15806 don't want the alternative below this comment to execute. */
15808 else if (CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15809 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV
15810 && PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15811 && (CHARPOS (startp) < ZV
15812 /* Avoid starting at end of buffer. */
15813 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
15814 || !window_outdated (w)))
15816 int d1, d2, d3, d4, d5, d6;
15818 /* If first window line is a continuation line, and window start
15819 is inside the modified region, but the first change is before
15820 current window start, we must select a new window start.
15822 However, if this is the result of a down-mouse event (e.g. by
15823 extending the mouse-drag-overlay), we don't want to select a
15824 new window start, since that would change the position under
15825 the mouse, resulting in an unwanted mouse-movement rather
15826 than a simple mouse-click. */
15827 if (!w->start_at_line_beg
15828 && NILP (do_mouse_tracking)
15829 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEGV
15830 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEG + beg_unchanged
15831 && CHARPOS (startp) <= Z - end_unchanged
15832 /* Even if w->start_at_line_beg is nil, a new window may
15833 start at a line_beg, since that's how set_buffer_window
15834 sets it. So, we need to check the return value of
15835 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line. (See also
15836 bug#197). */
15837 && XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer
15838 && compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w)
15839 /* It doesn't make sense to force the window start like we
15840 do at label force_start if it is already known that point
15841 will not be visible in the resulting window, because
15842 doing so will move point from its correct position
15843 instead of scrolling the window to bring point into view.
15844 See bug#9324. */
15845 && pos_visible_p (w, PT, &d1, &d2, &d3, &d4, &d5, &d6))
15847 w->force_start = 1;
15848 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15849 goto force_start;
15852 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15853 debug_method_add (w, "same window start");
15854 #endif
15856 /* Try to redisplay starting at same place as before.
15857 If point has not moved off frame, accept the results. */
15858 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15859 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
15860 because a window scroll function can have changed the
15861 buffer. */
15862 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
15863 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15864 || !(used_current_matrix_p
15865 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
15867 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "1"));
15868 if (try_window (window, startp, TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS) < 0)
15869 /* -1 means we need to scroll.
15870 0 means we need new matrices, but fonts_changed_p
15871 is set in that case, so we will detect it below. */
15872 goto try_to_scroll;
15875 if (fonts_changed_p)
15876 goto need_larger_matrices;
15878 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
15880 if (!just_this_one_p
15881 || current_buffer->clip_changed
15882 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
15883 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15884 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15886 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 1, 0))
15888 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15889 last_line_misfit = 1;
15891 /* Drop through and scroll. */
15892 else
15893 goto done;
15895 else
15896 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15899 try_to_scroll:
15901 w->last_modified = 0;
15902 w->last_overlay_modified = 0;
15904 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that. */
15905 if (!update_mode_line)
15907 update_mode_line = 1;
15908 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15911 /* Try to scroll by specified few lines. */
15912 if ((scroll_conservatively
15913 || emacs_scroll_step
15914 || temp_scroll_step
15915 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively))
15916 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively)))
15917 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15918 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15920 /* The function returns -1 if new fonts were loaded, 1 if
15921 successful, 0 if not successful. */
15922 int ss = try_scrolling (window, just_this_one_p,
15923 scroll_conservatively,
15924 emacs_scroll_step,
15925 temp_scroll_step, last_line_misfit);
15926 switch (ss)
15928 case SCROLLING_SUCCESS:
15929 goto done;
15931 case SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES:
15932 goto need_larger_matrices;
15934 case SCROLLING_FAILED:
15935 break;
15937 default:
15938 emacs_abort ();
15942 /* Finally, just choose a place to start which positions point
15943 according to user preferences. */
15945 recenter:
15947 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15948 debug_method_add (w, "recenter");
15949 #endif
15951 /* w->vscroll = 0; */
15953 /* Forget any previously recorded base line for line number display. */
15954 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15955 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15957 /* Determine the window start relative to point. */
15958 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
15959 it.current_y = it.last_visible_y;
15960 if (centering_position < 0)
15962 int margin =
15963 scroll_margin > 0
15964 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
15965 : 0;
15966 ptrdiff_t margin_pos = CHARPOS (startp);
15967 Lisp_Object aggressive;
15968 int scrolling_up;
15970 /* If there is a scroll margin at the top of the window, find
15971 its character position. */
15972 if (margin
15973 /* Cannot call start_display if startp is not in the
15974 accessible region of the buffer. This can happen when we
15975 have just switched to a different buffer and/or changed
15976 its restriction. In that case, startp is initialized to
15977 the character position 1 (BEGV) because we did not yet
15978 have chance to display the buffer even once. */
15979 && BEGV <= CHARPOS (startp) && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15981 struct it it1;
15982 void *it1data = NULL;
15984 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
15985 start_display (&it1, w, startp);
15986 move_it_vertically (&it1, margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
15987 margin_pos = IT_CHARPOS (it1);
15988 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
15990 scrolling_up = PT > margin_pos;
15991 aggressive =
15992 scrolling_up
15993 ? BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)
15994 : BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
15996 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15997 && (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT || NUMBERP (aggressive)))
15999 int pt_offset = 0;
16001 /* Setting scroll-conservatively overrides
16002 scroll-*-aggressively. */
16003 if (!scroll_conservatively && NUMBERP (aggressive))
16005 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive);
16007 pt_offset = float_amount * WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
16008 if (pt_offset == 0 && float_amount > 0)
16009 pt_offset = 1;
16010 if (pt_offset && margin > 0)
16011 margin -= 1;
16013 /* Compute how much to move the window start backward from
16014 point so that point will be displayed where the user
16015 wants it. */
16016 if (scrolling_up)
16018 centering_position = it.last_visible_y;
16019 if (pt_offset)
16020 centering_position -= pt_offset;
16021 centering_position -=
16022 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * (1 + margin + (last_line_misfit != 0))
16023 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16024 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
16025 the window. */
16026 if (centering_position < margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
16027 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
16029 else
16030 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) + pt_offset;
16032 else
16033 /* Set the window start half the height of the window backward
16034 from point. */
16035 centering_position = window_box_height (w) / 2;
16037 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, centering_position);
16039 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (it) >= BEGV);
16041 /* The function move_it_vertically_backward may move over more
16042 than the specified y-distance. If it->w is small, e.g. a
16043 mini-buffer window, we may end up in front of the window's
16044 display area. Start displaying at the start of the line
16045 containing PT in this case. */
16046 if (it.current_y <= 0)
16048 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
16049 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, 0);
16050 it.current_y = 0;
16053 it.current_x = it.hpos = 0;
16055 /* Set the window start position here explicitly, to avoid an
16056 infinite loop in case the functions in window-scroll-functions
16057 get errors. */
16058 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, IT_CHARPOS (it), IT_BYTEPOS (it));
16060 /* Run scroll hooks. */
16061 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, it.current.pos);
16063 /* Redisplay the window. */
16064 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
16065 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16066 || cursor_type_changed
16067 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
16068 because it can have changed the buffer. */
16069 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
16070 || !just_this_one_p
16071 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
16072 || !(used_current_matrix_p
16073 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
16074 try_window (window, startp, 0);
16076 /* If new fonts have been loaded (due to fontsets), give up. We
16077 have to start a new redisplay since we need to re-adjust glyph
16078 matrices. */
16079 if (fonts_changed_p)
16080 goto need_larger_matrices;
16082 /* If cursor did not appear assume that the middle of the window is
16083 in the first line of the window. Do it again with the next line.
16084 (Imagine a window of height 100, displaying two lines of height
16085 60. Moving back 50 from it->last_visible_y will end in the first
16086 line.) */
16087 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16089 if (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
16090 && PT >= Z - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
16092 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16093 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
16094 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16096 else if (PT < IT_CHARPOS (it))
16098 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16099 move_it_by_lines (&it, -1);
16100 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16102 else
16104 /* Not much we can do about it. */
16108 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV, there is
16109 invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that display starts at
16110 some point START > BEGV. It can happen that we are called with
16111 PT somewhere between BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
16112 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16114 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows;
16115 if (row->mode_line_p)
16116 ++row;
16117 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
16120 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
16122 /* If vscroll is enabled, disable it and try again. */
16123 if (w->vscroll)
16125 w->vscroll = 0;
16126 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16127 goto recenter;
16130 /* Users who set scroll-conservatively to a large number want
16131 point just above/below the scroll margin. If we ended up
16132 with point's row partially visible, move the window start to
16133 make that row fully visible and out of the margin. */
16134 if (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT)
16136 int margin =
16137 scroll_margin > 0
16138 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
16139 : 0;
16140 int move_down = w->cursor.vpos >= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 2;
16142 move_it_by_lines (&it, move_down ? margin + 1 : -(margin + 1));
16143 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16144 if (1 == try_window (window, it.current.pos,
16145 TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS))
16146 goto done;
16149 /* If centering point failed to make the whole line visible,
16150 put point at the top instead. That has to make the whole line
16151 visible, if it can be done. */
16152 if (centering_position == 0)
16153 goto done;
16155 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16156 centering_position = 0;
16157 goto recenter;
16160 done:
16162 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
16163 w->start_at_line_beg = (CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
16164 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n');
16166 /* Display the mode line, if we must. */
16167 if ((update_mode_line
16168 /* If window not full width, must redo its mode line
16169 if (a) the window to its side is being redone and
16170 (b) we do a frame-based redisplay. This is a consequence
16171 of how inverted lines are drawn in frame-based redisplay. */
16172 || (!just_this_one_p
16173 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16174 && !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w))
16175 /* Line number to display. */
16176 || INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
16177 /* Column number is displayed and different from the one displayed. */
16178 || (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
16179 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ())))
16180 /* This means that the window has a mode line. */
16181 && (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16182 || WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)))
16184 display_mode_lines (w);
16186 /* If mode line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16187 immediate redisplay using the correct mode line height. */
16188 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16189 && CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16191 fonts_changed_p = 1;
16192 MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16193 = DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16196 /* If header line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16197 immediate redisplay using the correct header line height. */
16198 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16199 && CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16201 fonts_changed_p = 1;
16202 MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16203 = DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16206 if (fonts_changed_p)
16207 goto need_larger_matrices;
16210 if (!line_number_displayed
16211 && !BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
16213 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
16214 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
16217 finish_menu_bars:
16219 /* When we reach a frame's selected window, redo the frame's menu bar. */
16220 if (update_mode_line
16221 && EQ (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f), window))
16223 int redisplay_menu_p = 0;
16225 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16227 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
16228 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
16229 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f);
16230 #else
16231 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16232 #endif
16234 else
16235 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16237 if (redisplay_menu_p)
16238 display_menu_bar (w);
16240 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16241 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16243 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
16244 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
16245 redisplay_tool_bar (f);
16246 #else
16247 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
16248 && (FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
16249 || !NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
16250 && redisplay_tool_bar (f))
16251 ignore_mouse_drag_p = 1;
16252 #endif
16254 #endif
16257 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16258 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16259 && update_window_fringes (w, (just_this_one_p
16260 || (!used_current_matrix_p && !overlay_arrow_seen)
16261 || w->pseudo_window_p)))
16263 update_begin (f);
16264 block_input ();
16265 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
16266 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
16267 unblock_input ();
16268 update_end (f);
16270 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
16272 /* We go to this label, with fonts_changed_p set,
16273 if it is necessary to try again using larger glyph matrices.
16274 We have to redeem the scroll bar even in this case,
16275 because the loop in redisplay_internal expects that. */
16276 need_larger_matrices:
16278 finish_scroll_bars:
16280 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
16282 /* Set the thumb's position and size. */
16283 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
16285 /* Note that we actually used the scroll bar attached to this
16286 window, so it shouldn't be deleted at the end of redisplay. */
16287 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook)
16288 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook) (w);
16291 /* Restore current_buffer and value of point in it. The window
16292 update may have changed the buffer, so first make sure `opoint'
16293 is still valid (Bug#6177). */
16294 if (CHARPOS (opoint) < BEGV)
16295 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
16296 else if (CHARPOS (opoint) > ZV)
16297 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
16298 else
16299 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (opoint), BYTEPOS (opoint));
16301 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
16302 /* Avoid an abort in TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH if the buffer has become
16303 shorter. This can be caused by log truncation in *Messages*. */
16304 if (CHARPOS (lpoint) <= ZV)
16305 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
16307 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
16311 /* Build the complete desired matrix of WINDOW with a window start
16312 buffer position POS.
16314 Value is 1 if successful. It is zero if fonts were loaded during
16315 redisplay which makes re-adjusting glyph matrices necessary, and -1
16316 if point would appear in the scroll margins.
16317 (We check the former only if TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE is
16318 unset in FLAGS, and the latter only if TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS is
16319 set in FLAGS.) */
16322 try_window (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos pos, int flags)
16324 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
16325 struct it it;
16326 struct glyph_row *last_text_row = NULL;
16327 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16329 /* Make POS the new window start. */
16330 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos));
16332 /* Mark cursor position as unknown. No overlay arrow seen. */
16333 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16334 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
16336 /* Initialize iterator and info to start at POS. */
16337 start_display (&it, w, pos);
16339 /* Display all lines of W. */
16340 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16342 if (display_line (&it))
16343 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16344 if (fonts_changed_p && !(flags & TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE))
16345 return 0;
16348 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
16349 if ((flags & TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS)
16350 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
16352 int this_scroll_margin;
16354 if (scroll_margin > 0)
16356 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
16357 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
16359 else
16360 this_scroll_margin = 0;
16362 if ((w->cursor.y >= 0 /* not vscrolled */
16363 && w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
16364 && CHARPOS (pos) > BEGV
16365 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV)
16366 /* rms: considering make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p here
16367 seems to give wrong results. We don't want to recenter
16368 when the last line is partly visible, we want to allow
16369 that case to be handled in the usual way. */
16370 || w->cursor.y > it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin - 1)
16372 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16373 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16374 return -1;
16378 /* If bottom moved off end of frame, change mode line percentage. */
16379 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= 0
16380 && Z != IT_CHARPOS (it))
16381 w->update_mode_line = 1;
16383 /* Set window_end_pos to the offset of the last character displayed
16384 on the window from the end of current_buffer. Set
16385 window_end_vpos to its row number. */
16386 if (last_text_row)
16388 eassert (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (last_text_row));
16389 w->window_end_bytepos
16390 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16391 wset_window_end_pos
16392 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16393 wset_window_end_vpos
16394 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, w->desired_matrix)));
16395 eassert
16396 (MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix,
16397 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos))->displays_text_p);
16399 else
16401 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16402 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - ZV));
16403 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (0));
16406 /* But that is not valid info until redisplay finishes. */
16407 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16408 return 1;
16413 /************************************************************************
16414 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has not changed
16415 ************************************************************************/
16417 /* Try redisplay of window W showing an unchanged buffer with a
16418 different window start than the last time it was displayed by
16419 reusing its current matrix. Value is non-zero if successful.
16420 W->start is the new window start. */
16422 static int
16423 try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *w)
16425 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16426 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
16427 struct it it;
16428 struct run run;
16429 struct text_pos start, new_start;
16430 int nrows_scrolled, i;
16431 struct glyph_row *last_text_row;
16432 struct glyph_row *last_reused_text_row;
16433 struct glyph_row *start_row;
16434 int start_vpos, min_y, max_y;
16436 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16437 if (inhibit_try_window_reusing)
16438 return 0;
16439 #endif
16441 if (/* This function doesn't handle terminal frames. */
16442 !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16443 /* Don't try to reuse the display if windows have been split
16444 or such. */
16445 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16446 || cursor_type_changed)
16447 return 0;
16449 /* Can't do this if region may have changed. */
16450 if ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
16451 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
16452 || !NILP (w->region_showing)
16453 || !NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
16454 return 0;
16456 /* If top-line visibility has changed, give up. */
16457 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16458 != MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->mode_line_p)
16459 return 0;
16461 /* Give up if old or new display is scrolled vertically. We could
16462 make this function handle this, but right now it doesn't. */
16463 start_row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16464 if (w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row))
16465 return 0;
16467 /* The variable new_start now holds the new window start. The old
16468 start `start' can be determined from the current matrix. */
16469 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (new_start, w->start);
16470 start = start_row->minpos;
16471 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16473 /* Clear the desired matrix for the display below. */
16474 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16476 if (CHARPOS (new_start) <= CHARPOS (start))
16478 /* Don't use this method if the display starts with an ellipsis
16479 displayed for invisible text. It's not easy to handle that case
16480 below, and it's certainly not worth the effort since this is
16481 not a frequent case. */
16482 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (&start_row->start, w))
16483 return 0;
16485 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "twu1"));
16487 /* Display up to a row that can be reused. The variable
16488 last_text_row is set to the last row displayed that displays
16489 text. Note that it.vpos == 0 if or if not there is a
16490 header-line; it's not the same as the MATRIX_ROW_VPOS! */
16491 start_display (&it, w, new_start);
16492 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16493 last_text_row = last_reused_text_row = NULL;
16495 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
16496 && !fonts_changed_p)
16498 /* If we have reached into the characters in the START row,
16499 that means the line boundaries have changed. So we
16500 can't start copying with the row START. Maybe it will
16501 work to start copying with the following row. */
16502 while (IT_CHARPOS (it) > CHARPOS (start))
16504 /* Advance to the next row as the "start". */
16505 start_row++;
16506 start = start_row->minpos;
16507 /* If there are no more rows to try, or just one, give up. */
16508 if (start_row == MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix) - 1
16509 || w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row)
16510 || CHARPOS (start) == ZV)
16512 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16513 return 0;
16516 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16518 /* If we have reached alignment, we can copy the rest of the
16519 rows. */
16520 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == CHARPOS (start)
16521 /* Don't accept "alignment" inside a display vector,
16522 since start_row could have started in the middle of
16523 that same display vector (thus their character
16524 positions match), and we have no way of telling if
16525 that is the case. */
16526 && it.current.dpvec_index < 0)
16527 break;
16529 if (display_line (&it))
16530 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16534 /* A value of current_y < last_visible_y means that we stopped
16535 at the previous window start, which in turn means that we
16536 have at least one reusable row. */
16537 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16539 struct glyph_row *row;
16541 /* IT.vpos always starts from 0; it counts text lines. */
16542 nrows_scrolled = it.vpos - (start_row - MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix));
16544 /* Find PT if not already found in the lines displayed. */
16545 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16547 int dy = it.current_y - start_row->y;
16549 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16550 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, row, NULL, dy);
16551 if (row)
16552 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0,
16553 dy, nrows_scrolled);
16554 else
16556 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16557 return 0;
16561 /* Scroll the display. Do it before the current matrix is
16562 changed. The problem here is that update has not yet
16563 run, i.e. part of the current matrix is not up to date.
16564 scroll_run_hook will clear the cursor, and use the
16565 current matrix to get the height of the row the cursor is
16566 in. */
16567 run.current_y = start_row->y;
16568 run.desired_y = it.current_y;
16569 run.height = it.last_visible_y - it.current_y;
16571 if (run.height > 0 && run.current_y != run.desired_y)
16573 update_begin (f);
16574 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16575 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16576 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16577 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16578 update_end (f);
16581 /* Shift current matrix down by nrows_scrolled lines. */
16582 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16583 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16584 start_vpos,
16585 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16586 nrows_scrolled);
16588 /* Disable lines that must be updated. */
16589 for (i = 0; i < nrows_scrolled; ++i)
16590 (start_row + i)->enabled_p = 0;
16592 /* Re-compute Y positions. */
16593 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16594 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16595 for (row = start_row + nrows_scrolled;
16596 row < bottom_row;
16597 ++row)
16599 row->y = it.current_y;
16600 row->visible_height = row->height;
16602 if (row->y < min_y)
16603 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16604 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16605 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16606 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16607 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16609 it.current_y += row->height;
16611 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16612 last_reused_text_row = row;
16613 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it.last_visible_y)
16614 break;
16617 /* Disable lines in the current matrix which are now
16618 below the window. */
16619 for (++row; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16620 row->enabled_p = row->mode_line_p = 0;
16623 /* Update window_end_pos etc.; last_reused_text_row is the last
16624 reused row from the current matrix containing text, if any.
16625 The value of last_text_row is the last displayed line
16626 containing text. */
16627 if (last_reused_text_row)
16629 w->window_end_bytepos
16630 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_reused_text_row);
16631 wset_window_end_pos
16632 (w, make_number (Z
16633 - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_reused_text_row)));
16634 wset_window_end_vpos
16635 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_reused_text_row,
16636 w->current_matrix)));
16638 else if (last_text_row)
16640 w->window_end_bytepos
16641 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16642 wset_window_end_pos
16643 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16644 wset_window_end_vpos
16645 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row,
16646 w->desired_matrix)));
16648 else
16650 /* This window must be completely empty. */
16651 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16652 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - ZV));
16653 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (0));
16655 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16657 /* Update hint: don't try scrolling again in update_window. */
16658 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16660 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16661 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 1");
16662 #endif
16663 return 1;
16665 else if (CHARPOS (new_start) > CHARPOS (start))
16667 struct glyph_row *pt_row, *row;
16668 struct glyph_row *first_reusable_row;
16669 struct glyph_row *first_row_to_display;
16670 int dy;
16671 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16673 /* Find the row starting at new_start, if there is one. Don't
16674 reuse a partially visible line at the end. */
16675 first_reusable_row = start_row;
16676 while (first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16677 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) < yb
16678 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16679 < CHARPOS (new_start)))
16680 ++first_reusable_row;
16682 /* Give up if there is no row to reuse. */
16683 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) >= yb
16684 || !first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16685 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16686 != CHARPOS (new_start)))
16687 return 0;
16689 /* We can reuse fully visible rows beginning with
16690 first_reusable_row to the end of the window. Set
16691 first_row_to_display to the first row that cannot be reused.
16692 Set pt_row to the row containing point, if there is any. */
16693 pt_row = NULL;
16694 for (first_row_to_display = first_reusable_row;
16695 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_row_to_display) < yb;
16696 ++first_row_to_display)
16698 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16699 && (PT < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16700 || (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16701 && first_row_to_display->ends_at_zv_p
16702 && pt_row == NULL)))
16703 pt_row = first_row_to_display;
16706 /* Start displaying at the start of first_row_to_display. */
16707 eassert (first_row_to_display->y < yb);
16708 init_to_row_start (&it, w, first_row_to_display);
16710 nrows_scrolled = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_reusable_row, w->current_matrix)
16711 - start_vpos);
16712 it.vpos = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_row_to_display, w->current_matrix)
16713 - nrows_scrolled);
16714 it.current_y = (first_row_to_display->y - first_reusable_row->y
16715 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w));
16717 /* Display lines beginning with first_row_to_display in the
16718 desired matrix. Set last_text_row to the last row displayed
16719 that displays text. */
16720 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, it.vpos);
16721 if (pt_row == NULL)
16722 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16723 last_text_row = NULL;
16724 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y && !fonts_changed_p)
16725 if (display_line (&it))
16726 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16728 /* If point is in a reused row, adjust y and vpos of the cursor
16729 position. */
16730 if (pt_row)
16732 w->cursor.vpos -= nrows_scrolled;
16733 w->cursor.y -= first_reusable_row->y - start_row->y;
16736 /* Give up if point isn't in a row displayed or reused. (This
16737 also handles the case where w->cursor.vpos < nrows_scrolled
16738 after the calls to display_line, which can happen with scroll
16739 margins. See bug#1295.) */
16740 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16742 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16743 return 0;
16746 /* Scroll the display. */
16747 run.current_y = first_reusable_row->y;
16748 run.desired_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16749 run.height = it.last_visible_y - run.current_y;
16750 dy = run.current_y - run.desired_y;
16752 if (run.height)
16754 update_begin (f);
16755 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16756 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16757 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16758 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16759 update_end (f);
16762 /* Adjust Y positions of reused rows. */
16763 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16764 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16765 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16766 for (row = first_reusable_row; row < first_row_to_display; ++row)
16768 row->y -= dy;
16769 row->visible_height = row->height;
16770 if (row->y < min_y)
16771 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16772 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16773 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16774 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16775 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16778 /* Scroll the current matrix. */
16779 eassert (nrows_scrolled > 0);
16780 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16781 start_vpos,
16782 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16783 -nrows_scrolled);
16785 /* Disable rows not reused. */
16786 for (row -= nrows_scrolled; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16787 row->enabled_p = 0;
16789 /* Point may have moved to a different line, so we cannot assume that
16790 the previous cursor position is valid; locate the correct row. */
16791 if (pt_row)
16793 for (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
16794 row < bottom_row
16795 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
16796 && !row->ends_at_zv_p;
16797 row++)
16799 w->cursor.vpos++;
16800 w->cursor.y = row->y;
16802 if (row < bottom_row)
16804 /* Can't simply scan the row for point with
16805 bidi-reordered glyph rows. Let set_cursor_from_row
16806 figure out where to put the cursor, and if it fails,
16807 give up. */
16808 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
16810 if (!set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
16811 0, 0, 0, 0))
16813 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16814 return 0;
16817 else
16819 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
16820 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
16822 for (; glyph < end
16823 && (!BUFFERP (glyph->object)
16824 || glyph->charpos < PT);
16825 glyph++)
16827 w->cursor.hpos++;
16828 w->cursor.x += glyph->pixel_width;
16834 /* Adjust window end. A null value of last_text_row means that
16835 the window end is in reused rows which in turn means that
16836 only its vpos can have changed. */
16837 if (last_text_row)
16839 w->window_end_bytepos
16840 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16841 wset_window_end_pos
16842 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16843 wset_window_end_vpos
16844 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row,
16845 w->desired_matrix)));
16847 else
16849 wset_window_end_vpos
16850 (w, make_number (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) - nrows_scrolled));
16853 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16854 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16856 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16857 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 2");
16858 #endif
16859 return 1;
16862 return 0;
16867 /************************************************************************
16868 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has changed
16869 ************************************************************************/
16871 static struct glyph_row *find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *);
16872 static struct glyph_row *find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *,
16873 ptrdiff_t *, ptrdiff_t *);
16874 static struct glyph_row *
16875 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *, struct it *,
16876 struct glyph_row *);
16879 /* Return the last row in MATRIX displaying text. If row START is
16880 non-null, start searching with that row. IT gives the dimensions
16881 of the display. Value is null if matrix is empty; otherwise it is
16882 a pointer to the row found. */
16884 static struct glyph_row *
16885 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, struct it *it,
16886 struct glyph_row *start)
16888 struct glyph_row *row, *row_found;
16890 /* Set row_found to the last row in IT->w's current matrix
16891 displaying text. The loop looks funny but think of partially
16892 visible lines. */
16893 row_found = NULL;
16894 row = start ? start : MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (matrix);
16895 while (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16897 eassert (row->enabled_p);
16898 row_found = row;
16899 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it->last_visible_y)
16900 break;
16901 ++row;
16904 return row_found;
16908 /* Return the last row in the current matrix of W that is not affected
16909 by changes at the start of current_buffer that occurred since W's
16910 current matrix was built. Value is null if no such row exists.
16912 BEG_UNCHANGED us the number of characters unchanged at the start of
16913 current_buffer. BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED is the buffer position of the
16914 first changed character in current_buffer. Characters at positions <
16915 BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED are at the same buffer positions as they were
16916 when the current matrix was built. */
16918 static struct glyph_row *
16919 find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *w)
16921 ptrdiff_t first_changed_pos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
16922 struct glyph_row *row;
16923 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16924 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16926 /* Find the last row displaying unchanged text. */
16927 for (row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16928 MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
16929 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) < first_changed_pos;
16930 ++row)
16932 if (/* If row ends before first_changed_pos, it is unchanged,
16933 except in some case. */
16934 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) <= first_changed_pos
16935 /* When row ends in ZV and we write at ZV it is not
16936 unchanged. */
16937 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
16938 /* When first_changed_pos is the end of a continued line,
16939 row is not unchanged because it may be no longer
16940 continued. */
16941 && !(MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == first_changed_pos
16942 && (row->continued_p
16943 || row->exact_window_width_line_p))
16944 /* If ROW->end is beyond ZV, then ROW->end is outdated and
16945 needs to be recomputed, so don't consider this row as
16946 unchanged. This happens when the last line was
16947 bidi-reordered and was killed immediately before this
16948 redisplay cycle. In that case, ROW->end stores the
16949 buffer position of the first visual-order character of
16950 the killed text, which is now beyond ZV. */
16951 && CHARPOS (row->end.pos) <= ZV)
16952 row_found = row;
16954 /* Stop if last visible row. */
16955 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb)
16956 break;
16959 return row_found;
16963 /* Find the first glyph row in the current matrix of W that is not
16964 affected by changes at the end of current_buffer since the
16965 time W's current matrix was built.
16967 Return in *DELTA the number of chars by which buffer positions in
16968 unchanged text at the end of current_buffer must be adjusted.
16970 Return in *DELTA_BYTES the corresponding number of bytes.
16972 Value is null if no such row exists, i.e. all rows are affected by
16973 changes. */
16975 static struct glyph_row *
16976 find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *w,
16977 ptrdiff_t *delta, ptrdiff_t *delta_bytes)
16979 struct glyph_row *row;
16980 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16982 *delta = *delta_bytes = 0;
16984 /* Display must not have been paused, otherwise the current matrix
16985 is not up to date. */
16986 eassert (!NILP (w->window_end_valid));
16988 /* A value of window_end_pos >= END_UNCHANGED means that the window
16989 end is in the range of changed text. If so, there is no
16990 unchanged row at the end of W's current matrix. */
16991 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) >= END_UNCHANGED)
16992 return NULL;
16994 /* Set row to the last row in W's current matrix displaying text. */
16995 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
16997 /* If matrix is entirely empty, no unchanged row exists. */
16998 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
17000 /* The value of row is the last glyph row in the matrix having a
17001 meaningful buffer position in it. The end position of row
17002 corresponds to window_end_pos. This allows us to translate
17003 buffer positions in the current matrix to current buffer
17004 positions for characters not in changed text. */
17005 ptrdiff_t Z_old =
17006 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17007 ptrdiff_t Z_BYTE_old =
17008 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
17009 ptrdiff_t last_unchanged_pos, last_unchanged_pos_old;
17010 struct glyph_row *first_text_row
17011 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
17013 *delta = Z - Z_old;
17014 *delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
17016 /* Set last_unchanged_pos to the buffer position of the last
17017 character in the buffer that has not been changed. Z is the
17018 index + 1 of the last character in current_buffer, i.e. by
17019 subtracting END_UNCHANGED we get the index of the last
17020 unchanged character, and we have to add BEG to get its buffer
17021 position. */
17022 last_unchanged_pos = Z - END_UNCHANGED + BEG;
17023 last_unchanged_pos_old = last_unchanged_pos - *delta;
17025 /* Search backward from ROW for a row displaying a line that
17026 starts at a minimum position >= last_unchanged_pos_old. */
17027 for (; row > first_text_row; --row)
17029 /* This used to abort, but it can happen.
17030 It is ok to just stop the search instead here. KFS. */
17031 if (!row->enabled_p || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
17032 break;
17034 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) >= last_unchanged_pos_old)
17035 row_found = row;
17039 eassert (!row_found || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row_found));
17041 return row_found;
17045 /* Make sure that glyph rows in the current matrix of window W
17046 reference the same glyph memory as corresponding rows in the
17047 frame's frame matrix. This function is called after scrolling W's
17048 current matrix on a terminal frame in try_window_id and
17049 try_window_reusing_current_matrix. */
17051 static void
17052 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *w)
17054 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17055 struct glyph_row *window_row, *window_row_end, *frame_row;
17057 /* Preconditions: W must be a leaf window and full-width. Its frame
17058 must have a frame matrix. */
17059 eassert (NILP (w->hchild) && NILP (w->vchild));
17060 eassert (WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w));
17061 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
17063 /* If W is a full-width window, glyph pointers in W's current matrix
17064 have, by definition, to be the same as glyph pointers in the
17065 corresponding frame matrix. Note that frame matrices have no
17066 marginal areas (see build_frame_matrix). */
17067 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows;
17068 window_row_end = window_row + w->current_matrix->nrows;
17069 frame_row = f->current_matrix->rows + WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w);
17070 while (window_row < window_row_end)
17072 struct glyph *start = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA];
17073 struct glyph *end = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA];
17075 frame_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = start;
17076 frame_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = start;
17077 frame_row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = end;
17078 frame_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] = end;
17080 /* Disable frame rows whose corresponding window rows have
17081 been disabled in try_window_id. */
17082 if (!window_row->enabled_p)
17083 frame_row->enabled_p = 0;
17085 ++window_row, ++frame_row;
17090 /* Find the glyph row in window W containing CHARPOS. Consider all
17091 rows between START and END (not inclusive). END null means search
17092 all rows to the end of the display area of W. Value is the row
17093 containing CHARPOS or null. */
17095 struct glyph_row *
17096 row_containing_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos,
17097 struct glyph_row *start, struct glyph_row *end, int dy)
17099 struct glyph_row *row = start;
17100 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
17101 ptrdiff_t mindif = BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) + 1;
17102 int last_y;
17104 /* If we happen to start on a header-line, skip that. */
17105 if (row->mode_line_p)
17106 ++row;
17108 if ((end && row >= end) || !row->enabled_p)
17109 return NULL;
17111 last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - dy;
17113 while (1)
17115 /* Give up if we have gone too far. */
17116 if (end && row >= end)
17117 return NULL;
17118 /* This formerly returned if they were equal.
17119 I think that both quantities are of a "last plus one" type;
17120 if so, when they are equal, the row is within the screen. -- rms. */
17121 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y)
17122 return NULL;
17124 /* If it is in this row, return this row. */
17125 if (! (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < charpos
17126 || (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == charpos
17127 /* The end position of a row equals the start
17128 position of the next row. If CHARPOS is there, we
17129 would rather display it in the next line, except
17130 when this line ends in ZV. */
17131 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
17132 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
17133 && charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
17135 struct glyph *g;
17137 if (NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
17138 || (!best_row && !row->continued_p))
17139 return row;
17140 /* In bidi-reordered rows, there could be several rows
17141 occluding point, all of them belonging to the same
17142 continued line. We need to find the row which fits
17143 CHARPOS the best. */
17144 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17145 g < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
17146 g++)
17148 if (!STRINGP (g->object))
17150 if (g->charpos > 0 && eabs (g->charpos - charpos) < mindif)
17152 mindif = eabs (g->charpos - charpos);
17153 best_row = row;
17154 /* Exact match always wins. */
17155 if (mindif == 0)
17156 return best_row;
17161 else if (best_row && !row->continued_p)
17162 return best_row;
17163 ++row;
17168 /* Try to redisplay window W by reusing its existing display. W's
17169 current matrix must be up to date when this function is called,
17170 i.e. window_end_valid must not be nil.
17172 Value is
17174 1 if display has been updated
17175 0 if otherwise unsuccessful
17176 -1 if redisplay with same window start is known not to succeed
17178 The following steps are performed:
17180 1. Find the last row in the current matrix of W that is not
17181 affected by changes at the start of current_buffer. If no such row
17182 is found, give up.
17184 2. Find the first row in W's current matrix that is not affected by
17185 changes at the end of current_buffer. Maybe there is no such row.
17187 3. Display lines beginning with the row + 1 found in step 1 to the
17188 row found in step 2 or, if step 2 didn't find a row, to the end of
17189 the window.
17191 4. If cursor is not known to appear on the window, give up.
17193 5. If display stopped at the row found in step 2, scroll the
17194 display and current matrix as needed.
17196 6. Maybe display some lines at the end of W, if we must. This can
17197 happen under various circumstances, like a partially visible line
17198 becoming fully visible, or because newly displayed lines are displayed
17199 in smaller font sizes.
17201 7. Update W's window end information. */
17203 static int
17204 try_window_id (struct window *w)
17206 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17207 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = w->current_matrix;
17208 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix;
17209 struct glyph_row *last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17210 struct glyph_row *first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17211 struct glyph_row *row;
17212 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
17213 int bottom_vpos;
17214 struct it it;
17215 ptrdiff_t delta = 0, delta_bytes = 0, stop_pos;
17216 int dvpos, dy;
17217 struct text_pos start_pos;
17218 struct run run;
17219 int first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = 0;
17220 struct glyph_row *last_text_row, *last_text_row_at_end;
17221 struct text_pos start;
17222 ptrdiff_t first_changed_charpos, last_changed_charpos;
17224 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17225 if (inhibit_try_window_id)
17226 return 0;
17227 #endif
17229 /* This is handy for debugging. */
17230 #if 0
17231 #define GIVE_UP(X) \
17232 do { \
17233 fprintf (stderr, "try_window_id give up %d\n", (X)); \
17234 return 0; \
17235 } while (0)
17236 #else
17237 #define GIVE_UP(X) return 0
17238 #endif
17240 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
17242 /* Don't use this for mini-windows because these can show
17243 messages and mini-buffers, and we don't handle that here. */
17244 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
17245 GIVE_UP (1);
17247 /* This flag is used to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17248 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || cursor_type_changed)
17249 GIVE_UP (2);
17251 /* Verify that narrowing has not changed.
17252 Also verify that we were not told to prevent redisplay optimizations.
17253 It would be nice to further
17254 reduce the number of cases where this prevents try_window_id. */
17255 if (current_buffer->clip_changed
17256 || current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p)
17257 GIVE_UP (3);
17259 /* Window must either use window-based redisplay or be full width. */
17260 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
17261 && (!FRAME_LINE_INS_DEL_OK (f)
17262 || !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)))
17263 GIVE_UP (4);
17265 /* Give up if point is known NOT to appear in W. */
17266 if (PT < CHARPOS (start))
17267 GIVE_UP (5);
17269 /* Another way to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17270 if (w->last_modified == 0)
17271 GIVE_UP (6);
17273 /* Verify that window is not hscrolled. */
17274 if (w->hscroll != 0)
17275 GIVE_UP (7);
17277 /* Verify that display wasn't paused. */
17278 if (NILP (w->window_end_valid))
17279 GIVE_UP (8);
17281 /* Can't use this if highlighting a region because a cursor movement
17282 will do more than just set the cursor. */
17283 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
17284 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
17285 GIVE_UP (9);
17287 /* Likewise if highlighting trailing whitespace. */
17288 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
17289 GIVE_UP (11);
17291 /* Likewise if showing a region. */
17292 if (!NILP (w->region_showing))
17293 GIVE_UP (10);
17295 /* Can't use this if overlay arrow position and/or string have
17296 changed. */
17297 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
17298 GIVE_UP (12);
17300 /* When word-wrap is on, adding a space to the first word of a
17301 wrapped line can change the wrap position, altering the line
17302 above it. It might be worthwhile to handle this more
17303 intelligently, but for now just redisplay from scratch. */
17304 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), word_wrap)))
17305 GIVE_UP (21);
17307 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
17308 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
17309 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
17310 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
17311 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
17312 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
17313 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization and
17314 redisplay from scratch. */
17315 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
17316 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
17317 GIVE_UP (22);
17319 /* Make sure beg_unchanged and end_unchanged are up to date. Do it
17320 only if buffer has really changed. The reason is that the gap is
17321 initially at Z for freshly visited files. The code below would
17322 set end_unchanged to 0 in that case. */
17323 if (MODIFF > SAVE_MODIFF
17324 /* This seems to happen sometimes after saving a buffer. */
17325 || BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED > Z_BYTE)
17327 if (GPT - BEG < BEG_UNCHANGED)
17328 BEG_UNCHANGED = GPT - BEG;
17329 if (Z - GPT < END_UNCHANGED)
17330 END_UNCHANGED = Z - GPT;
17333 /* The position of the first and last character that has been changed. */
17334 first_changed_charpos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
17335 last_changed_charpos = Z - END_UNCHANGED;
17337 /* If window starts after a line end, and the last change is in
17338 front of that newline, then changes don't affect the display.
17339 This case happens with stealth-fontification. Note that although
17340 the display is unchanged, glyph positions in the matrix have to
17341 be adjusted, of course. */
17342 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17343 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
17344 && ((last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start)
17345 && CHARPOS (start) == BEGV)
17346 || (last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start) - 1
17347 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start) - 1) == '\n')))
17349 ptrdiff_t Z_old, Z_delta, Z_BYTE_old, Z_delta_bytes;
17350 struct glyph_row *r0;
17352 /* Compute how many chars/bytes have been added to or removed
17353 from the buffer. */
17354 Z_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17355 Z_BYTE_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
17356 Z_delta = Z - Z_old;
17357 Z_delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
17359 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17360 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17361 front of the window start. */
17362 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta)
17363 GIVE_UP (13);
17365 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17366 as is, after adjusting glyph positions. No need to compute
17367 the window end again, since its offset from Z hasn't changed. */
17368 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17369 if (CHARPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r0) + Z_delta
17370 && BYTEPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (r0) + Z_delta_bytes
17371 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17372 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta
17373 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17375 /* Adjust positions in the glyph matrix. */
17376 if (Z_delta || Z_delta_bytes)
17378 struct glyph_row *r1
17379 = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17380 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
17381 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r0, current_matrix),
17382 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, current_matrix),
17383 Z_delta, Z_delta_bytes);
17386 /* Set the cursor. */
17387 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17388 if (row)
17389 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17390 else
17391 emacs_abort ();
17392 return 1;
17396 /* Handle the case that changes are all below what is displayed in
17397 the window, and that PT is in the window. This shortcut cannot
17398 be taken if ZV is visible in the window, and text has been added
17399 there that is visible in the window. */
17400 if (first_changed_charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17401 /* ZV is not visible in the window, or there are no
17402 changes at ZV, actually. */
17403 && (current_matrix->zv > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17404 || first_changed_charpos == last_changed_charpos))
17406 struct glyph_row *r0;
17408 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17409 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17410 front of the window start. */
17411 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17412 GIVE_UP (14);
17414 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17415 as is, without changing glyph positions since no text has
17416 been added/removed in front of the window end. */
17417 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17418 if (TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, r0->minpos)
17419 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17420 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
17421 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17423 /* We have to compute the window end anew since text
17424 could have been added/removed after it. */
17425 wset_window_end_pos
17426 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17427 w->window_end_bytepos
17428 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17430 /* Set the cursor. */
17431 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17432 if (row)
17433 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17434 else
17435 emacs_abort ();
17436 return 2;
17440 /* Give up if window start is in the changed area.
17442 The condition used to read
17444 (BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED != Z - BEG && ...)
17446 but why that was tested escapes me at the moment. */
17447 if (CHARPOS (start) >= first_changed_charpos
17448 && CHARPOS (start) <= last_changed_charpos)
17449 GIVE_UP (15);
17451 /* Check that window start agrees with the start of the first glyph
17452 row in its current matrix. Check this after we know the window
17453 start is not in changed text, otherwise positions would not be
17454 comparable. */
17455 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17456 if (!TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, row->minpos))
17457 GIVE_UP (16);
17459 /* Give up if the window ends in strings. Overlay strings
17460 at the end are difficult to handle, so don't try. */
17461 row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17462 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17463 GIVE_UP (20);
17465 /* Compute the position at which we have to start displaying new
17466 lines. Some of the lines at the top of the window might be
17467 reusable because they are not displaying changed text. Find the
17468 last row in W's current matrix not affected by changes at the
17469 start of current_buffer. Value is null if changes start in the
17470 first line of window. */
17471 last_unchanged_at_beg_row = find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (w);
17472 if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17474 /* Avoid starting to display in the middle of a character, a TAB
17475 for instance. This is easier than to set up the iterator
17476 exactly, and it's not a frequent case, so the additional
17477 effort wouldn't really pay off. */
17478 while ((MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17479 || last_unchanged_at_beg_row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
17480 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row > w->current_matrix->rows)
17481 --last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17483 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row))
17484 GIVE_UP (17);
17486 if (init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_unchanged_at_beg_row) == 0)
17487 GIVE_UP (18);
17488 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17490 /* Start displaying new lines in the desired matrix at the same
17491 vpos we would use in the current matrix, i.e. below
17492 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17493 it.vpos = 1 + MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row,
17494 current_matrix);
17495 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17496 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17498 eassert (it.hpos == 0 && it.current_x == 0);
17500 else
17502 /* There are no reusable lines at the start of the window.
17503 Start displaying in the first text line. */
17504 start_display (&it, w, start);
17505 it.vpos = it.first_vpos;
17506 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17509 /* Find the first row that is not affected by changes at the end of
17510 the buffer. Value will be null if there is no unchanged row, in
17511 which case we must redisplay to the end of the window. delta
17512 will be set to the value by which buffer positions beginning with
17513 first_unchanged_at_end_row have to be adjusted due to text
17514 changes. */
17515 first_unchanged_at_end_row
17516 = find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (w, &delta, &delta_bytes);
17517 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta = delta);
17518 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta_bytes = delta_bytes);
17520 /* Set stop_pos to the buffer position up to which we will have to
17521 display new lines. If first_unchanged_at_end_row != NULL, this
17522 is the buffer position of the start of the line displayed in that
17523 row. For first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL, use 0 to indicate
17524 that we don't stop at a buffer position. */
17525 stop_pos = 0;
17526 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17528 eassert (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL
17529 || first_unchanged_at_end_row >= last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17531 /* If this is a continuation line, move forward to the next one
17532 that isn't. Changes in lines above affect this line.
17533 Caution: this may move first_unchanged_at_end_row to a row
17534 not displaying text. */
17535 while (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17536 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17537 && (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17538 < it.last_visible_y))
17539 ++first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17541 if (!MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17542 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17543 >= it.last_visible_y))
17544 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17545 else
17547 stop_pos = (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17548 + delta);
17549 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos
17550 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, current_matrix);
17551 eassert (stop_pos >= Z - END_UNCHANGED);
17554 else if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL)
17555 GIVE_UP (19);
17558 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17560 /* Either there is no unchanged row at the end, or the one we have
17561 now displays text. This is a necessary condition for the window
17562 end pos calculation at the end of this function. */
17563 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17564 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row));
17566 debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos
17567 = (last_unchanged_at_beg_row
17568 ? MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row, current_matrix)
17569 : -1);
17570 debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
17572 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
17575 /* Display new lines. Set last_text_row to the last new line
17576 displayed which has text on it, i.e. might end up as being the
17577 line where the window_end_vpos is. */
17578 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17579 last_text_row = NULL;
17580 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
17581 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17582 && !fonts_changed_p
17583 && (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17584 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < stop_pos))
17586 if (display_line (&it))
17587 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
17590 if (fonts_changed_p)
17591 return -1;
17594 /* Compute differences in buffer positions, y-positions etc. for
17595 lines reused at the bottom of the window. Compute what we can
17596 scroll. */
17597 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17598 /* No lines reused because we displayed everything up to the
17599 bottom of the window. */
17600 && it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
17602 dvpos = (it.vpos
17603 - MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row,
17604 current_matrix));
17605 dy = it.current_y - first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17606 run.current_y = first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17607 run.desired_y = run.current_y + dy;
17608 run.height = it.last_visible_y - max (run.current_y, run.desired_y);
17610 else
17612 delta = delta_bytes = dvpos = dy
17613 = run.current_y = run.desired_y = run.height = 0;
17614 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17616 IF_DEBUG (debug_dvpos = dvpos; debug_dy = dy);
17619 /* Find the cursor if not already found. We have to decide whether
17620 PT will appear on this window (it sometimes doesn't, but this is
17621 not a very frequent case.) This decision has to be made before
17622 the current matrix is altered. A value of cursor.vpos < 0 means
17623 that PT is either in one of the lines beginning at
17624 first_unchanged_at_end_row or below the window. Don't care for
17625 lines that might be displayed later at the window end; as
17626 mentioned, this is not a frequent case. */
17627 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17629 /* Cursor in unchanged rows at the top? */
17630 if (PT < CHARPOS (start_pos)
17631 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17633 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT,
17634 MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix),
17635 last_unchanged_at_beg_row + 1, 0);
17636 if (row)
17637 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17640 /* Start from first_unchanged_at_end_row looking for PT. */
17641 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17643 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT - delta,
17644 first_unchanged_at_end_row, NULL, 0);
17645 if (row)
17646 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, delta,
17647 delta_bytes, dy, dvpos);
17650 /* Give up if cursor was not found. */
17651 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17653 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17654 return -1;
17658 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
17660 int this_scroll_margin, cursor_height;
17662 this_scroll_margin =
17663 max (0, min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4));
17664 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it.f);
17665 cursor_height = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->height;
17667 if ((w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
17668 && CHARPOS (start) > BEGV)
17669 /* Old redisplay didn't take scroll margin into account at the bottom,
17670 but then global-hl-line-mode doesn't scroll. KFS 2004-06-14 */
17671 || (w->cursor.y + (make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p
17672 ? cursor_height + this_scroll_margin
17673 : 1)) > it.last_visible_y)
17675 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17676 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17677 return -1;
17681 /* Scroll the display. Do it before changing the current matrix so
17682 that xterm.c doesn't get confused about where the cursor glyph is
17683 found. */
17684 if (dy && run.height)
17686 update_begin (f);
17688 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17690 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
17691 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17692 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
17693 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
17695 else
17697 /* Terminal frame. In this case, dvpos gives the number of
17698 lines to scroll by; dvpos < 0 means scroll up. */
17699 int from_vpos
17700 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, w->current_matrix);
17701 int from = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w) + from_vpos;
17702 int end = (WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w)
17703 + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0)
17704 + window_internal_height (w));
17706 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS)
17707 x_clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17708 #endif
17709 /* Perform the operation on the screen. */
17710 if (dvpos > 0)
17712 /* Scroll last_unchanged_at_beg_row to the end of the
17713 window down dvpos lines. */
17714 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17716 /* On dumb terminals delete dvpos lines at the end
17717 before inserting dvpos empty lines. */
17718 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17719 ins_del_lines (f, end - dvpos, -dvpos);
17721 /* Insert dvpos empty lines in front of
17722 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17723 ins_del_lines (f, from, dvpos);
17725 else if (dvpos < 0)
17727 /* Scroll up last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos to the end of
17728 the window to last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos - |dvpos|. */
17729 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17731 /* Delete dvpos lines in front of
17732 last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos. ins_del_lines will set
17733 the cursor to the given vpos and emit |dvpos| delete
17734 line sequences. */
17735 ins_del_lines (f, from + dvpos, dvpos);
17737 /* On a dumb terminal insert dvpos empty lines at the
17738 end. */
17739 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17740 ins_del_lines (f, end + dvpos, -dvpos);
17743 set_terminal_window (f, 0);
17746 update_end (f);
17749 /* Shift reused rows of the current matrix to the right position.
17750 BOTTOM_ROW is the last + 1 row in the current matrix reserved for
17751 text. */
17752 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17753 bottom_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, current_matrix);
17754 if (dvpos < 0)
17756 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17757 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17758 clear_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, bottom_vpos + dvpos,
17759 bottom_vpos);
17761 else if (dvpos > 0)
17763 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17764 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17765 clear_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17766 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos);
17769 /* For frame-based redisplay, make sure that current frame and window
17770 matrix are in sync with respect to glyph memory. */
17771 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17772 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (w);
17774 /* Adjust buffer positions in reused rows. */
17775 if (delta || delta_bytes)
17776 increment_matrix_positions (current_matrix,
17777 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17778 bottom_vpos, delta, delta_bytes);
17780 /* Adjust Y positions. */
17781 if (dy)
17782 shift_glyph_matrix (w, current_matrix,
17783 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17784 bottom_vpos, dy);
17786 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17788 first_unchanged_at_end_row += dvpos;
17789 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row->y >= it.last_visible_y
17790 || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row))
17791 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17794 /* If scrolling up, there may be some lines to display at the end of
17795 the window. */
17796 last_text_row_at_end = NULL;
17797 if (dy < 0)
17799 /* Scrolling up can leave for example a partially visible line
17800 at the end of the window to be redisplayed. */
17801 /* Set last_row to the glyph row in the current matrix where the
17802 window end line is found. It has been moved up or down in
17803 the matrix by dvpos. */
17804 int last_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) + dvpos;
17805 struct glyph_row *last_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, last_vpos);
17807 /* If last_row is the window end line, it should display text. */
17808 eassert (last_row->displays_text_p);
17810 /* If window end line was partially visible before, begin
17811 displaying at that line. Otherwise begin displaying with the
17812 line following it. */
17813 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row) - dy >= it.last_visible_y)
17815 init_to_row_start (&it, w, last_row);
17816 it.vpos = last_vpos;
17817 it.current_y = last_row->y;
17819 else
17821 init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_row);
17822 it.vpos = 1 + last_vpos;
17823 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row);
17824 ++last_row;
17827 /* We may start in a continuation line. If so, we have to
17828 get the right continuation_lines_width and current_x. */
17829 it.continuation_lines_width = last_row->continuation_lines_width;
17830 it.hpos = it.current_x = 0;
17832 /* Display the rest of the lines at the window end. */
17833 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17834 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17835 && !fonts_changed_p)
17837 /* Is it always sure that the display agrees with lines in
17838 the current matrix? I don't think so, so we mark rows
17839 displayed invalid in the current matrix by setting their
17840 enabled_p flag to zero. */
17841 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, it.vpos)->enabled_p = 0;
17842 if (display_line (&it))
17843 last_text_row_at_end = it.glyph_row - 1;
17847 /* Update window_end_pos and window_end_vpos. */
17848 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17849 && !last_text_row_at_end)
17851 /* Window end line if one of the preserved rows from the current
17852 matrix. Set row to the last row displaying text in current
17853 matrix starting at first_unchanged_at_end_row, after
17854 scrolling. */
17855 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row->displays_text_p);
17856 row = find_last_row_displaying_text (w->current_matrix, &it,
17857 first_unchanged_at_end_row);
17858 eassert (row && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row));
17860 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17861 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17862 wset_window_end_vpos
17863 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix)));
17864 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17865 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "A"));
17867 else if (last_text_row_at_end)
17869 wset_window_end_pos
17870 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row_at_end)));
17871 w->window_end_bytepos
17872 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row_at_end);
17873 wset_window_end_vpos
17874 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row_at_end,
17875 desired_matrix)));
17876 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17877 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "B"));
17879 else if (last_text_row)
17881 /* We have displayed either to the end of the window or at the
17882 end of the window, i.e. the last row with text is to be found
17883 in the desired matrix. */
17884 wset_window_end_pos
17885 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
17886 w->window_end_bytepos
17887 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
17888 wset_window_end_vpos
17889 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, desired_matrix)));
17890 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17892 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17893 && last_text_row == NULL
17894 && last_text_row_at_end == NULL)
17896 /* Displayed to end of window, but no line containing text was
17897 displayed. Lines were deleted at the end of the window. */
17898 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
17899 int vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos);
17900 struct glyph_row *current_row = current_matrix->rows + vpos;
17901 struct glyph_row *desired_row = desired_matrix->rows + vpos;
17903 for (row = NULL;
17904 row == NULL && vpos >= first_vpos;
17905 --vpos, --current_row, --desired_row)
17907 if (desired_row->enabled_p)
17909 if (desired_row->displays_text_p)
17910 row = desired_row;
17912 else if (current_row->displays_text_p)
17913 row = current_row;
17916 eassert (row != NULL);
17917 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (vpos + 1));
17918 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17919 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17920 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17921 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "C"));
17923 else
17924 emacs_abort ();
17926 IF_DEBUG (debug_end_pos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17927 debug_end_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17929 /* Record that display has not been completed. */
17930 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
17931 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
17932 return 3;
17934 #undef GIVE_UP
17939 /***********************************************************************
17940 More debugging support
17941 ***********************************************************************/
17943 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17945 void dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *, int, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17946 void dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17947 void dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *, struct glyph *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17950 /* Dump the contents of glyph matrix MATRIX on stderr.
17952 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
17953 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
17954 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
17956 void
17957 dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int glyphs)
17959 int i;
17960 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i)
17961 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, i), i, glyphs);
17965 /* Dump contents of glyph GLYPH to stderr. ROW and AREA are
17966 the glyph row and area where the glyph comes from. */
17968 void
17969 dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *row, struct glyph *glyph, int area)
17971 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
17973 fprintf (stderr,
17974 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17975 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17976 'C',
17977 glyph->charpos,
17978 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17979 ? 'B'
17980 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17981 ? 'S'
17982 : '-')),
17983 glyph->pixel_width,
17984 glyph->u.ch,
17985 (glyph->u.ch < 0x80 && glyph->u.ch >= ' '
17986 ? glyph->u.ch
17987 : '.'),
17988 glyph->face_id,
17989 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17990 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17992 else if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
17994 fprintf (stderr,
17995 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17996 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17997 'S',
17998 glyph->charpos,
17999 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18000 ? 'B'
18001 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18002 ? 'S'
18003 : '-')),
18004 glyph->pixel_width,
18006 '.',
18007 glyph->face_id,
18008 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18009 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18011 else if (glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
18013 fprintf (stderr,
18014 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18015 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18016 'I',
18017 glyph->charpos,
18018 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18019 ? 'B'
18020 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18021 ? 'S'
18022 : '-')),
18023 glyph->pixel_width,
18024 glyph->u.img_id,
18025 '.',
18026 glyph->face_id,
18027 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18028 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18030 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
18032 fprintf (stderr,
18033 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x",
18034 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18035 '+',
18036 glyph->charpos,
18037 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18038 ? 'B'
18039 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18040 ? 'S'
18041 : '-')),
18042 glyph->pixel_width,
18043 glyph->u.cmp.id);
18044 if (glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
18045 fprintf (stderr,
18046 "[%d-%d]",
18047 glyph->slice.cmp.from, glyph->slice.cmp.to);
18048 fprintf (stderr, " . %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18049 glyph->face_id,
18050 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18051 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18056 /* Dump the contents of glyph row at VPOS in MATRIX to stderr.
18057 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
18058 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
18059 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
18061 void
18062 dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *row, int vpos, int glyphs)
18064 if (glyphs != 1)
18066 fprintf (stderr, "Row Start End Used oE><\\CTZFesm X Y W H V A P\n");
18067 fprintf (stderr, "======================================================================\n");
18069 fprintf (stderr, "%3d %5"pI"d %5"pI"d %4d %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d\
18070 %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d\n",
18071 vpos,
18072 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
18073 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row),
18074 row->used[TEXT_AREA],
18075 row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p,
18076 row->enabled_p,
18077 row->truncated_on_left_p,
18078 row->truncated_on_right_p,
18079 row->continued_p,
18080 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row),
18081 row->displays_text_p,
18082 row->ends_at_zv_p,
18083 row->fill_line_p,
18084 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p,
18085 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p,
18086 row->mouse_face_p,
18087 row->x,
18088 row->y,
18089 row->pixel_width,
18090 row->height,
18091 row->visible_height,
18092 row->ascent,
18093 row->phys_ascent);
18094 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pD"d %5"pD"d\t%5d\n", row->start.overlay_string_index,
18095 row->end.overlay_string_index,
18096 row->continuation_lines_width);
18097 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pI"d %5"pI"d\n",
18098 CHARPOS (row->start.string_pos),
18099 CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos));
18100 fprintf (stderr, "%9d %5d\n", row->start.dpvec_index,
18101 row->end.dpvec_index);
18104 if (glyphs > 1)
18106 int area;
18108 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18110 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area];
18111 struct glyph *glyph_end = glyph + row->used[area];
18113 /* Glyph for a line end in text. */
18114 if (area == TEXT_AREA && glyph == glyph_end && glyph->charpos > 0)
18115 ++glyph_end;
18117 if (glyph < glyph_end)
18118 fprintf (stderr, " Glyph Type Pos O W Code C Face LR\n");
18120 for (; glyph < glyph_end; ++glyph)
18121 dump_glyph (row, glyph, area);
18124 else if (glyphs == 1)
18126 int area;
18128 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18130 char *s = alloca (row->used[area] + 1);
18131 int i;
18133 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i)
18135 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area] + i;
18136 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18137 && glyph->u.ch < 0x80
18138 && glyph->u.ch >= ' ')
18139 s[i] = glyph->u.ch;
18140 else
18141 s[i] = '.';
18144 s[i] = '\0';
18145 fprintf (stderr, "%3d: (%d) '%s'\n", vpos, row->enabled_p, s);
18151 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-matrix", Fdump_glyph_matrix,
18152 Sdump_glyph_matrix, 0, 1, "p",
18153 doc: /* Dump the current matrix of the selected window to stderr.
18154 Shows contents of glyph row structures. With non-nil
18155 parameter GLYPHS, dump glyphs as well. If GLYPHS is 1 show
18156 glyphs in short form, otherwise show glyphs in long form. */)
18157 (Lisp_Object glyphs)
18159 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
18160 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
18162 fprintf (stderr, "PT = %"pI"d, BEGV = %"pI"d. ZV = %"pI"d\n",
18163 BUF_PT (buffer), BUF_BEGV (buffer), BUF_ZV (buffer));
18164 fprintf (stderr, "Cursor x = %d, y = %d, hpos = %d, vpos = %d\n",
18165 w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y, w->cursor.hpos, w->cursor.vpos);
18166 fprintf (stderr, "=============================================\n");
18167 dump_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix,
18168 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 0);
18169 return Qnil;
18173 DEFUN ("dump-frame-glyph-matrix", Fdump_frame_glyph_matrix,
18174 Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix, 0, 0, "", doc: /* */)
18175 (void)
18177 struct frame *f = XFRAME (selected_frame);
18178 dump_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix, 1);
18179 return Qnil;
18183 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-row", Fdump_glyph_row, Sdump_glyph_row, 1, 2, "",
18184 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW to stderr.
18185 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18186 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18187 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18188 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18190 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
18191 EMACS_INT vpos;
18193 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18194 matrix = XWINDOW (selected_window)->current_matrix;
18195 vpos = XINT (row);
18196 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < matrix->nrows)
18197 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, vpos),
18198 vpos,
18199 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18200 return Qnil;
18204 DEFUN ("dump-tool-bar-row", Fdump_tool_bar_row, Sdump_tool_bar_row, 1, 2, "",
18205 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW of the tool-bar of the current frame to stderr.
18206 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18207 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18208 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18209 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18211 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
18212 struct glyph_matrix *m = XWINDOW (sf->tool_bar_window)->current_matrix;
18213 EMACS_INT vpos;
18215 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18216 vpos = XINT (row);
18217 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < m->nrows)
18218 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (m, vpos), vpos,
18219 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18220 return Qnil;
18224 DEFUN ("trace-redisplay", Ftrace_redisplay, Strace_redisplay, 0, 1, "P",
18225 doc: /* Toggle tracing of redisplay.
18226 With ARG, turn tracing on if and only if ARG is positive. */)
18227 (Lisp_Object arg)
18229 if (NILP (arg))
18230 trace_redisplay_p = !trace_redisplay_p;
18231 else
18233 arg = Fprefix_numeric_value (arg);
18234 trace_redisplay_p = XINT (arg) > 0;
18237 return Qnil;
18241 DEFUN ("trace-to-stderr", Ftrace_to_stderr, Strace_to_stderr, 1, MANY, "",
18242 doc: /* Like `format', but print result to stderr.
18243 usage: (trace-to-stderr STRING &rest OBJECTS) */)
18244 (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
18246 Lisp_Object s = Fformat (nargs, args);
18247 fprintf (stderr, "%s", SDATA (s));
18248 return Qnil;
18251 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
18255 /***********************************************************************
18256 Building Desired Matrix Rows
18257 ***********************************************************************/
18259 /* Return a temporary glyph row holding the glyphs of an overlay arrow.
18260 Used for non-window-redisplay windows, and for windows w/o left fringe. */
18262 static struct glyph_row *
18263 get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *w, Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string)
18265 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
18266 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
18267 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
18268 const unsigned char *arrow_string = SDATA (overlay_arrow_string);
18269 int arrow_len = SCHARS (overlay_arrow_string);
18270 const unsigned char *arrow_end = arrow_string + arrow_len;
18271 const unsigned char *p;
18272 struct it it;
18273 int multibyte_p;
18274 int n_glyphs_before;
18276 set_buffer_temp (buffer);
18277 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, &scratch_glyph_row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18278 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18279 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, 0, 0);
18281 multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
18282 p = arrow_string;
18283 while (p < arrow_end)
18285 Lisp_Object face, ilisp;
18287 /* Get the next character. */
18288 if (multibyte_p)
18289 it.c = it.char_to_display = string_char_and_length (p, &it.len);
18290 else
18292 it.c = it.char_to_display = *p, it.len = 1;
18293 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it.c))
18294 it.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it.c);
18296 p += it.len;
18298 /* Get its face. */
18299 ilisp = make_number (p - arrow_string);
18300 face = Fget_text_property (ilisp, Qface, overlay_arrow_string);
18301 it.face_id = compute_char_face (f, it.char_to_display, face);
18303 /* Compute its width, get its glyphs. */
18304 n_glyphs_before = it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18305 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, -1, -1);
18306 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it);
18308 /* If this character doesn't fit any more in the line, we have
18309 to remove some glyphs. */
18310 if (it.current_x > it.last_visible_x)
18312 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
18313 break;
18317 set_buffer_temp (old);
18318 return it.glyph_row;
18322 /* Insert truncation glyphs at the start of IT->glyph_row. Which
18323 glyphs to insert is determined by produce_special_glyphs. */
18325 static void
18326 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *it)
18328 struct it truncate_it;
18329 struct glyph *from, *end, *to, *toend;
18331 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
18332 || (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18333 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0)
18334 || (it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18335 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0));
18337 /* Get the truncation glyphs. */
18338 truncate_it = *it;
18339 truncate_it.current_x = 0;
18340 truncate_it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
18341 truncate_it.glyph_row = &scratch_glyph_row;
18342 truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18343 CHARPOS (truncate_it.position) = BYTEPOS (truncate_it.position) = -1;
18344 truncate_it.object = make_number (0);
18345 produce_special_glyphs (&truncate_it, IT_TRUNCATION);
18347 /* Overwrite glyphs from IT with truncation glyphs. */
18348 if (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18350 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18352 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18353 end = from + tused;
18354 to = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18355 toend = to + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18356 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18358 /* On GUI frames, when variable-size fonts are displayed,
18359 the truncation glyphs may need more pixels than the row's
18360 glyphs they overwrite. We overwrite more glyphs to free
18361 enough screen real estate, and enlarge the stretch glyph
18362 on the right (see display_line), if there is one, to
18363 preserve the screen position of the truncation glyphs on
18364 the right. */
18365 int w = 0;
18366 struct glyph *g = to;
18367 short used;
18369 /* The first glyph could be partially visible, in which case
18370 it->glyph_row->x will be negative. But we want the left
18371 truncation glyphs to be aligned at the left margin of the
18372 window, so we override the x coordinate at which the row
18373 will begin. */
18374 it->glyph_row->x = 0;
18375 while (g < toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18377 w += g->pixel_width;
18378 ++g;
18380 if (g - to - tused > 0)
18382 memmove (to + tused, g, (toend - g) * sizeof(*g));
18383 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] -= g - to - tused;
18385 used = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18386 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18387 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18388 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].type
18389 == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18391 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18393 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].pixel_width += extra;
18397 while (from < end)
18398 *to++ = *from++;
18400 /* There may be padding glyphs left over. Overwrite them too. */
18401 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18403 while (to < toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18405 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18406 while (from < end)
18407 *to++ = *from++;
18411 if (to > toend)
18412 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = to - it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18414 else
18416 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18418 /* In R2L rows, overwrite the last (rightmost) glyphs, and do
18419 that back to front. */
18420 end = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18421 from = end + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18422 toend = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18423 to = toend + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18424 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18426 int w = 0;
18427 struct glyph *g = to;
18429 while (g >= toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18431 w += g->pixel_width;
18432 --g;
18434 if (to - g - tused > 0)
18435 to = g + tused;
18436 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18437 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18438 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18440 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18442 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].pixel_width += extra;
18446 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18447 *to-- = *from--;
18448 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18450 while (to >= toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18452 from =
18453 truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
18454 + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18455 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18456 *to-- = *from--;
18459 if (from >= end)
18461 /* Need to free some room before prepending additional
18462 glyphs. */
18463 int move_by = from - end + 1;
18464 struct glyph *g0 = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18465 struct glyph *g = g0 + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18467 for ( ; g >= g0; g--)
18468 g[move_by] = *g;
18469 while (from >= end)
18470 *to-- = *from--;
18471 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] += move_by;
18476 /* Compute the hash code for ROW. */
18477 unsigned
18478 row_hash (struct glyph_row *row)
18480 int area, k;
18481 unsigned hashval = 0;
18483 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18484 for (k = 0; k < row->used[area]; ++k)
18485 hashval = ((((hashval << 4) + (hashval >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff)
18486 + row->glyphs[area][k].u.val
18487 + row->glyphs[area][k].face_id
18488 + row->glyphs[area][k].padding_p
18489 + (row->glyphs[area][k].type << 2));
18491 return hashval;
18494 /* Compute the pixel height and width of IT->glyph_row.
18496 Most of the time, ascent and height of a display line will be equal
18497 to the max_ascent and max_height values of the display iterator
18498 structure. This is not the case if
18500 1. We hit ZV without displaying anything. In this case, max_ascent
18501 and max_height will be zero.
18503 2. We have some glyphs that don't contribute to the line height.
18504 (The glyph row flag contributes_to_line_height_p is for future
18505 pixmap extensions).
18507 The first case is easily covered by using default values because in
18508 these cases, the line height does not really matter, except that it
18509 must not be zero. */
18511 static void
18512 compute_line_metrics (struct it *it)
18514 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
18516 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18518 int i, min_y, max_y;
18520 /* The line may consist of one space only, that was added to
18521 place the cursor on it. If so, the row's height hasn't been
18522 computed yet. */
18523 if (row->height == 0)
18525 if (it->max_ascent + it->max_descent == 0)
18526 it->max_descent = it->max_phys_descent = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
18527 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
18528 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
18529 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
18530 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
18531 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
18534 /* Compute the width of this line. */
18535 row->pixel_width = row->x;
18536 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ++i)
18537 row->pixel_width += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
18539 eassert (row->pixel_width >= 0);
18540 eassert (row->ascent >= 0 && row->height > 0);
18542 row->overlapping_p = (MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row)
18543 || MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row));
18545 /* If first line's physical ascent is larger than its logical
18546 ascent, use the physical ascent, and make the row taller.
18547 This makes accented characters fully visible. */
18548 if (row == MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix)
18549 && row->phys_ascent > row->ascent)
18551 row->height += row->phys_ascent - row->ascent;
18552 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent;
18555 /* Compute how much of the line is visible. */
18556 row->visible_height = row->height;
18558 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (it->w);
18559 max_y = WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w);
18561 if (row->y < min_y)
18562 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
18563 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
18564 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
18566 else
18568 row->pixel_width = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18569 if (row->continued_p)
18570 row->pixel_width -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
18571 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
18572 row->pixel_width -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
18573 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
18574 row->height = row->phys_height = row->visible_height = 1;
18575 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
18578 /* Compute a hash code for this row. */
18579 row->hash = row_hash (row);
18581 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
18582 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
18586 /* Append one space to the glyph row of iterator IT if doing a
18587 window-based redisplay. The space has the same face as
18588 IT->face_id. Value is non-zero if a space was added.
18590 This function is called to make sure that there is always one glyph
18591 at the end of a glyph row that the cursor can be set on under
18592 window-systems. (If there weren't such a glyph we would not know
18593 how wide and tall a box cursor should be displayed).
18595 At the same time this space let's a nicely handle clearing to the
18596 end of the line if the row ends in italic text. */
18598 static int
18599 append_space_for_newline (struct it *it, int default_face_p)
18601 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18603 int n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18605 if (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n
18606 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
18608 /* Save some values that must not be changed.
18609 Must save IT->c and IT->len because otherwise
18610 ITERATOR_AT_END_P wouldn't work anymore after
18611 append_space_for_newline has been called. */
18612 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18613 int saved_c = it->c, saved_len = it->len;
18614 int saved_char_to_display = it->char_to_display;
18615 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18616 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18617 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18618 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18619 struct face *face;
18621 saved_object = it->object;
18622 saved_pos = it->position;
18624 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18625 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18626 it->object = make_number (0);
18627 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18628 it->len = 1;
18630 /* If the default face was remapped, be sure to use the
18631 remapped face for the appended newline. */
18632 if (default_face_p)
18633 it->face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18634 else if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18635 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
18636 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
18637 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18639 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18641 it->override_ascent = -1;
18642 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 0;
18643 it->current_x = saved_x;
18644 it->object = saved_object;
18645 it->position = saved_pos;
18646 it->what = saved_what;
18647 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18648 it->len = saved_len;
18649 it->c = saved_c;
18650 it->char_to_display = saved_char_to_display;
18651 return 1;
18655 return 0;
18659 /* Extend the face of the last glyph in the text area of IT->glyph_row
18660 to the end of the display line. Called from display_line. If the
18661 glyph row is empty, add a space glyph to it so that we know the
18662 face to draw. Set the glyph row flag fill_line_p. If the glyph
18663 row is R2L, prepend a stretch glyph to cover the empty space to the
18664 left of the leftmost glyph. */
18666 static void
18667 extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *it)
18669 struct face *face, *default_face;
18670 struct frame *f = it->f;
18672 /* If line is already filled, do nothing. Non window-system frames
18673 get a grace of one more ``pixel'' because their characters are
18674 1-``pixel'' wide, so they hit the equality too early. This grace
18675 is needed only for R2L rows that are not continued, to produce
18676 one extra blank where we could display the cursor. */
18677 if (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x
18678 + (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18679 && it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18680 && !it->glyph_row->continued_p))
18681 return;
18683 /* The default face, possibly remapped. */
18684 default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, lookup_basic_face (f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
18686 /* Face extension extends the background and box of IT->face_id
18687 to the end of the line. If the background equals the background
18688 of the frame, we don't have to do anything. */
18689 if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18690 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->saved_face_id);
18691 else
18692 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->face_id);
18694 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18695 && it->glyph_row->displays_text_p
18696 && face->box == FACE_NO_BOX
18697 && face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f)
18698 && !face->stipple
18699 && !it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18700 return;
18702 /* Set the glyph row flag indicating that the face of the last glyph
18703 in the text area has to be drawn to the end of the text area. */
18704 it->glyph_row->fill_line_p = 1;
18706 /* If current character of IT is not ASCII, make sure we have the
18707 ASCII face. This will be automatically undone the next time
18708 get_next_display_element returns a multibyte character. Note
18709 that the character will always be single byte in unibyte
18710 text. */
18711 if (!ASCII_CHAR_P (it->c))
18713 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18716 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
18718 /* If the row is empty, add a space with the current face of IT,
18719 so that we know which face to draw. */
18720 if (it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
18722 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0] = space_glyph;
18723 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0].face_id = face->id;
18724 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 1;
18726 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
18727 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18729 /* Prepend a stretch glyph to the row, such that the
18730 rightmost glyph will be drawn flushed all the way to the
18731 right margin of the window. The stretch glyph that will
18732 occupy the empty space, if any, to the left of the
18733 glyphs. */
18734 struct font *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (f);
18735 struct glyph *row_start = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18736 struct glyph *row_end = row_start + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18737 struct glyph *g;
18738 int row_width, stretch_ascent, stretch_width;
18739 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18740 int saved_face_id, saved_avoid_cursor;
18742 for (row_width = 0, g = row_start; g < row_end; g++)
18743 row_width += g->pixel_width;
18744 stretch_width = window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) - row_width;
18745 if (stretch_width > 0)
18747 stretch_ascent =
18748 (((it->ascent + it->descent)
18749 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
18750 saved_pos = it->position;
18751 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18752 saved_avoid_cursor = it->avoid_cursor_p;
18753 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
18754 saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18755 /* The last row's stretch glyph should get the default
18756 face, to avoid painting the rest of the window with
18757 the region face, if the region ends at ZV. */
18758 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18759 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18760 else
18761 it->face_id = face->id;
18762 append_stretch_glyph (it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
18763 it->ascent + it->descent, stretch_ascent);
18764 it->position = saved_pos;
18765 it->avoid_cursor_p = saved_avoid_cursor;
18766 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18769 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
18771 else
18773 /* Save some values that must not be changed. */
18774 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18775 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18776 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18777 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18778 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18780 saved_object = it->object;
18781 saved_pos = it->position;
18783 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18784 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18785 it->object = make_number (0);
18786 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18787 it->len = 1;
18788 /* The last row's blank glyphs should get the default face, to
18789 avoid painting the rest of the window with the region face,
18790 if the region ends at ZV. */
18791 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18792 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18793 else
18794 it->face_id = face->id;
18796 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18798 while (it->current_x <= it->last_visible_x)
18799 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18801 /* Don't count these blanks really. It would let us insert a left
18802 truncation glyph below and make us set the cursor on them, maybe. */
18803 it->current_x = saved_x;
18804 it->object = saved_object;
18805 it->position = saved_pos;
18806 it->what = saved_what;
18807 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18812 /* Value is non-zero if text starting at CHARPOS in current_buffer is
18813 trailing whitespace. */
18815 static int
18816 trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t charpos)
18818 ptrdiff_t bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
18819 int c = 0;
18821 while (bytepos < ZV_BYTE
18822 && (c = FETCH_CHAR (bytepos),
18823 c == ' ' || c == '\t'))
18824 ++bytepos;
18826 if (bytepos >= ZV_BYTE || c == '\n' || c == '\r')
18828 if (bytepos != PT_BYTE)
18829 return 1;
18831 return 0;
18835 /* Highlight trailing whitespace, if any, in ROW. */
18837 static void
18838 highlight_trailing_whitespace (struct frame *f, struct glyph_row *row)
18840 int used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18842 if (used)
18844 struct glyph *start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18845 struct glyph *glyph = start + used - 1;
18847 if (row->reversed_p)
18849 /* Right-to-left rows need to be processed in the opposite
18850 direction, so swap the edge pointers. */
18851 glyph = start;
18852 start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + used - 1;
18855 /* Skip over glyphs inserted to display the cursor at the
18856 end of a line, for extending the face of the last glyph
18857 to the end of the line on terminals, and for truncation
18858 and continuation glyphs. */
18859 if (!row->reversed_p)
18861 while (glyph >= start
18862 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18863 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18864 --glyph;
18866 else
18868 while (glyph <= start
18869 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18870 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18871 ++glyph;
18874 /* If last glyph is a space or stretch, and it's trailing
18875 whitespace, set the face of all trailing whitespace glyphs in
18876 IT->glyph_row to `trailing-whitespace'. */
18877 if ((row->reversed_p ? glyph <= start : glyph >= start)
18878 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18879 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18880 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18881 && glyph->u.ch == ' '))
18882 && trailing_whitespace_p (glyph->charpos))
18884 int face_id = lookup_named_face (f, Qtrailing_whitespace, 0);
18885 if (face_id < 0)
18886 return;
18888 if (!row->reversed_p)
18890 while (glyph >= start
18891 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18892 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18893 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18894 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18895 (glyph--)->face_id = face_id;
18897 else
18899 while (glyph <= start
18900 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18901 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18902 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18903 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18904 (glyph++)->face_id = face_id;
18911 /* Value is non-zero if glyph row ROW should be
18912 used to hold the cursor. */
18914 static int
18915 cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *row)
18917 int result = 1;
18919 if (PT == CHARPOS (row->end.pos)
18920 || PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
18922 /* Suppose the row ends on a string.
18923 Unless the row is continued, that means it ends on a newline
18924 in the string. If it's anything other than a display string
18925 (e.g., a before-string from an overlay), we don't want the
18926 cursor there. (This heuristic seems to give the optimal
18927 behavior for the various types of multi-line strings.)
18928 One exception: if the string has `cursor' property on one of
18929 its characters, we _do_ want the cursor there. */
18930 if (CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos) >= 0)
18932 if (row->continued_p)
18933 result = 1;
18934 else
18936 /* Check for `display' property. */
18937 struct glyph *beg = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18938 struct glyph *end = beg + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18939 struct glyph *glyph;
18941 result = 0;
18942 for (glyph = end; glyph >= beg; --glyph)
18943 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
18945 Lisp_Object prop
18946 = Fget_char_property (make_number (PT),
18947 Qdisplay, Qnil);
18948 result =
18949 (!NILP (prop)
18950 && display_prop_string_p (prop, glyph->object));
18951 /* If there's a `cursor' property on one of the
18952 string's characters, this row is a cursor row,
18953 even though this is not a display string. */
18954 if (!result)
18956 Lisp_Object s = glyph->object;
18958 for ( ; glyph >= beg && EQ (glyph->object, s); --glyph)
18960 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
18962 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
18963 Qcursor, s)))
18965 result = 1;
18966 break;
18970 break;
18974 else if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
18976 /* If the row ends in middle of a real character,
18977 and the line is continued, we want the cursor here.
18978 That's because CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) would equal
18979 PT if PT is before the character. */
18980 if (!row->ends_in_ellipsis_p)
18981 result = row->continued_p;
18982 else
18983 /* If the row ends in an ellipsis, then
18984 CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) will equal point after the
18985 invisible text. We want that position to be displayed
18986 after the ellipsis. */
18987 result = 0;
18989 /* If the row ends at ZV, display the cursor at the end of that
18990 row instead of at the start of the row below. */
18991 else if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
18992 result = 1;
18993 else
18994 result = 0;
18997 return result;
19002 /* Push the property PROP so that it will be rendered at the current
19003 position in IT. Return 1 if PROP was successfully pushed, 0
19004 otherwise. Called from handle_line_prefix to handle the
19005 `line-prefix' and `wrap-prefix' properties. */
19007 static int
19008 push_prefix_prop (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
19010 struct text_pos pos =
19011 STRINGP (it->string) ? it->current.string_pos : it->current.pos;
19013 eassert (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
19014 || it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
19015 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING);
19017 /* We need to save the current buffer/string position, so it will be
19018 restored by pop_it, because iterate_out_of_display_property
19019 depends on that being set correctly, but some situations leave
19020 it->position not yet set when this function is called. */
19021 push_it (it, &pos);
19023 if (STRINGP (prop))
19025 if (SCHARS (prop) == 0)
19027 pop_it (it);
19028 return 0;
19031 it->string = prop;
19032 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 1;
19033 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
19034 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
19035 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
19036 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
19037 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
19038 it->stop_charpos = 0;
19039 it->prev_stop = 0;
19040 it->base_level_stop = 0;
19042 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
19043 buffer/string. */
19044 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
19045 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
19046 else
19047 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
19049 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
19050 if (it->bidi_p)
19052 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
19053 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
19054 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
19055 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
19056 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
19057 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
19058 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
19061 else if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qspace))
19063 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
19064 it->object = prop;
19066 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
19067 else if (IMAGEP (prop))
19069 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
19070 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
19071 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
19073 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
19074 else
19076 pop_it (it); /* bogus display property, give up */
19077 return 0;
19080 return 1;
19083 /* Return the character-property PROP at the current position in IT. */
19085 static Lisp_Object
19086 get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
19088 Lisp_Object position;
19090 if (STRINGP (it->object))
19091 position = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
19092 else if (BUFFERP (it->object))
19093 position = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19094 else
19095 return Qnil;
19097 return Fget_char_property (position, prop, it->object);
19100 /* See if there's a line- or wrap-prefix, and if so, push it on IT. */
19102 static void
19103 handle_line_prefix (struct it *it)
19105 Lisp_Object prefix;
19107 if (it->continuation_lines_width > 0)
19109 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qwrap_prefix);
19110 if (NILP (prefix))
19111 prefix = Vwrap_prefix;
19113 else
19115 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qline_prefix);
19116 if (NILP (prefix))
19117 prefix = Vline_prefix;
19119 if (! NILP (prefix) && push_prefix_prop (it, prefix))
19121 /* If the prefix is wider than the window, and we try to wrap
19122 it, it would acquire its own wrap prefix, and so on till the
19123 iterator stack overflows. So, don't wrap the prefix. */
19124 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
19125 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
19131 /* Remove N glyphs at the start of a reversed IT->glyph_row. Called
19132 only for R2L lines from display_line and display_string, when they
19133 decide that too many glyphs were produced by PRODUCE_GLYPHS, and
19134 the line/string needs to be continued on the next glyph row. */
19135 static void
19136 unproduce_glyphs (struct it *it, int n)
19138 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
19140 eassert (it->glyph_row);
19141 eassert (it->glyph_row->reversed_p);
19142 eassert (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
19143 eassert (n <= it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
19145 if (n > it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19146 n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19147 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n;
19148 end = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19149 for ( ; glyph < end; glyph++)
19150 glyph[-n] = *glyph;
19153 /* Find the positions in a bidi-reordered ROW to serve as ROW->minpos
19154 and ROW->maxpos. */
19155 static void
19156 find_row_edges (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row,
19157 ptrdiff_t min_pos, ptrdiff_t min_bpos,
19158 ptrdiff_t max_pos, ptrdiff_t max_bpos)
19160 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
19161 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
19163 /* ROW->minpos is the value of min_pos, the minimal buffer position
19164 we have in ROW, or ROW->start.pos if that is smaller. */
19165 if (min_pos <= ZV && min_pos < row->start.pos.charpos)
19166 SET_TEXT_POS (row->minpos, min_pos, min_bpos);
19167 else
19168 /* We didn't find buffer positions smaller than ROW->start, or
19169 didn't find _any_ valid buffer positions in any of the glyphs,
19170 so we must trust the iterator's computed positions. */
19171 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19172 if (max_pos <= 0)
19174 max_pos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
19175 max_bpos = BYTEPOS (it->current.pos);
19178 /* Here are the various use-cases for ending the row, and the
19179 corresponding values for ROW->maxpos:
19181 Line ends in a newline from buffer eol_pos + 1
19182 Line is continued from buffer max_pos + 1
19183 Line is truncated on right it->current.pos
19184 Line ends in a newline from string max_pos + 1(*)
19185 (*) + 1 only when line ends in a forward scan
19186 Line is continued from string max_pos
19187 Line is continued from display vector max_pos
19188 Line is entirely from a string min_pos == max_pos
19189 Line is entirely from a display vector min_pos == max_pos
19190 Line that ends at ZV ZV
19192 If you discover other use-cases, please add them here as
19193 appropriate. */
19194 if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
19195 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19196 else if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19198 int seen_this_string = 0;
19199 struct glyph_row *r1 = row - 1;
19201 /* Did we see the same display string on the previous row? */
19202 if (STRINGP (it->object)
19203 /* this is not the first row */
19204 && row > it->w->desired_matrix->rows
19205 /* previous row is not the header line */
19206 && !r1->mode_line_p
19207 /* previous row also ends in a newline from a string */
19208 && r1->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
19210 struct glyph *start, *end;
19212 /* Search for the last glyph of the previous row that came
19213 from buffer or string. Depending on whether the row is
19214 L2R or R2L, we need to process it front to back or the
19215 other way round. */
19216 if (!r1->reversed_p)
19218 start = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19219 end = start + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19220 /* Glyphs inserted by redisplay have an integer (zero)
19221 as their object. */
19222 while (end > start
19223 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
19224 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
19225 --end;
19226 if (end > start)
19228 if (EQ ((end - 1)->object, it->object))
19229 seen_this_string = 1;
19231 else
19232 /* If all the glyphs of the previous row were inserted
19233 by redisplay, it means the previous row was
19234 produced from a single newline, which is only
19235 possible if that newline came from the same string
19236 as the one which produced this ROW. */
19237 seen_this_string = 1;
19239 else
19241 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
19242 start = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19243 while (end < start
19244 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
19245 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
19246 ++end;
19247 if (end < start)
19249 if (EQ ((end + 1)->object, it->object))
19250 seen_this_string = 1;
19252 else
19253 seen_this_string = 1;
19256 /* Take note of each display string that covers a newline only
19257 once, the first time we see it. This is for when a display
19258 string includes more than one newline in it. */
19259 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p && !seen_this_string)
19261 /* If we were scanning the buffer forward when we displayed
19262 the string, we want to account for at least one buffer
19263 position that belongs to this row (position covered by
19264 the display string), so that cursor positioning will
19265 consider this row as a candidate when point is at the end
19266 of the visual line represented by this row. This is not
19267 required when scanning back, because max_pos will already
19268 have a much larger value. */
19269 if (CHARPOS (row->end.pos) > max_pos)
19270 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19271 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19273 else if (CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) > 0)
19274 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos,
19275 CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1, BYTEPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1);
19276 else if (row->continued_p)
19278 /* If max_pos is different from IT's current position, it
19279 means IT->method does not belong to the display element
19280 at max_pos. However, it also means that the display
19281 element at max_pos was displayed in its entirety on this
19282 line, which is equivalent to saying that the next line
19283 starts at the next buffer position. */
19284 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == max_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19285 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19286 else
19288 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19289 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19292 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
19293 /* display_line already called reseat_at_next_visible_line_start,
19294 which puts the iterator at the beginning of the next line, in
19295 the logical order. */
19296 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19297 else if (max_pos == min_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19298 /* A line that is entirely from a string/image/stretch... */
19299 row->maxpos = row->minpos;
19300 else
19301 emacs_abort ();
19303 else
19304 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19307 /* Construct the glyph row IT->glyph_row in the desired matrix of
19308 IT->w from text at the current position of IT. See dispextern.h
19309 for an overview of struct it. Value is non-zero if
19310 IT->glyph_row displays text, as opposed to a line displaying ZV
19311 only. */
19313 static int
19314 display_line (struct it *it)
19316 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
19317 Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string;
19318 struct it wrap_it;
19319 void *wrap_data = NULL;
19320 int may_wrap = 0, wrap_x IF_LINT (= 0);
19321 int wrap_row_used = -1;
19322 int wrap_row_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19323 int wrap_row_phys_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_phys_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19324 int wrap_row_extra_line_spacing IF_LINT (= 0);
19325 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_min_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19326 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_max_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19327 int cvpos;
19328 ptrdiff_t min_pos = ZV + 1, max_pos = 0;
19329 ptrdiff_t min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0), max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19331 /* We always start displaying at hpos zero even if hscrolled. */
19332 eassert (it->hpos == 0 && it->current_x == 0);
19334 if (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, it->w->desired_matrix)
19335 >= it->w->desired_matrix->nrows)
19337 it->w->nrows_scale_factor++;
19338 fonts_changed_p = 1;
19339 return 0;
19342 /* Is IT->w showing the region? */
19343 wset_region_showing (it->w, it->region_beg_charpos > 0 ? Qt : Qnil);
19345 /* Clear the result glyph row and enable it. */
19346 prepare_desired_row (row);
19348 row->y = it->current_y;
19349 row->start = it->start;
19350 row->continuation_lines_width = it->continuation_lines_width;
19351 row->displays_text_p = 1;
19352 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p;
19353 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 0;
19355 /* Arrange the overlays nicely for our purposes. Usually, we call
19356 display_line on only one line at a time, in which case this
19357 can't really hurt too much, or we call it on lines which appear
19358 one after another in the buffer, in which case all calls to
19359 recenter_overlay_lists but the first will be pretty cheap. */
19360 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19362 /* Move over display elements that are not visible because we are
19363 hscrolled. This may stop at an x-position < IT->first_visible_x
19364 if the first glyph is partially visible or if we hit a line end. */
19365 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
19367 enum move_it_result move_result;
19369 this_line_min_pos = row->start.pos;
19370 move_result = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, ZV, it->first_visible_x,
19371 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
19372 /* If we are under a large hscroll, move_it_in_display_line_to
19373 could hit the end of the line without reaching
19374 it->first_visible_x. Pretend that we did reach it. This is
19375 especially important on a TTY, where we will call
19376 extend_face_to_end_of_line, which needs to know how many
19377 blank glyphs to produce. */
19378 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x
19379 && (move_result == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
19380 || move_result == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV))
19381 it->current_x = it->first_visible_x;
19383 /* Record the smallest positions seen while we moved over
19384 display elements that are not visible. This is needed by
19385 redisplay_internal for optimizing the case where the cursor
19386 stays inside the same line. The rest of this function only
19387 considers positions that are actually displayed, so
19388 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS will not otherwise record positions that
19389 are hscrolled to the left of the left edge of the window. */
19390 min_pos = CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19391 min_bpos = BYTEPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19393 else
19395 /* We only do this when not calling `move_it_in_display_line_to'
19396 above, because move_it_in_display_line_to calls
19397 handle_line_prefix itself. */
19398 handle_line_prefix (it);
19401 /* Get the initial row height. This is either the height of the
19402 text hscrolled, if there is any, or zero. */
19403 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
19404 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
19405 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19406 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
19407 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
19409 /* Utility macro to record max and min buffer positions seen until now. */
19410 #define RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS(IT) \
19411 do \
19413 int composition_p = !STRINGP ((IT)->string) \
19414 && ((IT)->what == IT_COMPOSITION); \
19415 ptrdiff_t current_pos = \
19416 composition_p ? (IT)->cmp_it.charpos \
19417 : IT_CHARPOS (*(IT)); \
19418 ptrdiff_t current_bpos = \
19419 composition_p ? CHAR_TO_BYTE (current_pos) \
19420 : IT_BYTEPOS (*(IT)); \
19421 if (current_pos < min_pos) \
19423 min_pos = current_pos; \
19424 min_bpos = current_bpos; \
19426 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > max_pos) \
19428 max_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it); \
19429 max_bpos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it); \
19432 while (0)
19434 /* Loop generating characters. The loop is left with IT on the next
19435 character to display. */
19436 while (1)
19438 int n_glyphs_before, hpos_before, x_before;
19439 int x, nglyphs;
19440 int ascent = 0, descent = 0, phys_ascent = 0, phys_descent = 0;
19442 /* Retrieve the next thing to display. Value is zero if end of
19443 buffer reached. */
19444 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19446 /* Maybe add a space at the end of this line that is used to
19447 display the cursor there under X. Set the charpos of the
19448 first glyph of blank lines not corresponding to any text
19449 to -1. */
19450 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19451 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19452 else if ((append_space_for_newline (it, 1) && row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 1)
19453 || row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
19455 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = -1;
19456 row->displays_text_p = 0;
19458 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (it->w->buffer), indicate_empty_lines))
19459 && (!MINI_WINDOW_P (it->w)
19460 || (minibuf_level && EQ (it->window, minibuf_window))))
19461 row->indicate_empty_line_p = 1;
19464 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19465 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19466 /* A row that displays right-to-left text must always have
19467 its last face extended all the way to the end of line,
19468 even if this row ends in ZV, because we still write to
19469 the screen left to right. We also need to extend the
19470 last face if the default face is remapped to some
19471 different face, otherwise the functions that clear
19472 portions of the screen will clear with the default face's
19473 background color. */
19474 if (row->reversed_p
19475 || lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID) != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
19476 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19477 break;
19480 /* Now, get the metrics of what we want to display. This also
19481 generates glyphs in `row' (which is IT->glyph_row). */
19482 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19483 x = it->current_x;
19485 /* Remember the line height so far in case the next element doesn't
19486 fit on the line. */
19487 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
19489 ascent = it->max_ascent;
19490 descent = it->max_descent;
19491 phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19492 phys_descent = it->max_phys_descent;
19494 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
19496 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
19497 may_wrap = 1;
19498 else if (may_wrap)
19500 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
19501 wrap_x = x;
19502 wrap_row_used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19503 wrap_row_ascent = row->ascent;
19504 wrap_row_height = row->height;
19505 wrap_row_phys_ascent = row->phys_ascent;
19506 wrap_row_phys_height = row->phys_height;
19507 wrap_row_extra_line_spacing = row->extra_line_spacing;
19508 wrap_row_min_pos = min_pos;
19509 wrap_row_min_bpos = min_bpos;
19510 wrap_row_max_pos = max_pos;
19511 wrap_row_max_bpos = max_bpos;
19512 may_wrap = 0;
19517 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
19519 /* If this display element was in marginal areas, continue with
19520 the next one. */
19521 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
19523 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19524 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19525 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19526 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19527 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19528 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19529 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19530 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19531 continue;
19534 /* Does the display element fit on the line? If we truncate
19535 lines, we should draw past the right edge of the window. If
19536 we don't truncate, we want to stop so that we can display the
19537 continuation glyph before the right margin. If lines are
19538 continued, there are two possible strategies for characters
19539 resulting in more than 1 glyph (e.g. tabs): Display as many
19540 glyphs as possible in this line and leave the rest for the
19541 continuation line, or display the whole element in the next
19542 line. Original redisplay did the former, so we do it also. */
19543 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
19544 hpos_before = it->hpos;
19545 x_before = x;
19547 if (/* Not a newline. */
19548 nglyphs > 0
19549 /* Glyphs produced fit entirely in the line. */
19550 && it->current_x < it->last_visible_x)
19552 it->hpos += nglyphs;
19553 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19554 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19555 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19556 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19557 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19558 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19559 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19560 if (it->current_x - it->pixel_width < it->first_visible_x)
19561 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19562 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions seen so
19563 far in glyphs that will be displayed by this row. */
19564 if (it->bidi_p)
19565 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19567 else
19569 int i, new_x;
19570 struct glyph *glyph;
19572 for (i = 0; i < nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
19574 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
19575 new_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
19577 if (/* Lines are continued. */
19578 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
19579 && (/* Glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
19580 new_x > it->last_visible_x
19581 /* Or it fits exactly on a window system frame. */
19582 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19583 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19584 && (row->reversed_p
19585 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19586 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
19588 /* End of a continued line. */
19590 if (it->hpos == 0
19591 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19592 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19593 && (row->reversed_p
19594 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19595 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w))))
19597 /* Current glyph is the only one on the line or
19598 fits exactly on the line. We must continue
19599 the line because we can't draw the cursor
19600 after the glyph. */
19601 row->continued_p = 1;
19602 it->current_x = new_x;
19603 it->continuation_lines_width += new_x;
19604 ++it->hpos;
19605 if (i == nglyphs - 1)
19607 /* If line-wrap is on, check if a previous
19608 wrap point was found. */
19609 if (wrap_row_used > 0
19610 /* Even if there is a previous wrap
19611 point, continue the line here as
19612 usual, if (i) the previous character
19613 was a space or tab AND (ii) the
19614 current character is not. */
19615 && (!may_wrap
19616 || IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it)))
19617 goto back_to_wrap;
19619 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer
19620 positions seen so far in glyphs that will be
19621 displayed by this row. */
19622 if (it->bidi_p)
19623 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19624 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19625 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19627 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19629 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19630 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19631 row->continued_p = 0;
19632 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19634 else if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19636 row->continued_p = 0;
19637 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19641 else if (it->bidi_p)
19642 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19644 else if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph)
19645 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19647 /* A padding glyph that doesn't fit on this line.
19648 This means the whole character doesn't fit
19649 on the line. */
19650 if (row->reversed_p)
19651 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19652 - n_glyphs_before);
19653 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
19655 /* Fill the rest of the row with continuation
19656 glyphs like in 20.x. */
19657 while (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19658 < row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
19659 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19661 row->continued_p = 1;
19662 it->current_x = x_before;
19663 it->continuation_lines_width += x_before;
19665 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19666 element not fitting on the line. */
19667 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19668 it->max_descent = descent;
19669 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19670 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19672 else if (wrap_row_used > 0)
19674 back_to_wrap:
19675 if (row->reversed_p)
19676 unproduce_glyphs (it,
19677 row->used[TEXT_AREA] - wrap_row_used);
19678 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
19679 it->continuation_lines_width += wrap_x;
19680 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = wrap_row_used;
19681 row->ascent = wrap_row_ascent;
19682 row->height = wrap_row_height;
19683 row->phys_ascent = wrap_row_phys_ascent;
19684 row->phys_height = wrap_row_phys_height;
19685 row->extra_line_spacing = wrap_row_extra_line_spacing;
19686 min_pos = wrap_row_min_pos;
19687 min_bpos = wrap_row_min_bpos;
19688 max_pos = wrap_row_max_pos;
19689 max_bpos = wrap_row_max_bpos;
19690 row->continued_p = 1;
19691 row->ends_at_zv_p = 0;
19692 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 0;
19693 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19695 /* Make sure that a non-default face is extended
19696 up to the right margin of the window. */
19697 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19699 else if (it->c == '\t' && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19701 /* A TAB that extends past the right edge of the
19702 window. This produces a single glyph on
19703 window system frames. We leave the glyph in
19704 this row and let it fill the row, but don't
19705 consume the TAB. */
19706 if ((row->reversed_p
19707 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19708 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19709 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19710 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
19711 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19712 row->continued_p = 1;
19713 glyph->pixel_width = it->last_visible_x - x;
19714 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19716 else
19718 /* Something other than a TAB that draws past
19719 the right edge of the window. Restore
19720 positions to values before the element. */
19721 if (row->reversed_p)
19722 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19723 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
19724 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
19726 /* Display continuation glyphs. */
19727 it->current_x = x_before;
19728 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19729 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19730 || (row->reversed_p
19731 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19732 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19733 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19734 row->continued_p = 1;
19736 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19738 if (nglyphs > 1 && i > 0)
19740 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19741 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19744 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19745 element not fitting on the line. */
19746 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19747 it->max_descent = descent;
19748 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19749 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19752 break;
19754 else if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
19756 /* Increment number of glyphs actually displayed. */
19757 ++it->hpos;
19759 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions
19760 seen so far in glyphs that will be displayed by
19761 this row. */
19762 if (it->bidi_p)
19763 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19765 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
19766 /* Glyph is partially visible, i.e. row starts at
19767 negative X position. */
19768 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19770 else
19772 /* Glyph is completely off the left margin of the
19773 window. This should not happen because of the
19774 move_it_in_display_line at the start of this
19775 function, unless the text display area of the
19776 window is empty. */
19777 eassert (it->first_visible_x <= it->last_visible_x);
19780 /* Even if this display element produced no glyphs at all,
19781 we want to record its position. */
19782 if (it->bidi_p && nglyphs == 0)
19783 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19785 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19786 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19787 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19788 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19789 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19790 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19791 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19793 /* End of this display line if row is continued. */
19794 if (row->continued_p || row->ends_at_zv_p)
19795 break;
19798 at_end_of_line:
19799 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're also done, after making
19800 sure that a non-default face is extended up to the right
19801 margin of the window. */
19802 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19804 int used_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19806 row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p = STRINGP (it->object);
19808 /* Add a space at the end of the line that is used to
19809 display the cursor there. */
19810 if (!IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19811 append_space_for_newline (it, 0);
19813 /* Extend the face to the end of the line. */
19814 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19816 /* Make sure we have the position. */
19817 if (used_before == 0)
19818 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
19820 /* Record the position of the newline, for use in
19821 find_row_edges. */
19822 it->eol_pos = it->current.pos;
19824 /* Consume the line end. This skips over invisible lines. */
19825 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19826 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19827 break;
19830 /* Proceed with next display element. Note that this skips
19831 over lines invisible because of selective display. */
19832 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19834 /* If we truncate lines, we are done when the last displayed
19835 glyphs reach past the right margin of the window. */
19836 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
19837 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19838 ? (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
19839 : (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)))
19841 /* Maybe add truncation glyphs. */
19842 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19843 || (row->reversed_p
19844 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19845 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19847 int i, n;
19849 if (!row->reversed_p)
19851 for (i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; i > 0; --i)
19852 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19853 break;
19855 else
19857 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
19858 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19859 break;
19860 /* Remove any padding glyphs at the front of ROW, to
19861 make room for the truncation glyphs we will be
19862 adding below. The loop below always inserts at
19863 least one truncation glyph, so also remove the
19864 last glyph added to ROW. */
19865 unproduce_glyphs (it, i + 1);
19866 /* Adjust i for the loop below. */
19867 i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (i + 1);
19870 it->current_x = x_before;
19871 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19873 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i < n; ++i)
19875 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19876 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19879 else
19881 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19882 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19885 else if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19887 /* Don't truncate if we can overflow newline into fringe. */
19888 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19890 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19891 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19892 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19893 break;
19895 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19897 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19898 goto at_end_of_line;
19900 it->current_x = x_before;
19903 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
19904 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19905 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
19906 row->ends_at_zv_p = FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n';
19907 it->hpos = hpos_before;
19908 break;
19912 if (wrap_data)
19913 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
19915 /* If line is not empty and hscrolled, maybe insert truncation glyphs
19916 at the left window margin. */
19917 if (it->first_visible_x
19918 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) != CHARPOS (row->start.pos))
19920 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19921 || (row->reversed_p
19922 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19923 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19924 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
19925 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
19928 /* Remember the position at which this line ends.
19930 BIDI Note: any code that needs MATRIX_ROW_START/END_CHARPOS
19931 cannot be before the call to find_row_edges below, since that is
19932 where these positions are determined. */
19933 row->end = it->current;
19934 if (!it->bidi_p)
19936 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19937 row->maxpos = row->end.pos;
19939 else
19941 /* ROW->minpos and ROW->maxpos must be the smallest and
19942 `1 + the largest' buffer positions in ROW. But if ROW was
19943 bidi-reordered, these two positions can be anywhere in the
19944 row, so we must determine them now. */
19945 find_row_edges (it, row, min_pos, min_bpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19948 /* If the start of this line is the overlay arrow-position, then
19949 mark this glyph row as the one containing the overlay arrow.
19950 This is clearly a mess with variable size fonts. It would be
19951 better to let it be displayed like cursors under X. */
19952 if ((row->displays_text_p || !overlay_arrow_seen)
19953 && (overlay_arrow_string = overlay_arrow_at_row (it, row),
19954 !NILP (overlay_arrow_string)))
19956 /* Overlay arrow in window redisplay is a fringe bitmap. */
19957 if (STRINGP (overlay_arrow_string))
19959 struct glyph_row *arrow_row
19960 = get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (it->w, overlay_arrow_string);
19961 struct glyph *glyph = arrow_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19962 struct glyph *arrow_end = glyph + arrow_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19963 struct glyph *p = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19964 struct glyph *p2, *end;
19966 /* Copy the arrow glyphs. */
19967 while (glyph < arrow_end)
19968 *p++ = *glyph++;
19970 /* Throw away padding glyphs. */
19971 p2 = p;
19972 end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19973 while (p2 < end && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*p2))
19974 ++p2;
19975 if (p2 > p)
19977 while (p2 < end)
19978 *p++ = *p2++;
19979 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = p2 - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19982 else
19984 eassert (INTEGERP (overlay_arrow_string));
19985 row->overlay_arrow_bitmap = XINT (overlay_arrow_string);
19987 overlay_arrow_seen = 1;
19990 /* Highlight trailing whitespace. */
19991 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
19992 highlight_trailing_whitespace (it->f, it->glyph_row);
19994 /* Compute pixel dimensions of this line. */
19995 compute_line_metrics (it);
19997 /* Implementation note: No changes in the glyphs of ROW or in their
19998 faces can be done past this point, because compute_line_metrics
19999 computes ROW's hash value and stores it within the glyph_row
20000 structure. */
20002 /* Record whether this row ends inside an ellipsis. */
20003 row->ends_in_ellipsis_p
20004 = (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
20005 && it->ellipsis_p);
20007 /* Save fringe bitmaps in this row. */
20008 row->left_user_fringe_bitmap = it->left_user_fringe_bitmap;
20009 row->left_user_fringe_face_id = it->left_user_fringe_face_id;
20010 row->right_user_fringe_bitmap = it->right_user_fringe_bitmap;
20011 row->right_user_fringe_face_id = it->right_user_fringe_face_id;
20013 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
20014 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
20015 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
20016 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
20018 /* Maybe set the cursor. */
20019 cvpos = it->w->cursor.vpos;
20020 if ((cvpos < 0
20021 /* In bidi-reordered rows, keep checking for proper cursor
20022 position even if one has been found already, because buffer
20023 positions in such rows change non-linearly with ROW->VPOS,
20024 when a line is continued. One exception: when we are at ZV,
20025 display cursor on the first suitable glyph row, since all
20026 the empty rows after that also have their position set to ZV. */
20027 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
20028 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
20029 || (it->bidi_p
20030 && !MATRIX_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, cvpos)->ends_at_zv_p))
20031 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
20032 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
20033 && cursor_row_p (row))
20034 set_cursor_from_row (it->w, row, it->w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
20036 /* Prepare for the next line. This line starts horizontally at (X
20037 HPOS) = (0 0). Vertical positions are incremented. As a
20038 convenience for the caller, IT->glyph_row is set to the next
20039 row to be used. */
20040 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
20041 it->current_y += row->height;
20042 SET_TEXT_POS (it->eol_pos, 0, 0);
20043 ++it->vpos;
20044 ++it->glyph_row;
20045 /* The next row should by default use the same value of the
20046 reversed_p flag as this one. set_iterator_to_next decides when
20047 it's a new paragraph, and PRODUCE_GLYPHS recomputes the value of
20048 the flag accordingly. */
20049 if (it->glyph_row < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, it->w))
20050 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = row->reversed_p;
20051 it->start = row->end;
20052 return row->displays_text_p;
20054 #undef RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS
20057 DEFUN ("current-bidi-paragraph-direction", Fcurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction,
20058 Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction, 0, 1, 0,
20059 doc: /* Return paragraph direction at point in BUFFER.
20060 Value is either `left-to-right' or `right-to-left'.
20061 If BUFFER is omitted or nil, it defaults to the current buffer.
20063 Paragraph direction determines how the text in the paragraph is displayed.
20064 In left-to-right paragraphs, text begins at the left margin of the window
20065 and the reading direction is generally left to right. In right-to-left
20066 paragraphs, text begins at the right margin and is read from right to left.
20068 See also `bidi-paragraph-direction'. */)
20069 (Lisp_Object buffer)
20071 struct buffer *buf = current_buffer;
20072 struct buffer *old = buf;
20074 if (! NILP (buffer))
20076 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
20077 buf = XBUFFER (buffer);
20080 if (NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_display_reordering))
20081 || NILP (BVAR (buf, enable_multibyte_characters))
20082 /* When we are loading loadup.el, the character property tables
20083 needed for bidi iteration are not yet available. */
20084 || !NILP (Vpurify_flag))
20085 return Qleft_to_right;
20086 else if (!NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction)))
20087 return BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction);
20088 else
20090 /* Determine the direction from buffer text. We could try to
20091 use current_matrix if it is up to date, but this seems fast
20092 enough as it is. */
20093 struct bidi_it itb;
20094 ptrdiff_t pos = BUF_PT (buf);
20095 ptrdiff_t bytepos = BUF_PT_BYTE (buf);
20096 int c;
20097 void *itb_data = bidi_shelve_cache ();
20099 set_buffer_temp (buf);
20100 /* bidi_paragraph_init finds the base direction of the paragraph
20101 by searching forward from paragraph start. We need the base
20102 direction of the current or _previous_ paragraph, so we need
20103 to make sure we are within that paragraph. To that end, find
20104 the previous non-empty line. */
20105 if (pos >= ZV && pos > BEGV)
20107 pos--;
20108 bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (pos);
20110 if (fast_looking_at (build_string ("[\f\t ]*\n"),
20111 pos, bytepos, ZV, ZV_BYTE, Qnil) > 0)
20113 while ((c = FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)) == '\n'
20114 || c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == '\f')
20116 if (bytepos <= BEGV_BYTE)
20117 break;
20118 bytepos--;
20119 pos--;
20121 while (!CHAR_HEAD_P (FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)))
20122 bytepos--;
20124 bidi_init_it (pos, bytepos, FRAME_WINDOW_P (SELECTED_FRAME ()), &itb);
20125 itb.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
20126 itb.string.s = NULL;
20127 itb.string.lstring = Qnil;
20128 itb.string.bufpos = 0;
20129 itb.string.unibyte = 0;
20130 bidi_paragraph_init (NEUTRAL_DIR, &itb, 1);
20131 bidi_unshelve_cache (itb_data, 0);
20132 set_buffer_temp (old);
20133 switch (itb.paragraph_dir)
20135 case L2R:
20136 return Qleft_to_right;
20137 break;
20138 case R2L:
20139 return Qright_to_left;
20140 break;
20141 default:
20142 emacs_abort ();
20149 /***********************************************************************
20150 Menu Bar
20151 ***********************************************************************/
20153 /* Redisplay the menu bar in the frame for window W.
20155 The menu bar of X frames that don't have X toolkit support is
20156 displayed in a special window W->frame->menu_bar_window.
20158 The menu bar of terminal frames is treated specially as far as
20159 glyph matrices are concerned. Menu bar lines are not part of
20160 windows, so the update is done directly on the frame matrix rows
20161 for the menu bar. */
20163 static void
20164 display_menu_bar (struct window *w)
20166 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
20167 struct it it;
20168 Lisp_Object items;
20169 int i;
20171 /* Don't do all this for graphical frames. */
20172 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
20173 if (FRAME_W32_P (f))
20174 return;
20175 #endif
20176 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
20177 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
20178 return;
20179 #endif
20181 #ifdef HAVE_NS
20182 if (FRAME_NS_P (f))
20183 return;
20184 #endif /* HAVE_NS */
20186 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
20187 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
20188 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows, MENU_FACE_ID);
20189 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20190 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20191 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
20192 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
20194 /* Menu bar lines are displayed in the desired matrix of the
20195 dummy window menu_bar_window. */
20196 struct window *menu_w;
20197 eassert (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window));
20198 menu_w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window);
20199 init_iterator (&it, menu_w, -1, -1, menu_w->desired_matrix->rows,
20200 MENU_FACE_ID);
20201 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20202 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20204 else
20206 /* This is a TTY frame, i.e. character hpos/vpos are used as
20207 pixel x/y. */
20208 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows,
20209 MENU_FACE_ID);
20210 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20211 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_COLS (f);
20213 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
20215 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. See the
20216 comments in redisplay_tool_bar and display_mode_line about
20217 this. */
20218 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20220 /* Clear all rows of the menu bar. */
20221 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f); ++i)
20223 struct glyph_row *row = it.glyph_row + i;
20224 clear_glyph_row (row);
20225 row->enabled_p = 1;
20226 row->full_width_p = 1;
20229 /* Display all items of the menu bar. */
20230 items = FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (it.f);
20231 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (items); i += 4)
20233 Lisp_Object string;
20235 /* Stop at nil string. */
20236 string = AREF (items, i + 1);
20237 if (NILP (string))
20238 break;
20240 /* Remember where item was displayed. */
20241 ASET (items, i + 3, make_number (it.hpos));
20243 /* Display the item, pad with one space. */
20244 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20245 display_string (NULL, string, Qnil, 0, 0, &it,
20246 SCHARS (string) + 1, 0, 0, -1);
20249 /* Fill out the line with spaces. */
20250 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20251 display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, -1, 0, 0, -1);
20253 /* Compute the total height of the lines. */
20254 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20259 /***********************************************************************
20260 Mode Line
20261 ***********************************************************************/
20263 /* Redisplay mode lines in the window tree whose root is WINDOW. If
20264 FORCE is non-zero, redisplay mode lines unconditionally.
20265 Otherwise, redisplay only mode lines that are garbaged. Value is
20266 the number of windows whose mode lines were redisplayed. */
20268 static int
20269 redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object window, int force)
20271 int nwindows = 0;
20273 while (!NILP (window))
20275 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
20277 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
20278 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->hchild, force);
20279 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
20280 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->vchild, force);
20281 else if (force
20282 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
20283 || !MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->enabled_p)
20285 struct text_pos lpoint;
20286 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
20288 /* Set the window's buffer for the mode line display. */
20289 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
20290 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
20292 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any
20293 other window, set up appropriate value. */
20294 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
20296 struct text_pos pt;
20298 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (pt, w->pointm);
20299 if (CHARPOS (pt) < BEGV)
20300 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
20301 else if (CHARPOS (pt) > (ZV - 1))
20302 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (ZV, ZV_BYTE);
20303 else
20304 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (pt), BYTEPOS (pt));
20307 /* Display mode lines. */
20308 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
20309 if (display_mode_lines (w))
20311 ++nwindows;
20312 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
20315 /* Restore old settings. */
20316 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
20317 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
20320 window = w->next;
20323 return nwindows;
20327 /* Display the mode and/or header line of window W. Value is the
20328 sum number of mode lines and header lines displayed. */
20330 static int
20331 display_mode_lines (struct window *w)
20333 Lisp_Object old_selected_window, old_selected_frame;
20334 int n = 0;
20336 old_selected_frame = selected_frame;
20337 selected_frame = w->frame;
20338 old_selected_window = selected_window;
20339 XSETWINDOW (selected_window, w);
20341 /* These will be set while the mode line specs are processed. */
20342 line_number_displayed = 0;
20343 wset_column_number_displayed (w, Qnil);
20345 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
20347 struct window *sel_w = XWINDOW (old_selected_window);
20349 /* Select mode line face based on the real selected window. */
20350 display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID_3 (sel_w, sel_w, w),
20351 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
20352 ++n;
20355 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
20357 display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
20358 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
20359 ++n;
20362 selected_frame = old_selected_frame;
20363 selected_window = old_selected_window;
20364 return n;
20368 /* Display mode or header line of window W. FACE_ID specifies which
20369 line to display; it is either MODE_LINE_FACE_ID or
20370 HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID. FORMAT is the mode/header line format to
20371 display. Value is the pixel height of the mode/header line
20372 displayed. */
20374 static int
20375 display_mode_line (struct window *w, enum face_id face_id, Lisp_Object format)
20377 struct it it;
20378 struct face *face;
20379 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
20381 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
20382 /* Don't extend on a previously drawn mode-line.
20383 This may happen if called from pos_visible_p. */
20384 it.glyph_row->enabled_p = 0;
20385 prepare_desired_row (it.glyph_row);
20387 it.glyph_row->mode_line_p = 1;
20389 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But
20390 supporting such an option is not trivial, since the mode line is
20391 made up of many separate strings. */
20392 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20394 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
20395 format_mode_line_unwind_data (NULL, NULL, Qnil, 0));
20397 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
20399 /* Temporarily make frame's keyboard the current kboard so that
20400 kboard-local variables in the mode_line_format will get the right
20401 values. */
20402 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
20403 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
20404 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
20405 pop_kboard ();
20407 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
20409 /* Fill up with spaces. */
20410 display_string (" ", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, 10000, -1, -1, 0);
20412 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20413 it.glyph_row->full_width_p = 1;
20414 it.glyph_row->continued_p = 0;
20415 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
20416 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
20418 /* Make a 3D mode-line have a shadow at its right end. */
20419 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it.f, face_id);
20420 extend_face_to_end_of_line (&it);
20421 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
20423 struct glyph *last = (it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20424 + it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1);
20425 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
20428 return it.glyph_row->height;
20431 /* Move element ELT in LIST to the front of LIST.
20432 Return the updated list. */
20434 static Lisp_Object
20435 move_elt_to_front (Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object list)
20437 register Lisp_Object tail, prev;
20438 register Lisp_Object tem;
20440 tail = list;
20441 prev = Qnil;
20442 while (CONSP (tail))
20444 tem = XCAR (tail);
20446 if (EQ (elt, tem))
20448 /* Splice out the link TAIL. */
20449 if (NILP (prev))
20450 list = XCDR (tail);
20451 else
20452 Fsetcdr (prev, XCDR (tail));
20454 /* Now make it the first. */
20455 Fsetcdr (tail, list);
20456 return tail;
20458 else
20459 prev = tail;
20460 tail = XCDR (tail);
20461 QUIT;
20464 /* Not found--return unchanged LIST. */
20465 return list;
20468 /* Contribute ELT to the mode line for window IT->w. How it
20469 translates into text depends on its data type.
20471 IT describes the display environment in which we display, as usual.
20473 DEPTH is the depth in recursion. It is used to prevent
20474 infinite recursion here.
20476 FIELD_WIDTH is the number of characters the display of ELT should
20477 occupy in the mode line, and PRECISION is the maximum number of
20478 characters to display from ELT's representation. See
20479 display_string for details.
20481 Returns the hpos of the end of the text generated by ELT.
20483 PROPS is a property list to add to any string we encounter.
20485 If RISKY is nonzero, remove (disregard) any properties in any string
20486 we encounter, and ignore :eval and :propertize.
20488 The global variable `mode_line_target' determines whether the
20489 output is passed to `store_mode_line_noprop',
20490 `store_mode_line_string', or `display_string'. */
20492 static int
20493 display_mode_element (struct it *it, int depth, int field_width, int precision,
20494 Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object props, int risky)
20496 int n = 0, field, prec;
20497 int literal = 0;
20499 tail_recurse:
20500 if (depth > 100)
20501 elt = build_string ("*too-deep*");
20503 depth++;
20505 switch (XTYPE (elt))
20507 case Lisp_String:
20509 /* A string: output it and check for %-constructs within it. */
20510 unsigned char c;
20511 ptrdiff_t offset = 0;
20513 if (SCHARS (elt) > 0
20514 && (!NILP (props) || risky))
20516 Lisp_Object oprops, aelt;
20517 oprops = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), elt);
20519 /* If the starting string's properties are not what
20520 we want, translate the string. Also, if the string
20521 is risky, do that anyway. */
20523 if (NILP (Fequal (props, oprops)) || risky)
20525 /* If the starting string has properties,
20526 merge the specified ones onto the existing ones. */
20527 if (! NILP (oprops) && !risky)
20529 Lisp_Object tem;
20531 oprops = Fcopy_sequence (oprops);
20532 tem = props;
20533 while (CONSP (tem))
20535 oprops = Fplist_put (oprops, XCAR (tem),
20536 XCAR (XCDR (tem)));
20537 tem = XCDR (XCDR (tem));
20539 props = oprops;
20542 aelt = Fassoc (elt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20543 if (! NILP (aelt) && !NILP (Fequal (props, XCDR (aelt))))
20545 /* AELT is what we want. Move it to the front
20546 without consing. */
20547 elt = XCAR (aelt);
20548 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20549 = move_elt_to_front (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20551 else
20553 Lisp_Object tem;
20555 /* If AELT has the wrong props, it is useless.
20556 so get rid of it. */
20557 if (! NILP (aelt))
20558 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20559 = Fdelq (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20561 elt = Fcopy_sequence (elt);
20562 Fset_text_properties (make_number (0), Flength (elt),
20563 props, elt);
20564 /* Add this item to mode_line_proptrans_alist. */
20565 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20566 = Fcons (Fcons (elt, props),
20567 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20568 /* Truncate mode_line_proptrans_alist
20569 to at most 50 elements. */
20570 tem = Fnthcdr (make_number (50),
20571 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20572 if (! NILP (tem))
20573 XSETCDR (tem, Qnil);
20578 offset = 0;
20580 if (literal)
20582 prec = precision - n;
20583 switch (mode_line_target)
20585 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20586 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20587 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt), -1, prec);
20588 break;
20589 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20590 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, elt, 1, 0, prec, Qnil);
20591 break;
20592 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20593 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, 0, it,
20594 0, prec, 0, STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20595 break;
20598 break;
20601 /* Handle the non-literal case. */
20603 while ((precision <= 0 || n < precision)
20604 && SREF (elt, offset) != 0
20605 && (mode_line_target != MODE_LINE_DISPLAY
20606 || it->current_x < it->last_visible_x))
20608 ptrdiff_t last_offset = offset;
20610 /* Advance to end of string or next format specifier. */
20611 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) != '\0' && c != '%')
20614 if (offset - 1 != last_offset)
20616 ptrdiff_t nchars, nbytes;
20618 /* Output to end of string or up to '%'. Field width
20619 is length of string. Don't output more than
20620 PRECISION allows us. */
20621 offset--;
20623 prec = c_string_width (SDATA (elt) + last_offset,
20624 offset - last_offset, precision - n,
20625 &nchars, &nbytes);
20627 switch (mode_line_target)
20629 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20630 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20631 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt) + last_offset, 0, prec);
20632 break;
20633 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20635 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
20636 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20637 ptrdiff_t endpos = (precision <= 0
20638 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, offset)
20639 : charpos + nchars);
20641 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL,
20642 Fsubstring (elt, make_number (charpos),
20643 make_number (endpos)),
20644 0, 0, 0, Qnil);
20646 break;
20647 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20649 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
20650 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20652 if (precision <= 0)
20653 nchars = string_byte_to_char (elt, offset) - charpos;
20654 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, charpos,
20655 it, 0, nchars, 0,
20656 STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20658 break;
20661 else /* c == '%' */
20663 ptrdiff_t percent_position = offset;
20665 /* Get the specified minimum width. Zero means
20666 don't pad. */
20667 field = 0;
20668 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) >= '0' && c <= '9')
20669 field = field * 10 + c - '0';
20671 /* Don't pad beyond the total padding allowed. */
20672 if (field_width - n > 0 && field > field_width - n)
20673 field = field_width - n;
20675 /* Note that either PRECISION <= 0 or N < PRECISION. */
20676 prec = precision - n;
20678 if (c == 'M')
20679 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field, prec,
20680 Vglobal_mode_string, props,
20681 risky);
20682 else if (c != 0)
20684 int multibyte;
20685 ptrdiff_t bytepos, charpos;
20686 const char *spec;
20687 Lisp_Object string;
20689 bytepos = percent_position;
20690 charpos = (STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt)
20691 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos)
20692 : bytepos);
20693 spec = decode_mode_spec (it->w, c, field, &string);
20694 multibyte = STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string);
20696 switch (mode_line_target)
20698 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20699 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20700 n += store_mode_line_noprop (spec, field, prec);
20701 break;
20702 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20704 Lisp_Object tem = build_string (spec);
20705 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (charpos), elt);
20706 /* Should only keep face property in props */
20707 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, tem, 0, field, prec, props);
20709 break;
20710 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20712 int nglyphs_before, nwritten;
20714 nglyphs_before = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
20715 nwritten = display_string (spec, string, elt,
20716 charpos, 0, it,
20717 field, prec, 0,
20718 multibyte);
20720 /* Assign to the glyphs written above the
20721 string where the `%x' came from, position
20722 of the `%'. */
20723 if (nwritten > 0)
20725 struct glyph *glyph
20726 = (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20727 + nglyphs_before);
20728 int i;
20730 for (i = 0; i < nwritten; ++i)
20732 glyph[i].object = elt;
20733 glyph[i].charpos = charpos;
20736 n += nwritten;
20739 break;
20742 else /* c == 0 */
20743 break;
20747 break;
20749 case Lisp_Symbol:
20750 /* A symbol: process the value of the symbol recursively
20751 as if it appeared here directly. Avoid error if symbol void.
20752 Special case: if value of symbol is a string, output the string
20753 literally. */
20755 register Lisp_Object tem;
20757 /* If the variable is not marked as risky to set
20758 then its contents are risky to use. */
20759 if (NILP (Fget (elt, Qrisky_local_variable)))
20760 risky = 1;
20762 tem = Fboundp (elt);
20763 if (!NILP (tem))
20765 tem = Fsymbol_value (elt);
20766 /* If value is a string, output that string literally:
20767 don't check for % within it. */
20768 if (STRINGP (tem))
20769 literal = 1;
20771 if (!EQ (tem, elt))
20773 /* Give up right away for nil or t. */
20774 elt = tem;
20775 goto tail_recurse;
20779 break;
20781 case Lisp_Cons:
20783 register Lisp_Object car, tem;
20785 /* A cons cell: five distinct cases.
20786 If first element is :eval or :propertize, do something special.
20787 If first element is a string or a cons, process all the elements
20788 and effectively concatenate them.
20789 If first element is a negative number, truncate displaying cdr to
20790 at most that many characters. If positive, pad (with spaces)
20791 to at least that many characters.
20792 If first element is a symbol, process the cadr or caddr recursively
20793 according to whether the symbol's value is non-nil or nil. */
20794 car = XCAR (elt);
20795 if (EQ (car, QCeval))
20797 /* An element of the form (:eval FORM) means evaluate FORM
20798 and use the result as mode line elements. */
20800 if (risky)
20801 break;
20803 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20805 Lisp_Object spec;
20806 spec = safe_eval (XCAR (XCDR (elt)));
20807 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20808 precision - n, spec, props,
20809 risky);
20812 else if (EQ (car, QCpropertize))
20814 /* An element of the form (:propertize ELT PROPS...)
20815 means display ELT but applying properties PROPS. */
20817 if (risky)
20818 break;
20820 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20821 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20822 precision - n, XCAR (XCDR (elt)),
20823 XCDR (XCDR (elt)), risky);
20825 else if (SYMBOLP (car))
20827 tem = Fboundp (car);
20828 elt = XCDR (elt);
20829 if (!CONSP (elt))
20830 goto invalid;
20831 /* elt is now the cdr, and we know it is a cons cell.
20832 Use its car if CAR has a non-nil value. */
20833 if (!NILP (tem))
20835 tem = Fsymbol_value (car);
20836 if (!NILP (tem))
20838 elt = XCAR (elt);
20839 goto tail_recurse;
20842 /* Symbol's value is nil (or symbol is unbound)
20843 Get the cddr of the original list
20844 and if possible find the caddr and use that. */
20845 elt = XCDR (elt);
20846 if (NILP (elt))
20847 break;
20848 else if (!CONSP (elt))
20849 goto invalid;
20850 elt = XCAR (elt);
20851 goto tail_recurse;
20853 else if (INTEGERP (car))
20855 register int lim = XINT (car);
20856 elt = XCDR (elt);
20857 if (lim < 0)
20859 /* Negative int means reduce maximum width. */
20860 if (precision <= 0)
20861 precision = -lim;
20862 else
20863 precision = min (precision, -lim);
20865 else if (lim > 0)
20867 /* Padding specified. Don't let it be more than
20868 current maximum. */
20869 if (precision > 0)
20870 lim = min (precision, lim);
20872 /* If that's more padding than already wanted, queue it.
20873 But don't reduce padding already specified even if
20874 that is beyond the current truncation point. */
20875 field_width = max (lim, field_width);
20877 goto tail_recurse;
20879 else if (STRINGP (car) || CONSP (car))
20881 Lisp_Object halftail = elt;
20882 int len = 0;
20884 while (CONSP (elt)
20885 && (precision <= 0 || n < precision))
20887 n += display_mode_element (it, depth,
20888 /* Do padding only after the last
20889 element in the list. */
20890 (! CONSP (XCDR (elt))
20891 ? field_width - n
20892 : 0),
20893 precision - n, XCAR (elt),
20894 props, risky);
20895 elt = XCDR (elt);
20896 len++;
20897 if ((len & 1) == 0)
20898 halftail = XCDR (halftail);
20899 /* Check for cycle. */
20900 if (EQ (halftail, elt))
20901 break;
20905 break;
20907 default:
20908 invalid:
20909 elt = build_string ("*invalid*");
20910 goto tail_recurse;
20913 /* Pad to FIELD_WIDTH. */
20914 if (field_width > 0 && n < field_width)
20916 switch (mode_line_target)
20918 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20919 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20920 n += store_mode_line_noprop ("", field_width - n, 0);
20921 break;
20922 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20923 n += store_mode_line_string ("", Qnil, 0, field_width - n, 0, Qnil);
20924 break;
20925 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20926 n += display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, it, field_width - n,
20927 0, 0, 0);
20928 break;
20932 return n;
20935 /* Store a mode-line string element in mode_line_string_list.
20937 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
20938 string LISP_STRING is displayed.
20940 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
20941 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
20942 with spaces. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
20944 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
20945 STRING. PRECISION <= 0 means don't truncate the string.
20947 If COPY_STRING is non-zero, make a copy of LISP_STRING before adding
20948 properties to the string.
20950 PROPS are the properties to add to the string.
20951 The mode_line_string_face face property is always added to the string.
20954 static int
20955 store_mode_line_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, int copy_string,
20956 int field_width, int precision, Lisp_Object props)
20958 ptrdiff_t len;
20959 int n = 0;
20961 if (string != NULL)
20963 len = strlen (string);
20964 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20965 len = precision;
20966 lisp_string = make_string (string, len);
20967 if (NILP (props))
20968 props = mode_line_string_face_prop;
20969 else if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20971 Lisp_Object face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20972 props = Fcopy_sequence (props);
20973 if (NILP (face))
20974 face = mode_line_string_face;
20975 else
20976 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
20977 props = Fplist_put (props, Qface, face);
20979 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
20980 props, lisp_string);
20982 else
20984 len = XFASTINT (Flength (lisp_string));
20985 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20987 len = precision;
20988 lisp_string = Fsubstring (lisp_string, make_number (0), make_number (len));
20989 precision = -1;
20991 if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20993 Lisp_Object face;
20994 if (NILP (props))
20995 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), lisp_string);
20996 face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20997 if (NILP (face))
20998 face = mode_line_string_face;
20999 else
21000 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
21001 props = Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil));
21002 if (copy_string)
21003 lisp_string = Fcopy_sequence (lisp_string);
21005 if (!NILP (props))
21006 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
21007 props, lisp_string);
21010 if (len > 0)
21012 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
21013 n += len;
21016 if (field_width > len)
21018 field_width -= len;
21019 lisp_string = Fmake_string (make_number (field_width), make_number (' '));
21020 if (!NILP (props))
21021 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (field_width),
21022 props, lisp_string);
21023 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
21024 n += field_width;
21027 return n;
21031 DEFUN ("format-mode-line", Fformat_mode_line, Sformat_mode_line,
21032 1, 4, 0,
21033 doc: /* Format a string out of a mode line format specification.
21034 First arg FORMAT specifies the mode line format (see `mode-line-format'
21035 for details) to use.
21037 By default, the format is evaluated for the currently selected window.
21039 Optional second arg FACE specifies the face property to put on all
21040 characters for which no face is specified. The value nil means the
21041 default face. The value t means whatever face the window's mode line
21042 currently uses (either `mode-line' or `mode-line-inactive',
21043 depending on whether the window is the selected window or not).
21044 An integer value means the value string has no text
21045 properties.
21047 Optional third and fourth args WINDOW and BUFFER specify the window
21048 and buffer to use as the context for the formatting (defaults
21049 are the selected window and the WINDOW's buffer). */)
21050 (Lisp_Object format, Lisp_Object face,
21051 Lisp_Object window, Lisp_Object buffer)
21053 struct it it;
21054 int len;
21055 struct window *w;
21056 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
21057 int face_id;
21058 int no_props = INTEGERP (face);
21059 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
21060 Lisp_Object str;
21061 int string_start = 0;
21063 w = decode_any_window (window);
21064 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
21066 if (NILP (buffer))
21067 buffer = w->buffer;
21068 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
21070 /* Make formatting the modeline a non-op when noninteractive, otherwise
21071 there will be problems later caused by a partially initialized frame. */
21072 if (NILP (format) || noninteractive)
21073 return empty_unibyte_string;
21075 if (no_props)
21076 face = Qnil;
21078 face_id = (NILP (face) || EQ (face, Qdefault)) ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
21079 : EQ (face, Qt) ? (EQ (window, selected_window)
21080 ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID : MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
21081 : EQ (face, Qmode_line) ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
21082 : EQ (face, Qmode_line_inactive) ? MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID
21083 : EQ (face, Qheader_line) ? HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID
21084 : EQ (face, Qtool_bar) ? TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
21085 : DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
21087 old_buffer = current_buffer;
21089 /* Save things including mode_line_proptrans_alist,
21090 and set that to nil so that we don't alter the outer value. */
21091 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
21092 format_mode_line_unwind_data
21093 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)),
21094 old_buffer, selected_window, 1));
21095 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
21097 Fselect_window (window, Qt);
21098 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
21100 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
21102 if (no_props)
21104 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_NOPROP;
21105 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
21106 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21107 string_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
21109 else
21111 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_STRING;
21112 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21113 mode_line_string_face = face;
21114 mode_line_string_face_prop
21115 = (NILP (face) ? Qnil : Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil)));
21118 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
21119 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
21120 pop_kboard ();
21122 if (no_props)
21124 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (string_start);
21125 str = make_string (mode_line_noprop_buf + string_start, len);
21127 else
21129 mode_line_string_list = Fnreverse (mode_line_string_list);
21130 str = Fmapconcat (intern ("identity"), mode_line_string_list,
21131 empty_unibyte_string);
21134 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21135 return str;
21138 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal representation of
21139 the positive integer D to BUF using a minimal field width WIDTH. */
21141 static void
21142 pint2str (register char *buf, register int width, register ptrdiff_t d)
21144 register char *p = buf;
21146 if (d <= 0)
21147 *p++ = '0';
21148 else
21150 while (d > 0)
21152 *p++ = d % 10 + '0';
21153 d /= 10;
21157 for (width -= (int) (p - buf); width > 0; --width)
21158 *p++ = ' ';
21159 *p-- = '\0';
21160 while (p > buf)
21162 d = *buf;
21163 *buf++ = *p;
21164 *p-- = d;
21168 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal and "human
21169 readable" representation of the nonnegative integer D to BUF using
21170 a minimal field width WIDTH. D should be smaller than 999.5e24. */
21172 static const char power_letter[] =
21174 0, /* no letter */
21175 'k', /* kilo */
21176 'M', /* mega */
21177 'G', /* giga */
21178 'T', /* tera */
21179 'P', /* peta */
21180 'E', /* exa */
21181 'Z', /* zetta */
21182 'Y' /* yotta */
21185 static void
21186 pint2hrstr (char *buf, int width, ptrdiff_t d)
21188 /* We aim to represent the nonnegative integer D as
21189 QUOTIENT.TENTHS * 10 ^ (3 * EXPONENT). */
21190 ptrdiff_t quotient = d;
21191 int remainder = 0;
21192 /* -1 means: do not use TENTHS. */
21193 int tenths = -1;
21194 int exponent = 0;
21196 /* Length of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21197 int length;
21199 char * psuffix;
21200 char * p;
21202 if (1000 <= quotient)
21204 /* Scale to the appropriate EXPONENT. */
21207 remainder = quotient % 1000;
21208 quotient /= 1000;
21209 exponent++;
21211 while (1000 <= quotient);
21213 /* Round to nearest and decide whether to use TENTHS or not. */
21214 if (quotient <= 9)
21216 tenths = remainder / 100;
21217 if (50 <= remainder % 100)
21219 if (tenths < 9)
21220 tenths++;
21221 else
21223 quotient++;
21224 if (quotient == 10)
21225 tenths = -1;
21226 else
21227 tenths = 0;
21231 else
21232 if (500 <= remainder)
21234 if (quotient < 999)
21235 quotient++;
21236 else
21238 quotient = 1;
21239 exponent++;
21240 tenths = 0;
21245 /* Calculate the LENGTH of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21246 if (tenths == -1 && quotient <= 99)
21247 if (quotient <= 9)
21248 length = 1;
21249 else
21250 length = 2;
21251 else
21252 length = 3;
21253 p = psuffix = buf + max (width, length);
21255 /* Print EXPONENT. */
21256 *psuffix++ = power_letter[exponent];
21257 *psuffix = '\0';
21259 /* Print TENTHS. */
21260 if (tenths >= 0)
21262 *--p = '0' + tenths;
21263 *--p = '.';
21266 /* Print QUOTIENT. */
21269 int digit = quotient % 10;
21270 *--p = '0' + digit;
21272 while ((quotient /= 10) != 0);
21274 /* Print leading spaces. */
21275 while (buf < p)
21276 *--p = ' ';
21279 /* Set a mnemonic character for coding_system (Lisp symbol) in BUF.
21280 If EOL_FLAG is 1, set also a mnemonic character for end-of-line
21281 type of CODING_SYSTEM. Return updated pointer into BUF. */
21283 static unsigned char invalid_eol_type[] = "(*invalid*)";
21285 static char *
21286 decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object coding_system, register char *buf, int eol_flag)
21288 Lisp_Object val;
21289 int multibyte = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
21290 const unsigned char *eol_str;
21291 int eol_str_len;
21292 /* The EOL conversion we are using. */
21293 Lisp_Object eoltype;
21295 val = CODING_SYSTEM_SPEC (coding_system);
21296 eoltype = Qnil;
21298 if (!VECTORP (val)) /* Not yet decided. */
21300 *buf++ = multibyte ? '-' : ' ';
21301 if (eol_flag)
21302 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21303 /* Don't mention EOL conversion if it isn't decided. */
21305 else
21307 Lisp_Object attrs;
21308 Lisp_Object eolvalue;
21310 attrs = AREF (val, 0);
21311 eolvalue = AREF (val, 2);
21313 *buf++ = multibyte
21314 ? XFASTINT (CODING_ATTR_MNEMONIC (attrs))
21315 : ' ';
21317 if (eol_flag)
21319 /* The EOL conversion that is normal on this system. */
21321 if (NILP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21322 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21323 else if (VECTORP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21324 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21325 else /* eolvalue is Qunix, Qdos, or Qmac. */
21326 eoltype = (EQ (eolvalue, Qunix)
21327 ? eol_mnemonic_unix
21328 : (EQ (eolvalue, Qdos) == 1
21329 ? eol_mnemonic_dos : eol_mnemonic_mac));
21333 if (eol_flag)
21335 /* Mention the EOL conversion if it is not the usual one. */
21336 if (STRINGP (eoltype))
21338 eol_str = SDATA (eoltype);
21339 eol_str_len = SBYTES (eoltype);
21341 else if (CHARACTERP (eoltype))
21343 unsigned char *tmp = alloca (MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH);
21344 int c = XFASTINT (eoltype);
21345 eol_str_len = CHAR_STRING (c, tmp);
21346 eol_str = tmp;
21348 else
21350 eol_str = invalid_eol_type;
21351 eol_str_len = sizeof (invalid_eol_type) - 1;
21353 memcpy (buf, eol_str, eol_str_len);
21354 buf += eol_str_len;
21357 return buf;
21360 /* Return a string for the output of a mode line %-spec for window W,
21361 generated by character C. FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad the string
21362 returned with spaces to that value. Return a Lisp string in
21363 *STRING if the resulting string is taken from that Lisp string.
21365 Note we operate on the current buffer for most purposes,
21366 the exception being w->base_line_pos. */
21368 static char lots_of_dashes[] = "--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------";
21370 static const char *
21371 decode_mode_spec (struct window *w, register int c, int field_width,
21372 Lisp_Object *string)
21374 Lisp_Object obj;
21375 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
21376 char *decode_mode_spec_buf = f->decode_mode_spec_buffer;
21377 /* We are going to use f->decode_mode_spec_buffer as the buffer to
21378 produce strings from numerical values, so limit preposterously
21379 large values of FIELD_WIDTH to avoid overrunning the buffer's
21380 end. The size of the buffer is enough for FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE
21381 bytes plus the terminating null. */
21382 int width = min (field_width, FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f));
21383 struct buffer *b = current_buffer;
21385 obj = Qnil;
21386 *string = Qnil;
21388 switch (c)
21390 case '*':
21391 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
21392 return "%";
21393 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21394 return "*";
21395 return "-";
21397 case '+':
21398 /* This differs from %* only for a modified read-only buffer. */
21399 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21400 return "*";
21401 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
21402 return "%";
21403 return "-";
21405 case '&':
21406 /* This differs from %* in ignoring read-only-ness. */
21407 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21408 return "*";
21409 return "-";
21411 case '%':
21412 return "%";
21414 case '[':
21416 int i;
21417 char *p;
21419 if (command_loop_level > 5)
21420 return "[[[... ";
21421 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21422 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
21423 *p++ = '[';
21424 *p = 0;
21425 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21428 case ']':
21430 int i;
21431 char *p;
21433 if (command_loop_level > 5)
21434 return " ...]]]";
21435 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21436 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
21437 *p++ = ']';
21438 *p = 0;
21439 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21442 case '-':
21444 register int i;
21446 /* Let lots_of_dashes be a string of infinite length. */
21447 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_NOPROP ||
21448 mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_STRING)
21449 return "--";
21450 if (field_width <= 0
21451 || field_width > sizeof (lots_of_dashes))
21453 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) - 1; ++i)
21454 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '-';
21455 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '\0';
21456 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21458 else
21459 return lots_of_dashes;
21462 case 'b':
21463 obj = BVAR (b, name);
21464 break;
21466 case 'c':
21467 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'.
21468 (In redisplay_internal, the frame title is drawn _before_ the
21469 windows are updated, so the stuff which depends on actual
21470 window contents (such as %l) may fail to render properly, or
21471 even crash emacs.) */
21472 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
21473 return "";
21474 else
21476 ptrdiff_t col = current_column ();
21477 wset_column_number_displayed (w, make_number (col));
21478 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, col);
21479 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21482 case 'e':
21483 #ifndef SYSTEM_MALLOC
21485 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
21486 return "";
21487 else
21488 return "!MEM FULL! ";
21490 #else
21491 return "";
21492 #endif
21494 case 'F':
21495 /* %F displays the frame name. */
21496 if (!NILP (f->title))
21497 return SSDATA (f->title);
21498 if (f->explicit_name || ! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21499 return SSDATA (f->name);
21500 return "Emacs";
21502 case 'f':
21503 obj = BVAR (b, filename);
21504 break;
21506 case 'i':
21508 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
21509 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, size);
21510 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21513 case 'I':
21515 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
21516 pint2hrstr (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, size);
21517 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21520 case 'l':
21522 ptrdiff_t startpos, startpos_byte, line, linepos, linepos_byte;
21523 ptrdiff_t topline, nlines, height;
21524 ptrdiff_t junk;
21526 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'. */
21527 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
21528 return "";
21530 startpos = XMARKER (w->start)->charpos;
21531 startpos_byte = marker_byte_position (w->start);
21532 height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
21534 /* If we decided that this buffer isn't suitable for line numbers,
21535 don't forget that too fast. */
21536 if (EQ (w->base_line_pos, w->buffer))
21537 goto no_value;
21538 /* But do forget it, if the window shows a different buffer now. */
21539 else if (BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
21540 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
21542 /* If the buffer is very big, don't waste time. */
21543 if (INTEGERP (Vline_number_display_limit)
21544 && BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b) > XINT (Vline_number_display_limit))
21546 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
21547 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
21548 goto no_value;
21551 if (INTEGERP (w->base_line_number)
21552 && INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
21553 && XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos) <= startpos)
21555 line = XFASTINT (w->base_line_number);
21556 linepos = XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos);
21557 linepos_byte = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (b, linepos);
21559 else
21561 line = 1;
21562 linepos = BUF_BEGV (b);
21563 linepos_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
21566 /* Count lines from base line to window start position. */
21567 nlines = display_count_lines (linepos_byte,
21568 startpos_byte,
21569 startpos, &junk);
21571 topline = nlines + line;
21573 /* Determine a new base line, if the old one is too close
21574 or too far away, or if we did not have one.
21575 "Too close" means it's plausible a scroll-down would
21576 go back past it. */
21577 if (startpos == BUF_BEGV (b))
21579 wset_base_line_number (w, make_number (topline));
21580 wset_base_line_pos (w, make_number (BUF_BEGV (b)));
21582 else if (nlines < height + 25 || nlines > height * 3 + 50
21583 || linepos == BUF_BEGV (b))
21585 ptrdiff_t limit = BUF_BEGV (b);
21586 ptrdiff_t limit_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
21587 ptrdiff_t position;
21588 ptrdiff_t distance =
21589 (height * 2 + 30) * line_number_display_limit_width;
21591 if (startpos - distance > limit)
21593 limit = startpos - distance;
21594 limit_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
21597 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
21598 limit_byte,
21599 - (height * 2 + 30),
21600 &position);
21601 /* If we couldn't find the lines we wanted within
21602 line_number_display_limit_width chars per line,
21603 give up on line numbers for this window. */
21604 if (position == limit_byte && limit == startpos - distance)
21606 wset_base_line_pos (w, w->buffer);
21607 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
21608 goto no_value;
21611 wset_base_line_number (w, make_number (topline - nlines));
21612 wset_base_line_pos (w, make_number (BYTE_TO_CHAR (position)));
21615 /* Now count lines from the start pos to point. */
21616 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
21617 PT_BYTE, PT, &junk);
21619 /* Record that we did display the line number. */
21620 line_number_displayed = 1;
21622 /* Make the string to show. */
21623 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, topline + nlines);
21624 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21625 no_value:
21627 char* p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21628 int pad = width - 2;
21629 while (pad-- > 0)
21630 *p++ = ' ';
21631 *p++ = '?';
21632 *p++ = '?';
21633 *p = '\0';
21634 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21637 break;
21639 case 'm':
21640 obj = BVAR (b, mode_name);
21641 break;
21643 case 'n':
21644 if (BUF_BEGV (b) > BUF_BEG (b) || BUF_ZV (b) < BUF_Z (b))
21645 return " Narrow";
21646 break;
21648 case 'p':
21650 ptrdiff_t pos = marker_position (w->start);
21651 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21653 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= BUF_Z (b) - BUF_ZV (b))
21655 if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21656 return "All";
21657 else
21658 return "Bottom";
21660 else if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21661 return "Top";
21662 else
21664 if (total > 1000000)
21665 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21666 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21667 else
21668 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21669 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21670 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21671 if (total == 100)
21672 total = 99;
21673 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
21674 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21678 /* Display percentage of size above the bottom of the screen. */
21679 case 'P':
21681 ptrdiff_t toppos = marker_position (w->start);
21682 ptrdiff_t botpos = BUF_Z (b) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
21683 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21685 if (botpos >= BUF_ZV (b))
21687 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21688 return "All";
21689 else
21690 return "Bottom";
21692 else
21694 if (total > 1000000)
21695 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21696 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21697 else
21698 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21699 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21700 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21701 if (total == 100)
21702 total = 99;
21703 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21704 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "Top%2"pD"d%%", total);
21705 else
21706 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
21707 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21711 case 's':
21712 /* status of process */
21713 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21714 if (NILP (obj))
21715 return "no process";
21716 #ifndef MSDOS
21717 obj = Fsymbol_name (Fprocess_status (obj));
21718 #endif
21719 break;
21721 case '@':
21723 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
21724 Lisp_Object val = call1 (intern ("file-remote-p"),
21725 BVAR (current_buffer, directory));
21726 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21728 if (NILP (val))
21729 return "-";
21730 else
21731 return "@";
21734 case 't': /* indicate TEXT or BINARY */
21735 return "T";
21737 case 'z':
21738 /* coding-system (not including end-of-line format) */
21739 case 'Z':
21740 /* coding-system (including end-of-line type) */
21742 int eol_flag = (c == 'Z');
21743 char *p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21745 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21747 /* No need to mention EOL here--the terminal never needs
21748 to do EOL conversion. */
21749 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21750 (FRAME_KEYBOARD_CODING (f)->id),
21751 p, 0);
21752 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21753 (FRAME_TERMINAL_CODING (f)->id),
21754 p, 0);
21756 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (BVAR (b, buffer_file_coding_system),
21757 p, eol_flag);
21759 #if 0 /* This proves to be annoying; I think we can do without. -- rms. */
21760 #ifdef subprocesses
21761 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21762 if (PROCESSP (obj))
21764 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
21765 (XPROCESS (obj)->decode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
21766 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
21767 (XPROCESS (obj)->encode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
21769 #endif /* subprocesses */
21770 #endif /* 0 */
21771 *p = 0;
21772 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21776 if (STRINGP (obj))
21778 *string = obj;
21779 return SSDATA (obj);
21781 else
21782 return "";
21786 /* Count up to COUNT lines starting from START_BYTE.
21787 But don't go beyond LIMIT_BYTE.
21788 Return the number of lines thus found (always nonnegative).
21790 Set *BYTE_POS_PTR to 1 if we found COUNT lines, 0 if we hit LIMIT. */
21792 static ptrdiff_t
21793 display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t start_byte,
21794 ptrdiff_t limit_byte, ptrdiff_t count,
21795 ptrdiff_t *byte_pos_ptr)
21797 register unsigned char *cursor;
21798 unsigned char *base;
21800 register ptrdiff_t ceiling;
21801 register unsigned char *ceiling_addr;
21802 ptrdiff_t orig_count = count;
21804 /* If we are not in selective display mode,
21805 check only for newlines. */
21806 int selective_display = (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
21807 && !INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)));
21809 if (count > 0)
21811 while (start_byte < limit_byte)
21813 ceiling = BUFFER_CEILING_OF (start_byte);
21814 ceiling = min (limit_byte - 1, ceiling);
21815 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) + 1;
21816 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte));
21817 while (1)
21819 if (selective_display)
21820 while (*cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015 && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21822 else
21823 while (*cursor != '\n' && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21826 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21828 if (--count == 0)
21830 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21831 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21832 return orig_count;
21834 else
21835 if (++cursor == ceiling_addr)
21836 break;
21838 else
21839 break;
21841 start_byte += cursor - base;
21844 else
21846 while (start_byte > limit_byte)
21848 ceiling = BUFFER_FLOOR_OF (start_byte - 1);
21849 ceiling = max (limit_byte, ceiling);
21850 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) - 1;
21851 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte - 1) + 1);
21852 while (1)
21854 if (selective_display)
21855 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr
21856 && *cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015)
21858 else
21859 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr && *cursor != '\n')
21862 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21864 if (++count == 0)
21866 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21867 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21868 /* When scanning backwards, we should
21869 not count the newline posterior to which we stop. */
21870 return - orig_count - 1;
21873 else
21874 break;
21876 /* Here we add 1 to compensate for the last decrement
21877 of CURSOR, which took it past the valid range. */
21878 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21882 *byte_pos_ptr = limit_byte;
21884 if (count < 0)
21885 return - orig_count + count;
21886 return orig_count - count;
21892 /***********************************************************************
21893 Displaying strings
21894 ***********************************************************************/
21896 /* Display a NUL-terminated string, starting with index START.
21898 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
21899 string LISP_STRING is displayed. There's a case that STRING is
21900 non-null and LISP_STRING is not nil. It means STRING is a string
21901 data of LISP_STRING. In that case, we display LISP_STRING while
21902 ignoring its text properties.
21904 If FACE_STRING is not nil, FACE_STRING_POS is a position in
21905 FACE_STRING. Display STRING or LISP_STRING with the face at
21906 FACE_STRING_POS in FACE_STRING:
21908 Display the string in the environment given by IT, but use the
21909 standard display table, temporarily.
21911 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
21912 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
21913 with spaces. If STRING has more characters, more than FIELD_WIDTH
21914 glyphs will be produced. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
21916 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
21917 STRING. PRECISION < 0 means don't truncate the string.
21919 This is roughly equivalent to printf format specifiers:
21921 FIELD_WIDTH PRECISION PRINTF
21922 ----------------------------------------
21923 -1 -1 %s
21924 -1 10 %.10s
21925 10 -1 %10s
21926 20 10 %20.10s
21928 MULTIBYTE zero means do not display multibyte chars, > 0 means do
21929 display them, and < 0 means obey the current buffer's value of
21930 enable_multibyte_characters.
21932 Value is the number of columns displayed. */
21934 static int
21935 display_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, Lisp_Object face_string,
21936 ptrdiff_t face_string_pos, ptrdiff_t start, struct it *it,
21937 int field_width, int precision, int max_x, int multibyte)
21939 int hpos_at_start = it->hpos;
21940 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
21941 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
21942 ptrdiff_t it_charpos;
21944 /* Initialize the iterator IT for iteration over STRING beginning
21945 with index START. */
21946 reseat_to_string (it, NILP (lisp_string) ? string : NULL, lisp_string, start,
21947 precision, field_width, multibyte);
21948 if (string && STRINGP (lisp_string))
21949 /* LISP_STRING is the one returned by decode_mode_spec. We should
21950 ignore its text properties. */
21951 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
21953 /* If displaying STRING, set up the face of the iterator from
21954 FACE_STRING, if that's given. */
21955 if (STRINGP (face_string))
21957 ptrdiff_t endptr;
21958 struct face *face;
21960 it->face_id
21961 = face_at_string_position (it->w, face_string, face_string_pos,
21962 0, it->region_beg_charpos,
21963 it->region_end_charpos,
21964 &endptr, it->base_face_id, 0);
21965 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
21966 it->face_box_p = face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
21969 /* Set max_x to the maximum allowed X position. Don't let it go
21970 beyond the right edge of the window. */
21971 if (max_x <= 0)
21972 max_x = it->last_visible_x;
21973 else
21974 max_x = min (max_x, it->last_visible_x);
21976 /* Skip over display elements that are not visible. because IT->w is
21977 hscrolled. */
21978 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
21979 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, 100000, it->first_visible_x,
21980 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
21982 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
21983 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
21984 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
21985 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
21986 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
21988 if (STRINGP (it->string))
21989 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
21990 else
21991 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
21993 /* This condition is for the case that we are called with current_x
21994 past last_visible_x. */
21995 while (it->current_x < max_x)
21997 int x_before, x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
21999 /* Get the next display element. */
22000 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
22001 break;
22003 /* Produce glyphs. */
22004 x_before = it->current_x;
22005 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
22006 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
22008 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
22009 i = 0;
22010 x = x_before;
22011 while (i < nglyphs)
22013 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
22015 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
22016 && x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
22018 /* End of continued line or max_x reached. */
22019 if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph))
22021 /* A wide character is unbreakable. */
22022 if (row->reversed_p)
22023 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
22024 - n_glyphs_before);
22025 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
22026 it->current_x = x_before;
22028 else
22030 if (row->reversed_p)
22031 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
22032 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
22033 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
22034 it->current_x = x;
22036 break;
22038 else if (x + glyph->pixel_width >= it->first_visible_x)
22040 /* Glyph is at least partially visible. */
22041 ++it->hpos;
22042 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
22043 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
22045 else
22047 /* Glyph is off the left margin of the display area.
22048 Should not happen. */
22049 emacs_abort ();
22052 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
22053 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
22054 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
22055 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
22056 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
22057 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
22058 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
22059 x += glyph->pixel_width;
22060 ++i;
22063 /* Stop if max_x reached. */
22064 if (i < nglyphs)
22065 break;
22067 /* Stop at line ends. */
22068 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
22070 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
22071 break;
22074 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
22075 if (STRINGP (it->string))
22076 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
22077 else
22078 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
22080 /* Stop if truncating at the right edge. */
22081 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
22082 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
22084 /* Add truncation mark, but don't do it if the line is
22085 truncated at a padding space. */
22086 if (it_charpos < it->string_nchars)
22088 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
22090 int ii, n;
22092 if (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)
22094 if (!row->reversed_p)
22096 for (ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; ii > 0; --ii)
22097 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22098 break;
22100 else
22102 for (ii = 0; ii < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii++)
22103 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22104 break;
22105 unproduce_glyphs (it, ii + 1);
22106 ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (ii + 1);
22108 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii < n; ++ii)
22110 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = ii;
22111 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22114 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22116 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
22118 break;
22122 /* Maybe insert a truncation at the left. */
22123 if (it->first_visible_x
22124 && it_charpos > 0)
22126 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22127 || (row->reversed_p
22128 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22129 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
22130 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
22131 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
22134 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
22136 /* Value is number of columns displayed. */
22137 return it->hpos - hpos_at_start;
22142 /* This is like a combination of memq and assq. Return 1/2 if PROPVAL
22143 appears as an element of LIST or as the car of an element of LIST.
22144 If PROPVAL is a list, compare each element against LIST in that
22145 way, and return 1/2 if any element of PROPVAL is found in LIST.
22146 Otherwise return 0. This function cannot quit.
22147 The return value is 2 if the text is invisible but with an ellipsis
22148 and 1 if it's invisible and without an ellipsis. */
22151 invisible_p (register Lisp_Object propval, Lisp_Object list)
22153 register Lisp_Object tail, proptail;
22155 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22157 register Lisp_Object tem;
22158 tem = XCAR (tail);
22159 if (EQ (propval, tem))
22160 return 1;
22161 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propval, XCAR (tem)))
22162 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22165 if (CONSP (propval))
22167 for (proptail = propval; CONSP (proptail); proptail = XCDR (proptail))
22169 Lisp_Object propelt;
22170 propelt = XCAR (proptail);
22171 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22173 register Lisp_Object tem;
22174 tem = XCAR (tail);
22175 if (EQ (propelt, tem))
22176 return 1;
22177 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propelt, XCAR (tem)))
22178 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22183 return 0;
22186 DEFUN ("invisible-p", Finvisible_p, Sinvisible_p, 1, 1, 0,
22187 doc: /* Non-nil if the property makes the text invisible.
22188 POS-OR-PROP can be a marker or number, in which case it is taken to be
22189 a position in the current buffer and the value of the `invisible' property
22190 is checked; or it can be some other value, which is then presumed to be the
22191 value of the `invisible' property of the text of interest.
22192 The non-nil value returned can be t for truly invisible text or something
22193 else if the text is replaced by an ellipsis. */)
22194 (Lisp_Object pos_or_prop)
22196 Lisp_Object prop
22197 = (NATNUMP (pos_or_prop) || MARKERP (pos_or_prop)
22198 ? Fget_char_property (pos_or_prop, Qinvisible, Qnil)
22199 : pos_or_prop);
22200 int invis = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
22201 return (invis == 0 ? Qnil
22202 : invis == 1 ? Qt
22203 : make_number (invis));
22206 /* Calculate a width or height in pixels from a specification using
22207 the following elements:
22209 SPEC ::=
22210 NUM - a (fractional) multiple of the default font width/height
22211 (NUM) - specifies exactly NUM pixels
22212 UNIT - a fixed number of pixels, see below.
22213 ELEMENT - size of a display element in pixels, see below.
22214 (NUM . SPEC) - equals NUM * SPEC
22215 (+ SPEC SPEC ...) - add pixel values
22216 (- SPEC SPEC ...) - subtract pixel values
22217 (- SPEC) - negate pixel value
22219 NUM ::=
22220 INT or FLOAT - a number constant
22221 SYMBOL - use symbol's (buffer local) variable binding.
22223 UNIT ::=
22224 in - pixels per inch *)
22225 mm - pixels per 1/1000 meter *)
22226 cm - pixels per 1/100 meter *)
22227 width - width of current font in pixels.
22228 height - height of current font in pixels.
22230 *) using the ratio(s) defined in display-pixels-per-inch.
22232 ELEMENT ::=
22234 left-fringe - left fringe width in pixels
22235 right-fringe - right fringe width in pixels
22237 left-margin - left margin width in pixels
22238 right-margin - right margin width in pixels
22240 scroll-bar - scroll-bar area width in pixels
22242 Examples:
22244 Pixels corresponding to 5 inches:
22245 (5 . in)
22247 Total width of non-text areas on left side of window (if scroll-bar is on left):
22248 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin scroll-bar))
22250 Align to first text column (in header line):
22251 '(space :align-to 0)
22253 Align to middle of text area minus half the width of variable `my-image'
22254 containing a loaded image:
22255 '(space :align-to (0.5 . (- text my-image)))
22257 Width of left margin minus width of 1 character in the default font:
22258 '(space :width (- left-margin 1))
22260 Width of left margin minus width of 2 characters in the current font:
22261 '(space :width (- left-margin (2 . width)))
22263 Center 1 character over left-margin (in header line):
22264 '(space :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin) -0.5))
22266 Different ways to express width of left fringe plus left margin minus one pixel:
22267 '(space :width (- (+ left-fringe left-margin) (1)))
22268 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (- (1))))
22269 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (-1)))
22273 #define NUMVAL(X) \
22274 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
22275 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
22276 : - 1)
22278 static int
22279 calc_pixel_width_or_height (double *res, struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop,
22280 struct font *font, int width_p, int *align_to)
22282 double pixels;
22284 #define OK_PIXELS(val) ((*res = (double)(val)), 1)
22285 #define OK_ALIGN_TO(val) ((*align_to = (int)(val)), 1)
22287 if (NILP (prop))
22288 return OK_PIXELS (0);
22290 eassert (FRAME_LIVE_P (it->f));
22292 if (SYMBOLP (prop))
22294 if (SCHARS (SYMBOL_NAME (prop)) == 2)
22296 char *unit = SSDATA (SYMBOL_NAME (prop));
22298 if (unit[0] == 'i' && unit[1] == 'n')
22299 pixels = 1.0;
22300 else if (unit[0] == 'm' && unit[1] == 'm')
22301 pixels = 25.4;
22302 else if (unit[0] == 'c' && unit[1] == 'm')
22303 pixels = 2.54;
22304 else
22305 pixels = 0;
22306 if (pixels > 0)
22308 double ppi;
22309 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22310 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22311 && (ppi = (width_p
22312 ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resx
22313 : FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resy),
22314 ppi > 0))
22315 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22316 #endif
22318 if ((ppi = NUMVAL (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch), ppi > 0)
22319 || (CONSP (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch)
22320 && (ppi = (width_p
22321 ? NUMVAL (XCAR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))
22322 : NUMVAL (XCDR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))),
22323 ppi > 0)))
22324 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22326 return 0;
22330 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22331 if (EQ (prop, Qheight))
22332 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_HEIGHT (font) : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22333 if (EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22334 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_WIDTH (font) : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f));
22335 #else
22336 if (EQ (prop, Qheight) || EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22337 return OK_PIXELS (1);
22338 #endif
22340 if (EQ (prop, Qtext))
22341 return OK_PIXELS (width_p
22342 ? window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22343 : WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w));
22345 if (align_to && *align_to < 0)
22347 *res = 0;
22348 if (EQ (prop, Qleft))
22349 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22350 if (EQ (prop, Qright))
22351 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22352 if (EQ (prop, Qcenter))
22353 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22354 + window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) / 2);
22355 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
22356 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22357 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w)
22358 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
22359 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
22360 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22361 ? window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
22362 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22363 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
22364 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
22365 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
22366 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA));
22367 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
22368 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (it->w)
22370 : (window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
22371 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22372 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22373 : 0)));
22375 else
22377 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
22378 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
22379 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
22380 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
22381 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
22382 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
22383 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
22384 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
22385 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
22386 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w));
22389 prop = buffer_local_value_1 (prop, it->w->buffer);
22390 if (EQ (prop, Qunbound))
22391 prop = Qnil;
22394 if (INTEGERP (prop) || FLOATP (prop))
22396 int base_unit = (width_p
22397 ? FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f)
22398 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22399 return OK_PIXELS (XFLOATINT (prop) * base_unit);
22402 if (CONSP (prop))
22404 Lisp_Object car = XCAR (prop);
22405 Lisp_Object cdr = XCDR (prop);
22407 if (SYMBOLP (car))
22409 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22410 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22411 && valid_image_p (prop))
22413 ptrdiff_t id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
22414 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, id);
22416 return OK_PIXELS (width_p ? img->width : img->height);
22418 #endif
22419 if (EQ (car, Qplus) || EQ (car, Qminus))
22421 int first = 1;
22422 double px;
22424 pixels = 0;
22425 while (CONSP (cdr))
22427 if (!calc_pixel_width_or_height (&px, it, XCAR (cdr),
22428 font, width_p, align_to))
22429 return 0;
22430 if (first)
22431 pixels = (EQ (car, Qplus) ? px : -px), first = 0;
22432 else
22433 pixels += px;
22434 cdr = XCDR (cdr);
22436 if (EQ (car, Qminus))
22437 pixels = -pixels;
22438 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
22441 car = buffer_local_value_1 (car, it->w->buffer);
22442 if (EQ (car, Qunbound))
22443 car = Qnil;
22446 if (INTEGERP (car) || FLOATP (car))
22448 double fact;
22449 pixels = XFLOATINT (car);
22450 if (NILP (cdr))
22451 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
22452 if (calc_pixel_width_or_height (&fact, it, cdr,
22453 font, width_p, align_to))
22454 return OK_PIXELS (pixels * fact);
22455 return 0;
22458 return 0;
22461 return 0;
22465 /***********************************************************************
22466 Glyph Display
22467 ***********************************************************************/
22469 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22471 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
22473 void
22474 dump_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22476 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
22477 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
22478 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
22479 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
22480 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
22481 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
22482 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
22483 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
22484 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
22485 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
22486 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
22487 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
22490 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
22492 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
22493 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
22494 init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
22495 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
22496 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
22497 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
22498 face-override for drawing S. */
22500 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22501 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc,
22502 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc;
22503 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f) hdc = get_frame_dc ((f))
22504 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f) release_frame_dc ((f), (hdc))
22505 #endif
22507 #ifndef OPTIONAL_HDC
22508 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc)
22509 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc)
22510 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f)
22511 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f)
22512 #endif
22514 static void
22515 init_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s,
22516 OPTIONAL_HDC (hdc)
22517 XChar2b *char2b, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
22518 enum glyph_row_area area, int start, enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
22520 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
22521 s->w = w;
22522 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
22523 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22524 s->hdc = hdc;
22525 #endif
22526 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
22527 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
22528 s->char2b = char2b;
22529 s->hl = hl;
22530 s->row = row;
22531 s->area = area;
22532 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
22533 s->height = row->height;
22534 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
22535 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
22539 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
22540 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
22542 static void
22543 append_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22544 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
22546 if (h)
22548 if (*head)
22549 (*tail)->next = h;
22550 else
22551 *head = h;
22552 h->prev = *tail;
22553 *tail = t;
22558 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
22559 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
22560 result. */
22562 static void
22563 prepend_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22564 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
22566 if (h)
22568 if (*head)
22569 (*head)->prev = t;
22570 else
22571 *tail = t;
22572 t->next = *head;
22573 *head = h;
22578 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
22579 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
22581 static void
22582 append_glyph_string (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22583 struct glyph_string *s)
22585 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
22586 append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
22590 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame F.
22591 The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. DISPLAY_P non-zero means
22592 make sure that X resources for the face returned are allocated.
22593 Value is a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display if
22594 DISPLAY_P is non-zero. */
22596 static struct face *
22597 get_char_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, int c, int face_id,
22598 XChar2b *char2b, int display_p)
22600 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
22602 if (face->font)
22604 unsigned code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, c);
22606 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22607 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22608 else
22609 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22612 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22613 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
22614 if (display_p)
22615 #endif
22617 eassert (face != NULL);
22618 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22621 return face;
22625 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
22626 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
22627 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
22629 static struct face *
22630 get_glyph_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph,
22631 XChar2b *char2b, int *two_byte_p)
22633 struct face *face;
22635 eassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
22636 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
22638 if (two_byte_p)
22639 *two_byte_p = 0;
22641 if (face->font)
22643 unsigned code;
22645 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (glyph->u.ch))
22646 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (glyph->u.ch);
22647 else
22648 code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, glyph->u.ch);
22650 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22651 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22652 else
22653 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22656 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22657 eassert (face != NULL);
22658 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22659 return face;
22663 /* Get glyph code of character C in FONT in the two-byte form CHAR2B.
22664 Return 1 if FONT has a glyph for C, otherwise return 0. */
22666 static int
22667 get_char_glyph_code (int c, struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22669 unsigned code;
22671 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
22672 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
22673 else
22674 code = font->driver->encode_char (font, c);
22676 if (code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22677 return 0;
22678 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22679 return 1;
22683 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
22685 BASE_FACE is the base face of the composition.
22686 S->cmp_from is the index of the first component for S.
22688 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22689 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22691 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
22693 static int
22694 fill_composite_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, struct face *base_face,
22695 int overlaps)
22697 int i;
22698 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
22699 S->cmp_from, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
22700 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
22701 struct face *face;
22703 eassert (s);
22705 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22706 s->face = NULL;
22707 s->font = NULL;
22708 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp->glyph_len; i++)
22710 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, i);
22712 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding space
22713 on the left or right. */
22714 if (c != '\t')
22716 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, base_face->ascii_face, c,
22717 -1, Qnil);
22719 face = get_char_face_and_encoding (s->f, c, face_id,
22720 s->char2b + i, 1);
22721 if (face)
22723 if (! s->face)
22725 s->face = face;
22726 s->font = s->face->font;
22728 else if (s->face != face)
22729 break;
22732 ++s->nchars;
22734 s->cmp_to = i;
22736 if (s->face == NULL)
22738 s->face = base_face->ascii_face;
22739 s->font = s->face->font;
22742 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
22743 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
22744 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22746 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
22747 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22748 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
22749 characters of the glyph string. */
22750 if (s->font == NULL)
22752 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22753 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22756 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22757 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22759 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
22760 s->two_byte_p = 1;
22762 return s->cmp_to;
22765 static int
22766 fill_gstring_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22767 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22769 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22770 Lisp_Object lgstring;
22771 int i;
22773 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22774 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22775 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22776 s->cmp_id = glyph->u.cmp.id;
22777 s->cmp_from = glyph->slice.cmp.from;
22778 s->cmp_to = glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22779 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22780 lgstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
22781 s->font = XFONT_OBJECT (LGSTRING_FONT (lgstring));
22782 glyph++;
22783 while (glyph < last
22784 && glyph->u.cmp.automatic
22785 && glyph->u.cmp.id == s->cmp_id
22786 && s->cmp_to == glyph->slice.cmp.from)
22787 s->cmp_to = (glyph++)->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22789 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
22791 Lisp_Object lglyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (lgstring, i);
22792 unsigned code = LGLYPH_CODE (lglyph);
22794 STORE_XCHAR2B ((s->char2b + i), code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
22796 s->width = composition_gstring_width (lgstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, NULL);
22797 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22801 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence glyphs for glyphless characters.
22802 See the comment of fill_glyph_string for arguments.
22803 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22806 static int
22807 fill_glyphless_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22808 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22810 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22811 int voffset;
22813 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH);
22814 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22815 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22816 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22817 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22818 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22819 s->font = s->face->font ? s->face->font : FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22820 s->nchars = 1;
22821 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22822 glyph++;
22823 while (glyph < last
22824 && glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
22825 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22826 && glyph->face_id == face_id)
22828 s->nchars++;
22829 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22830 glyph++;
22832 s->ybase += voffset;
22833 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22837 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
22839 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
22840 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
22841 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22842 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22844 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22846 static int
22847 fill_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22848 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22850 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22851 int voffset;
22852 int glyph_not_available_p;
22854 eassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
22855 eassert (s->nchars == 0);
22856 eassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
22858 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22859 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22860 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22861 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22862 s->padding_p = glyph->padding_p;
22863 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
22865 while (glyph < last
22866 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
22867 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22868 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
22869 && glyph->face_id == face_id
22870 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
22872 int two_byte_p;
22874 s->face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
22875 s->char2b + s->nchars,
22876 &two_byte_p);
22877 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
22878 ++s->nchars;
22879 eassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
22880 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22881 if (glyph++->padding_p != s->padding_p)
22882 break;
22885 s->font = s->face->font;
22887 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
22888 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22889 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
22890 characters of the glyph string. */
22891 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
22893 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22894 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22897 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22898 s->ybase += voffset;
22900 eassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
22901 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22905 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
22907 static void
22908 fill_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22910 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
22911 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
22912 eassert (s->img);
22913 s->slice = s->first_glyph->slice.img;
22914 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
22915 s->font = s->face->font;
22916 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22918 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22919 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22923 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
22925 START is the index of the first glyph to consider,
22926 END is the index of the last + 1.
22928 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22930 static int
22931 fill_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int end)
22933 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22934 int voffset, face_id;
22936 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
22938 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22939 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22940 face_id = glyph->face_id;
22941 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22942 s->font = s->face->font;
22943 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22944 s->nchars = 1;
22945 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22947 for (++glyph;
22948 (glyph < last
22949 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
22950 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22951 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
22952 ++glyph)
22953 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22955 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22956 s->ybase += voffset;
22958 /* The case that face->gc == 0 is handled when drawing the glyph
22959 string by calling PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY. */
22960 eassert (s->face);
22961 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22964 static struct font_metrics *
22965 get_per_char_metric (struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22967 static struct font_metrics metrics;
22968 unsigned code = (XCHAR2B_BYTE1 (char2b) << 8) | XCHAR2B_BYTE2 (char2b);
22970 if (! font || code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22971 return NULL;
22972 font->driver->text_extents (font, &code, 1, &metrics);
22973 return &metrics;
22976 /* EXPORT for RIF:
22977 Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
22978 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
22979 assumed to be zero. */
22981 void
22982 x_get_glyph_overhangs (struct glyph *glyph, struct frame *f, int *left, int *right)
22984 *left = *right = 0;
22986 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
22988 struct face *face;
22989 XChar2b char2b;
22990 struct font_metrics *pcm;
22992 face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
22993 if (face->font && (pcm = get_per_char_metric (face->font, &char2b)))
22995 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
22996 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
22997 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
22998 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
23001 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
23003 if (! glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
23005 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[glyph->u.cmp.id];
23007 if (cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width)
23008 *right = cmp->rbearing - cmp->pixel_width;
23009 if (cmp->lbearing < 0)
23010 *left = - cmp->lbearing;
23012 else
23014 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (glyph->u.cmp.id);
23015 struct font_metrics metrics;
23017 composition_gstring_width (gstring, glyph->slice.cmp.from,
23018 glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1, &metrics);
23019 if (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width)
23020 *right = metrics.rbearing - metrics.width;
23021 if (metrics.lbearing < 0)
23022 *left = - metrics.lbearing;
23028 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
23029 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
23030 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
23032 static int
23033 left_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
23035 int k;
23037 if (s->left_overhang)
23039 int x = 0, i;
23040 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23041 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23043 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
23044 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23046 k = i + 1;
23048 else
23049 k = -1;
23051 return k;
23055 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
23056 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
23057 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
23059 static int
23060 left_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23062 int i, k, x;
23063 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23064 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23066 k = -1;
23067 x = 0;
23068 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
23070 int left, right;
23071 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23072 if (x + right > 0)
23073 k = i;
23074 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23077 return k;
23081 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
23082 overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
23083 no such glyph is found. */
23085 static int
23086 right_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
23088 int k = -1;
23090 if (s->right_overhang)
23092 int x = 0, i;
23093 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23094 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs
23095 + (s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH ? 1 : s->nchars));
23096 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23098 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
23099 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23101 k = i;
23104 return k;
23108 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
23109 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
23110 if no such glyph is found. */
23112 static int
23113 right_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23115 int i, k, x;
23116 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23117 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23118 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs
23119 + (s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH ? 1 : s->nchars));
23121 k = -1;
23122 x = 0;
23123 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
23125 int left, right;
23126 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23127 if (x - left < 0)
23128 k = i;
23129 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23132 return k;
23136 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
23137 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
23138 in the drawing area. */
23140 static void
23141 set_glyph_string_background_width (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int last_x)
23143 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
23144 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
23146 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
23147 && s->area == TEXT_AREA
23148 && ((s->row->fill_line_p
23149 && (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
23150 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
23151 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN))
23152 || s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE))
23153 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
23155 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
23156 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
23157 area. */
23158 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
23159 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
23160 else
23161 s->background_width = s->width;
23165 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
23166 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
23167 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
23169 static void
23170 compute_overhangs_and_x (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int backward_p)
23172 if (backward_p)
23174 while (s)
23176 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23177 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23178 x -= s->width;
23179 s->x = x;
23180 s = s->prev;
23183 else
23185 while (s)
23187 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23188 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23189 s->x = x;
23190 x += s->width;
23191 s = s->next;
23198 /* The following macros are only called from draw_glyphs below.
23199 They reference the following parameters of that function directly:
23200 `w', `row', `area', and `overlap_p'
23201 as well as the following local variables:
23202 `s', `f', and `hdc' (in W32) */
23204 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
23205 /* On W32, silently add local `hdc' variable to argument list of
23206 init_glyph_string. */
23207 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23208 init_glyph_string (s, hdc, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23209 #else
23210 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23211 init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23212 #endif
23214 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
23215 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
23216 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23217 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23218 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23219 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23220 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23222 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
23223 and below -- keep them on one line. */
23224 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23225 do \
23227 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23228 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23229 START = fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, START, END); \
23230 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23231 s->x = (X); \
23233 while (0)
23236 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
23237 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
23238 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23239 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23240 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23241 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23242 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23244 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23245 do \
23247 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23248 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23249 fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
23250 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23251 ++START; \
23252 s->x = (X); \
23254 while (0)
23257 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
23258 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
23259 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
23260 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
23261 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
23262 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
23263 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
23264 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23266 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23267 do \
23269 int face_id; \
23270 XChar2b *char2b; \
23272 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23274 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23275 char2b = alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
23276 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23277 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23278 s->x = (X); \
23279 START = fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23281 while (0)
23284 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
23285 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
23286 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
23287 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
23288 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
23289 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
23290 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
23291 x-position of the drawing area. */
23293 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23294 do { \
23295 int face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23296 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id); \
23297 ptrdiff_t cmp_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id; \
23298 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
23299 XChar2b *char2b; \
23300 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
23301 int n; \
23303 char2b = alloca (cmp->glyph_len * sizeof *char2b); \
23305 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
23306 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
23307 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
23309 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23310 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23311 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23312 s->cmp = cmp; \
23313 s->cmp_from = n; \
23314 s->x = (X); \
23315 if (n == 0) \
23316 first_s = s; \
23317 n = fill_composite_glyph_string (s, base_face, overlaps); \
23320 ++START; \
23321 s = first_s; \
23322 } while (0)
23325 /* Add a glyph string for a glyph-string sequence to the list of strings
23326 between HEAD and TAIL. */
23328 #define BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23329 do { \
23330 int face_id; \
23331 XChar2b *char2b; \
23332 Lisp_Object gstring; \
23334 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23335 gstring = (composition_gstring_from_id \
23336 ((row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id)); \
23337 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23338 char2b = alloca (LGSTRING_GLYPH_LEN (gstring) * sizeof *char2b); \
23339 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23340 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23341 s->x = (X); \
23342 START = fill_gstring_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23343 } while (0)
23346 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of glyphless character's glyphs
23347 to the list of strings between HEAD and TAIL. The meanings of
23348 arguments are the same as those of BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS. */
23350 #define BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23351 do \
23353 int face_id; \
23355 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23357 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23358 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23359 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23360 s->x = (X); \
23361 START = fill_glyphless_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
23362 overlaps); \
23364 while (0)
23367 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
23368 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
23369 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
23370 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
23371 x-positions of the drawing area.
23373 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
23374 to allocate glyph strings (because draw_glyphs can be called
23375 asynchronously). */
23377 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23378 do \
23380 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
23381 while (START < END) \
23383 struct glyph *first_glyph = (row)->glyphs[area] + START; \
23384 switch (first_glyph->type) \
23386 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
23387 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23388 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23389 break; \
23391 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
23392 if (first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic) \
23393 BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23394 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23395 else \
23396 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23397 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23398 break; \
23400 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
23401 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23402 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23403 break; \
23405 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
23406 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23407 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23408 break; \
23410 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH: \
23411 BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23412 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23413 break; \
23415 default: \
23416 emacs_abort (); \
23419 if (s) \
23421 set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
23422 (X) += s->width; \
23425 } while (0)
23428 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
23429 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
23430 face-override with the following meaning:
23432 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
23433 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
23434 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
23435 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
23436 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
23437 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
23439 If OVERLAPS is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters and
23440 clip to the physical height of ROW. Non-zero value also defines
23441 the overlapping part to be drawn:
23443 OVERLAPS_PRED overlap with preceding rows
23444 OVERLAPS_SUCC overlap with succeeding rows
23445 OVERLAPS_BOTH overlap with both preceding/succeeding rows
23446 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR overlap with erased cursor area
23448 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
23450 static int
23451 draw_glyphs (struct window *w, int x, struct glyph_row *row,
23452 enum glyph_row_area area, ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end,
23453 enum draw_glyphs_face hl, int overlaps)
23455 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
23456 struct glyph_string *s;
23457 struct glyph_string *clip_head = NULL, *clip_tail = NULL;
23458 int i, j, x_reached, last_x, area_left = 0;
23459 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
23460 DECLARE_HDC (hdc);
23462 ALLOCATE_HDC (hdc, f);
23464 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
23465 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
23466 start = max (0, start);
23467 start = min (end, start);
23469 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
23470 end of the drawing area. */
23471 if (row->full_width_p)
23473 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
23474 or fringes. */
23475 area_left = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
23476 last_x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w) + WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
23478 else
23480 area_left = window_box_left (w, area);
23481 last_x = area_left + window_box_width (w, area);
23483 x += area_left;
23485 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
23486 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
23487 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
23488 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
23489 i = start;
23490 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x);
23491 if (tail)
23492 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
23493 else
23494 x_reached = x;
23496 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
23497 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
23498 strings built above. */
23499 if (head && !overlaps && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
23501 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
23502 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
23503 int mouse_beg_col IF_LINT (= 0), mouse_end_col IF_LINT (= 0);
23504 int check_mouse_face = 0;
23505 int dummy_x = 0;
23507 /* If mouse highlighting is on, we may need to draw adjacent
23508 glyphs using mouse-face highlighting. */
23509 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->mouse_face_p
23510 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row >= 0
23511 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row >= 0)
23513 struct glyph_row *mouse_beg_row, *mouse_end_row;
23515 mouse_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
23516 mouse_end_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
23518 if (row >= mouse_beg_row && row <= mouse_end_row)
23520 check_mouse_face = 1;
23521 mouse_beg_col = (row == mouse_beg_row)
23522 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col : 0;
23523 mouse_end_col = (row == mouse_end_row)
23524 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
23525 : row->used[TEXT_AREA];
23529 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
23530 if (FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23531 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23532 FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23534 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
23535 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
23536 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
23537 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
23538 draws over it. */
23539 i = left_overwritten (head);
23540 if (i >= 0)
23542 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23544 /* If this row contains mouse highlighting, attempt to draw
23545 the overlapped glyphs with the correct highlight. This
23546 code fails if the overlap encompasses more than one glyph
23547 and mouse-highlight spans only some of these glyphs.
23548 However, making it work perfectly involves a lot more
23549 code, and I don't know if the pathological case occurs in
23550 practice, so we'll stick to this for now. --- cyd */
23551 if (check_mouse_face
23552 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
23553 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23554 else
23555 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23557 j = i;
23558 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (j, start, h, t,
23559 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
23560 start = i;
23561 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
23562 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23563 clip_head = head;
23566 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
23567 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
23568 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
23569 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
23570 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
23571 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
23572 strings exist. */
23573 i = left_overwriting (head);
23574 if (i >= 0)
23576 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23578 if (check_mouse_face
23579 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
23580 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23581 else
23582 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23584 clip_head = head;
23585 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, start, h, t,
23586 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
23587 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
23588 s->background_filled_p = 1;
23589 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
23590 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23593 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
23594 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
23595 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
23596 over it. */
23597 i = right_overwritten (tail);
23598 if (i >= 0)
23600 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23602 if (check_mouse_face
23603 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
23604 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23605 else
23606 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23608 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
23609 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
23610 /* Because BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS updates the first argument,
23611 we don't have `end = i;' here. */
23612 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
23613 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23614 clip_tail = tail;
23617 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
23618 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
23619 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
23620 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
23621 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
23622 i = right_overwriting (tail);
23623 if (i >= 0)
23625 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23626 if (check_mouse_face
23627 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
23628 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23629 else
23630 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23632 clip_tail = tail;
23633 i++; /* We must include the Ith glyph. */
23634 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
23635 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
23636 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
23637 s->background_filled_p = 1;
23638 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
23639 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23641 if (clip_head || clip_tail)
23642 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23644 s->clip_head = clip_head;
23645 s->clip_tail = clip_tail;
23649 /* Draw all strings. */
23650 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23651 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_glyph_string (s);
23653 #ifndef HAVE_NS
23654 /* When focus a sole frame and move horizontally, this sets on_p to 0
23655 causing a failure to erase prev cursor position. */
23656 if (area == TEXT_AREA
23657 && !row->full_width_p
23658 /* When drawing overlapping rows, only the glyph strings'
23659 foreground is drawn, which doesn't erase a cursor
23660 completely. */
23661 && !overlaps)
23663 int x0 = clip_head ? clip_head->x : (head ? head->x : x);
23664 int x1 = (clip_tail ? clip_tail->x + clip_tail->background_width
23665 : (tail ? tail->x + tail->background_width : x));
23666 x0 -= area_left;
23667 x1 -= area_left;
23669 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, TEXT_AREA, x0, x1,
23670 row->y, MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row));
23672 #endif
23674 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
23675 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
23676 if (row->full_width_p)
23677 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
23678 else
23679 x_reached -= area_left;
23681 RELEASE_HDC (hdc, f);
23683 return x_reached;
23686 /* Expand row matrix if too narrow. Don't expand if area
23687 is not present. */
23689 #define IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH(it, area) \
23691 if (!fonts_changed_p \
23692 && (it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] \
23693 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])) \
23695 it->w->ncols_scale_factor++; \
23696 fonts_changed_p = 1; \
23700 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
23701 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
23703 static void
23704 append_glyph (struct it *it)
23706 struct glyph *glyph;
23707 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23709 eassert (it->glyph_row);
23710 eassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
23712 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23713 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23715 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23716 rather than append it. */
23717 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
23719 struct glyph *g;
23721 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
23722 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
23723 g[1] = *g;
23724 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
23726 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23727 glyph->object = it->object;
23728 if (it->pixel_width > 0)
23730 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23731 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23733 else
23735 /* Assure at least 1-pixel width. Otherwise, cursor can't
23736 be displayed correctly. */
23737 glyph->pixel_width = 1;
23738 glyph->padding_p = 1;
23740 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23741 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23742 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23743 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
23744 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23745 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23746 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23747 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23748 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23749 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23750 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
23751 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23752 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
23753 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
23754 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23755 if (it->bidi_p)
23757 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23758 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23759 emacs_abort ();
23760 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23762 else
23764 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
23765 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
23767 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23769 else
23770 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23773 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_it.id in
23774 IT->glyph_row. Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is
23775 non-null. */
23777 static void
23778 append_composite_glyph (struct it *it)
23780 struct glyph *glyph;
23781 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23783 eassert (it->glyph_row);
23785 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23786 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23788 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23789 rather than append it. */
23790 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
23792 struct glyph *g;
23794 /* Make room for the new glyph. */
23795 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area]; g--)
23796 g[1] = *g;
23797 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area];
23799 glyph->charpos = it->cmp_it.charpos;
23800 glyph->object = it->object;
23801 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23802 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23803 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23804 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23805 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
23806 if (it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
23808 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 0;
23809 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23810 glyph->slice.cmp.from = glyph->slice.cmp.to = 0;
23812 else
23814 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 1;
23815 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23816 glyph->slice.cmp.from = it->cmp_it.from;
23817 glyph->slice.cmp.to = it->cmp_it.to - 1;
23819 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23820 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23821 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23822 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23823 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23824 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23825 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23826 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23827 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23828 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23829 if (it->bidi_p)
23831 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23832 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23833 emacs_abort ();
23834 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23836 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23838 else
23839 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23843 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
23844 IT->voffset. */
23846 static void
23847 take_vertical_position_into_account (struct it *it)
23849 if (it->voffset)
23851 if (it->voffset < 0)
23852 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
23853 in the line. */
23854 it->ascent -= it->voffset;
23855 else
23856 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
23857 in the line. */
23858 it->descent += it->voffset;
23863 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
23864 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
23865 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
23867 static void
23868 produce_image_glyph (struct it *it)
23870 struct image *img;
23871 struct face *face;
23872 int glyph_ascent, crop;
23873 struct glyph_slice slice;
23875 eassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
23877 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
23878 eassert (face);
23879 /* Make sure X resources of the face is loaded. */
23880 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
23882 if (it->image_id < 0)
23884 /* Fringe bitmap. */
23885 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = 0;
23886 it->descent = it->phys_descent = 0;
23887 it->pixel_width = 0;
23888 it->nglyphs = 0;
23889 return;
23892 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
23893 eassert (img);
23894 /* Make sure X resources of the image is loaded. */
23895 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
23897 slice.x = slice.y = 0;
23898 slice.width = img->width;
23899 slice.height = img->height;
23901 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.x))
23902 slice.x = XINT (it->slice.x);
23903 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.x))
23904 slice.x = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.x) * img->width;
23906 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.y))
23907 slice.y = XINT (it->slice.y);
23908 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.y))
23909 slice.y = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.y) * img->height;
23911 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.width))
23912 slice.width = XINT (it->slice.width);
23913 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.width))
23914 slice.width = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.width) * img->width;
23916 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.height))
23917 slice.height = XINT (it->slice.height);
23918 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.height))
23919 slice.height = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.height) * img->height;
23921 if (slice.x >= img->width)
23922 slice.x = img->width;
23923 if (slice.y >= img->height)
23924 slice.y = img->height;
23925 if (slice.x + slice.width >= img->width)
23926 slice.width = img->width - slice.x;
23927 if (slice.y + slice.height > img->height)
23928 slice.height = img->height - slice.y;
23930 if (slice.width == 0 || slice.height == 0)
23931 return;
23933 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = glyph_ascent = image_ascent (img, face, &slice);
23935 it->descent = slice.height - glyph_ascent;
23936 if (slice.y == 0)
23937 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23938 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23939 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23940 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
23942 it->pixel_width = slice.width;
23943 if (slice.x == 0)
23944 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23945 if (slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23946 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23948 /* It's quite possible for images to have an ascent greater than
23949 their height, so don't get confused in that case. */
23950 if (it->descent < 0)
23951 it->descent = 0;
23953 it->nglyphs = 1;
23955 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
23957 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
23959 if (slice.y == 0)
23960 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
23961 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23962 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
23965 if (it->start_of_box_run_p && slice.x == 0)
23966 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23967 if (it->end_of_box_run_p && slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23968 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23971 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
23973 /* Automatically crop wide image glyphs at right edge so we can
23974 draw the cursor on same display row. */
23975 if ((crop = it->pixel_width - (it->last_visible_x - it->current_x), crop > 0)
23976 && (it->hpos == 0 || it->pixel_width > it->last_visible_x / 4))
23978 it->pixel_width -= crop;
23979 slice.width -= crop;
23982 if (it->glyph_row)
23984 struct glyph *glyph;
23985 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23987 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23988 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23990 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23991 glyph->object = it->object;
23992 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23993 glyph->ascent = glyph_ascent;
23994 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23995 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23996 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
23997 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23998 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23999 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24000 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24001 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
24002 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24003 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24004 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24005 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
24006 glyph->slice.img = slice;
24007 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24008 if (it->bidi_p)
24010 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24011 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24012 emacs_abort ();
24013 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24015 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24017 else
24018 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24023 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
24024 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
24025 stretch. ASCENT is the ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= HEIGHT). */
24027 static void
24028 append_stretch_glyph (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object,
24029 int width, int height, int ascent)
24031 struct glyph *glyph;
24032 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24034 eassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= height);
24036 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24037 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24039 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24040 rather than append it. */
24041 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24043 struct glyph *g;
24045 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
24046 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24047 g[1] = *g;
24048 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24050 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24051 glyph->object = object;
24052 glyph->pixel_width = width;
24053 glyph->ascent = ascent;
24054 glyph->descent = height - ascent;
24055 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24056 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
24057 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24058 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24059 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24060 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24061 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
24062 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24063 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24064 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24065 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = ascent;
24066 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
24067 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
24068 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24069 if (it->bidi_p)
24071 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24072 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24073 emacs_abort ();
24074 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24076 else
24078 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
24079 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
24081 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24083 else
24084 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24087 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24089 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
24090 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
24091 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
24092 being recognized:
24094 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
24095 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
24096 point number.
24098 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
24099 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
24100 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
24102 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
24103 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
24105 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
24107 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
24108 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
24110 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the
24111 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
24112 the glyph property.
24114 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
24116 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
24117 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
24118 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
24120 void
24121 produce_stretch_glyph (struct it *it)
24123 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT ...) */
24124 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
24125 int width = 0, height = 0, align_to = -1;
24126 int zero_width_ok_p = 0;
24127 double tem;
24128 struct font *font = NULL;
24130 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24131 int ascent = 0;
24132 int zero_height_ok_p = 0;
24134 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24136 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24137 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24138 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24140 #endif
24142 /* List should start with `space'. */
24143 eassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
24144 plist = XCDR (it->object);
24146 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
24147 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth), !NILP (prop))
24148 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, 0))
24150 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
24151 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24152 width = (int)tem;
24154 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24155 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
24156 && (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width), NUMVAL (prop) > 0))
24158 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
24159 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
24160 property. */
24161 struct it it2;
24162 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
24164 it2 = *it;
24165 if (it->multibyte_p)
24166 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it2.len);
24167 else
24169 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = *p, it2.len = 1;
24170 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it2.c))
24171 it2.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it2.c);
24174 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
24175 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24176 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
24177 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
24179 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24180 else if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to), !NILP (prop))
24181 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, &align_to))
24183 if (it->glyph_row == NULL || !it->glyph_row->mode_line_p)
24184 align_to = (align_to < 0
24186 : align_to - window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
24187 else if (align_to < 0)
24188 align_to = window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA);
24189 width = max (0, (int)tem + align_to - it->current_x);
24190 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24192 else
24193 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
24194 width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
24196 if (width <= 0 && (width < 0 || !zero_width_ok_p))
24197 width = 1;
24199 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24200 /* Compute height. */
24201 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24203 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight), !NILP (prop))
24204 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24206 height = (int)tem;
24207 zero_height_ok_p = 1;
24209 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
24210 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
24211 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
24212 else
24213 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24215 if (height <= 0 && (height < 0 || !zero_height_ok_p))
24216 height = 1;
24218 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
24219 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
24220 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
24221 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
24222 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
24223 ascent = height * NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
24224 else if (!NILP (prop)
24225 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24226 ascent = min (max (0, (int)tem), height);
24227 else
24228 ascent = (height * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24230 else
24231 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24232 height = 1;
24234 if (width > 0 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
24235 && it->current_x + width > it->last_visible_x)
24237 width = it->last_visible_x - it->current_x;
24238 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24239 /* Subtract one more pixel from the stretch width, but only on
24240 GUI frames, since on a TTY each glyph is one "pixel" wide. */
24241 width -= FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f);
24242 #endif
24245 if (width > 0 && height > 0 && it->glyph_row)
24247 Lisp_Object o_object = it->object;
24248 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
24249 int n = width;
24251 if (!STRINGP (object))
24252 object = it->w->buffer;
24253 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24254 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24255 append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
24256 else
24257 #endif
24259 it->object = object;
24260 it->char_to_display = ' ';
24261 it->pixel_width = it->len = 1;
24262 while (n--)
24263 tty_append_glyph (it);
24264 it->object = o_object;
24268 it->pixel_width = width;
24269 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24270 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24272 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = ascent;
24273 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
24274 it->nglyphs = width > 0 && height > 0 ? 1 : 0;
24275 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24277 else
24278 #endif
24279 it->nglyphs = width;
24282 /* Get information about special display element WHAT in an
24283 environment described by IT. WHAT is one of IT_TRUNCATION or
24284 IT_CONTINUATION. Maybe produce glyphs for WHAT if IT has a
24285 non-null glyph_row member. This function ensures that fields like
24286 face_id, c, len of IT are left untouched. */
24288 static void
24289 produce_special_glyphs (struct it *it, enum display_element_type what)
24291 struct it temp_it;
24292 Lisp_Object gc;
24293 GLYPH glyph;
24295 temp_it = *it;
24296 temp_it.object = make_number (0);
24297 memset (&temp_it.current, 0, sizeof temp_it.current);
24299 if (what == IT_CONTINUATION)
24301 /* Continuation glyph. For R2L lines, we mirror it by hand. */
24302 if (it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
24303 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '/');
24304 else
24305 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '\\');
24306 if (it->dp
24307 && (gc = DISP_CONTINUE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24309 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
24310 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
24311 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
24314 else if (what == IT_TRUNCATION)
24316 /* Truncation glyph. */
24317 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '$');
24318 if (it->dp
24319 && (gc = DISP_TRUNC_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24321 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
24322 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
24323 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
24326 else
24327 emacs_abort ();
24329 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24330 /* On a GUI frame, when the right fringe (left fringe for R2L rows)
24331 is turned off, we precede the truncation/continuation glyphs by a
24332 stretch glyph whose width is computed such that these special
24333 glyphs are aligned at the window margin, even when very different
24334 fonts are used in different glyph rows. */
24335 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (temp_it.f)
24336 /* init_iterator calls this with it->glyph_row == NULL, and it
24337 wants only the pixel width of the truncation/continuation
24338 glyphs. */
24339 && temp_it.glyph_row
24340 /* insert_left_trunc_glyphs calls us at the beginning of the
24341 row, and it has its own calculation of the stretch glyph
24342 width. */
24343 && temp_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
24344 && (temp_it.glyph_row->reversed_p
24345 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)
24346 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)) == 0)
24348 int stretch_width = temp_it.last_visible_x - temp_it.current_x;
24350 if (stretch_width > 0)
24352 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (temp_it.f, temp_it.face_id);
24353 struct font *font =
24354 face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (temp_it.f);
24355 int stretch_ascent =
24356 (((temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent)
24357 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24359 append_stretch_glyph (&temp_it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
24360 temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent,
24361 stretch_ascent);
24364 #endif
24366 temp_it.dp = NULL;
24367 temp_it.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24368 temp_it.len = 1;
24369 temp_it.c = temp_it.char_to_display = GLYPH_CHAR (glyph);
24370 temp_it.face_id = GLYPH_FACE (glyph);
24371 temp_it.len = CHAR_BYTES (temp_it.c);
24373 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&temp_it);
24374 it->pixel_width = temp_it.pixel_width;
24375 it->nglyphs = temp_it.pixel_width;
24378 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24380 /* Calculate line-height and line-spacing properties.
24381 An integer value specifies explicit pixel value.
24382 A float value specifies relative value to current face height.
24383 A cons (float . face-name) specifies relative value to
24384 height of specified face font.
24386 Returns height in pixels, or nil. */
24389 static Lisp_Object
24390 calc_line_height_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object val, struct font *font,
24391 int boff, int override)
24393 Lisp_Object face_name = Qnil;
24394 int ascent, descent, height;
24396 if (NILP (val) || INTEGERP (val) || (override && EQ (val, Qt)))
24397 return val;
24399 if (CONSP (val))
24401 face_name = XCAR (val);
24402 val = XCDR (val);
24403 if (!NUMBERP (val))
24404 val = make_number (1);
24405 if (NILP (face_name))
24407 height = it->ascent + it->descent;
24408 goto scale;
24412 if (NILP (face_name))
24414 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24415 boff = FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (it->f);
24417 else if (EQ (face_name, Qt))
24419 override = 0;
24421 else
24423 int face_id;
24424 struct face *face;
24426 face_id = lookup_named_face (it->f, face_name, 0);
24427 if (face_id < 0)
24428 return make_number (-1);
24430 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24431 font = face->font;
24432 if (font == NULL)
24433 return make_number (-1);
24434 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24435 if (font->vertical_centering)
24436 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24439 ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24440 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24442 if (override)
24444 it->override_ascent = ascent;
24445 it->override_descent = descent;
24446 it->override_boff = boff;
24449 height = ascent + descent;
24451 scale:
24452 if (FLOATP (val))
24453 height = (int)(XFLOAT_DATA (val) * height);
24454 else if (INTEGERP (val))
24455 height *= XINT (val);
24457 return make_number (height);
24461 /* Append a glyph for a glyphless character to IT->glyph_row. FACE_ID
24462 is a face ID to be used for the glyph. FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if
24463 and only if this is for a character for which no font was found.
24465 If the display method (it->glyphless_method) is
24466 GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM or GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE, LEN is a
24467 length of the acronym or the hexadecimal string, UPPER_XOFF and
24468 UPPER_YOFF are pixel offsets for the upper part of the string,
24469 LOWER_XOFF and LOWER_YOFF are for the lower part.
24471 For the other display methods, LEN through LOWER_YOFF are zero. */
24473 static void
24474 append_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int face_id, int for_no_font, int len,
24475 short upper_xoff, short upper_yoff,
24476 short lower_xoff, short lower_yoff)
24478 struct glyph *glyph;
24479 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24481 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24482 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24484 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24485 rather than append it. */
24486 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24488 struct glyph *g;
24490 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
24491 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24492 g[1] = *g;
24493 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24495 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24496 glyph->object = it->object;
24497 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
24498 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
24499 glyph->descent = it->descent;
24500 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24501 glyph->type = GLYPHLESS_GLYPH;
24502 glyph->u.glyphless.method = it->glyphless_method;
24503 glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font = for_no_font;
24504 glyph->u.glyphless.len = len;
24505 glyph->u.glyphless.ch = it->c;
24506 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff = upper_xoff;
24507 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff = upper_yoff;
24508 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff = lower_xoff;
24509 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff = lower_yoff;
24510 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24511 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24512 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24513 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24514 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
24515 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
24516 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24517 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24518 glyph->face_id = face_id;
24519 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24520 if (it->bidi_p)
24522 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24523 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24524 emacs_abort ();
24525 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24527 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24529 else
24530 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24534 /* Produce a glyph for a glyphless character for iterator IT.
24535 IT->glyphless_method specifies which method to use for displaying
24536 the character. See the description of enum
24537 glyphless_display_method in dispextern.h for the detail.
24539 FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if and only if this is for a character for
24540 which no font was found. ACRONYM, if non-nil, is an acronym string
24541 for the character. */
24543 static void
24544 produce_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int for_no_font, Lisp_Object acronym)
24546 int face_id;
24547 struct face *face;
24548 struct font *font;
24549 int base_width, base_height, width, height;
24550 short upper_xoff, upper_yoff, lower_xoff, lower_yoff;
24551 int len;
24553 /* Get the metrics of the base font. We always refer to the current
24554 ASCII face. */
24555 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id)->ascii_face;
24556 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24557 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + font->baseline_offset;
24558 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - font->baseline_offset;
24559 base_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
24560 base_width = font->average_width;
24562 /* Get a face ID for the glyph by utilizing a cache (the same way as
24563 done for `escape-glyph' in get_next_display_element). */
24564 if (it->f == last_glyphless_glyph_frame
24565 && it->face_id == last_glyphless_glyph_face_id)
24567 face_id = last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id;
24569 else
24571 /* Merge the `glyphless-char' face into the current face. */
24572 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qglyphless_char, 0, it->face_id);
24573 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = it->f;
24574 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
24575 last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
24578 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
24580 it->pixel_width = THIN_SPACE_WIDTH;
24581 len = 0;
24582 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
24584 else if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX)
24586 width = CHAR_WIDTH (it->c);
24587 if (width == 0)
24588 width = 1;
24589 else if (width > 4)
24590 width = 4;
24591 it->pixel_width = base_width * width;
24592 len = 0;
24593 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
24595 else
24597 char buf[7];
24598 const char *str;
24599 unsigned int code[6];
24600 int upper_len;
24601 int ascent, descent;
24602 struct font_metrics metrics_upper, metrics_lower;
24604 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24605 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24606 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24608 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
24610 if (! STRINGP (acronym) && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display))
24611 acronym = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, it->c);
24612 if (CONSP (acronym))
24613 acronym = XCAR (acronym);
24614 str = STRINGP (acronym) ? SSDATA (acronym) : "";
24616 else
24618 eassert (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE);
24619 sprintf (buf, "%0*X", it->c < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6, it->c);
24620 str = buf;
24622 for (len = 0; str[len] && ASCII_BYTE_P (str[len]) && len < 6; len++)
24623 code[len] = font->driver->encode_char (font, str[len]);
24624 upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
24625 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, upper_len,
24626 &metrics_upper);
24627 font->driver->text_extents (font, code + upper_len, len - upper_len,
24628 &metrics_lower);
24632 /* +4 is for vertical bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at both side. */
24633 width = max (metrics_upper.width, metrics_lower.width) + 4;
24634 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = 2; /* the typical case */
24635 if (base_width >= width)
24637 /* Align the upper to the left, the lower to the right. */
24638 it->pixel_width = base_width;
24639 lower_xoff = base_width - 2 - metrics_lower.width;
24641 else
24643 /* Center the shorter one. */
24644 it->pixel_width = width;
24645 if (metrics_upper.width >= metrics_lower.width)
24646 lower_xoff = (width - metrics_lower.width) / 2;
24647 else
24649 /* FIXME: This code doesn't look right. It formerly was
24650 missing the "lower_xoff = 0;", which couldn't have
24651 been right since it left lower_xoff uninitialized. */
24652 lower_xoff = 0;
24653 upper_xoff = (width - metrics_upper.width) / 2;
24657 /* +5 is for horizontal bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at
24658 top, bottom, and between upper and lower strings. */
24659 height = (metrics_upper.ascent + metrics_upper.descent
24660 + metrics_lower.ascent + metrics_lower.descent) + 5;
24661 /* Center vertically.
24662 H:base_height, D:base_descent
24663 h:height, ld:lower_descent, la:lower_ascent, ud:upper_descent
24665 ascent = - (D - H/2 - h/2 + 1); "+ 1" for rounding up
24666 descent = D - H/2 + h/2;
24667 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - ld;
24668 upper_yoff = lower_yoff - la - 1 - ud; */
24669 ascent = - (it->descent - (base_height + height + 1) / 2);
24670 descent = it->descent - (base_height - height) / 2;
24671 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - metrics_lower.descent;
24672 upper_yoff = (lower_yoff - metrics_lower.ascent - 1
24673 - metrics_upper.descent);
24674 /* Don't make the height shorter than the base height. */
24675 if (height > base_height)
24677 it->ascent = ascent;
24678 it->descent = descent;
24682 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24683 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24684 if (it->glyph_row)
24685 append_glyphless_glyph (it, face_id, for_no_font, len,
24686 upper_xoff, upper_yoff,
24687 lower_xoff, lower_yoff);
24688 it->nglyphs = 1;
24689 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24693 /* RIF:
24694 Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
24695 loaded with. See the description of struct it in dispextern.h
24696 for an overview of struct it. */
24698 void
24699 x_produce_glyphs (struct it *it)
24701 int extra_line_spacing = it->extra_line_spacing;
24703 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24705 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
24707 XChar2b char2b;
24708 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24709 struct font *font = face->font;
24710 struct font_metrics *pcm = NULL;
24711 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24713 if (font == NULL)
24715 /* When no suitable font is found, display this character by
24716 the method specified in the first extra slot of
24717 Vglyphless_char_display. */
24718 Lisp_Object acronym = lookup_glyphless_char_display (-1, it);
24720 eassert (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS);
24721 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 1, STRINGP (acronym) ? acronym : Qnil);
24722 goto done;
24725 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24726 if (font->vertical_centering)
24727 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24729 if (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t')
24731 int stretched_p;
24733 it->nglyphs = 1;
24735 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24737 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24738 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24739 boff = it->override_boff;
24741 else
24743 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24744 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24747 if (get_char_glyph_code (it->char_to_display, font, &char2b))
24749 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
24750 if (pcm->width == 0
24751 && pcm->rbearing == 0 && pcm->lbearing == 0)
24752 pcm = NULL;
24755 if (pcm)
24757 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
24758 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
24759 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
24761 else
24763 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
24764 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24765 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24766 it->pixel_width = font->space_width;
24769 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24771 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24773 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24774 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24776 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24778 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24779 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24781 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24782 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24783 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24786 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
24787 `space-width' property, change its width. */
24788 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
24789 if (stretched_p)
24790 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
24792 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
24793 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
24794 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
24795 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
24797 int thick = face->box_line_width;
24799 if (thick > 0)
24801 it->ascent += thick;
24802 it->descent += thick;
24804 else
24805 thick = -thick;
24807 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
24808 it->pixel_width += thick;
24809 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
24810 it->pixel_width += thick;
24813 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
24814 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
24815 if (face->overline_p)
24816 it->ascent += overline_margin;
24818 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24820 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24821 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24822 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24823 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24826 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24828 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
24829 if (it->glyph_row)
24831 if (stretched_p)
24833 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
24834 into a stretch glyph. */
24835 int ascent = (((it->ascent + it->descent) * FONT_BASE (font))
24836 / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24837 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24838 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
24840 else
24841 append_glyph (it);
24843 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
24844 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
24845 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
24846 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
24847 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
24849 if (! stretched_p && it->pixel_width == 0)
24850 /* We assure that all visible glyphs have at least 1-pixel
24851 width. */
24852 it->pixel_width = 1;
24854 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
24856 /* A newline has no width, but we need the height of the
24857 line. But if previous part of the line sets a height,
24858 don't increase that height */
24860 Lisp_Object height;
24861 Lisp_Object total_height = Qnil;
24863 it->override_ascent = -1;
24864 it->pixel_width = 0;
24865 it->nglyphs = 0;
24867 height = get_it_property (it, Qline_height);
24868 /* Split (line-height total-height) list */
24869 if (CONSP (height)
24870 && CONSP (XCDR (height))
24871 && NILP (XCDR (XCDR (height))))
24873 total_height = XCAR (XCDR (height));
24874 height = XCAR (height);
24876 height = calc_line_height_property (it, height, font, boff, 1);
24878 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24880 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24881 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24882 boff = it->override_boff;
24884 else
24886 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24887 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24890 if (EQ (height, Qt))
24892 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24894 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24895 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24897 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24899 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24900 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24902 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24903 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24904 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 1;
24905 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24907 else
24909 Lisp_Object spacing;
24911 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24912 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24914 if ((it->max_ascent > 0 || it->max_descent > 0)
24915 && face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
24916 && face->box_line_width > 0)
24918 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
24919 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
24921 if (!NILP (height)
24922 && XINT (height) > it->ascent + it->descent)
24923 it->ascent = XINT (height) - it->descent;
24925 if (!NILP (total_height))
24926 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, total_height, font, boff, 0);
24927 else
24929 spacing = get_it_property (it, Qline_spacing);
24930 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, spacing, font, boff, 0);
24932 if (INTEGERP (spacing))
24934 extra_line_spacing = XINT (spacing);
24935 if (!NILP (total_height))
24936 extra_line_spacing -= (it->phys_ascent + it->phys_descent);
24940 else /* i.e. (it->char_to_display == '\t') */
24942 if (font->space_width > 0)
24944 int tab_width = it->tab_width * font->space_width;
24945 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
24946 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
24948 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
24949 stop is less than a space character width, use the
24950 tab stop after that. */
24951 if (next_tab_x - x < font->space_width)
24952 next_tab_x += tab_width;
24954 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
24955 it->nglyphs = 1;
24956 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24957 it->descent = it->phys_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24959 if (it->glyph_row)
24961 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24962 it->ascent + it->descent, it->ascent);
24965 else
24967 it->pixel_width = 0;
24968 it->nglyphs = 1;
24972 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
24974 /* A static composition.
24976 Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
24977 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs.
24979 Important note: pixel_width, ascent, and descent are the
24980 values of what is drawn by draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of
24981 the overall glyphs composed). */
24982 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24983 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24984 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
24985 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len;
24986 struct font *font = face->font;
24988 it->nglyphs = 1;
24990 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
24991 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
24992 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
24993 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
24994 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This may
24995 lead to incorrect display, but it's very rare, and C-l
24996 (recenter-top-bottom) can correct the display anyway. */
24997 if (! cmp->font || cmp->font != font)
24999 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character
25000 of this composition (adjusted by baseline offset).
25001 Ascent and descent of overall glyphs should not be less
25002 than these, respectively. */
25003 int font_ascent, font_descent, font_height;
25004 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
25005 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
25006 int lbearing, rbearing;
25007 int i, width, ascent, descent;
25008 int left_padded = 0, right_padded = 0;
25009 int c IF_LINT (= 0); /* cmp->glyph_len can't be zero; see Bug#8512 */
25010 XChar2b char2b;
25011 struct font_metrics *pcm;
25012 int font_not_found_p;
25013 ptrdiff_t pos;
25015 for (glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; glyph_len > 0; glyph_len--)
25016 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, glyph_len - 1)) != '\t')
25017 break;
25018 if (glyph_len < cmp->glyph_len)
25019 right_padded = 1;
25020 for (i = 0; i < glyph_len; i++)
25022 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
25023 break;
25024 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
25026 if (i > 0)
25027 left_padded = 1;
25029 pos = (STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
25030 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
25031 /* If no suitable font is found, use the default font. */
25032 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
25033 if (font_not_found_p)
25035 face = face->ascii_face;
25036 font = face->font;
25038 boff = font->baseline_offset;
25039 if (font->vertical_centering)
25040 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
25041 font_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
25042 font_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
25043 font_height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
25045 cmp->font = font;
25047 pcm = NULL;
25048 if (! font_not_found_p)
25050 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, c, it->face_id,
25051 &char2b, 0);
25052 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25055 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
25056 if (pcm)
25058 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? pcm->width : 0;
25059 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25060 descent = pcm->descent;
25061 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25062 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25064 else
25066 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? font->space_width : 0;
25067 ascent = FONT_BASE (font);
25068 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font);
25069 lbearing = 0;
25070 rbearing = width;
25073 rightmost = width;
25074 leftmost = 0;
25075 lowest = - descent + boff;
25076 highest = ascent + boff;
25078 if (! font_not_found_p
25079 && font->default_ascent
25080 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
25081 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
25082 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
25083 highest = font->default_ascent + boff;
25085 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
25086 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn
25087 at the left. */
25088 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = 0;
25089 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = boff;
25090 cmp->lbearing = lbearing;
25091 cmp->rbearing = rbearing;
25093 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
25094 for (i++; i < glyph_len; i++)
25096 int left, right, btm, top;
25097 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
25098 int face_id;
25099 struct face *this_face;
25101 if (ch == '\t')
25102 ch = ' ';
25103 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch, pos, it->string);
25104 this_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
25105 font = this_face->font;
25107 if (font == NULL)
25108 pcm = NULL;
25109 else
25111 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face_id,
25112 &char2b, 0);
25113 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25115 if (! pcm)
25116 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
25117 else
25119 width = pcm->width;
25120 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25121 descent = pcm->descent;
25122 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25123 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25124 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
25126 /* Relative composition with or without
25127 alternate chars. */
25128 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
25129 btm = - descent + boff;
25130 if (font->relative_compose
25131 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
25132 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
25133 make_number (ch)))))
25136 if (- descent >= font->relative_compose)
25137 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25138 btm = highest + 1;
25139 else if (ascent <= 0)
25140 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25141 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
25144 else
25146 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
25147 value that encodes global and new reference
25148 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
25149 specified by numbers as below:
25151 0---1---2 -- ascent
25155 9--10--11 -- center
25157 ---3---4---5--- baseline
25159 6---7---8 -- descent
25161 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
25162 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy, xoff, yoff;
25164 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref, xoff, yoff);
25165 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
25166 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
25167 if (xoff)
25168 xoff = font_height * (xoff - 128) / 256;
25169 if (yoff)
25170 yoff = font_height * (yoff - 128) / 256;
25172 left = (leftmost
25173 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
25174 - nrefx * width / 2
25175 + xoff);
25177 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
25178 : grefy == 1 ? 0
25179 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
25180 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
25181 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
25182 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
25183 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
25184 : (ascent + descent) / 2)
25185 + yoff);
25188 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
25189 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
25191 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
25192 if (width > 0)
25194 right = left + width;
25195 if (left < leftmost)
25196 leftmost = left;
25197 if (right > rightmost)
25198 rightmost = right;
25200 top = btm + descent + ascent;
25201 if (top > highest)
25202 highest = top;
25203 if (btm < lowest)
25204 lowest = btm;
25206 if (cmp->lbearing > left + lbearing)
25207 cmp->lbearing = left + lbearing;
25208 if (cmp->rbearing < left + rbearing)
25209 cmp->rbearing = left + rbearing;
25213 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
25214 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
25215 non-negative. */
25216 if (leftmost < 0)
25218 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25219 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
25220 rightmost -= leftmost;
25221 cmp->lbearing -= leftmost;
25222 cmp->rbearing -= leftmost;
25225 if (left_padded && cmp->lbearing < 0)
25227 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25228 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= cmp->lbearing;
25229 rightmost -= cmp->lbearing;
25230 cmp->rbearing -= cmp->lbearing;
25231 cmp->lbearing = 0;
25233 if (right_padded && rightmost < cmp->rbearing)
25235 rightmost = cmp->rbearing;
25238 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
25239 cmp->ascent = highest;
25240 cmp->descent = - lowest;
25241 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
25242 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
25243 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
25244 cmp->descent = font_descent;
25247 if (it->glyph_row
25248 && (cmp->lbearing < 0
25249 || cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width))
25250 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25252 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
25253 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
25254 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
25255 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25257 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25259 if (thick > 0)
25261 it->ascent += thick;
25262 it->descent += thick;
25264 else
25265 thick = - thick;
25267 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25268 it->pixel_width += thick;
25269 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25270 it->pixel_width += thick;
25273 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25274 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25275 if (face->overline_p)
25276 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25278 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25279 if (it->ascent < 0)
25280 it->ascent = 0;
25281 if (it->descent < 0)
25282 it->descent = 0;
25284 if (it->glyph_row && cmp->glyph_len > 0)
25285 append_composite_glyph (it);
25287 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
25289 /* A dynamic (automatic) composition. */
25290 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
25291 Lisp_Object gstring;
25292 struct font_metrics metrics;
25294 it->nglyphs = 1;
25296 gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
25297 it->pixel_width
25298 = composition_gstring_width (gstring, it->cmp_it.from, it->cmp_it.to,
25299 &metrics);
25300 if (it->glyph_row
25301 && (metrics.lbearing < 0 || metrics.rbearing > metrics.width))
25302 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25303 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = metrics.ascent;
25304 it->descent = it->phys_descent = metrics.descent;
25305 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25307 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25309 if (thick > 0)
25311 it->ascent += thick;
25312 it->descent += thick;
25314 else
25315 thick = - thick;
25317 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25318 it->pixel_width += thick;
25319 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25320 it->pixel_width += thick;
25322 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25323 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25324 if (face->overline_p)
25325 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25326 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25327 if (it->ascent < 0)
25328 it->ascent = 0;
25329 if (it->descent < 0)
25330 it->descent = 0;
25332 if (it->glyph_row)
25333 append_composite_glyph (it);
25335 else if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
25336 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 0, Qnil);
25337 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
25338 produce_image_glyph (it);
25339 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
25340 produce_stretch_glyph (it);
25342 done:
25343 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
25344 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
25345 eassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
25346 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
25347 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
25349 if (extra_line_spacing > 0)
25351 it->descent += extra_line_spacing;
25352 if (extra_line_spacing > it->max_extra_line_spacing)
25353 it->max_extra_line_spacing = extra_line_spacing;
25356 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
25357 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
25358 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
25359 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
25362 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25363 Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
25364 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
25365 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
25366 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
25367 row being updated. */
25369 void
25370 x_write_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
25372 int x, hpos, chpos = updated_window->phys_cursor.hpos;
25374 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25375 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
25376 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
25377 margin in that case. */
25378 if (!updated_row->reversed_p && chpos < 0)
25379 chpos = 0;
25380 if (updated_row->reversed_p && chpos >= updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25381 chpos = updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25383 block_input ();
25385 /* Write glyphs. */
25387 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
25388 x = draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
25389 updated_row, updated_area,
25390 hpos, hpos + len,
25391 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
25393 /* Invalidate old phys cursor if the glyph at its hpos is redrawn. */
25394 if (updated_area == TEXT_AREA
25395 && updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p
25396 && updated_window->phys_cursor.vpos == output_cursor.vpos
25397 && chpos >= hpos
25398 && chpos < hpos + len)
25399 updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25401 unblock_input ();
25403 /* Advance the output cursor. */
25404 output_cursor.hpos += len;
25405 output_cursor.x = x;
25409 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25410 Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
25412 void
25413 x_insert_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
25415 struct frame *f;
25416 struct window *w;
25417 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
25418 struct glyph_row *row;
25419 struct glyph *glyph;
25420 int frame_x, frame_y;
25421 ptrdiff_t hpos;
25423 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25424 block_input ();
25425 w = updated_window;
25426 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
25428 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
25429 row = updated_row;
25430 line_height = row->height;
25432 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
25433 shift_by_width = 0;
25434 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
25435 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
25437 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
25438 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
25439 - output_cursor.x
25440 - shift_by_width);
25442 /* Shift right. */
25443 frame_x = window_box_left (w, updated_area) + output_cursor.x;
25444 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
25446 FRAME_RIF (f)->shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, frame_x, frame_y, shifted_region_width,
25447 line_height, shift_by_width);
25449 /* Write the glyphs. */
25450 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
25451 draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area,
25452 hpos, hpos + len,
25453 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
25455 /* Advance the output cursor. */
25456 output_cursor.hpos += len;
25457 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
25458 unblock_input ();
25462 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25463 Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
25464 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
25465 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
25467 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
25468 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
25470 void
25471 x_clear_end_of_line (int to_x)
25473 struct frame *f;
25474 struct window *w = updated_window;
25475 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
25476 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
25478 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25479 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25481 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
25482 max_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
25483 else
25484 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
25485 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
25487 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
25488 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
25489 if (to_x == 0)
25490 return;
25491 else if (to_x < 0)
25492 to_x = max_x;
25493 else
25494 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
25496 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
25498 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
25499 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
25500 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, updated_area,
25501 output_cursor.x, -1,
25502 updated_row->y,
25503 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (updated_row));
25505 from_x = output_cursor.x;
25507 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
25508 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
25510 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
25511 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
25513 else
25515 int area_left = window_box_left (w, updated_area);
25516 from_x += area_left;
25517 to_x += area_left;
25520 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
25521 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
25522 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
25524 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
25525 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
25527 block_input ();
25528 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, from_x, from_y,
25529 to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y);
25530 unblock_input ();
25534 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25538 /***********************************************************************
25539 Cursor types
25540 ***********************************************************************/
25542 /* Value is the internal representation of the specified cursor type
25543 ARG. If type is BAR_CURSOR, return in *WIDTH the specified width
25544 of the bar cursor. */
25546 static enum text_cursor_kinds
25547 get_specified_cursor_type (Lisp_Object arg, int *width)
25549 enum text_cursor_kinds type;
25551 if (NILP (arg))
25552 return NO_CURSOR;
25554 if (EQ (arg, Qbox))
25555 return FILLED_BOX_CURSOR;
25557 if (EQ (arg, Qhollow))
25558 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25560 if (EQ (arg, Qbar))
25562 *width = 2;
25563 return BAR_CURSOR;
25566 if (CONSP (arg)
25567 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qbar)
25568 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
25570 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
25571 return BAR_CURSOR;
25574 if (EQ (arg, Qhbar))
25576 *width = 2;
25577 return HBAR_CURSOR;
25580 if (CONSP (arg)
25581 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qhbar)
25582 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
25584 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
25585 return HBAR_CURSOR;
25588 /* Treat anything unknown as "hollow box cursor".
25589 It was bad to signal an error; people have trouble fixing
25590 .Xdefaults with Emacs, when it has something bad in it. */
25591 type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25593 return type;
25596 /* Set the default cursor types for specified frame. */
25597 void
25598 set_frame_cursor_types (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object arg)
25600 int width = 1;
25601 Lisp_Object tem;
25603 FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f) = get_specified_cursor_type (arg, &width);
25604 FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
25606 /* By default, set up the blink-off state depending on the on-state. */
25608 tem = Fassoc (arg, Vblink_cursor_alist);
25609 if (!NILP (tem))
25611 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f)
25612 = get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (tem), &width);
25613 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
25615 else
25616 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
25620 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25622 /* Return the cursor we want to be displayed in window W. Return
25623 width of bar/hbar cursor through WIDTH arg. Return with
25624 ACTIVE_CURSOR arg set to 1 if cursor in window W is `active'
25625 (i.e. if the `system caret' should track this cursor).
25627 In a mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we
25628 are reading input from this window. For the selected window, we
25629 want the cursor type given by the frame parameter or buffer local
25630 setting of cursor-type. If explicitly marked off, draw no cursor.
25631 In all other cases, we want a hollow box cursor. */
25633 static enum text_cursor_kinds
25634 get_window_cursor_type (struct window *w, struct glyph *glyph, int *width,
25635 int *active_cursor)
25637 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25638 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
25639 int cursor_type = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
25640 Lisp_Object alt_cursor;
25641 int non_selected = 0;
25643 *active_cursor = 1;
25645 /* Echo area */
25646 if (cursor_in_echo_area
25647 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
25648 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
25650 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
25652 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt) || NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
25654 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25655 return FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
25657 else
25658 return get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
25661 *active_cursor = 0;
25662 non_selected = 1;
25665 /* Detect a nonselected window or nonselected frame. */
25666 else if (w != XWINDOW (f->selected_window)
25667 || f != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame)
25669 *active_cursor = 0;
25671 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && minibuf_level == 0)
25672 return NO_CURSOR;
25674 non_selected = 1;
25677 /* Never display a cursor in a window in which cursor-type is nil. */
25678 if (NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
25679 return NO_CURSOR;
25681 /* Get the normal cursor type for this window. */
25682 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt))
25684 cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
25685 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25687 else
25688 cursor_type = get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
25690 /* Use cursor-in-non-selected-windows instead
25691 for non-selected window or frame. */
25692 if (non_selected)
25694 alt_cursor = BVAR (b, cursor_in_non_selected_windows);
25695 if (!EQ (Qt, alt_cursor))
25696 return get_specified_cursor_type (alt_cursor, width);
25697 /* t means modify the normal cursor type. */
25698 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25699 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25700 else if (cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR && *width > 1)
25701 --*width;
25702 return cursor_type;
25705 /* Use normal cursor if not blinked off. */
25706 if (!w->cursor_off_p)
25708 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
25710 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25712 /* Using a block cursor on large images can be very annoying.
25713 So use a hollow cursor for "large" images.
25714 If image is not transparent (no mask), also use hollow cursor. */
25715 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
25716 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
25718 /* Arbitrarily, interpret "Large" as >32x32 and >NxN
25719 where N = size of default frame font size.
25720 This should cover most of the "tiny" icons people may use. */
25721 if (!img->mask
25722 || img->width > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w))
25723 || img->height > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w)))
25724 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25727 else if (cursor_type != NO_CURSOR)
25729 /* Display current only supports BOX and HOLLOW cursors for images.
25730 So for now, unconditionally use a HOLLOW cursor when cursor is
25731 not a solid box cursor. */
25732 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25735 return cursor_type;
25738 /* Cursor is blinked off, so determine how to "toggle" it. */
25740 /* First look for an entry matching the buffer's cursor-type in blink-cursor-alist. */
25741 if ((alt_cursor = Fassoc (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Vblink_cursor_alist), !NILP (alt_cursor)))
25742 return get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (alt_cursor), width);
25744 /* Then see if frame has specified a specific blink off cursor type. */
25745 if (FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) != DEFAULT_CURSOR)
25747 *width = FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25748 return FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f);
25751 #if 0
25752 /* Some people liked having a permanently visible blinking cursor,
25753 while others had very strong opinions against it. So it was
25754 decided to remove it. KFS 2003-09-03 */
25756 /* Finally perform built-in cursor blinking:
25757 filled box <-> hollow box
25758 wide [h]bar <-> narrow [h]bar
25759 narrow [h]bar <-> no cursor
25760 other type <-> no cursor */
25762 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25763 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25765 if ((cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR) && *width > 1)
25767 *width = 1;
25768 return cursor_type;
25770 #endif
25772 return NO_CURSOR;
25776 /* Notice when the text cursor of window W has been completely
25777 overwritten by a drawing operation that outputs glyphs in AREA
25778 starting at X0 and ending at X1 in the line starting at Y0 and
25779 ending at Y1. X coordinates are area-relative. X1 < 0 means all
25780 the rest of the line after X0 has been written. Y coordinates
25781 are window-relative. */
25783 static void
25784 notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area,
25785 int x0, int x1, int y0, int y1)
25787 int cx0, cx1, cy0, cy1;
25788 struct glyph_row *row;
25790 if (!w->phys_cursor_on_p)
25791 return;
25792 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
25793 return;
25795 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos < 0
25796 || w->phys_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
25797 || (row = w->current_matrix->rows + w->phys_cursor.vpos,
25798 !(row->enabled_p && row->displays_text_p)))
25799 return;
25801 if (row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25803 row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25804 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, row->reversed_p);
25805 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25806 return;
25809 cx0 = w->phys_cursor.x;
25810 cx1 = cx0 + w->phys_cursor_width;
25811 if (x0 > cx0 || (x1 >= 0 && x1 < cx1))
25812 return;
25814 /* The cursor image will be completely removed from the
25815 screen if the output area intersects the cursor area in
25816 y-direction. When we draw in [y0 y1[, and some part of
25817 the cursor is at y < y0, that part must have been drawn
25818 before. When scrolling, the cursor is erased before
25819 actually scrolling, so we don't come here. When not
25820 scrolling, the rows above the old cursor row must have
25821 changed, and in this case these rows must have written
25822 over the cursor image.
25824 Likewise if part of the cursor is below y1, with the
25825 exception of the cursor being in the first blank row at
25826 the buffer and window end because update_text_area
25827 doesn't draw that row. (Except when it does, but
25828 that's handled in update_text_area.) */
25830 cy0 = w->phys_cursor.y;
25831 cy1 = cy0 + w->phys_cursor_height;
25832 if ((y0 < cy0 || y0 >= cy1) && (y1 <= cy0 || y1 >= cy1))
25833 return;
25835 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25838 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25841 /************************************************************************
25842 Mouse Face
25843 ************************************************************************/
25845 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25847 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25848 Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W
25849 with respect to the overlapping part OVERLAPS. */
25851 void
25852 x_fix_overlapping_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25853 enum glyph_row_area area, int overlaps)
25855 int i, x;
25857 block_input ();
25859 x = 0;
25860 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
25862 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
25864 int start = i, start_x = x;
25868 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25869 ++i;
25871 while (i < row->used[area]
25872 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
25874 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area,
25875 start, i,
25876 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, overlaps);
25878 else
25880 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25881 ++i;
25885 unblock_input ();
25889 /* EXPORT:
25890 Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
25891 comment of draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
25893 void
25894 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25895 enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
25897 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
25898 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
25899 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
25900 if ((row->reversed_p
25901 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= 0)
25902 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
25904 int on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
25905 int x1;
25906 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25908 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
25909 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
25910 window margin in that case. */
25911 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
25912 hpos = 0;
25913 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25914 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25916 x1 = draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA, hpos, hpos + 1,
25917 hl, 0);
25918 w->phys_cursor_on_p = on_p;
25920 if (hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
25921 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25922 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
25923 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
25924 are redrawn. */
25925 else if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
25927 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25929 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
25930 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
25931 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA,
25932 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25934 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
25935 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
25936 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA,
25937 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25943 /* EXPORT:
25944 Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
25946 void
25947 erase_phys_cursor (struct window *w)
25949 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25950 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
25951 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25952 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
25953 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
25954 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
25955 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
25956 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
25957 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
25959 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
25960 screen. */
25961 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
25962 goto mark_cursor_off;
25964 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
25965 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
25966 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
25967 goto mark_cursor_off;
25969 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
25970 can do. */
25971 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
25972 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
25973 goto mark_cursor_off;
25975 /* If line spacing is > 0, old cursor may only be partially visible in
25976 window after split-window. So adjust visible height. */
25977 cursor_row->visible_height = min (cursor_row->visible_height,
25978 window_text_bottom_y (w) - cursor_row->y);
25980 /* If row is completely invisible, don't attempt to delete a cursor which
25981 isn't there. This can happen if cursor is at top of a window, and
25982 we switch to a buffer with a header line in that window. */
25983 if (cursor_row->visible_height <= 0)
25984 goto mark_cursor_off;
25986 /* If cursor is in the fringe, erase by drawing actual bitmap there. */
25987 if (cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25989 cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25990 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, cursor_row, cursor_row->reversed_p);
25991 goto mark_cursor_off;
25994 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
25995 In this case, either draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
25996 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
25997 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
25998 cursor glyph at hand. */
25999 if ((cursor_row->reversed_p
26000 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
26001 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
26002 goto mark_cursor_off;
26004 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
26005 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
26006 margin in that case. */
26007 if (!cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26008 hpos = 0;
26009 if (cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26010 hpos = cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26012 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
26013 we clear the cursor. */
26014 if (! NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26015 && coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos)
26016 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
26017 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
26018 mouse highlighting does not. */
26019 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos && hpos >= 0)
26020 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
26022 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
26023 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
26025 int x, y, left_x;
26026 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
26027 int width;
26029 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
26030 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
26031 goto mark_cursor_off;
26033 width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
26034 left_x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA);
26035 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
26036 if (x < left_x)
26037 width -= left_x - x;
26038 width = min (width, window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA) - x);
26039 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height, cursor_row->y));
26040 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, max (x, left_x));
26042 if (width > 0)
26043 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, cursor_row->visible_height);
26046 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
26047 if (mouse_face_here_p)
26048 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
26049 else
26050 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
26051 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
26053 mark_cursor_off:
26054 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26055 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
26059 /* EXPORT:
26060 Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
26061 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
26062 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
26064 void
26065 display_and_set_cursor (struct window *w, int on,
26066 int hpos, int vpos, int x, int y)
26068 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
26069 int new_cursor_type;
26070 int new_cursor_width;
26071 int active_cursor;
26072 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
26073 struct glyph *glyph;
26075 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
26076 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
26077 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
26078 window. */
26079 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
26080 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
26081 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26082 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26083 return;
26085 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
26086 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26087 return;
26089 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26090 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
26091 display the cursor. */
26092 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
26094 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26095 return;
26098 glyph = NULL;
26099 if (!glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
26100 || (0 <= hpos && hpos < glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]))
26101 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
26103 eassert (input_blocked_p ());
26105 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. */
26106 new_cursor_type = get_window_cursor_type (w, glyph,
26107 &new_cursor_width, &active_cursor);
26109 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
26110 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
26111 erase it. */
26112 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
26113 && (!on
26114 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
26115 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
26116 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type
26117 || ((new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || new_cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR)
26118 && new_cursor_width != w->phys_cursor_width)))
26119 erase_phys_cursor (w);
26121 /* Don't check phys_cursor_on_p here because that flag is only set
26122 to zero in some cases where we know that the cursor has been
26123 completely erased, to avoid the extra work of erasing the cursor
26124 twice. In other words, phys_cursor_on_p can be 1 and the cursor
26125 still not be visible, or it has only been partly erased. */
26126 if (on)
26128 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
26129 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
26131 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
26132 of them may need the information. */
26133 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
26134 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
26135 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
26136 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
26139 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y,
26140 new_cursor_type, new_cursor_width,
26141 on, active_cursor);
26145 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
26146 of ON. */
26148 static void
26149 update_window_cursor (struct window *w, int on)
26151 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
26152 of being deleted. */
26153 if (w->current_matrix)
26155 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26156 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26157 struct glyph_row *row;
26159 if (vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26160 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26161 return;
26163 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26165 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26166 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26167 window margin in that case. */
26168 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26169 hpos = 0;
26170 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26171 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26173 block_input ();
26174 display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos,
26175 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26176 unblock_input ();
26181 /* Call update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
26182 in the window tree rooted at W. */
26184 static void
26185 update_cursor_in_window_tree (struct window *w, int on_p)
26187 while (w)
26189 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
26190 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
26191 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
26192 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
26193 else
26194 update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
26196 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
26201 /* EXPORT:
26202 Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
26203 Don't change the cursor's position. */
26205 void
26206 x_update_cursor (struct frame *f, int on_p)
26208 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
26212 /* EXPORT:
26213 Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
26214 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
26215 is about to be rewritten. */
26217 void
26218 x_clear_cursor (struct window *w)
26220 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26221 update_window_cursor (w, 0);
26224 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26226 /* Implementation of draw_row_with_mouse_face for GUI sessions, GPM,
26227 and MSDOS. */
26228 static void
26229 draw_row_with_mouse_face (struct window *w, int start_x, struct glyph_row *row,
26230 int start_hpos, int end_hpos,
26231 enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26233 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26234 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
26236 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, 0);
26237 return;
26239 #endif
26240 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS) || defined (WINDOWSNT)
26241 tty_draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, row, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26242 #endif
26245 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_* according to DRAW. */
26247 static void
26248 show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo, enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26250 struct window *w = XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window);
26251 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
26253 if (/* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
26254 to do anything. */
26255 w->current_matrix != NULL
26256 /* Don't update mouse highlight if hidden */
26257 && (draw != DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
26258 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
26259 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
26260 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row < w->current_matrix->nrows)
26262 int phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
26263 struct glyph_row *row, *first, *last;
26265 first = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
26266 last = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
26268 for (row = first; row <= last && row->enabled_p; ++row)
26270 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
26272 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
26273 if (row == first)
26275 /* R2L rows have BEG and END in reversed order, but the
26276 screen drawing geometry is always left to right. So
26277 we need to mirror the beginning and end of the
26278 highlighted area in R2L rows. */
26279 if (!row->reversed_p)
26281 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26282 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
26284 else if (row == last)
26286 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26287 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26289 else
26291 start_hpos = 0;
26292 start_x = 0;
26295 else if (row->reversed_p && row == last)
26297 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26298 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26300 else
26302 start_hpos = 0;
26303 start_x = 0;
26306 if (row == last)
26308 if (!row->reversed_p)
26309 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26310 else if (row == first)
26311 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26312 else
26314 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26315 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
26316 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
26319 else if (row->reversed_p && row == first)
26320 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26321 else
26323 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26324 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
26325 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
26328 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
26330 draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, start_x, row,
26331 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26333 row->mouse_face_p
26334 = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || draw == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
26338 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26339 /* When we've written over the cursor, arrange for it to
26340 be displayed again. */
26341 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
26342 && phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26344 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26346 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26347 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26348 window margin in that case. */
26349 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26350 hpos = 0;
26351 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26352 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26354 block_input ();
26355 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
26356 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26357 unblock_input ();
26359 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26362 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26363 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
26364 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
26366 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
26367 && !EQ (hlinfo->mouse_face_window, f->tool_bar_window))
26368 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor);
26369 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
26370 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor);
26371 else
26372 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor);
26374 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26377 /* EXPORT:
26378 Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
26379 Redraw it un-highlighted first. Value is non-zero if mouse
26380 face was actually drawn unhighlighted. */
26383 clear_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo)
26385 int cleared = 0;
26387 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && !NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
26389 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
26390 cleared = 1;
26393 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
26394 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
26395 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
26396 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
26397 return cleared;
26400 /* Return non-zero if the coordinates HPOS and VPOS on windows W are
26401 within the mouse face on that window. */
26402 static int
26403 coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w, int hpos, int vpos)
26405 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
26407 /* Quickly resolve the easy cases. */
26408 if (!(WINDOWP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26409 && XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window) == w))
26410 return 0;
26411 if (vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26412 || vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26413 return 0;
26414 if (vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26415 && vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26416 return 1;
26418 if (!MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p)
26420 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26422 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
26423 return 1;
26425 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26426 && hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26427 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
26428 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
26429 return 1;
26431 else
26433 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26435 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col < hpos && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26436 return 1;
26438 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26439 && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26440 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
26441 && hpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
26442 return 1;
26444 return 0;
26448 /* EXPORT:
26449 Non-zero if physical cursor of window W is within mouse face. */
26452 cursor_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w)
26454 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26455 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26456 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26458 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
26459 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
26460 margin in that case. */
26461 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26462 hpos = 0;
26463 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26464 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26466 return coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
26471 /* Find the glyph rows START_ROW and END_ROW of window W that display
26472 characters between buffer positions START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS
26473 (excluding END_CHARPOS). DISP_STRING is a display string that
26474 covers these buffer positions. This is similar to
26475 row_containing_pos, but is more accurate when bidi reordering makes
26476 buffer positions change non-linearly with glyph rows. */
26477 static void
26478 rows_from_pos_range (struct window *w,
26479 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
26480 Lisp_Object disp_string,
26481 struct glyph_row **start, struct glyph_row **end)
26483 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26484 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26485 struct glyph_row *row;
26487 *start = NULL;
26488 *end = NULL;
26490 while (!first->enabled_p
26491 && first < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w))
26492 first++;
26494 /* Find the START row. */
26495 for (row = first;
26496 row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y;
26497 row++)
26499 /* A row can potentially be the START row if the range of the
26500 characters it displays intersects the range
26501 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS). */
26502 if (! ((start_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
26503 && end_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
26504 /* See the commentary in row_containing_pos, for the
26505 explanation of the complicated way to check whether
26506 some position is beyond the end of the characters
26507 displayed by a row. */
26508 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26509 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26510 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26511 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
26512 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26513 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26514 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26515 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))))))
26517 /* Found a candidate row. Now make sure at least one of the
26518 glyphs it displays has a charpos from the range
26519 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS).
26521 This is not obvious because bidi reordering could make
26522 buffer positions of a row be 1,2,3,102,101,100, and if we
26523 want to highlight characters in [50..60), we don't want
26524 this row, even though [50..60) does intersect [1..103),
26525 the range of character positions given by the row's start
26526 and end positions. */
26527 struct glyph *g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26528 struct glyph *e = g + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26530 while (g < e)
26532 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
26533 && start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
26534 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
26535 definition to be highlighted. */
26536 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
26537 *start = row;
26538 g++;
26540 if (*start)
26541 break;
26545 /* Find the END row. */
26546 if (!*start
26547 /* If the last row is partially visible, start looking for END
26548 from that row, instead of starting from FIRST. */
26549 && !(row->enabled_p
26550 && row->y < last_y && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y))
26551 row = first;
26552 for ( ; row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y; row++)
26554 struct glyph_row *next = row + 1;
26555 ptrdiff_t next_start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next);
26557 if (!next->enabled_p
26558 || next >= MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w)
26559 /* The first row >= START whose range of displayed characters
26560 does NOT intersect the range [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS]
26561 is the row END + 1. */
26562 || (start_charpos < next_start
26563 && end_charpos < next_start)
26564 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26565 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26566 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
26567 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))
26568 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26569 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26570 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
26571 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))))
26573 *end = row;
26574 break;
26576 else
26578 /* If the next row's edges intersect [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS],
26579 but none of the characters it displays are in the range, it is
26580 also END + 1. */
26581 struct glyph *g = next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26582 struct glyph *s = g;
26583 struct glyph *e = g + next->used[TEXT_AREA];
26585 while (g < e)
26587 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
26588 && ((start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
26589 /* If the buffer position of the first glyph in
26590 the row is equal to END_CHARPOS, it means
26591 the last character to be highlighted is the
26592 newline of ROW, and we must consider NEXT as
26593 END, not END+1. */
26594 || (((!next->reversed_p && g == s)
26595 || (next->reversed_p && g == e - 1))
26596 && (g->charpos == end_charpos
26597 /* Special case for when NEXT is an
26598 empty line at ZV. */
26599 || (g->charpos == -1
26600 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26601 && next_start == end_charpos)))))
26602 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
26603 definition to be highlighted. */
26604 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
26605 break;
26606 g++;
26608 if (g == e)
26610 *end = row;
26611 break;
26613 /* The first row that ends at ZV must be the last to be
26614 highlighted. */
26615 else if (next->ends_at_zv_p)
26617 *end = next;
26618 break;
26624 /* This function sets the mouse_face_* elements of HLINFO, assuming
26625 the mouse cursor is on a glyph with buffer charpos MOUSE_CHARPOS in
26626 window WINDOW. START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS are buffer positions
26627 for the overlay or run of text properties specifying the mouse
26628 face. BEFORE_STRING and AFTER_STRING, if non-nil, are a
26629 before-string and after-string that must also be highlighted.
26630 DISP_STRING, if non-nil, is a display string that may cover some
26631 or all of the highlighted text. */
26633 static void
26634 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (Lisp_Object window,
26635 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
26636 ptrdiff_t mouse_charpos,
26637 ptrdiff_t start_charpos,
26638 ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
26639 Lisp_Object before_string,
26640 Lisp_Object after_string,
26641 Lisp_Object disp_string)
26643 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
26644 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26645 struct glyph_row *r1, *r2;
26646 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
26647 ptrdiff_t ignore, pos;
26648 int x;
26650 eassert (NILP (disp_string) || STRINGP (disp_string));
26651 eassert (NILP (before_string) || STRINGP (before_string));
26652 eassert (NILP (after_string) || STRINGP (after_string));
26654 /* Find the rows corresponding to START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26655 rows_from_pos_range (w, start_charpos, end_charpos, disp_string, &r1, &r2);
26656 if (r1 == NULL)
26657 r1 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26658 /* If the before-string or display-string contains newlines,
26659 rows_from_pos_range skips to its last row. Move back. */
26660 if (!NILP (before_string) || !NILP (disp_string))
26662 struct glyph_row *prev;
26663 while ((prev = r1 - 1, prev >= first)
26664 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (prev) == start_charpos
26665 && prev->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0)
26667 struct glyph *beg = prev->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26668 glyph = beg + prev->used[TEXT_AREA];
26669 while (--glyph >= beg && INTEGERP (glyph->object));
26670 if (glyph < beg
26671 || !(EQ (glyph->object, before_string)
26672 || EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)))
26673 break;
26674 r1 = prev;
26677 if (r2 == NULL)
26679 r2 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26680 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 1;
26682 else if (!NILP (after_string))
26684 /* If the after-string has newlines, advance to its last row. */
26685 struct glyph_row *next;
26686 struct glyph_row *last
26687 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26689 for (next = r2 + 1;
26690 next <= last
26691 && next->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
26692 && EQ (next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->object, after_string);
26693 ++next)
26694 r2 = next;
26696 /* The rest of the display engine assumes that mouse_face_beg_row is
26697 either above mouse_face_end_row or identical to it. But with
26698 bidi-reordered continued lines, the row for START_CHARPOS could
26699 be below the row for END_CHARPOS. If so, swap the rows and store
26700 them in correct order. */
26701 if (r1->y > r2->y)
26703 struct glyph_row *tem = r2;
26705 r2 = r1;
26706 r1 = tem;
26709 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r1->y;
26710 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, w->current_matrix);
26711 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r2->y;
26712 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r2, w->current_matrix);
26714 /* For a bidi-reordered row, the positions of BEFORE_STRING,
26715 AFTER_STRING, DISP_STRING, START_CHARPOS, and END_CHARPOS
26716 could be anywhere in the row and in any order. The strategy
26717 below is to find the leftmost and the rightmost glyph that
26718 belongs to either of these 3 strings, or whose position is
26719 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS, and highlight all the
26720 glyphs between those two. This may cover more than just the text
26721 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS if the range of characters
26722 strides the bidi level boundary, e.g. if the beginning is in R2L
26723 text while the end is in L2R text or vice versa. */
26724 if (!r1->reversed_p)
26726 /* This row is in a left to right paragraph. Scan it left to
26727 right. */
26728 glyph = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26729 end = glyph + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
26730 x = r1->x;
26732 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
26733 if (r1->displays_text_p)
26734 for (; glyph < end
26735 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26736 && glyph->charpos < 0;
26737 ++glyph)
26738 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26740 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
26741 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
26742 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26743 for (; glyph < end
26744 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26745 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
26746 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
26747 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
26748 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
26749 ++glyph)
26751 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26752 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26753 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26754 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
26756 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string,
26757 start_charpos);
26758 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
26759 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
26760 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26761 break;
26763 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
26765 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26766 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26767 break;
26769 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26771 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
26772 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26774 else
26776 /* This row is in a right to left paragraph. Scan it right to
26777 left. */
26778 struct glyph *g;
26780 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26781 glyph = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
26783 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
26784 if (r1->displays_text_p)
26785 for (; glyph > end
26786 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26787 && glyph->charpos < 0;
26788 --glyph)
26791 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
26792 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
26793 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26794 for (; glyph > end
26795 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26796 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
26797 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
26798 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
26799 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
26800 --glyph)
26802 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26803 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26804 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26805 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
26807 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26808 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
26809 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
26810 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26811 break;
26813 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
26815 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26816 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26817 break;
26821 glyph++; /* first glyph to the right of the highlighted area */
26822 for (g = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = r1->x; g < glyph; g++)
26823 x += g->pixel_width;
26824 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
26825 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26828 /* If the highlight ends in a different row, compute GLYPH and END
26829 for the end row. Otherwise, reuse the values computed above for
26830 the row where the highlight begins. */
26831 if (r2 != r1)
26833 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26835 glyph = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26836 end = glyph + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26837 x = r2->x;
26839 else
26841 end = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26842 glyph = end + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26846 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26848 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26849 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26850 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26851 while (end > glyph
26852 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object))
26853 --end;
26854 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26855 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26856 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26857 and END_CHARPOS */
26858 for (--end;
26859 end > glyph
26860 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26861 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
26862 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26863 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26864 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26865 --end)
26867 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26868 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26869 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26870 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26872 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26873 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26874 break;
26876 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26878 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26879 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26880 break;
26883 /* Find the X coordinate of the last glyph to be highlighted. */
26884 for (; glyph <= end; ++glyph)
26885 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26887 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26888 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = glyph - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26890 else
26892 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26893 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26894 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26895 x = r2->x;
26896 end++;
26897 while (end < glyph
26898 && INTEGERP (end->object))
26900 x += end->pixel_width;
26901 ++end;
26903 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26904 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26905 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26906 and END_CHARPOS */
26907 for ( ;
26908 end < glyph
26909 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26910 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
26911 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26912 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26913 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26914 ++end)
26916 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26917 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26918 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26919 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26921 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26922 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26923 break;
26925 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26927 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26928 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26929 break;
26931 x += end->pixel_width;
26933 /* If we exited the above loop because we arrived at the last
26934 glyph of the row, and its buffer position is still not in
26935 range, it means the last character in range is the preceding
26936 newline. Bump the end column and x values to get past the
26937 last glyph. */
26938 if (end == glyph
26939 && BUFFERP (end->object)
26940 && (end->charpos < start_charpos
26941 || end->charpos >= end_charpos))
26943 x += end->pixel_width;
26944 ++end;
26946 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26947 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = end - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26950 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
26951 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
26952 = face_at_buffer_position (w, mouse_charpos, 0, 0, &ignore,
26953 mouse_charpos + 1,
26954 !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden, -1);
26955 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
26958 /* The following function is not used anymore (replaced with
26959 mouse_face_from_string_pos), but I leave it here for the time
26960 being, in case someone would. */
26962 #if 0 /* not used */
26964 /* Find the position of the glyph for position POS in OBJECT in
26965 window W's current matrix, and return in *X, *Y the pixel
26966 coordinates, and return in *HPOS, *VPOS the column/row of the glyph.
26968 RIGHT_P non-zero means return the position of the right edge of the
26969 glyph, RIGHT_P zero means return the left edge position.
26971 If no glyph for POS exists in the matrix, return the position of
26972 the glyph with the next smaller position that is in the matrix, if
26973 RIGHT_P is zero. If RIGHT_P is non-zero, and no glyph for POS
26974 exists in the matrix, return the position of the glyph with the
26975 next larger position in OBJECT.
26977 Value is non-zero if a glyph was found. */
26979 static int
26980 fast_find_string_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t pos, Lisp_Object object,
26981 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *x, int *y, int right_p)
26983 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26984 struct glyph_row *r;
26985 struct glyph *best_glyph = NULL;
26986 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
26987 int best_x = 0;
26989 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26990 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
26991 ++r)
26993 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26994 struct glyph *e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
26995 int gx;
26997 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
26998 if (EQ (g->object, object))
27000 if (g->charpos == pos)
27002 best_glyph = g;
27003 best_x = gx;
27004 best_row = r;
27005 goto found;
27007 else if (best_glyph == NULL
27008 || ((eabs (g->charpos - pos)
27009 < eabs (best_glyph->charpos - pos))
27010 && (right_p
27011 ? g->charpos < pos
27012 : g->charpos > pos)))
27014 best_glyph = g;
27015 best_x = gx;
27016 best_row = r;
27021 found:
27023 if (best_glyph)
27025 *x = best_x;
27026 *hpos = best_glyph - best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27028 if (right_p)
27030 *x += best_glyph->pixel_width;
27031 ++*hpos;
27034 *y = best_row->y;
27035 *vpos = best_row - w->current_matrix->rows;
27038 return best_glyph != NULL;
27040 #endif /* not used */
27042 /* Find the positions of the first and the last glyphs in window W's
27043 current matrix that occlude positions [STARTPOS..ENDPOS] in OBJECT
27044 (assumed to be a string), and return in HLINFO's mouse_face_*
27045 members the pixel and column/row coordinates of those glyphs. */
27047 static void
27048 mouse_face_from_string_pos (struct window *w, Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
27049 Lisp_Object object,
27050 ptrdiff_t startpos, ptrdiff_t endpos)
27052 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
27053 struct glyph_row *r;
27054 struct glyph *g, *e;
27055 int gx;
27056 int found = 0;
27058 /* Find the glyph row with at least one position in the range
27059 [STARTPOS..ENDPOS], and the first glyph in that row whose
27060 position belongs to that range. */
27061 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
27062 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
27063 ++r)
27065 if (!r->reversed_p)
27067 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27068 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27069 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
27070 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27071 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
27073 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27074 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
27075 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27076 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27077 found = 1;
27078 break;
27081 else
27083 struct glyph *g1;
27085 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27086 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27087 for ( ; g > e; --g)
27088 if (EQ ((g-1)->object, object)
27089 && startpos <= (g-1)->charpos && (g-1)->charpos <= endpos)
27091 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27092 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
27093 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27094 for (gx = r->x, g1 = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; g1 < g; ++g1)
27095 gx += g1->pixel_width;
27096 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27097 found = 1;
27098 break;
27101 if (found)
27102 break;
27105 if (!found)
27106 return;
27108 /* Starting with the next row, look for the first row which does NOT
27109 include any glyphs whose positions are in the range. */
27110 for (++r; r->enabled_p && r->y < yb; ++r)
27112 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27113 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27114 found = 0;
27115 for ( ; g < e; ++g)
27116 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27117 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
27119 found = 1;
27120 break;
27122 if (!found)
27123 break;
27126 /* The highlighted region ends on the previous row. */
27127 r--;
27129 /* Set the end row and its vertical pixel coordinate. */
27130 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27131 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r->y;
27133 /* Compute and set the end column and the end column's horizontal
27134 pixel coordinate. */
27135 if (!r->reversed_p)
27137 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27138 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27139 for ( ; e > g; --e)
27140 if (EQ ((e-1)->object, object)
27141 && startpos <= (e-1)->charpos && (e-1)->charpos <= endpos)
27142 break;
27143 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - g;
27145 for (gx = r->x; g < e; ++g)
27146 gx += g->pixel_width;
27147 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27149 else
27151 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27152 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27153 for (gx = r->x ; e < g; ++e)
27155 if (EQ (e->object, object)
27156 && startpos <= e->charpos && e->charpos <= endpos)
27157 break;
27158 gx += e->pixel_width;
27160 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27161 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27165 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27167 /* See if position X, Y is within a hot-spot of an image. */
27169 static int
27170 on_hot_spot_p (Lisp_Object hot_spot, int x, int y)
27172 if (!CONSP (hot_spot))
27173 return 0;
27175 if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qrect))
27177 /* CDR is (Top-Left . Bottom-Right) = ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1)) */
27178 Lisp_Object rect = XCDR (hot_spot);
27179 Lisp_Object tem;
27180 if (!CONSP (rect))
27181 return 0;
27182 if (!CONSP (XCAR (rect)))
27183 return 0;
27184 if (!CONSP (XCDR (rect)))
27185 return 0;
27186 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x >= XINT (tem)))
27187 return 0;
27188 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y >= XINT (tem)))
27189 return 0;
27190 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x <= XINT (tem)))
27191 return 0;
27192 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y <= XINT (tem)))
27193 return 0;
27194 return 1;
27196 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qcircle))
27198 /* CDR is (Center . Radius) = ((x0 . y0) . r) */
27199 Lisp_Object circ = XCDR (hot_spot);
27200 Lisp_Object lr, lx0, ly0;
27201 if (CONSP (circ)
27202 && CONSP (XCAR (circ))
27203 && (lr = XCDR (circ), INTEGERP (lr) || FLOATP (lr))
27204 && (lx0 = XCAR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (lx0))
27205 && (ly0 = XCDR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (ly0)))
27207 double r = XFLOATINT (lr);
27208 double dx = XINT (lx0) - x;
27209 double dy = XINT (ly0) - y;
27210 return (dx * dx + dy * dy <= r * r);
27213 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qpoly))
27215 /* CDR is [x0 y0 x1 y1 x2 y2 ...x(n-1) y(n-1)] */
27216 if (VECTORP (XCDR (hot_spot)))
27218 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (XCDR (hot_spot));
27219 Lisp_Object *poly = v->contents;
27220 ptrdiff_t n = v->header.size;
27221 ptrdiff_t i;
27222 int inside = 0;
27223 Lisp_Object lx, ly;
27224 int x0, y0;
27226 /* Need an even number of coordinates, and at least 3 edges. */
27227 if (n < 6 || n & 1)
27228 return 0;
27230 /* Count edge segments intersecting line from (X,Y) to (X,infinity).
27231 If count is odd, we are inside polygon. Pixels on edges
27232 may or may not be included depending on actual geometry of the
27233 polygon. */
27234 if ((lx = poly[n-2], !INTEGERP (lx))
27235 || (ly = poly[n-1], !INTEGERP (lx)))
27236 return 0;
27237 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27238 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 2)
27240 int x1 = x0, y1 = y0;
27241 if ((lx = poly[i], !INTEGERP (lx))
27242 || (ly = poly[i+1], !INTEGERP (ly)))
27243 return 0;
27244 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27246 /* Does this segment cross the X line? */
27247 if (x0 >= x)
27249 if (x1 >= x)
27250 continue;
27252 else if (x1 < x)
27253 continue;
27254 if (y > y0 && y > y1)
27255 continue;
27256 if (y < y0 + ((y1 - y0) * (x - x0)) / (x1 - x0))
27257 inside = !inside;
27259 return inside;
27262 return 0;
27265 Lisp_Object
27266 find_hot_spot (Lisp_Object map, int x, int y)
27268 while (CONSP (map))
27270 if (CONSP (XCAR (map))
27271 && on_hot_spot_p (XCAR (XCAR (map)), x, y))
27272 return XCAR (map);
27273 map = XCDR (map);
27276 return Qnil;
27279 DEFUN ("lookup-image-map", Flookup_image_map, Slookup_image_map,
27280 3, 3, 0,
27281 doc: /* Lookup in image map MAP coordinates X and Y.
27282 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
27283 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
27284 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
27285 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
27286 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
27287 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
27288 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
27289 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
27290 Returns the alist element for the first matching AREA in MAP. */)
27291 (Lisp_Object map, Lisp_Object x, Lisp_Object y)
27293 if (NILP (map))
27294 return Qnil;
27296 CHECK_NUMBER (x);
27297 CHECK_NUMBER (y);
27299 return find_hot_spot (map,
27300 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (x), INT_MAX),
27301 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (y), INT_MAX));
27305 /* Display frame CURSOR, optionally using shape defined by POINTER. */
27306 static void
27307 define_frame_cursor1 (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor, Lisp_Object pointer)
27309 /* Do not change cursor shape while dragging mouse. */
27310 if (!NILP (do_mouse_tracking))
27311 return;
27313 if (!NILP (pointer))
27315 if (EQ (pointer, Qarrow))
27316 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27317 else if (EQ (pointer, Qhand))
27318 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor;
27319 else if (EQ (pointer, Qtext))
27320 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
27321 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hdrag")))
27322 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
27323 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27324 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("vdrag")))
27325 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27326 #endif
27327 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hourglass")))
27328 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hourglass_cursor;
27329 else if (EQ (pointer, Qmodeline))
27330 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->modeline_cursor;
27331 else
27332 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27335 if (cursor != No_Cursor)
27336 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, cursor);
27339 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27341 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or header line
27342 or marginal area AREA of window W, x-position X and y-position Y.
27343 X is relative to the start of the text display area of W, so the
27344 width of bitmap areas and scroll bars must be subtracted to get a
27345 position relative to the start of the mode line. */
27347 static void
27348 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (Lisp_Object window, int x, int y,
27349 enum window_part area)
27351 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
27352 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
27353 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27354 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27355 Display_Info *dpyinfo;
27356 #endif
27357 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
27358 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil;
27359 int dx, dy, width, height;
27360 ptrdiff_t charpos;
27361 Lisp_Object string, object = Qnil;
27362 Lisp_Object pos IF_LINT (= Qnil), help;
27364 Lisp_Object mouse_face;
27365 int original_x_pixel = x;
27366 struct glyph * glyph = NULL, * row_start_glyph = NULL;
27367 struct glyph_row *row IF_LINT (= 0);
27369 if (area == ON_MODE_LINE || area == ON_HEADER_LINE)
27371 int x0;
27372 struct glyph *end;
27374 /* Kludge alert: mode_line_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
27375 returns them in row/column units! */
27376 string = mode_line_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
27377 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
27379 row = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
27380 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
27381 : MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
27383 /* Find the glyph under the mouse pointer. */
27384 if (row->mode_line_p && row->enabled_p)
27386 glyph = row_start_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27387 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
27389 for (x0 = original_x_pixel;
27390 glyph < end && x0 >= glyph->pixel_width;
27391 ++glyph)
27392 x0 -= glyph->pixel_width;
27394 if (glyph >= end)
27395 glyph = NULL;
27398 else
27400 x -= WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
27401 /* Kludge alert: marginal_area_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
27402 returns them in row/column units! */
27403 string = marginal_area_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
27404 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
27407 help = Qnil;
27409 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27410 if (IMAGEP (object))
27412 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
27413 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCmap),
27414 !NILP (image_map))
27415 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map, dx, dy),
27416 CONSP (hotspot))
27417 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
27419 Lisp_Object plist;
27421 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave this hot-spot.
27422 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
27423 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
27424 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
27425 if (CONSP (hotspot)
27426 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
27428 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
27429 if (NILP (pointer))
27430 pointer = Qhand;
27431 help = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
27432 if (!NILP (help))
27434 help_echo_string = help;
27435 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27436 help_echo_object = w->buffer;
27437 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27441 if (NILP (pointer))
27442 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCpointer);
27444 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27446 if (STRINGP (string))
27447 pos = make_number (charpos);
27449 /* Set the help text and mouse pointer. If the mouse is on a part
27450 of the mode line without any text (e.g. past the right edge of
27451 the mode line text), use the default help text and pointer. */
27452 if (STRINGP (string) || area == ON_MODE_LINE)
27454 /* Arrange to display the help by setting the global variables
27455 help_echo_string, help_echo_object, and help_echo_pos. */
27456 if (NILP (help))
27458 if (STRINGP (string))
27459 help = Fget_text_property (pos, Qhelp_echo, string);
27461 if (!NILP (help))
27463 help_echo_string = help;
27464 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27465 help_echo_object = string;
27466 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27468 else if (area == ON_MODE_LINE)
27470 Lisp_Object default_help
27471 = buffer_local_value_1 (Qmode_line_default_help_echo,
27472 w->buffer);
27474 if (STRINGP (default_help))
27476 help_echo_string = default_help;
27477 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27478 help_echo_object = Qnil;
27479 help_echo_pos = -1;
27484 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27485 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under it. */
27486 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27488 dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
27489 if (STRINGP (string))
27491 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27493 if (NILP (pointer))
27494 pointer = Fget_text_property (pos, Qpointer, string);
27496 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
27497 if (NILP (pointer)
27498 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE)))
27500 Lisp_Object map;
27501 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qlocal_map, string);
27502 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
27503 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qkeymap, string);
27504 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
27505 cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27508 else
27509 /* Default mode-line pointer. */
27510 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27512 #endif
27515 /* Change the mouse face according to what is under X/Y. */
27516 if (STRINGP (string))
27518 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (pos, Qmouse_face, string);
27519 if (!NILP (mouse_face)
27520 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
27521 && glyph)
27523 Lisp_Object b, e;
27525 struct glyph * tmp_glyph;
27527 int gpos;
27528 int gseq_length;
27529 int total_pixel_width;
27530 ptrdiff_t begpos, endpos, ignore;
27532 int vpos, hpos;
27534 b = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (charpos + 1),
27535 Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
27536 if (NILP (b))
27537 begpos = 0;
27538 else
27539 begpos = XINT (b);
27541 e = Fnext_single_property_change (pos, Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
27542 if (NILP (e))
27543 endpos = SCHARS (string);
27544 else
27545 endpos = XINT (e);
27547 /* Calculate the glyph position GPOS of GLYPH in the
27548 displayed string, relative to the beginning of the
27549 highlighted part of the string.
27551 Note: GPOS is different from CHARPOS. CHARPOS is the
27552 position of GLYPH in the internal string object. A mode
27553 line string format has structures which are converted to
27554 a flattened string by the Emacs Lisp interpreter. The
27555 internal string is an element of those structures. The
27556 displayed string is the flattened string. */
27557 tmp_glyph = row_start_glyph;
27558 while (tmp_glyph < glyph
27559 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
27560 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
27561 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos)))
27562 tmp_glyph++;
27563 gpos = glyph - tmp_glyph;
27565 /* Calculate the length GSEQ_LENGTH of the glyph sequence of
27566 the highlighted part of the displayed string to which
27567 GLYPH belongs. Note: GSEQ_LENGTH is different from
27568 SCHARS (STRING), because the latter returns the length of
27569 the internal string. */
27570 for (tmp_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
27571 tmp_glyph > glyph
27572 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
27573 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
27574 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos));
27575 tmp_glyph--)
27577 gseq_length = gpos + (tmp_glyph - glyph) + 1;
27579 /* Calculate the total pixel width of all the glyphs between
27580 the beginning of the highlighted area and GLYPH. */
27581 total_pixel_width = 0;
27582 for (tmp_glyph = glyph - gpos; tmp_glyph != glyph; tmp_glyph++)
27583 total_pixel_width += tmp_glyph->pixel_width;
27585 /* Pre calculation of re-rendering position. Note: X is in
27586 column units here, after the call to mode_line_string or
27587 marginal_area_string. */
27588 hpos = x - gpos;
27589 vpos = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
27590 ? (w->current_matrix)->nrows - 1
27591 : 0);
27593 /* If GLYPH's position is included in the region that is
27594 already drawn in mouse face, we have nothing to do. */
27595 if ( EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27596 && (!row->reversed_p
27597 ? (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos
27598 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
27599 /* In R2L rows we swap BEG and END, see below. */
27600 : (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col <= hpos
27601 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
27602 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == vpos )
27603 return;
27605 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27606 cursor = No_Cursor;
27608 if (!row->reversed_p)
27610 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
27611 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = original_x_pixel
27612 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
27613 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + gseq_length;
27614 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = 0;
27616 else
27618 /* In R2L rows, show_mouse_face expects BEG and END
27619 coordinates to be swapped. */
27620 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos;
27621 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = original_x_pixel
27622 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
27623 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos + gseq_length;
27624 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = 0;
27627 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
27628 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row;
27629 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = 0;
27630 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = 0;
27631 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27632 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27634 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = face_at_string_position (w, string,
27635 charpos,
27636 0, 0, 0,
27637 &ignore,
27638 glyph->face_id,
27640 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27642 if (NILP (pointer))
27643 pointer = Qhand;
27645 else if ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
27646 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27648 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27649 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27650 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
27651 #endif
27655 /* EXPORT:
27656 Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
27657 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
27658 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
27659 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
27661 void
27662 note_mouse_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
27664 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27665 enum window_part part = ON_NOTHING;
27666 Lisp_Object window;
27667 struct window *w;
27668 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
27669 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil; /* Takes precedence over cursor! */
27670 struct buffer *b;
27672 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
27673 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (MSDOS)
27674 if (popup_activated ())
27675 return;
27676 #endif
27678 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight)
27679 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p
27680 || f->pointer_invisible)
27681 return;
27683 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
27684 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
27685 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
27687 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_defer)
27688 return;
27690 /* Which window is that in? */
27691 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &part, 1);
27693 /* If displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
27694 if (! EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27695 /* Also clear if we move out of text area in same window. */
27696 || (!NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27697 && !NILP (window)
27698 && part != ON_TEXT
27699 && part != ON_MODE_LINE
27700 && part != ON_HEADER_LINE))
27701 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27703 /* Not on a window -> return. */
27704 if (!WINDOWP (window))
27705 return;
27707 /* Reset help_echo_string. It will get recomputed below. */
27708 help_echo_string = Qnil;
27710 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
27711 w = XWINDOW (window);
27712 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
27714 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27715 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
27716 buffer. */
27717 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
27719 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
27720 return;
27722 #endif
27724 /* Mouse is on the mode, header line or margin? */
27725 if (part == ON_MODE_LINE || part == ON_HEADER_LINE
27726 || part == ON_LEFT_MARGIN || part == ON_RIGHT_MARGIN)
27728 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (window, x, y, part);
27729 return;
27732 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27733 if (part == ON_VERTICAL_BORDER)
27735 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
27736 help_echo_string = build_string ("drag-mouse-1: resize");
27738 else if (part == ON_LEFT_FRINGE || part == ON_RIGHT_FRINGE
27739 || part == ON_SCROLL_BAR)
27740 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27741 else
27742 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
27743 #endif
27745 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
27746 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
27747 b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
27748 if (part == ON_TEXT
27749 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
27750 && w->last_modified == BUF_MODIFF (b)
27751 && w->last_overlay_modified == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b))
27753 int hpos, vpos, dx, dy, area = LAST_AREA;
27754 ptrdiff_t pos;
27755 struct glyph *glyph;
27756 Lisp_Object object;
27757 Lisp_Object mouse_face = Qnil, position;
27758 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec = NULL;
27759 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
27760 struct buffer *obuf;
27761 ptrdiff_t obegv, ozv;
27762 int same_region;
27764 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
27765 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &dx, &dy, &area);
27767 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27768 /* Look for :pointer property on image. */
27769 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
27771 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
27772 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
27774 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
27775 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCmap),
27776 !NILP (image_map))
27777 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map,
27778 glyph->slice.img.x + dx,
27779 glyph->slice.img.y + dy),
27780 CONSP (hotspot))
27781 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
27783 Lisp_Object plist;
27785 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave
27786 this hot-spot.
27787 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
27788 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
27789 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
27790 if (CONSP (hotspot)
27791 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
27793 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
27794 if (NILP (pointer))
27795 pointer = Qhand;
27796 help_echo_string = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
27797 if (!NILP (help_echo_string))
27799 help_echo_window = window;
27800 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
27801 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
27805 if (NILP (pointer))
27806 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCpointer);
27809 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27811 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
27812 if (glyph == NULL
27813 || area != TEXT_AREA
27814 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p
27815 /* Glyph's OBJECT is an integer for glyphs inserted by the
27816 display engine for its internal purposes, like truncation
27817 and continuation glyphs and blanks beyond the end of
27818 line's text on text terminals. If we are over such a
27819 glyph, we are not over any text. */
27820 || INTEGERP (glyph->object)
27821 /* R2L rows have a stretch glyph at their front, which
27822 stands for no text, whereas L2R rows have no glyphs at
27823 all beyond the end of text. Treat such stretch glyphs
27824 like we do with NULL glyphs in L2R rows. */
27825 || (MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p
27826 && glyph == MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
27827 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
27828 && glyph->avoid_cursor_p))
27830 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27831 cursor = No_Cursor;
27832 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27833 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
27835 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
27836 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27837 else
27838 pointer = Vvoid_text_area_pointer;
27840 #endif
27841 goto set_cursor;
27844 pos = glyph->charpos;
27845 object = glyph->object;
27846 if (!STRINGP (object) && !BUFFERP (object))
27847 goto set_cursor;
27849 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
27850 if (BUFFERP (object) && pos > BUF_Z (b))
27851 goto set_cursor;
27853 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
27854 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
27855 obuf = current_buffer;
27856 current_buffer = b;
27857 obegv = BEGV;
27858 ozv = ZV;
27859 BEGV = BEG;
27860 ZV = Z;
27862 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
27863 position = make_number (pos);
27865 if (BUFFERP (object))
27867 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec. */
27868 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlay_vec, noverlays, NULL, 0);
27869 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
27870 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
27872 else
27873 noverlays = 0;
27875 same_region = coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
27877 if (same_region)
27878 cursor = No_Cursor;
27880 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
27881 if (! same_region
27882 /* If there exists an overlay with mouse-face overlapping
27883 the one we are currently highlighting, we have to
27884 check if we enter the overlapping overlay, and then
27885 highlight only that. */
27886 || (OVERLAYP (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)
27887 && mouse_face_overlay_overlaps (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)))
27889 /* Find the highest priority overlay with a mouse-face. */
27890 Lisp_Object overlay = Qnil;
27891 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (overlay); --i)
27893 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
27894 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27895 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
27898 /* If we're highlighting the same overlay as before, there's
27899 no need to do that again. */
27900 if (!NILP (overlay) && EQ (overlay, hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay))
27901 goto check_help_echo;
27902 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = overlay;
27904 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
27905 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27906 cursor = No_Cursor;
27908 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
27909 if (NILP (overlay))
27910 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, object);
27912 /* Next, compute the bounds of the mouse highlighting and
27913 display it. */
27914 if (!NILP (mouse_face) && STRINGP (object))
27916 /* The mouse-highlighting comes from a display string
27917 with a mouse-face. */
27918 Lisp_Object s, e;
27919 ptrdiff_t ignore;
27921 s = Fprevious_single_property_change
27922 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27923 e = Fnext_single_property_change
27924 (position, Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27925 if (NILP (s))
27926 s = make_number (0);
27927 if (NILP (e))
27928 e = make_number (SCHARS (object) - 1);
27929 mouse_face_from_string_pos (w, hlinfo, object,
27930 XINT (s), XINT (e));
27931 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27932 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27933 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
27934 = face_at_string_position (w, object, pos, 0, 0, 0, &ignore,
27935 glyph->face_id, 1);
27936 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27937 cursor = No_Cursor;
27939 else
27941 /* The mouse-highlighting, if any, comes from an overlay
27942 or text property in the buffer. */
27943 Lisp_Object buffer IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27944 Lisp_Object disp_string IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27946 if (STRINGP (object))
27948 /* If we are on a display string with no mouse-face,
27949 check if the text under it has one. */
27950 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
27951 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
27952 pos = string_buffer_position (object, start);
27953 if (pos > 0)
27955 mouse_face = get_char_property_and_overlay
27956 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, w->buffer, &overlay);
27957 buffer = w->buffer;
27958 disp_string = object;
27961 else
27963 buffer = object;
27964 disp_string = Qnil;
27967 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27969 Lisp_Object before, after;
27970 Lisp_Object before_string, after_string;
27971 /* To correctly find the limits of mouse highlight
27972 in a bidi-reordered buffer, we must not use the
27973 optimization of limiting the search in
27974 previous-single-property-change and
27975 next-single-property-change, because
27976 rows_from_pos_range needs the real start and end
27977 positions to DTRT in this case. That's because
27978 the first row visible in a window does not
27979 necessarily display the character whose position
27980 is the smallest. */
27981 Lisp_Object lim1 =
27982 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
27983 ? Fmarker_position (w->start)
27984 : Qnil;
27985 Lisp_Object lim2 =
27986 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
27987 ? make_number (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
27988 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
27989 : Qnil;
27991 if (NILP (overlay))
27993 /* Handle the text property case. */
27994 before = Fprevious_single_property_change
27995 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim1);
27996 after = Fnext_single_property_change
27997 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim2);
27998 before_string = after_string = Qnil;
28000 else
28002 /* Handle the overlay case. */
28003 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
28004 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
28005 before_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string);
28006 after_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string);
28008 if (!STRINGP (before_string)) before_string = Qnil;
28009 if (!STRINGP (after_string)) after_string = Qnil;
28012 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (window, hlinfo, pos,
28013 NILP (before)
28015 : XFASTINT (before),
28016 NILP (after)
28017 ? BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
28018 : XFASTINT (after),
28019 before_string, after_string,
28020 disp_string);
28021 cursor = No_Cursor;
28026 check_help_echo:
28028 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
28029 if (NILP (help_echo_string)) {
28030 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
28032 /* Check overlays first. */
28033 help = overlay = Qnil;
28034 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
28036 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
28037 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
28040 if (!NILP (help))
28042 help_echo_string = help;
28043 help_echo_window = window;
28044 help_echo_object = overlay;
28045 help_echo_pos = pos;
28047 else
28049 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28050 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28052 /* Try text properties. */
28053 if (STRINGP (obj)
28054 && charpos >= 0
28055 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28057 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28058 Qhelp_echo, obj);
28059 if (NILP (help))
28061 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a help-echo,
28062 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28063 struct glyph_row *r
28064 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28065 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28066 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28067 if (p > 0)
28069 help = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28070 Qhelp_echo, w->buffer);
28071 if (!NILP (help))
28073 charpos = p;
28074 obj = w->buffer;
28079 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28080 && charpos >= BEGV
28081 && charpos < ZV)
28082 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos), Qhelp_echo,
28083 obj);
28085 if (!NILP (help))
28087 help_echo_string = help;
28088 help_echo_window = window;
28089 help_echo_object = obj;
28090 help_echo_pos = charpos;
28095 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28096 /* Look for a `pointer' property. */
28097 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
28099 /* Check overlays first. */
28100 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (pointer); --i)
28101 pointer = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qpointer);
28103 if (NILP (pointer))
28105 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28106 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28108 /* Try text properties. */
28109 if (STRINGP (obj)
28110 && charpos >= 0
28111 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28113 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28114 Qpointer, obj);
28115 if (NILP (pointer))
28117 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a pointer,
28118 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28119 struct glyph_row *r
28120 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28121 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28122 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28123 if (p > 0)
28124 pointer = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28125 Qpointer, w->buffer);
28128 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28129 && charpos >= BEGV
28130 && charpos < ZV)
28131 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28132 Qpointer, obj);
28135 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28137 BEGV = obegv;
28138 ZV = ozv;
28139 current_buffer = obuf;
28142 set_cursor:
28144 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28145 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
28146 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
28147 #else
28148 /* This is here to prevent a compiler error, about "label at end of
28149 compound statement". */
28150 return;
28151 #endif
28155 /* EXPORT for RIF:
28156 Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
28157 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
28158 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
28160 void
28161 x_clear_window_mouse_face (struct window *w)
28163 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
28164 Lisp_Object window;
28166 block_input ();
28167 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
28168 if (EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
28169 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28170 unblock_input ();
28174 /* EXPORT:
28175 Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
28176 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
28178 void
28179 cancel_mouse_face (struct frame *f)
28181 Lisp_Object window;
28182 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28184 window = hlinfo->mouse_face_window;
28185 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
28187 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
28188 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
28189 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
28195 /***********************************************************************
28196 Exposure Events
28197 ***********************************************************************/
28199 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28201 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
28202 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
28204 static void
28205 expose_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r,
28206 enum glyph_row_area area)
28208 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
28209 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
28210 struct glyph *last;
28211 int first_x, start_x, x;
28213 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
28214 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
28215 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, area,
28216 0, row->used[area],
28217 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28218 else
28220 /* Set START_X to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
28221 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
28222 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
28223 start_x = window_box_left_offset (w, area);
28224 x = start_x;
28225 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
28226 x += row->x;
28228 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
28229 while (first < end
28230 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
28232 x += first->pixel_width;
28233 ++first;
28236 /* Find the last one. */
28237 last = first;
28238 first_x = x;
28239 while (last < end
28240 && x < r->x + r->width)
28242 x += last->pixel_width;
28243 ++last;
28246 /* Repaint. */
28247 if (last > first)
28248 draw_glyphs (w, first_x - start_x, row, area,
28249 first - row->glyphs[area], last - row->glyphs[area],
28250 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28255 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
28256 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. Value is
28257 non-zero if mouse-face was overwritten. */
28259 static int
28260 expose_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r)
28262 eassert (row->enabled_p);
28264 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
28265 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA,
28266 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
28267 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28268 else
28270 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28271 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
28272 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28273 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
28274 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28275 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
28276 draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row);
28279 return row->mouse_face_p;
28283 /* Redraw those parts of glyphs rows during expose event handling that
28284 overlap other rows. Redrawing of an exposed line writes over parts
28285 of lines overlapping that exposed line; this function fixes that.
28287 W is the window being exposed. FIRST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the first
28288 row in W's current matrix that is exposed and overlaps other rows.
28289 LAST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the last such row. */
28291 static void
28292 expose_overlaps (struct window *w,
28293 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row,
28294 struct glyph_row *last_overlapping_row,
28295 XRectangle *r)
28297 struct glyph_row *row;
28299 for (row = first_overlapping_row; row <= last_overlapping_row; ++row)
28300 if (row->overlapping_p)
28302 eassert (row->enabled_p && !row->mode_line_p);
28304 row->clip = r;
28305 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28306 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28308 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28309 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28311 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28312 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28313 row->clip = NULL;
28318 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
28320 static int
28321 phys_cursor_in_rect_p (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
28323 XRectangle cr, result;
28324 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
28325 struct glyph_row *row;
28327 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos >= 0
28328 && w->phys_cursor.vpos < w->current_matrix->nrows
28329 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos),
28330 row->enabled_p)
28331 && row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
28333 /* Cursor is in the fringe. */
28334 cr.x = window_box_right_offset (w,
28335 (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
28336 ? RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
28337 : TEXT_AREA));
28338 cr.y = row->y;
28339 cr.width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
28340 cr.height = row->height;
28341 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
28344 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
28345 if (cursor_glyph)
28347 /* r is relative to W's box, but w->phys_cursor.x is relative
28348 to left edge of W's TEXT area. Adjust it. */
28349 cr.x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + w->phys_cursor.x;
28350 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
28351 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
28352 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
28353 /* ++KFS: W32 version used W32-specific IntersectRect here, but
28354 I assume the effect is the same -- and this is portable. */
28355 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
28357 /* If we don't understand the format, pretend we're not in the hot-spot. */
28358 return 0;
28362 /* EXPORT:
28363 Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
28364 have vertical scroll bars. */
28366 void
28367 x_draw_vertical_border (struct window *w)
28369 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
28371 /* We could do better, if we knew what type of scroll-bar the adjacent
28372 windows (on either side) have... But we don't :-(
28373 However, I think this works ok. ++KFS 2003-04-25 */
28375 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
28376 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
28377 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
28378 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
28379 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (w->frame)))
28380 return;
28382 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
28383 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
28385 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
28387 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
28388 y1 -= 1;
28390 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
28391 x1 -= 1;
28393 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x1, y0, y1);
28395 else if (!WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
28396 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
28398 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
28400 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
28401 y1 -= 1;
28403 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
28404 x0 -= 1;
28406 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x0, y0, y1);
28411 /* Redraw the part of window W intersection rectangle FR. Pixel
28412 coordinates in FR are frame-relative. Call this function with
28413 input blocked. Value is non-zero if the exposure overwrites
28414 mouse-face. */
28416 static int
28417 expose_window (struct window *w, XRectangle *fr)
28419 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28420 XRectangle wr, r;
28421 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28423 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
28424 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
28425 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
28426 created window. */
28427 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
28428 return 0;
28430 /* When we're currently updating the window, display and current
28431 matrix usually don't agree. Arrange for a thorough display
28432 later. */
28433 if (w == updated_window)
28435 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
28436 return 0;
28439 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
28440 wr.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
28441 wr.y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
28442 wr.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
28443 wr.height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
28445 if (x_intersect_rectangles (fr, &wr, &r))
28447 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
28448 struct glyph_row *row;
28449 int cursor_cleared_p, phys_cursor_on_p;
28450 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row, *last_overlapping_row;
28452 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
28453 r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
28455 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
28456 r.x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
28457 r.y -= WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
28459 /* Turn off the cursor. */
28460 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
28461 && phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, &r))
28463 x_clear_cursor (w);
28464 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
28466 else
28467 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
28469 /* If the row containing the cursor extends face to end of line,
28470 then expose_area might overwrite the cursor outside the
28471 rectangle and thus notice_overwritten_cursor might clear
28472 w->phys_cursor_on_p. We remember the original value and
28473 check later if it is changed. */
28474 phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
28476 /* Update lines intersecting rectangle R. */
28477 first_overlapping_row = last_overlapping_row = NULL;
28478 for (row = w->current_matrix->rows;
28479 row->enabled_p;
28480 ++row)
28482 int y0 = row->y;
28483 int y1 = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row);
28485 if ((y0 >= r.y && y0 < r.y + r.height)
28486 || (y1 > r.y && y1 < r.y + r.height)
28487 || (r.y >= y0 && r.y < y1)
28488 || (r.y + r.height > y0 && r.y + r.height < y1))
28490 /* A header line may be overlapping, but there is no need
28491 to fix overlapping areas for them. KFS 2005-02-12 */
28492 if (row->overlapping_p && !row->mode_line_p)
28494 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
28495 first_overlapping_row = row;
28496 last_overlapping_row = row;
28499 row->clip = fr;
28500 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
28501 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
28502 row->clip = NULL;
28504 else if (row->overlapping_p)
28506 /* We must redraw a row overlapping the exposed area. */
28507 if (y0 < r.y
28508 ? y0 + row->phys_height > r.y
28509 : y0 + row->ascent - row->phys_ascent < r.y +r.height)
28511 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
28512 first_overlapping_row = row;
28513 last_overlapping_row = row;
28517 if (y1 >= yb)
28518 break;
28521 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
28522 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
28523 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
28524 row->enabled_p)
28525 && row->y < r.y + r.height)
28527 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
28528 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
28531 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
28533 /* Fix the display of overlapping rows. */
28534 if (first_overlapping_row)
28535 expose_overlaps (w, first_overlapping_row, last_overlapping_row,
28536 fr);
28538 /* Draw border between windows. */
28539 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
28541 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
28542 if (cursor_cleared_p
28543 || (phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p))
28544 update_window_cursor (w, 1);
28548 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
28553 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
28554 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. Value is
28555 non-zero if the exposure overwrites mouse-face. */
28557 static int
28558 expose_window_tree (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
28560 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28561 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28563 while (w && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28565 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
28566 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28567 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
28568 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
28569 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28570 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
28571 else
28572 mouse_face_overwritten_p |= expose_window (w, r);
28574 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next);
28577 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
28581 /* EXPORT:
28582 Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
28583 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
28584 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
28585 the entire frame. */
28587 void
28588 expose_frame (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int w, int h)
28590 XRectangle r;
28591 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28593 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
28595 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
28596 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28598 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
28599 return;
28602 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
28603 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
28604 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
28605 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
28606 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
28608 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
28609 return;
28612 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
28614 r.x = r.y = 0;
28615 r.width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) * FRAME_COLS (f);
28616 r.height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f);
28618 else
28620 r.x = x;
28621 r.y = y;
28622 r.width = w;
28623 r.height = h;
28626 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
28627 mouse_face_overwritten_p = expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
28629 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
28630 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28631 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window), &r);
28633 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28634 #ifndef MSDOS
28635 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
28636 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
28637 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28638 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), &r);
28639 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
28640 #endif
28641 #endif
28643 /* Some window managers support a focus-follows-mouse style with
28644 delayed raising of frames. Imagine a partially obscured frame,
28645 and moving the mouse into partially obscured mouse-face on that
28646 frame. The visible part of the mouse-face will be highlighted,
28647 then the WM raises the obscured frame. With at least one WM, KDE
28648 2.1, Emacs is not getting any event for the raising of the frame
28649 (even tried with SubstructureRedirectMask), only Expose events.
28650 These expose events will draw text normally, i.e. not
28651 highlighted. Which means we must redo the highlight here.
28652 Subsume it under ``we love X''. --gerd 2001-08-15 */
28653 /* Included in Windows version because Windows most likely does not
28654 do the right thing if any third party tool offers
28655 focus-follows-mouse with delayed raise. --jason 2001-10-12 */
28656 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28658 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28659 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
28661 int mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x;
28662 int mouse_y = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y;
28663 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28664 note_mouse_highlight (f, mouse_x, mouse_y);
28670 /* EXPORT:
28671 Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
28672 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
28673 empty. */
28676 x_intersect_rectangles (XRectangle *r1, XRectangle *r2, XRectangle *result)
28678 XRectangle *left, *right;
28679 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
28680 int intersection_p = 0;
28682 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
28683 if (r1->x < r2->x)
28684 left = r1, right = r2;
28685 else
28686 left = r2, right = r1;
28688 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
28689 otherwise there is no intersection. */
28690 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
28692 result->x = right->x;
28694 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of
28695 the right ends of left and right. */
28696 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
28697 - result->x);
28699 /* Same game for Y. */
28700 if (r1->y < r2->y)
28701 upper = r1, lower = r2;
28702 else
28703 upper = r2, lower = r1;
28705 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
28706 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
28707 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
28709 result->y = lower->y;
28711 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
28712 ends of upper and lower. */
28713 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
28714 upper->y + upper->height)
28715 - result->y);
28716 intersection_p = 1;
28720 return intersection_p;
28723 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28726 /***********************************************************************
28727 Initialization
28728 ***********************************************************************/
28730 void
28731 syms_of_xdisp (void)
28733 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
28734 staticpro (&Vwith_echo_area_save_vector);
28736 Vmessage_stack = Qnil;
28737 staticpro (&Vmessage_stack);
28739 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_redisplay, "inhibit-redisplay");
28740 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_internal, "redisplay_internal (C function)");
28742 message_dolog_marker1 = Fmake_marker ();
28743 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker1);
28744 message_dolog_marker2 = Fmake_marker ();
28745 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker2);
28746 message_dolog_marker3 = Fmake_marker ();
28747 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker3);
28749 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
28750 defsubr (&Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix);
28751 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_matrix);
28752 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_row);
28753 defsubr (&Sdump_tool_bar_row);
28754 defsubr (&Strace_redisplay);
28755 defsubr (&Strace_to_stderr);
28756 #endif
28757 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28758 defsubr (&Stool_bar_lines_needed);
28759 defsubr (&Slookup_image_map);
28760 #endif
28761 defsubr (&Sformat_mode_line);
28762 defsubr (&Sinvisible_p);
28763 defsubr (&Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction);
28765 DEFSYM (Qmenu_bar_update_hook, "menu-bar-update-hook");
28766 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, "overriding-terminal-local-map");
28767 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_local_map, "overriding-local-map");
28768 DEFSYM (Qwindow_scroll_functions, "window-scroll-functions");
28769 DEFSYM (Qwindow_text_change_functions, "window-text-change-functions");
28770 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions, "redisplay-end-trigger-functions");
28771 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, "inhibit-point-motion-hooks");
28772 DEFSYM (Qeval, "eval");
28773 DEFSYM (QCdata, ":data");
28774 DEFSYM (Qdisplay, "display");
28775 DEFSYM (Qspace_width, "space-width");
28776 DEFSYM (Qraise, "raise");
28777 DEFSYM (Qslice, "slice");
28778 DEFSYM (Qspace, "space");
28779 DEFSYM (Qmargin, "margin");
28780 DEFSYM (Qpointer, "pointer");
28781 DEFSYM (Qleft_margin, "left-margin");
28782 DEFSYM (Qright_margin, "right-margin");
28783 DEFSYM (Qcenter, "center");
28784 DEFSYM (Qline_height, "line-height");
28785 DEFSYM (QCalign_to, ":align-to");
28786 DEFSYM (QCrelative_width, ":relative-width");
28787 DEFSYM (QCrelative_height, ":relative-height");
28788 DEFSYM (QCeval, ":eval");
28789 DEFSYM (QCpropertize, ":propertize");
28790 DEFSYM (QCfile, ":file");
28791 DEFSYM (Qfontified, "fontified");
28792 DEFSYM (Qfontification_functions, "fontification-functions");
28793 DEFSYM (Qtrailing_whitespace, "trailing-whitespace");
28794 DEFSYM (Qescape_glyph, "escape-glyph");
28795 DEFSYM (Qnobreak_space, "nobreak-space");
28796 DEFSYM (Qimage, "image");
28797 DEFSYM (Qtext, "text");
28798 DEFSYM (Qboth, "both");
28799 DEFSYM (Qboth_horiz, "both-horiz");
28800 DEFSYM (Qtext_image_horiz, "text-image-horiz");
28801 DEFSYM (QCmap, ":map");
28802 DEFSYM (QCpointer, ":pointer");
28803 DEFSYM (Qrect, "rect");
28804 DEFSYM (Qcircle, "circle");
28805 DEFSYM (Qpoly, "poly");
28806 DEFSYM (Qmessage_truncate_lines, "message-truncate-lines");
28807 DEFSYM (Qgrow_only, "grow-only");
28808 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_menubar_update, "inhibit-menubar-update");
28809 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay, "inhibit-eval-during-redisplay");
28810 DEFSYM (Qposition, "position");
28811 DEFSYM (Qbuffer_position, "buffer-position");
28812 DEFSYM (Qobject, "object");
28813 DEFSYM (Qbar, "bar");
28814 DEFSYM (Qhbar, "hbar");
28815 DEFSYM (Qbox, "box");
28816 DEFSYM (Qhollow, "hollow");
28817 DEFSYM (Qhand, "hand");
28818 DEFSYM (Qarrow, "arrow");
28819 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, "inhibit-free-realized-faces");
28821 list_of_error = Fcons (Fcons (intern_c_string ("error"),
28822 Fcons (intern_c_string ("void-variable"), Qnil)),
28823 Qnil);
28824 staticpro (&list_of_error);
28826 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_position, "last-arrow-position");
28827 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_string, "last-arrow-string");
28828 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_string, "overlay-arrow-string");
28829 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap, "overlay-arrow-bitmap");
28831 echo_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1] = Qnil;
28832 staticpro (&echo_buffer[0]);
28833 staticpro (&echo_buffer[1]);
28835 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
28836 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[0]);
28837 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[1]);
28839 Vmessages_buffer_name = build_pure_c_string ("*Messages*");
28840 staticpro (&Vmessages_buffer_name);
28842 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
28843 staticpro (&mode_line_proptrans_alist);
28844 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
28845 staticpro (&mode_line_string_list);
28846 mode_line_string_face = Qnil;
28847 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face);
28848 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
28849 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face_prop);
28850 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
28851 staticpro (&Vmode_line_unwind_vector);
28853 DEFSYM (Qmode_line_default_help_echo, "mode-line-default-help-echo");
28855 help_echo_string = Qnil;
28856 staticpro (&help_echo_string);
28857 help_echo_object = Qnil;
28858 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
28859 help_echo_window = Qnil;
28860 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
28861 previous_help_echo_string = Qnil;
28862 staticpro (&previous_help_echo_string);
28863 help_echo_pos = -1;
28865 DEFSYM (Qright_to_left, "right-to-left");
28866 DEFSYM (Qleft_to_right, "left-to-right");
28868 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28869 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", x_stretch_cursor_p,
28870 doc: /* Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.
28871 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as
28872 wide as that tab on the display. */);
28873 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
28874 #endif
28876 DEFVAR_LISP ("show-trailing-whitespace", Vshow_trailing_whitespace,
28877 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight trailing whitespace.
28878 The face used for trailing whitespace is `trailing-whitespace'. */);
28879 Vshow_trailing_whitespace = Qnil;
28881 DEFVAR_LISP ("nobreak-char-display", Vnobreak_char_display,
28882 doc: /* Control highlighting of non-ASCII space and hyphen chars.
28883 If the value is t, Emacs highlights non-ASCII chars which have the
28884 same appearance as an ASCII space or hyphen, using the `nobreak-space'
28885 or `escape-glyph' face respectively.
28887 U+00A0 (no-break space), U+00AD (soft hyphen), U+2010 (hyphen), and
28888 U+2011 (non-breaking hyphen) are affected.
28890 Any other non-nil value means to display these characters as a escape
28891 glyph followed by an ordinary space or hyphen.
28893 A value of nil means no special handling of these characters. */);
28894 Vnobreak_char_display = Qt;
28896 DEFVAR_LISP ("void-text-area-pointer", Vvoid_text_area_pointer,
28897 doc: /* The pointer shape to show in void text areas.
28898 A value of nil means to show the text pointer. Other options are `arrow',
28899 `text', `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'. */);
28900 Vvoid_text_area_pointer = Qarrow;
28902 DEFVAR_LISP ("inhibit-redisplay", Vinhibit_redisplay,
28903 doc: /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay.
28904 This is used for internal purposes. */);
28905 Vinhibit_redisplay = Qnil;
28907 DEFVAR_LISP ("global-mode-string", Vglobal_mode_string,
28908 doc: /* String (or mode line construct) included (normally) in `mode-line-format'. */);
28909 Vglobal_mode_string = Qnil;
28911 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-position", Voverlay_arrow_position,
28912 doc: /* Marker for where to display an arrow on top of the buffer text.
28913 This must be the beginning of a line in order to work.
28914 See also `overlay-arrow-string'. */);
28915 Voverlay_arrow_position = Qnil;
28917 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-string", Voverlay_arrow_string,
28918 doc: /* String to display as an arrow in non-window frames.
28919 See also `overlay-arrow-position'. */);
28920 Voverlay_arrow_string = build_pure_c_string ("=>");
28922 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-variable-list", Voverlay_arrow_variable_list,
28923 doc: /* List of variables (symbols) which hold markers for overlay arrows.
28924 The symbols on this list are examined during redisplay to determine
28925 where to display overlay arrows. */);
28926 Voverlay_arrow_variable_list
28927 = Fcons (intern_c_string ("overlay-arrow-position"), Qnil);
28929 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-step", emacs_scroll_step,
28930 doc: /* The number of lines to try scrolling a window by when point moves out.
28931 If that fails to bring point back on frame, point is centered instead.
28932 If this is zero, point is always centered after it moves off frame.
28933 If you want scrolling to always be a line at a time, you should set
28934 `scroll-conservatively' to a large value rather than set this to 1. */);
28936 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-conservatively", scroll_conservatively,
28937 doc: /* Scroll up to this many lines, to bring point back on screen.
28938 If point moves off-screen, redisplay will scroll by up to
28939 `scroll-conservatively' lines in order to bring point just barely
28940 onto the screen again. If that cannot be done, then redisplay
28941 recenters point as usual.
28943 If the value is greater than 100, redisplay will never recenter point,
28944 but will always scroll just enough text to bring point into view, even
28945 if you move far away.
28947 A value of zero means always recenter point if it moves off screen. */);
28948 scroll_conservatively = 0;
28950 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-margin", scroll_margin,
28951 doc: /* Number of lines of margin at the top and bottom of a window.
28952 Recenter the window whenever point gets within this many lines
28953 of the top or bottom of the window. */);
28954 scroll_margin = 0;
28956 DEFVAR_LISP ("display-pixels-per-inch", Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch,
28957 doc: /* Pixels per inch value for non-window system displays.
28958 Value is a number or a cons (WIDTH-DPI . HEIGHT-DPI). */);
28959 Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch = make_float (72.0);
28961 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
28962 DEFVAR_INT ("debug-end-pos", debug_end_pos, doc: /* Don't ask. */);
28963 #endif
28965 DEFVAR_LISP ("truncate-partial-width-windows",
28966 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows,
28967 doc: /* Non-nil means truncate lines in windows narrower than the frame.
28968 For an integer value, truncate lines in each window narrower than the
28969 full frame width, provided the window width is less than that integer;
28970 otherwise, respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28972 For any other non-nil value, truncate lines in all windows that do
28973 not span the full frame width.
28975 A value of nil means to respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28977 If `word-wrap' is enabled, you might want to reduce this. */);
28978 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows = make_number (50);
28980 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-number-display-limit", Vline_number_display_limit,
28981 doc: /* Maximum buffer size for which line number should be displayed.
28982 If the buffer is bigger than this, the line number does not appear
28983 in the mode line. A value of nil means no limit. */);
28984 Vline_number_display_limit = Qnil;
28986 DEFVAR_INT ("line-number-display-limit-width",
28987 line_number_display_limit_width,
28988 doc: /* Maximum line width (in characters) for line number display.
28989 If the average length of the lines near point is bigger than this, then the
28990 line number may be omitted from the mode line. */);
28991 line_number_display_limit_width = 200;
28993 DEFVAR_BOOL ("highlight-nonselected-windows", highlight_nonselected_windows,
28994 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight region even in nonselected windows. */);
28995 highlight_nonselected_windows = 0;
28997 DEFVAR_BOOL ("multiple-frames", multiple_frames,
28998 doc: /* Non-nil if more than one frame is visible on this display.
28999 Minibuffer-only frames don't count, but iconified frames do.
29000 This variable is not guaranteed to be accurate except while processing
29001 `frame-title-format' and `icon-title-format'. */);
29003 DEFVAR_LISP ("frame-title-format", Vframe_title_format,
29004 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of visible frames.
29005 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
29007 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format', except that
29008 the %c and %l constructs are ignored. It is used only on frames for
29009 which no explicit name has been set \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
29011 DEFVAR_LISP ("icon-title-format", Vicon_title_format,
29012 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of an iconified frame.
29013 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
29014 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format' (which see),
29015 and is used only on frames for which no explicit name has been set
29016 \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
29017 Vicon_title_format
29018 = Vframe_title_format
29019 = listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 3,
29020 intern_c_string ("multiple-frames"),
29021 build_pure_c_string ("%b"),
29022 listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 4,
29023 empty_unibyte_string,
29024 intern_c_string ("invocation-name"),
29025 build_pure_c_string ("@"),
29026 intern_c_string ("system-name")));
29028 DEFVAR_LISP ("message-log-max", Vmessage_log_max,
29029 doc: /* Maximum number of lines to keep in the message log buffer.
29030 If nil, disable message logging. If t, log messages but don't truncate
29031 the buffer when it becomes large. */);
29032 Vmessage_log_max = make_number (1000);
29034 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-size-change-functions", Vwindow_size_change_functions,
29035 doc: /* Functions called before redisplay, if window sizes have changed.
29036 The value should be a list of functions that take one argument.
29037 Just before redisplay, for each frame, if any of its windows have changed
29038 size since the last redisplay, or have been split or deleted,
29039 all the functions in the list are called, with the frame as argument. */);
29040 Vwindow_size_change_functions = Qnil;
29042 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-scroll-functions", Vwindow_scroll_functions,
29043 doc: /* List of functions to call before redisplaying a window with scrolling.
29044 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and its new
29045 display-start position. Note that these functions are also called by
29046 `set-window-buffer'. Also note that the value of `window-end' is not
29047 valid when these functions are called.
29049 Warning: Do not use this feature to alter the way the window
29050 is scrolled. It is not designed for that, and such use probably won't
29051 work. */);
29052 Vwindow_scroll_functions = Qnil;
29054 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-text-change-functions",
29055 Vwindow_text_change_functions,
29056 doc: /* Functions to call in redisplay when text in the window might change. */);
29057 Vwindow_text_change_functions = Qnil;
29059 DEFVAR_LISP ("redisplay-end-trigger-functions", Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions,
29060 doc: /* Functions called when redisplay of a window reaches the end trigger.
29061 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and the end trigger value.
29062 See `set-window-redisplay-end-trigger'. */);
29063 Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions = Qnil;
29065 DEFVAR_LISP ("mouse-autoselect-window", Vmouse_autoselect_window,
29066 doc: /* Non-nil means autoselect window with mouse pointer.
29067 If nil, do not autoselect windows.
29068 A positive number means delay autoselection by that many seconds: a
29069 window is autoselected only after the mouse has remained in that
29070 window for the duration of the delay.
29071 A negative number has a similar effect, but causes windows to be
29072 autoselected only after the mouse has stopped moving. \(Because of
29073 the way Emacs compares mouse events, you will occasionally wait twice
29074 that time before the window gets selected.\)
29075 Any other value means to autoselect window instantaneously when the
29076 mouse pointer enters it.
29078 Autoselection selects the minibuffer only if it is active, and never
29079 unselects the minibuffer if it is active.
29081 When customizing this variable make sure that the actual value of
29082 `focus-follows-mouse' matches the behavior of your window manager. */);
29083 Vmouse_autoselect_window = Qnil;
29085 DEFVAR_LISP ("auto-resize-tool-bars", Vauto_resize_tool_bars,
29086 doc: /* Non-nil means automatically resize tool-bars.
29087 This dynamically changes the tool-bar's height to the minimum height
29088 that is needed to make all tool-bar items visible.
29089 If value is `grow-only', the tool-bar's height is only increased
29090 automatically; to decrease the tool-bar height, use \\[recenter]. */);
29091 Vauto_resize_tool_bars = Qt;
29093 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons", auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p,
29094 doc: /* Non-nil means raise tool-bar buttons when the mouse moves over them. */);
29095 auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p = 1;
29097 DEFVAR_BOOL ("make-cursor-line-fully-visible", make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p,
29098 doc: /* Non-nil means to scroll (recenter) cursor line if it is not fully visible. */);
29099 make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p = 1;
29101 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-border", Vtool_bar_border,
29102 doc: /* Border below tool-bar in pixels.
29103 If an integer, use it as the height of the border.
29104 If it is one of `internal-border-width' or `border-width', use the
29105 value of the corresponding frame parameter.
29106 Otherwise, no border is added below the tool-bar. */);
29107 Vtool_bar_border = Qinternal_border_width;
29109 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-button-margin", Vtool_bar_button_margin,
29110 doc: /* Margin around tool-bar buttons in pixels.
29111 If an integer, use that for both horizontal and vertical margins.
29112 Otherwise, value should be a pair of integers `(HORZ . VERT)' with
29113 HORZ specifying the horizontal margin, and VERT specifying the
29114 vertical margin. */);
29115 Vtool_bar_button_margin = make_number (DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN);
29117 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-button-relief", tool_bar_button_relief,
29118 doc: /* Relief thickness of tool-bar buttons. */);
29119 tool_bar_button_relief = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
29121 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-style", Vtool_bar_style,
29122 doc: /* Tool bar style to use.
29123 It can be one of
29124 image - show images only
29125 text - show text only
29126 both - show both, text below image
29127 both-horiz - show text to the right of the image
29128 text-image-horiz - show text to the left of the image
29129 any other - use system default or image if no system default.
29131 This variable only affects the GTK+ toolkit version of Emacs. */);
29132 Vtool_bar_style = Qnil;
29134 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-max-label-size", tool_bar_max_label_size,
29135 doc: /* Maximum number of characters a label can have to be shown.
29136 The tool bar style must also show labels for this to have any effect, see
29137 `tool-bar-style'. */);
29138 tool_bar_max_label_size = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_LABEL_SIZE;
29140 DEFVAR_LISP ("fontification-functions", Vfontification_functions,
29141 doc: /* List of functions to call to fontify regions of text.
29142 Each function is called with one argument POS. Functions must
29143 fontify a region starting at POS in the current buffer, and give
29144 fontified regions the property `fontified'. */);
29145 Vfontification_functions = Qnil;
29146 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qfontification_functions);
29148 DEFVAR_BOOL ("unibyte-display-via-language-environment",
29149 unibyte_display_via_language_environment,
29150 doc: /* Non-nil means display unibyte text according to language environment.
29151 Specifically, this means that raw bytes in the range 160-255 decimal
29152 are displayed by converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters
29153 according to the current language environment. As a result, they are
29154 displayed according to the current fontset.
29156 Note that this variable affects only how these bytes are displayed,
29157 but does not change the fact they are interpreted as raw bytes. */);
29158 unibyte_display_via_language_environment = 0;
29160 DEFVAR_LISP ("max-mini-window-height", Vmax_mini_window_height,
29161 doc: /* Maximum height for resizing mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29162 If a float, it specifies a fraction of the mini-window frame's height.
29163 If an integer, it specifies a number of lines. */);
29164 Vmax_mini_window_height = make_float (0.25);
29166 DEFVAR_LISP ("resize-mini-windows", Vresize_mini_windows,
29167 doc: /* How to resize mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29168 A value of nil means don't automatically resize mini-windows.
29169 A value of t means resize them to fit the text displayed in them.
29170 A value of `grow-only', the default, means let mini-windows grow only;
29171 they return to their normal size when the minibuffer is closed, or the
29172 echo area becomes empty. */);
29173 Vresize_mini_windows = Qgrow_only;
29175 DEFVAR_LISP ("blink-cursor-alist", Vblink_cursor_alist,
29176 doc: /* Alist specifying how to blink the cursor off.
29177 Each element has the form (ON-STATE . OFF-STATE). Whenever the
29178 `cursor-type' frame-parameter or variable equals ON-STATE,
29179 comparing using `equal', Emacs uses OFF-STATE to specify
29180 how to blink it off. ON-STATE and OFF-STATE are values for
29181 the `cursor-type' frame parameter.
29183 If a frame's ON-STATE has no entry in this list,
29184 the frame's other specifications determine how to blink the cursor off. */);
29185 Vblink_cursor_alist = Qnil;
29187 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-hscroll-mode", automatic_hscrolling_p,
29188 doc: /* Allow or disallow automatic horizontal scrolling of windows.
29189 If non-nil, windows are automatically scrolled horizontally to make
29190 point visible. */);
29191 automatic_hscrolling_p = 1;
29192 DEFSYM (Qauto_hscroll_mode, "auto-hscroll-mode");
29194 DEFVAR_INT ("hscroll-margin", hscroll_margin,
29195 doc: /* How many columns away from the window edge point is allowed to get
29196 before automatic hscrolling will horizontally scroll the window. */);
29197 hscroll_margin = 5;
29199 DEFVAR_LISP ("hscroll-step", Vhscroll_step,
29200 doc: /* How many columns to scroll the window when point gets too close to the edge.
29201 When point is less than `hscroll-margin' columns from the window
29202 edge, automatic hscrolling will scroll the window by the amount of columns
29203 determined by this variable. If its value is a positive integer, scroll that
29204 many columns. If it's a positive floating-point number, it specifies the
29205 fraction of the window's width to scroll. If it's nil or zero, point will be
29206 centered horizontally after the scroll. Any other value, including negative
29207 numbers, are treated as if the value were zero.
29209 Automatic hscrolling always moves point outside the scroll margin, so if
29210 point was more than scroll step columns inside the margin, the window will
29211 scroll more than the value given by the scroll step.
29213 Note that the lower bound for automatic hscrolling specified by `scroll-left'
29214 and `scroll-right' overrides this variable's effect. */);
29215 Vhscroll_step = make_number (0);
29217 DEFVAR_BOOL ("message-truncate-lines", message_truncate_lines,
29218 doc: /* If non-nil, messages are truncated instead of resizing the echo area.
29219 Bind this around calls to `message' to let it take effect. */);
29220 message_truncate_lines = 0;
29222 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-bar-update-hook", Vmenu_bar_update_hook,
29223 doc: /* Normal hook run to update the menu bar definitions.
29224 Redisplay runs this hook before it redisplays the menu bar.
29225 This is used to update submenus such as Buffers,
29226 whose contents depend on various data. */);
29227 Vmenu_bar_update_hook = Qnil;
29229 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-updating-frame", Vmenu_updating_frame,
29230 doc: /* Frame for which we are updating a menu.
29231 The enable predicate for a menu binding should check this variable. */);
29232 Vmenu_updating_frame = Qnil;
29234 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-menubar-update", inhibit_menubar_update,
29235 doc: /* Non-nil means don't update menu bars. Internal use only. */);
29236 inhibit_menubar_update = 0;
29238 DEFVAR_LISP ("wrap-prefix", Vwrap_prefix,
29239 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all continuation lines at display time.
29240 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29241 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29243 This variable is overridden by any `wrap-prefix' text or overlay
29244 property.
29246 To add a prefix to non-continuation lines, use `line-prefix'. */);
29247 Vwrap_prefix = Qnil;
29248 DEFSYM (Qwrap_prefix, "wrap-prefix");
29249 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qwrap_prefix);
29251 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-prefix", Vline_prefix,
29252 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all non-continuation lines at display time.
29253 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29254 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29256 This variable is overridden by any `line-prefix' text or overlay
29257 property.
29259 To add a prefix to continuation lines, use `wrap-prefix'. */);
29260 Vline_prefix = Qnil;
29261 DEFSYM (Qline_prefix, "line-prefix");
29262 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qline_prefix);
29264 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-eval-during-redisplay", inhibit_eval_during_redisplay,
29265 doc: /* Non-nil means don't eval Lisp during redisplay. */);
29266 inhibit_eval_during_redisplay = 0;
29268 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-free-realized-faces", inhibit_free_realized_faces,
29269 doc: /* Non-nil means don't free realized faces. Internal use only. */);
29270 inhibit_free_realized_faces = 0;
29272 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
29273 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-id", inhibit_try_window_id,
29274 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_id display optimization. */);
29275 inhibit_try_window_id = 0;
29277 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-reusing", inhibit_try_window_reusing,
29278 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_reusing display optimization. */);
29279 inhibit_try_window_reusing = 0;
29281 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-cursor-movement", inhibit_try_cursor_movement,
29282 doc: /* Inhibit try_cursor_movement display optimization. */);
29283 inhibit_try_cursor_movement = 0;
29284 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
29286 DEFVAR_INT ("overline-margin", overline_margin,
29287 doc: /* Space between overline and text, in pixels.
29288 The default value is 2: the height of the overline (1 pixel) plus 1 pixel
29289 margin to the character height. */);
29290 overline_margin = 2;
29292 DEFVAR_INT ("underline-minimum-offset",
29293 underline_minimum_offset,
29294 doc: /* Minimum distance between baseline and underline.
29295 This can improve legibility of underlined text at small font sizes,
29296 particularly when using variable `x-use-underline-position-properties'
29297 with fonts that specify an UNDERLINE_POSITION relatively close to the
29298 baseline. The default value is 1. */);
29299 underline_minimum_offset = 1;
29301 DEFVAR_BOOL ("display-hourglass", display_hourglass_p,
29302 doc: /* Non-nil means show an hourglass pointer, when Emacs is busy.
29303 This feature only works when on a window system that can change
29304 cursor shapes. */);
29305 display_hourglass_p = 1;
29307 DEFVAR_LISP ("hourglass-delay", Vhourglass_delay,
29308 doc: /* Seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass pointer when Emacs is busy. */);
29309 Vhourglass_delay = make_number (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY);
29311 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
29312 hourglass_shown_p = 0;
29314 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char, "glyphless-char");
29315 DEFSYM (Qhex_code, "hex-code");
29316 DEFSYM (Qempty_box, "empty-box");
29317 DEFSYM (Qthin_space, "thin-space");
29318 DEFSYM (Qzero_width, "zero-width");
29320 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char_display, "glyphless-char-display");
29321 /* Intern this now in case it isn't already done.
29322 Setting this variable twice is harmless.
29323 But don't staticpro it here--that is done in alloc.c. */
29324 Qchar_table_extra_slots = intern_c_string ("char-table-extra-slots");
29325 Fput (Qglyphless_char_display, Qchar_table_extra_slots, make_number (1));
29327 DEFVAR_LISP ("glyphless-char-display", Vglyphless_char_display,
29328 doc: /* Char-table defining glyphless characters.
29329 Each element, if non-nil, should be one of the following:
29330 an ASCII acronym string: display this string in a box
29331 `hex-code': display the hexadecimal code of a character in a box
29332 `empty-box': display as an empty box
29333 `thin-space': display as 1-pixel width space
29334 `zero-width': don't display
29335 An element may also be a cons cell (GRAPHICAL . TEXT), which specifies the
29336 display method for graphical terminals and text terminals respectively.
29337 GRAPHICAL and TEXT should each have one of the values listed above.
29339 The char-table has one extra slot to control the display of a character for
29340 which no font is found. This slot only takes effect on graphical terminals.
29341 Its value should be an ASCII acronym string, `hex-code', `empty-box', or
29342 `thin-space'. The default is `empty-box'. */);
29343 Vglyphless_char_display = Fmake_char_table (Qglyphless_char_display, Qnil);
29344 Fset_char_table_extra_slot (Vglyphless_char_display, make_number (0),
29345 Qempty_box);
29347 DEFVAR_LISP ("debug-on-message", Vdebug_on_message,
29348 doc: /* If non-nil, debug if a message matching this regexp is displayed. */);
29349 Vdebug_on_message = Qnil;
29353 /* Initialize this module when Emacs starts. */
29355 void
29356 init_xdisp (void)
29358 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
29360 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
29362 if (!noninteractive)
29364 struct window *m = XWINDOW (minibuf_window);
29365 Lisp_Object frame = m->frame;
29366 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
29367 Lisp_Object root = FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f);
29368 struct window *r = XWINDOW (root);
29369 int i;
29371 echo_area_window = minibuf_window;
29373 wset_top_line (r, make_number (FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)));
29374 wset_total_lines
29375 (r, make_number (FRAME_LINES (f) - 1 - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)));
29376 wset_total_cols (r, make_number (FRAME_COLS (f)));
29377 wset_top_line (m, make_number (FRAME_LINES (f) - 1));
29378 wset_total_lines (m, make_number (1));
29379 wset_total_cols (m, make_number (FRAME_COLS (f)));
29381 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = scratch_glyphs;
29382 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA + 1]
29383 = scratch_glyphs + MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS;
29385 /* The default ellipsis glyphs `...'. */
29386 for (i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
29387 default_invis_vector[i] = make_number ('.');
29391 /* Allocate the buffer for frame titles.
29392 Also used for `format-mode-line'. */
29393 int size = 100;
29394 mode_line_noprop_buf = xmalloc (size);
29395 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
29396 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf;
29397 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
29400 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
29403 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
29405 /* Cancel a currently active hourglass timer, and start a new one. */
29406 void
29407 start_hourglass (void)
29409 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
29410 EMACS_TIME delay;
29412 cancel_hourglass ();
29414 if (INTEGERP (Vhourglass_delay)
29415 && XINT (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
29416 delay = make_emacs_time (min (XINT (Vhourglass_delay),
29417 TYPE_MAXIMUM (time_t)),
29419 else if (FLOATP (Vhourglass_delay)
29420 && XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
29421 delay = EMACS_TIME_FROM_DOUBLE (XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay));
29422 else
29423 delay = make_emacs_time (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY, 0);
29425 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
29427 extern void w32_note_current_window (void);
29428 w32_note_current_window ();
29430 #endif /* HAVE_NTGUI */
29432 hourglass_atimer = start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, delay,
29433 show_hourglass, NULL);
29434 #endif
29438 /* Cancel the hourglass cursor timer if active, hide a busy cursor if
29439 shown. */
29440 void
29441 cancel_hourglass (void)
29443 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
29444 if (hourglass_atimer)
29446 cancel_atimer (hourglass_atimer);
29447 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
29450 if (hourglass_shown_p)
29451 hide_hourglass ();
29452 #endif